= $e * AMERICAN JOURNAL Se. NEW HAVEN: Bold by A. eo ‘MALTBY and B. & W. NOYES.—Philadelphia, CAREY & HART and J. 8. LITTELL.—Baltimore, Md., N. HICKMAN.—New York, “CARVILL & Co., No. 108 Broadway, and G. 8. SILLIMAN, No. 44 Wil. Pe . St.—Boston, C. C. LITTLE E & Co.—London, JAMES ss. IODSO;! ; yi Sere fea 8 St. and WILEY & PUTNAM, 35 Pat ternoster Row.—Paris, Af RRON, Rue Mabillon.—Hamburgh, Messrs. NESTLER PRINTED BY B. L. HAMLEN. CONTENTS. Art. I. Meteorologital Observations during a Residence in Co- lombia, between the Years 1820 and 1830; by Col. Richard Wright, . ; II. Remarks on the Trilobite; by Prof. Grea, M. D, Ill. Description of a New Trilobite ; by Prof. Jacob Green, " IV. On the Natural History of Volcanos and eee by Prof. Gustav Bischof, A V. Reply of Dr. Daubeny to Prof. Bischof ’s Objection to the Chemical Theories of Volcanos, VI. Mountains in New York; by E. F. Johnson, ~ VII. Account of a Tornado; by Willis Gaylord, ~~ - VIII. On Meteoric Stones—From the Annual Account of the Progress of Physics and Chemistry ; by Berzelius, IX. Terrestrial Magnetism ; by J. Hamilton, Bs Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen, with Soaks on Hemming’s Safety Tube; by Prof. J. W. Webster, XI. On the Greek Conjugations ; by Prof. J: W. Gibbs, XII. Notice of Prof. Ehrenberg’s Discoveries in relation to Fossil Animalcules ; also Notices of Deceased Mem- bers of the Geological Society of London, being ex- tracts from the Address of Rev. William Whewell, B. D. F.R.S., . ets tee e XIII. Account of a Meteor seen in Connecticut, December 14, 1837; with some considerations on the Meteo- rite which exploded near Weston, Dec. 14, 1807; By Edward C. Herrick, : ‘ , XIV. Some Notice of British Naturalists ; by Rey. Charles Fox, : - S MISCELLANIES. 1. Pictorial delineations by light; solar, lunar, stellar, and arti- ficial, called Photogenic and the art Photography, . 2. Correction of an Error—Cinnabar not found in Michigan, Page. 116 130 136 185 ~ 22. Formation of Metallic Veins by tilsaaig Ageney, be ata : ii CONTENTS. Page. ; 3, 4. An Essay on the Development and Modifications of the external Organs of Plants—Journal of the Essex County 4 (Mass.) Natural History Society, . ‘ . 18% 4 5. Transactions of the American Philosophical Society, . 188 6, 7. Notice of the Journal of the Statistical Society of London. —Progress of the U. S, Exploring Expedition, F - Jee 7 8, 9. Cold Bokkeveld Meteorites—Meteoric Iron from Potosi, 190 12. Latanium, a New Metal, : 13, Biography of Scientific Men, . 193° « 14, 15, 16. Note by Mr. E. F. Johnson, Civil Engin A Nor- thern Lynx taken in Connecticut—Preservation Geapinal Fat for Soap Making, 10, 11. Encke’s Comet—Remains of the Mastodon i in Rent 191 192 17. Notice of Vespertilio Pruinosus and Ioterus Phe 19% 18. Malaria, . é 19€ | 19. Electrical Bitliewent i in isthe: by itt > dee 197 20, 21. Great Scheme for Magnetical Observations—Action of * Spungy Platina, To our Subscribers and Readers, . at . 200° 1 7 ya RRR SS Sie Rs gf I ee By c calomath Pe oe CONDUCTED BY BENJAMIN SILLIMAN, M.D. LL.D. Prof. Chem., Min., &c. in Yale Coll.; Cor. Mem. Soc. Arts, Man. and Com. Cor. Mem. Met. Soc. > and Por. Mem. Geal. § Fa haga Hon. Me . Br, and For. Abor. ProreeszSoc , Mem. Geol, ee ‘See., and Hon. ideas Tits ang S Sots., 35 ern, Roy..Min. Soc., Dresden; Nat. os Bist. oe burp. a mune he t. at. Sots Belfast, sae Soap and eo 2 bit. Boc., fine Ra ; Hon. Me m, Rey: meee x st, ne apbion, Eng.; Cor. em: 7m and of the : hens, sg T3 ang vue. ace Quebec ; Mem. = variou i. and Scien. Sec: in the U. Sta ‘ AIDED BY = BBNJAMIN SILLIMAN, Jn., ae: 31 exént of: vara nei Mineralogy and Goto in Yale College; Gor: Mee. See =sagp a . ee ge ist. Soc., Mem. of the Conn. he srinaticg, New v York, &c, a No, 1.—JULY, 1839. Bis. Sold by A. H. MALTBY and B. & = i el hia, CAREY. & RT and J... LITTELL Baltimore, Mi, N. WICKM AN Neu! York, VE Con anrtharenac eto vase trowel pie ote pyloric ile th ee ebiem ged ahha onreghgiairy Space wPiictet og Re. 108 Brostvete “and G. &. SILEIMAN, ae wit ¢. LYPELE & Co.— pot HO ere peraem ACKNOWLEDGMENTS TO CORRESPONDENTS, FRIENDS AND STRANGERS. Remarks.—This method of acknowledgment has been adopt- ed, because it is not always practicable to write letters, where they might be reasonably expected; and still more difficult is it to prepare and insert in this Journal; notices of all the books, pamph- lets, &c., which are kindly presented, even in cases, where such no- tices, thecal or commendatory, would be appropriate ; for it is often equally impossible to command the fime requisite to frame them, or even to read the works; still, judicious remarks, from other hands, would usually find both acceptance and insertion. In-public, it is rarely prgper to advert to personal concerns ; to excuse, for instance, : any apparent neglect of courtesy, by pleading the unintermitting pressure of labor, and the numerous calls of our fellow-men for information, advice, or assistance, in lines of duty, with which they presume us to be acquainted. The apology, implied in this remark, is drawn from us, that we may = not seem inattentive to the civilities of many respectable persons, au- “thors, editors, publishers, and others, both at home and abroad. It is still our endeavor to reply to all letters which appear to require an answer ; although, as a substitute, many acknowledgments are made in these pages, which may sometimes be, in part, retrospective. — Eds. ‘ a se la SCIENCE.—FOREIGN. ‘Important facts embracing man in Peicr, A A.M. London, 1837, grommet can ag ale a Lethea Geognostica, by Prof. H. G. Bronn, thes last Livraisons, with the index and table of contents. Author Observations on some new Organic Remains in Flint of Chalk, by Rev. J. B. Read, M. A., F. R. S. London, 1838. From G Mantell, Esq. Works of Confucius in Chinese, from the Rev. Mr. Dickinson, American missionary, for the ema < Yale College. _— 2 the Indian , by J. H. gapore, 1837, Vol. I, en for the Library f Yale Colleze, front Rev. J. F, ‘Dickinson, Singapore. 2 : Chart, exhibiting the plan proposed by Lieut. John Fayer, R. N. Commander of the steamship Liverpool, for extinguishing by steam, fires arising from spontaneous combustion of coals in other parts of a vessel. January, 1838. From Messrs. Abraham Bell & Co., con- signees of the Liverpool steamship, New York. British Annual and Epitome of the Progress of Science, for 1839. Edited by Robert D. Thomson, M. D. London. Hippolyte Ba- illiere, 1838. From the Author Consistency of the Discoveries of Modern Geology with the Sa- cred History of the Creation and the Deluge, by Prof. Silliman of Yale Sollee. Reprint by J. S. Hodson, ‘112 Fleet st. London, odson. The Seventh Report of the British Association for the Advance- ment of Science, Vol. VI. From the mesoeeetion. London. Jobn Murray, Peaabeetk of the Society for the Enebdrazerent of Arts, Man- ufactures and Commerce, Vol. LI, Part II, and Vol. LII, Part I. From the Society through A. Akin, Esq. London, 1838. Institution of Civil Engineers. Minutes of Proceedings and Ses- sions 1838 and 1839, pp. 52 and 26. London, 1838, 1839. From the Institute of Civil Enginee ers. almer’s New Catalogue of Chemical and Ebilspophice appara- tus. Several copies. London, 1838. From Mr. r. A Catalocue of Ancient and Modern Botanical Books, offered for sale by O. Rich. From O. Rich Henry Coxhead’s Catalogues of New Scientific Books. The Silurian System founded on Geological Researches, in the & Counties of Salop, Hereford, &c., with descriptions of the Coalfields — and overlying arts by Roderick Impey Murchison, F. R. S., F.L.S., in two parts, 4to., including an atlas of drawings and large separate see From the author. London, John Murray, Alber- marl st. 1839. A magnificent work. Part of the Poissons Fossiles of Prof. Louis Agassiz. From the author. Neuchatel, Suisse, 1839, Monographies D’Echinodermes Vivans et Fossiles, par L. Agassiz, 1 a Contenant les Salenes. Neuchatel, 1838. From the autho Bulletin de Soc. — ique de France. Tome ix, pp. 145 to 508. From the Socie Fe we _ On the Geological Relations vt the South of Ireland, by Thomas F.G.S., Bs il c. From the author, 4to. (from . + OC.5 on, Val. V, new series, pp. 68. Dr. Mantell’s Wonders = Cecibey. 2d London edition, 2 Vols. € paper. From the author. way Mag. and Steam Nav. Journal, No. 29, for July, 1838, a June, 1839, inclusive. From the Editor, John Here- 3 SCIENCE.—DOMESTIC. Contributions to Electricity and Magnetism, by Joseph Henry, Prof. of Nat. ein in the Coll. of N. Jersey. Philadelphia, 1839. From the autho Catalogue of eon Shells in the Cabinet of John C. Jay, M. D. of N. Y. 4to. with 10 plates of new and rare Shells; two sation, one for the Yale Nat. Hist. Soc. From the Author. Transactions of the American ae Society, pre iee Vol. VI, Part II. Key & Biddle Boston Journal of Natural History ; ; goa papers oe com- munications read before the Boston Society of Natural History, ‘Part I, No. 3, and Vol. II, No. 1. Boston, 1836 and 1889. From the Society. The Alabama State Alnanac for the year 1839. ‘Tuscaloosa, Alabama. From Prof. Barna An Essay on the “sel ‘nd Modification of the External Organs of Plants; compiled chiefly from the writings of J. Wollgang von Goethe. By Wa. Darlington, os < West Chester Point, 2 copies. From the Author=one for Yale Nat. Hist. Society. Annual Report of the Geologist of Maryland, 1838. Fr rom the Geologist, Dr. Ducatel. First and Second Reports of the Progress of the Geological par vey of the State of Virginia, for the year 1836 and 1837; from Wm. B. Rogers, Prof. Nat. Phil. in the University of Va. Report of the Peotitis of the Geological Survey of the State of Va. for the year 1838; by Prof. Wm. B. Rogers. From the Author. A Chart of Cape May Roads, including Crow Shoal. From Major J. D. Graham, U. S. Army, for Y.C. Library. Chart of the Entrance into erm Bay ; by and from Maj. Graham, U.S. Army, for Y. C. Libra A Map of the Seirnitiy of Cape Cod, including the townships of Provincetown and Truro, with a Chart of their Sea Coasts and Cape od Harbor, executed under the direction of Maj. raham, U. S. Top. Engs. - 1833, 4 & 5, (in 4 large sheets), from Maj. Gra- ham, for Y. L. The same to Prof. Silliman, from Maj. Graham. Chart of the Mouth of Connecticut River. From Capt. Swift. Letters to the Sec. of the Treasury, on the History cat Causes of Steamboat Explosions, and the Manner of Prevention ; by W. C. Redfield. Revised edition. N. York, 1839. From the Author. Essay on Meteorological Observations ; by J. N. Nicollet, nay i by order of the vet go ere: May, 1839. From Col t, U. S. Engine Two New York Journal of Medicine sod ens, July 1839. No.1, Vol. I. From the Edi Third Annual Sagat 2 the Geology of Maine. From Dr. C. T. Jackson. 4 Address delivered on laying the Corner Stone of the Academy of Sciences of Philadelphia, May 25, 1839. From W. R. Johnson, Esq., Author. Four plates of Dr. S. Morton’s Crania Americana: Viz. 17, 28, 37 and 62. From the Author. Account of a Tornado in Rhode Island; by R. Hare, M. D. From the Author. Report of the Progress of the Geological Survey of New York, for 1839. One from Prof. Emmons, one from James Hall, and one from an unknown friend. ond Annual Report on a Geological Survey of Ohio; by W. W. Mather. From Mr. Mather. Columbus, 1839. Third Annual Report of the Geological Survey of Pennsylvania. From Hon. Judge D. Daggett ; also one from N. Ellmaker. Journal of the Essex County Nat. Hist. Soc. Vol. 1, No. Il, 1839. From the Society. Treatise on the Eye. “By and from Dr. W. C. Wallace, oculist of New York. | 3 MISCELLANEOUS.—FOREIGN. Scotch Life Assurance. From Mr. Fox of Durham, England. Synopsis of a System of Education Established by the University of Kings College. Fredericton. New Brunswick, 1888. , Views of Clapham Common Eng. From Dr. Gideon Mantell. iew of the present state of Thames Tunnel. From the same. Report on the Indians of Upper Canada. London, 1839. Eee: Reports and Proceedings of the British and Foreign Aborigines Society. Four pamphlets from the Society. 1839. _ MISCELLANEOUS.—pDomESTIC. Catalogue of Bowdoin College, New Brunswick, Me. From Prof. Cleaveland. be rospectus of the New York Quarterly Journal of Medicine and rgery. | Circular of Irwinton Literary Institute. Irwinton, Alabama, 1839. rom O. P, Hammond. _ Annual Announcement of the Medical Department of Transylva- nia University, Lexington, Ky. 1839. reular of Rutger’s Female Institute, New York. From Mr. - E. West. Ha York Literary Gazette, No. 64, containing Retzsch’s Game of Life. Barber’s Historical Collections. thor. 8vo, 1839. New Haven. A eview of the Rev. Horace Bushnell’s Discourse on the Sla- 3 ee by Francis Gillett. Hartford, 1839. From the Massachusetts. From the Au- 5 Introductory Lecture to a Course of Chemistry delivered in Washington College, Lexington, Va. Feb. 21, 1838; by Geo. D. Armstrong, A. M., Richmond, 1888. From the Author. History of the Old South ‘Church in Boston; by Rev. B. B. Winslow, former Pastor of the Church. From Rev. J. W. Tagien, present Pastor Catalogue of a Collection of Rare, Chicncg and Valuable Books on Divinity, Classics, &c. to be sold 23d and 24th May at auction, by Bangs, Richards & Platt, N. Speech of the Hon. Thomas Mortis of Ohio, in Senate of U. S. February ne 1839, in reply to Henry Clay. New York. From the Autho ” Davis? Descriptive Catalogue of Apparatus and Experiments Ilastrative of Galvanism, Electro-Magnetism, ny amc om D. Davis. ‘Boston. Several copies from Taxa States Naval Lyceum Report on the State af the Institu- 3 tion for 1839. From the Lyceum Constitution and By-Laws of the N. Y. Historical Society, 1839. From G. Gibbs, Esq A Catalogue of Siacalennins oer for sale by Little & Brown, Boston, 1839. From the Publish Annual Catalogue of the New England ig pa Warehouse. aa 1839. From Joseph Breck & School pe aaa Several ce ‘from Marsh, Capen, & oe Boston, 1839. Dr. Noah Webner s Address to the friends of Literature. From the Author. Minutes of the ree Society of Tennessee. Held in Nashville, May, 1839. Colum From the Society Mitchell’s School Geoerapy (with an attai,) 12mo. Philadel- phia, 1839. From Mr. Mit A Manual of Useful Studice for the Instruction of Young Persons. By and from Noah Webster, LL. D. New Haven, 1839. Address at the opening of the Rutger’s Female Institute, by Dr. Isaac Ferris. From the Author, and 1 from C. E. West to B. S., Jr. Burmese Tract, called the Ship of Grace. Twenty Third Report of the Directors of the American Asylum at Hartford for the Deaf and Dumb. Hartford, 1839. From Mr. Weld. First Annual Report of the Commissioners of Common Schools in Connecticut. Hartford, 1839. From H. Beardsley, Esq., Sec- Gielogie af Sh TR poe Fos = Scientific Books, sold in N. York, Jun From the Auction Catalogue . an extensive calle: of Old English Books sold in New York, June 20 and 21, 1839. Analysis of Sounds, and saat of Stenography, by C. P. Newton. A 6 ‘Repat of Edwin F. Johnson, Civil Engineer, in relation to the the — of the Ogdensburg and Champlain Rail Road. From the Aut ‘abilee ‘of the Comeenron; by J. Q. Adams. From George Gibbs, Esq. Second Report of the MP areizn bene Association. New York, 1839. From Rev. Mr. Bai Valedictory Oration before the ae of Brothers in Unity, by C. J. Stille. m Robinson. Proceedings of the President and Fellows of the Conn. Medical Society. Hartford, 1839. Catalogue of Paintings, &c., .at the Apollo Gallery, 410 Broad- way, N. York. List No. II, of English Books, by Wiley & Putnam. Hartford Young Men’s Society, Charter and By-Laws. From H. Barnard, Esq. The Statutes of Emory College, — the By-Laws of the Faculty. Oxford, Ga. From Prof. A. Mean Annual Report of the Regents of the University to the Legislature of the State of New York. 1839. From the Regents. Annual Report of the A. B. C. F. M. for 1839. From the Board. Proceedings of the American Philosophy Society. Philadelphia. Vol. 1. Nos. 4,5 and 6. From the Societ Second Hae Report of the Geology of Ohio. From C. B. i Esq. Also one to Yale Nat. Hist. Soc. From W. W. sed Report of the Home Missionary Society, 1839. NEWSPAPERS.—FOREIGN. The Atheneum Journal, Nos. 584, 585, 596, and 601. From Charles Fox, Esq. NEWSPAPERS.—DOMESTIC, The Boston Atlas. Tuesday, April 16, with notice of sales of the late Dr. King’s Electrical Apparatus. ; ew Era. Monday, March 25, 1839. From E. Williams. With a notice of Dr. H. H. Sherwood’s memorial to Congress on Mag- netism. The Miner’s Journal. Pottsville. March 30th, 1839. With a _ Notice of the coal mines of the region. Mr. Wm. W. Selfridge. N.Y. Daily Whig. Friday, April 12th. st Tennessean. Rogersville. Tuesday, April 2d, 1839. No. 1. With a notice of the Marbles of Tennesse, by Dr. Troost. ew Orleans Commercial oes = eereh 28, 1839. Witha notice of J. S. Buckin ee Lectu pasidlvsn einen ase iaiinac libel ta ey Soe os 7 Feliciana Hep biost and Louisana Literary Messenger. Sat- urday, April 6, 1839. Containing Prof. Cabis’ Temperance Speech. From Prof. W. M. Car penter. The Colored Aeisicah, Saturday, Jan. 29, 1839. Report of the Public ee in New Orleans to establish a a Sailor’s Home. N. O. Com. Bulletin of April 18th, 1839., Boston Calavator. May 11, 1839, From Hovey & Co. With a catalogue of new Dahlias, for 1839. : The Sun (of N. Y.) July 29. Fan Dr. Peck. Containing an account and drawing of the Steamer British Queen, and of Fitch’s Steamboat of 1786, on the Delaware. he Rockton ee Several Nos. From E. Griffing, Editor, Little Falls, (Rockton The rien for 1838-9. From Judge J. Buel. Alban ny. The Weekly True American. N. Orleans. No. 59. Jan. 9, 1839. Pitoediins of the Broadway Tabernacle soe Lewis Tappan. Philadelphia North American. May 2ist, 1939. Friend of Man. July 3d, 1839. N. Y. American. May 28th. With a notice of this Journal Family Schoolmaster.. Richmond, Indiana, Jan 26th The Virginia Herald. Fredericksburg, Jan. 26th, 1839. With an account of the Russian mode of extracting gold. From James Williams, Esq. Republican Farmer. Wilkesbarre,Pa. Jan. 26th, 1839. From E. J. Turner. ~ Norwalk Gazette, Conn. July 17. Containing remarks of Rev. John Noyes, on 4th July, 1839. N. Y. Commercial Advertizer. June 7th, 1839. With a notice of Mr. Frelinghuysen’ s Inauguration as Chancellor of the University. SPECIMENS—FOREIGN AND DOMESTIC. — Quartz Crystals from Little Falls, N. ¥. From E. M. Twe wo aula of dried plants from ee for the Yale Natural History Society. 3 Pe S Sulphate of Strontia from Sicily. Miss Pratt, Summer st., Boston. Section of an Elephant’s tooth. From Mr. J. E. Pratt, Boston. A box of impressions of fossil plants as Alabama. From Prof. F. A. P. Barnard, Tuscaloosa, Alabam A box of wid from the face near New Echota, Ga. From W. J. Parvin, Esq., P. M. A suite of SSeidegioal Specimens from S. Africa, near Capetown. From Rey. George Champion. The box also contained several other articles of interest in Botany and other parts of Nat. Hist. Beautiful Beryls from Haddam, Ct. From Prof. J. Johnston, Wesleyan University. r 8 A box of — curiosities. From Rev. Dr. Parker, Canton, China. This box was detained in N. Y. Custom House, six mo’s. or it would have “s sooner noticed. An Alligator in alcohol, from S. Carolina. W. 'T. Hatch, Esq. Several rare Cape Bulbs Gladiolus Ixia Sparaxis, and also seeds and flowers of several species of Zeranthemum Ammobum, &c. From Rev. George pbampion, through Mrs. J. sie Boston. A box of Fossils from Niagara. From Mr. Stro Box of Bituminized Wood from the banks of. ti Mississippi. From Prof. Carpenter, Jackson College, La. Box of Fossils from Alabama. Eros Miss Shedden to Yale Nat. History Society. . - _ NEW EDITION OF DR. MANTELL’S WONDERS OF GEOLOGY. A full notice was given of this work in our Vol, xxxrv, p. 387, and we announced in Vol. xxxv, p. 384 that arrangements had been made with the author and his publishers, by which Mr. A. H. Maltby of New Haven would publish the new edition in this country as soon as it could cross the ocean, and that by the author’s approbation it would appear under the direction of Prof. Silliman, with introductory remarks by him; the proper type and illustrations to be identical - with those of the London edition. This work is now received in an enlarged and improved edition: it has 10 plates and sections, of which six are colored, and nearly 100 additional engravings. While it is full and exact in science, it is without doubt the most attractive and interesting work on Geology which has ever been published. It does not interfere with the excellent treatises of Bakewell, Lyell, ~ Murchison, De la Beche, Daubeny and other eminent geologists ; it occupies a peculiar niche of its own, and reflects both the image of geological nature and of the author’s own elegant and accom- plished mind. Without any other than a friendly interest in these volumes, we cordially recommend them, as being equally instructive and delightful.— Eds. Pee arr THE AMERICAN JOURNAL OF SCIENCE, &c. Arr. 1L—Meteorological Observations during a Residence in Colombia, between the Years 1820 and 1830.* By Colonel Ricuarp Wricut, Governor. of the Province of Loxa, and Confidential Agent of the Republic of the Equator, &c. &c. Ir the materials of science could be gathered only by the sci- entific, the following collection of observations would be a useless labor; but it frequently happens that, in distant countries, the opportunity of observing natural phenomena falls to the lot of those very ill fitted in most respects to profit by it. The genius of Humboldt, like an incantation of science, descends upon the New World but once in a series of ages. The most that can be done by an ordinary observer, is to offer his mite,—a single stone towards the pyramid of knowledge,—in the hope that he may casually prove useful; and with such | 1umble pretensions can scarcely be deemed ‘importimate. - Should even this apology barely extentiate the: sterility. of a ten years’ residence in a on try so admirably varied and rich in natural phenomena as Co bia, something farther may be urged in excuse of the aay traveller, obliged frequently to hurry through the most interesting parts, and to vegetate whole years in others of minor importance ; without books, without instruments, withont resources ; fettered too often by the chain of his own daily wants and sufferings ; and * From the London and Edinburgh Philosophical Magazine and Journal of Sci- ence, Vol. 14, No. 85, January, 1839. rm Vol. xxxvil, No. 1 .—July—Oct., 1839. F : J — : ay ers : oo 2 Meteorological Observations made in fallen on a time when every species of local and traditional in- formation, every glimmering of philosophic research had been buried and obliterated amid the storms and struggles of the rev- olution. . = The geographical features of Colombia have been portrayed by Humboldt with an accuracy which renders further description superfluous. It is, however, impossible to traverse this extensive. territory, without being struck by the physical phenomena of a country where height produces the effect of latitude, and where the changes of climate, with all the consequent revolutions of an- imal and vegetable life, are brought about by localities to which — we find little analogy in Europe. 'The equatorial seasons, as is well known, are merely the wet and dry; and though the Span- iards, influenced by European recollections, have given the former _ the name of winter invierno, it is during this period that na- i ture revives from the vegetative torpor which the scorching - tropical heats produce in the lowlands in almost an equal degree 4 with the frosts of northern climates. In the vast plains which extend to the south and east of the great chain of the Andes, the rainy season observes an invariable order. The Orinoco begins to rise in April, and attains its maximum of increase in July and August, when the immense savannas which extend to the base — of the Andes are converted into the appearance of an inland 3 ocean. It decreases from this period, and the summer is reckon- 4 ed from October to April. In the mountains, on the contrary, — the rains commence about the former month, and predominate, with intervals of fair weather, till May or June. The winter of the low lands, to the west and north of the Cordillera, both on the Pacific and Atlantic coasts, is governed by that of the mountains, but with several curious localities. 'Thus, the rainy season of Guayaquil is nearly as regular as that of the plains, be- ing reckoned from the middle of December to the middle of May ; while the thick forests, which further to the north cover the — provinces of Esmeraldas, Barbacoas, and Choco, produce, by their coustant evaporation, an almost perpetual deluge. Wherever, on the contrary, the Cordillera recedes to some distance from the coast, as is the case with parts of the Venezuelan chain, the intermediate conpEy is parched often by a drought of several years. Mara- caybo, and a considerable part of the province of Coro, are in- stances where sandy plains, scantily shaded by Mimosas and eat - ap _ oi Pura Lees a Pali 2 tt 5 a oy) Ry ae papi aid rac ah ea Miyctees ie ih a mH sis ii rear ae Ts CR ae a 8 z Pe: Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 3 thick aa afford shelter and subsistance only to flocks of goats and asses. The coast of Rio Hacha is equally dry and sterile, till it approaches the foot of the isolated ridge of Santa Marta; while the Goagira territory, situated betwixt Rio Hacha and Mar- acaybo, is regularly inundated every year, and consequently, though destitute of streams, maintains considerable herds of cat- tle and horses ; a circumstance to be ascribed to the vicinity of - the Ocafia branch of the Andes, which extends, with its clouds and thick forests, almost to the confines of this province. The whole Peruvian coast from Payta to Lima, is an additional in- stance of the same fact, where the recession of the Andes from the coast is marked by sandy deserts, which the industry of the ‘Incas had rendered produétive by artificial irrigation. In the val- leys and on the table lands of the mountains themselves, the cul- minating summits produce great variations in the distribution of moisture. The city of Caraccas, situated at the foot of the Silla, has the benefit of a regular though mild rainy season, while within a league there are spots which suffer several years of drought. Popayan, placed at the head of a sultry valley of the Cauca, and surrounded by lofty paramos, has nine months of continued rains and tempests, attributable to the clouds which are driven in opposite directions from the mountains till they — encounter the hot ascending air of the valley. In the ancient kingdom of Quito, now called the Republic of the Equator, the mass of Chimborazo interrupts the passage of the clouds from south to north; so that, while the western slopes are deluged with rain, the elevated plains of Riobamba to the east recall to the imagination of the traveller the deserts of Arabia Petra. Fol- lowiag the same mountain chain towards the city of Quito, we observe the storms arrested between Cotopaxi and Pichinca, over the valley of Chillo; while two leagues farther to the north, the climate of the tiles of Pomasqui is so dry as to have psp it the name of Piurita (little Piura. ) The manner in which rain is formed and precipitated at vari- ous elevations, seems to illustrate and confirm the theory of Leslie. In the region of paramos, i. e. from 12,000 feet upwards, the en- countering aérial currents, unless in the case of some strong agi- tation of the mass of surrounding atmosphere, are of low and nearly equal temperature. The rains in consequence assume the form of thick drizzling mists, known by the name of paramitos. 4 Meteorological Observations made in | On the elevated plains we find the showers more or less sudden — and violent, according to localities which give rise to a mixture © of currents more or less variably heated. Quito, for example, is ~ situated on what may be called a dedge of the lofty mountai of a Pichincha, aud overlooks the valley of Chillo of Guaillapamba, _ ; furrowing the adjacent table land, on which the therr 4 ten rises to 80? in the shade. The encounter of port atmosphere, thus variously heated, produces showers as sud aud heavy as those which generally distinguish tropical clima On the slopes of the Cordillera the rains are generally violent | the same reason. Looking to the hygrometrical state of the at- mosphere, as it results from observations made on the table lands © of the equator and the coast of the Pacific, we find it to vary from 0° in the damp forests of Esmeraldas to 97°-1 on the ele- vated plain of Cayambe ; the experiments in both places being ~ made during June and July, the summer months both of the — coast and mountains. The average medium for the low lands is : 23°-85 ; for the Cordillera 44°-36 of the hygrometer constructed upon Leslie’s principle ; but we are in want of sufficient data for those elevatious which approach to the limit of perpetual snow. To judge, however, from a small number of observations made on the mountain of Cayambe at 12,705 and 14,217 feet of eleva- tion, and at the hut of Antisana at 14,520 feet, where the hygro- meter was found to give 16°-5, 13°-9, and 30.°3, it would not — seem that the dryness of the atmosphere increases in ratio of the elevation ; at least, in the neighborhood of snowy mountains, where a continual moisture is exhaled, and heavy mists sweep over the soil towards evenings even of the fairest days. To estimate the general distribution of temperatures through the vast territory of Colombia, we may conveniently consider it as divided into five zones. Ist. That of the level, or nearly so, of the ocean. 2nd. That of the small elevations, from 500 to 1,500 feet. 3rd. That of the slopes of the Cordillera, from 2,000 to 7,000 feet. 4th. That of the elevated plains, or table lands, from 8,000 to 10,000 feet; and 5th, That of the paramos, from 11,000 feet to the limit of perpetual snow. 1. The degree of heat at or near the level of the ocean is mod- ified by a variety of local circumstances, which may be ranged under the following heads: proximity of the sea; of great rivers and lakes ; of lofty ridges of mountains ; of extensive forests; of Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 5 contiguous elevarietis which impede the circulation of air, and 4 poate reflected heat. The various combinations of these cir- nces may be considered as affording a rule of the increase ainutio tion of temperature. Thus, Le Guayra, situated on a b Ki cess of see 2: and the re- ~ 7 ‘sonal eet rative, vol. iii, p. 386,) the mean annual tempera- - being 82°-6; yet the observations I made during some s’ residence in Maracaybo give an armual mean of 84°-63. Yor is this surprising, when we consider the localities of both places. In Maracaybo the sun’s rays are reflected from a barren sandy soil, scantily sprinkled with Mimosas and prickly plants. The mountain chains are too remote to have any influence on the atmosphere, so that several years frequently pass without any regular fall of rain. The vicinity of the lake, no doubt, acts slightly as a refrigerant ; but the city is built on the border of its outlet to the sea, where it is both narrowest and shallowest, and is consequently heated nearly to the temperature of the in- cumbent atmosphere. Add to this, the small sandy elevations to the north, which intercept the partial effect of the sea-breezes, so that they are scarcely felt, except in the months of December and January, when the thermometer sometimes sinks to 73° : ; yet the medium even of these two months is not less than 81°; while that of La Guayra from November to December at noon, is, ac- cording to Humboldt, 75°-8, and at night 70°-9. (Personal Nar- rative, vol. iii, p. 387.) Rio Hacha is situated on a sandy beach; the sea-breeze blows with such violence that boats can seditihe land between ten in the morning and four in the afternoon. These winds, however, sweeping over the hot plains of Coro and Maracaybo, have but a partial effect in lowering the temperature, the annual mean of which is 19-98 less than that of Maracaybo, I never saw the thermometer lower than 75°, nor above 89°. In Santa Marta the average of the coolest months is 82°-25. The thermometer, however, never rose during my residence there above 87°. The soil is sandy, and the city is surrounded by bare rocky heights to the north and south, which counterpoise the cooling influence of the Sierra coal, (snowy mountains, ) = be ii jo = - - eo es : Meteorological Observations made in oe . << ‘qa 285 Ps Se eto is but a few leagues distant. The temperature of a village situated on the river Magdalena, about eighteen miles from its mouth, is nearly the same with that of a Santa Marta; for if, on the one hand, the air is refreshed by the ag evaporation from a damp soil covered with luxuriant forests and the vicinity of a large river, on the other, it is beyond the reach ~ of the sea-breeze, and the influence of the mountains which ope- rate in Santa Marta. The annual mean is 82°20. That of Cu- — ‘mana is, according to Humboldt, 81°. The breezes which sweep from the gulf of Paria over the wooded Brigantine chain, pro oe bly contribute to lower the temperature. — ds 4 We have thus, on a calculation of six points on the Atlantic coast of Colombia, a mean annual temperature of 82°-56.* The a shores of the Pacific, as far as the latitude of Payta, are subjected = to other influences, being almost entirely covered by damp, lux- urient forests; while the ocean itself is cooled, as Humboldt ob- serves, by the winds which blow continually from the south. This, however, is more perceptibly the case from latitude 8° to to 13°, where the air is cooled to an average of 71°°8 (Hum- boldt De Distributione Geog. Pl. p. 92.) Betwixt 9° N. lat. and 3° §S. lat. if we may trust to observations made at the five points of Panama, Esmeraldas, El Morro, the island of Puna, and Guayaquil, the annual mean is 80°11, being 2°-45 less than the mean of the Atlantic coast. A notable difference also arises from the superior elevation of the Pacific chain of the Andes, and its more immediate vicinity to the coast, while the Venezuelan branch, with the exception of the Santa Marta ridge, is both low- er and more inland. A curious exception to the general temper- ature of the Pacific coast, may be found on passing Punta Galera and Cabo San Francisco (lat. 50/ N .)tothe south. The sky is here almost perpetually clouded, and a drizzling rain falls through the greater part of the year. During a week I passed there Ineversaw the sun ; and the average temperature was only 749-14. ‘This was | the more striking, as along the coast, immediately to the north of Punta Galera, the weather was constantly dry and the sky clear. The miry state of the road across the point of the Cape of ge . Thave not —— Cartagena, because the number of observations is perhaps a i aw a conclusion as to the yearly temperature. If we take them calculation, the annual mean would be 82°-86, which is probably too high. Colombia between the Years 1820 and San Francisco indicates the line of arto oti two dis- tinct climates. It will be seen by tl . Galera the en after running nearly due wet fms abe to the ~ south. 2. — into the interior of the country, and exam- ining the temperature « levations, we may take, as form- ing an aggregate specimen of the whol e country try: 1s The damp wooded valleys of the Orinoco and "Miedleta 2. The forests _ which border on the Pacific ; and 3. The immense plains of Ven- ‘ Sscis, alternately flooded. and parched with excessive heat, iboldt assigns to the valley of the Orinoco a mean tempera- ture of 78°-2. The small number of observations I have made on that of the Magdalena; would give a mean of nearly 83°, which I should scarcely think too high, considering the localities of the river, which, flowing from south to north, affords no chan- nel to the sea-breezes. Its mass of water is also much less con- siderable than that of the Orinoco; while its numerous sinuosities, and the low ridges which border it in the upper part of its course, contribute to render the air stagnant and suffocating. The te perature of Honda, at 1,200 feet of elevation, is as high as that of : any part of the coast except Maracaybo. The unbroken forests which extend from the roots of the Quitenian Andes to the shores of the Pacific have a much lower temperature, caused by the proximity of the snow-capped Cordillera, and the humidity which prevails throughout the year. Accurate observations give an annual mean of 76°-78, or 1°-42 lower than the valley of the Orinoco, and 6°-22 lower than that of the Magdalena. The ‘Mean temperature of the plains of Venezuela is reckoned by Humboldt at 88-4, (De Distributione Geog. Plant. p. 92. ;) yet several reasons may induce the belief that this calculation is ex- cessive. This illustrious traveller performed his journey during the summer season, when the atmosphere is heated by the rever- berations from a ceria and naked soil. Persons who have re- sided near the Apure, state the climate in rainy weather to be cool, and refreshed by a constant breeze. It is only on the coast of the Pacific that the rainy season is the period of the greatest heat, when the air is still, and undisturbed by those electric ex- plosions so common on the mountains and in the interior. The observations I made at Varinas and San Carlos, towards the be- ginning of the winter season, give a mean of 81°; and averaging 8 Meteorological Observations made in the dry season at 88°°4, we have a yearly mean of 84°-7, which is probably the extreme, or something beyond it. There is no doubt it is in the plains of the interior we find the greatest heat during the dry season. In the level country, called the valley of Upar, betwixt the mountain ridges of Santa Marta and Ocana, I found the thermometer in the shade several times above 100°, and once as high as 108°. The average of nineteen observations made at different points of this district is 89°-9; but we must allow a considerable decrease during the months when the soil is covered with thick vegetation, and drenched by continual rains. As a general mean of the interior, at small elevations, we may take 80°-67, or nearly that of Cumana. 3. The temperate mountain region lies nearly betwixt the ele- vations of 3,000 and 7,000 feet. Below this may be considered as a hot climate, such, for instance, as Valencia and the valleys of Aragua in Venezuela, the height of which is from 1,500 to 2,000 feet, and its mean temperature 78°, or 0°-24 above that of Guay- aquil on the Pacific ; but the soil, stripped by cultivation of its ancient forests, imbibes freely the solar rays, which are besides reflected from the rocky elevations which every where surround the cultivated districts. The temperature of Caraccas (elevation 2904 feet) was fixed by Humboldt in his Essay De Distributione Geographica Plantarum, p. 98, at 69°-6; but in his Personal — Narrative, b. iv, c. xii, p. 460, he considers 179-2 of Reaumur == 70°.40 of Fahrenheit, nearly as the true yearly mean. My own observations during a residence of some months give 719-40. The preference would be certainly due to Humboldt’s calcula- tion, but for some collateral circumstances deserving attention. I heard it generally remarked in the city, that the seasons had grown hotter since the earthquake of 1812. It would be difficult to explain how the temporary evolution of volcanic gases, sup- posing such to have taken place, could operate any permanent change on the surrounding atmosphere; yet other causes may have produced an eflect falsely ascribed to the phenomenon most impressed on the imagination of the inhabitants. On looking over Humboldt’s collection of observations for December and January, 1799, we find the thermometer seldom rise to 75°, and often sink to 59°; so that the mean of these months is about 68°. During the same months in 1821, the daily range was from 65° to 76°. I never observed it lower than 61°-5, and on one occa- SS ee ee a a Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. ; 9 sion, at 5 a. m., it stood at 61°-0. The mean of these two months is 70°-21, or 2°21 higher than the estimate of Humboldt. ‘The clearness and beauty of the sky, during almost the whole period of my residence, is also a circumstance opposed to Hum- boldt’s “celum sepe nubibus grave que post solis occasum terre appropinquant.” De Distributione Geog. Plant. p.98. I remera- ber but once to have seen a fog in the streets of the city. Fu- ture observations will show whether any change of climate has really taken place, or whether the differences observed be only such variations as may be frequently remarked in the same place betwixt one year and another. ‘The mean of the whole temperate mountain region may be reckoned at 67°-80; that is, if we limit ourselves to the districts partially cultivated and inhabited. The declivities of the Andes, still covered with vast and humid forests, have probably their temperature proportionably lowered. ‘Thus the village of Mindo, on the western declivity of Pinchinca, em- bosomed in humid forests, at 3,932 feet of elevation hasa medium temperature of 65°°5, the same with that of Popayan. 4. The elevated plains of the Andes, betwixt 8,000 and 11,000 feet, on which were auciently united the most powerful and civ- ilized indigenous nations beneath the dominion of the Zipas of Tunja and Bogota and the Incas of Quito, and where the great mass of Indian population is still to be found, have a general me- dium temperature of 59°-37, modified however by local cireum- stances, and particularly by the proximity of the Nevados. Thus the village of Guaranda, placed at the base of Chimborazo, though nearly 500 feet less elevated, is at least one degree colder than the city of Qnito, sheltered on all sides by the ramifications of Pichincha. The city again is above one degree warmer than its suburbs on the plains of Anaguito and Turupamba to the north and south. Riobamba is about two hundred feet below Quito; yet its situation on an open plain, | bordered by the snowy moun- tains of Chimborazo, Tunguragua, ‘and La Candelaria, renders the climate colder and more variable ; while the town of Hamba- to, only 300 feet lower than Quito, but built in a nook of the river which runs near it, and shut in by dry, sandy elevations, has a climate about 2°-0 warmer; so that sugar-cane is cultiva- ted in its immediate vicinity. The general uniformity of tem- ‘perature, which spreads a certain monotony over tropical regions, is joined, at great elevations, to a daily variability which must Vol. xxxvi1, No. 1—July-Oct. 1 2 10. Meteorological Observations made in exercise a considerable influence both on vegetable and animal life. The thermometer, which often sinks at night to 44°, rises in the sun wherever there is a reflected heat, frequently to 120°, being equal to the heat of Jamaica; while in the shade, it seldom exceeds 65°; so that, on passing from shade to sunshine, one is immediately exposed to a difference of above 5U°, and, in the course of twenty-four hours, to nearly 80°. The shade, in con- sequence, even on the hottest days, imparts a feeling of chilliness ; while the solar rays seem to scorch like the vapor of a heated oven. ‘The same difference is perceptible on the paramos. At the foot of the Nevado of Santa Marta I observed the thermome- ter at 5 a.m. sink to 22°; at 9a. m. it rose to 73° in the sun. On the height of Pichan, betwixt Quito and Esmeraldas, eleva- tion 12,986 feet, the thermometer stood at 53° in the shade, an 83° in the sun. On Antisana, the difference was 22° at the same time, but 34° betwixt 6 a.m.and3 p.m. When the atmosphere is calm it is much more considerable. 5. Although at great elevations, i. e. from 12,000 to 16,000 feet, it is difficult to form a series of meteorological observations, such is the yearly equality of the temperature, that a single day may be safely taken as a sample of the whole year; nay, more, a collection of observations made at similar heights, though in different places, will give a similar result to a series taken on the same spot. ‘Thus in the following table there is little difference betwixt the result of eight observations made on seven sagen mountains, and the six made on that of Antisana : 1 Paramo of Santa Marta 15,000 ft. | 22° 54 A. M, 2. | Paramo of Cayambe 12,705 A ie eee. s Paramo of El! Altar 9 et» laa a 4 Condorasto 14,496 45°) 12. % 5 Voleano of Pichincha 15,705 46°°0 1p. Mm. 6 Mountain of Atacaso 14,820 ay°o-9 eG 7 Nevado of Cayambe 14,217 43°O 1f 3 8 Paramo of Antisana 14,520 38°58 6 “ observations. Ge neral ‘Iean | 39° Although it scarcely falls wi within th the | limits of a a mere e meteoro- logical journal to expatiate on the wide field of inference which opens to our view, when we reflect on the influence of tempera- ture, not merely on animal but on social life, yet the operation of local circumstances has been so striking, aod will probably play so important a part in the future destinies of the South American continent, that it is difficult to forbear some remarks on so inter- esting a — ei, se " eee ae ri iz Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 11 Climate is one of the first agents which operates upon the pro- pagation of the human race over the face of the globe, presenting itself sometimes as a benignant conductor, at other times raising a hostile barrier which science and industry slowly overcome. The Spaniards who people that part of South America now under con- sideration, as soon as they had formed on the coast the establish- ments hecessary to preserve their connection with the mother country, seem to have traversed hastily the fertile but insalubri- ous lowlands to meet on the Cordillera a temperature adapted to their habits and constitutions. The dominion of the Incas had, upon similar principles, extended itself along the immense ridge ; and the descendants of the conquerors and conquered are, to this day, found united on the same elevations, from whence the popu- lation has descended gradually into the plains; and would have done so much more slowly, but for the importation of the African race, who find on the sandy coast and sultry savanna a climate congenial to their constitution. It may be a matter of curiosity to inquire, why that portion of the bronzed race which constitu- ted the empire of the Incas and of the Lipas has constantly exhi- bited a constitutional type so different from the tribes of the same race now thinly scattered through the plains and valleys. The dominion of the Incas could scarcely be said to have established itself in the lowlands. With the exception of the dry narrow track of the Peruvian coast, their empire was exclusively of the mountains ; and Indians who speak the Quichua, or general lan- guage of the Incas, still manifest the same preference for cold and © elevated situations; sleeping in the open air rather than under a roof, and exhibiting an insurmountable repugnance to descend into the hot country, where they fall victims more rapidly than even the Europeans. The latter, although commercial interests have led them to form establishments on the coasts, and more par- tially on the great rivers, may be said to live in a state of perpet- ual hostility with the climate. Their complexions become sal- low, their frames feeble ; and although, where heat is uncombined with great moisture, as in Cumana, Coro and Maracaybo, they are subject to few diseases of a violent character, the strength is gradually undermined, and the species may be rather said to veg- etate than to increase. The individuals of African race, who complain of cold when the yearly mean is 75°, alone develope all the physical strength and energy of their character in the hot 12 Melsot@latical Observations mate tn ~ lowlands of the coast and interior. The mixed race, or people of color, unite to bodily hardihood intrepidity, ambition, and a dead- ly feeling of those prejudices which, in spite of laws, continue to separate them from the white descendants of the Spaniards, who thus encounter, both in the high and lowland, two races in whom the seeds of hostility have been sown by injustice, and fostered by mistaken feelings of interest and vanity.* It is on the moun- tain slopes of from 3,000 to 7,000 feet that we encounter climates most analagous to our ideas both of health and pleasure. Raised above the noxious miasmata of the coast, we dwell in perpetual summer amid the richest vegetable productions of nature, amid a continued succession of fruits and flowers. ‘This picture, how- ever, must: not be considered as universally exact. In those un- broken forests where population has made little progress, the sky is often clouded, and the soil deluged with continual rains. The western declivities of the Andes, which front the Pacific, are par- ticularly exposed to this inconvenience, It might be expected that with regard to human life and vigor, the elevated plains of the Andes would correspond tothe northern countries of Europe. This, however, as far as regards the inhab- itants of the European race, does not seem exactly to take place. It is true they escape the billious and intermittent fevers so prev- alent in the lowlands ; but they are generally subject to typhus, dropsy, goitre, and such complaints as indicate constitutional de- bility. Nordo we fiud among them either the muscular strength or longevity of the Indians or Africans; and still less of the nations of northern Europe. Are the diurnal changes of temperature to which they are exposed, less favorable to health than the alterna- tion of European seasons which expose the frame to changes equally great but less rapid? Or must we rather look for the cause in their domestic habits, which exhibit a strange mixture of effeminacy and discomfort ? When we examine the social or political effects of climate and localities, we are struck with their powerful effects on the past struggles and present state of the country. ‘The cities of the Coast must be considered as the inlets both of European products and European ideas. Liberal opinions have extended themselves *Itis the people of color, or mixture of Africans with Whites and Indians, who on the plains form the most hardy and warlike part of the population of Colombia. ' , ro Ce ee aN ee Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 13 ' towards the interior in proportion to local obstacles, i. e. to the greater or less facility of communication. _ It is this circumstance which marks the difference betwixt Venezuela and the south and the centre of Colombia, indicating a distinct and more rapid ca- reer of civilization and prosperity. _The branch of the Andes which traverses Venezuela is much inferior in elevation to the ridges of Quito and New Grenada. The whole of the inhabited part of it belongs to the hot country or temperate mountain zone. The following are the heights sf the principal towns through its whole extent: Caraccas - « ~ 2903 ft. Mean temp. 71° Valencia . a 1495 78 Barquisimeto " ~ A85 ——-_ 78 Tocuyo . i ' 2058" ——— 75 Truxillo ; ’ . 2684 ——— 75 Merida . ‘ ‘ 5280 ———_ 66 Cucuta . . about 400 —— 83 The differences of climate and productions betwixt the differ- ent parts of. the country are consequently trifling, and form no bar to general communication betwixt the coast ia terior: There is therefore an amalgamation of ideas, an homogeneity, if we may use the term, in the mass of feelings and opinions on _ political subjects. ‘The population is not only more enlightened, but, what is of more importance, more equally so. A different state of things presents itself, when we examine the centre and south. The main ridge of the Andes ascends rapidly from the frontier of Venezuela, and, by its direction from north to south, places the population at a continually increasing distance from the sea-ports of the Atlantic ; while its superior elevation producing a different climate and temperature, gives birth to new habits and a distinct nationality. ‘To descend to the coast from these altitudes, is a matter both of risk and difficulty. The line betwixt the Liane- ros and Serranos is strongly drawn, and a separation of character evident. ‘The country from Cueuta to Bogota through Pamplona and Tunja has a mean elevation of from 8,000 to 10,000 feet, and a temperature of about 59° Fahr. It is true that Bogota com- municates with Europe by the valley of the Magdalena; but the length and inconvenience of this channel of intercourse render it accessible but to few. Hence the struggle of opinions in New Grenada, where the civilization of the superior class is out of pro- portion to that of the bulk of the people. this view of the subject. The following is the line of svat ¥ A between Quito and Chimborazo : é Quito. ; 2 . 9,537 feet 59° abr. Llactacunga : . . 10,285 57° Hambato ‘ P : 61° Riobamba j = 9,377 57° Guaranda . : . 9,075 58° The roads which descend to the coast of the Pacific are few, almost impassible, and lead to no seaport of importance except Guayaquil. Journeys thither are undertaken with fear and hesi- tation; and the character of the Serranos is marked with all the traits of isolation resulting from the geography of the country. Next to the direct influence exercised by. climate on the frame of man, we may consider it relatively to the facility it affords of nourishing him, and advancing his progress in civilization. 'The most important presents made by the Old to the New World are cattle and cerealia. The only domesticated quadruped known to the Indians was the llama, which furnished, like the sheep, with thick wool, unwillingly descends or is propagated in the sultry lowlands. The horned cattle of Europe, on the contrary, have multiplied almost equally on the plains as on the paramos. On the farm of Antisana, for instance, at an elevation of from 12,000 to 16,000 feet, there is no less than 4,000 head. The herds rais- ed on the plains of Venezuela, as on the Pampas of Buenos Ayres, are, or were previous to the revolution, almost countless. ‘Two immense magazines of animal food are thus placed at the two extremes of temperature, in situations uninterfered with by agricultural labor. 'The horse has been destined to figure in the political changes of the New World. The fear and respect with which he inspired the natives at the period of the Conquest is well known. Horses have since multiplied prodigiously in all parts of the country, but more especially in the plains of Venezu- ela. There, during the war of independence, Paez, and other guerilla chiefs, at the head of an irregular cavalry, and maintained by the cattle, defied the efforts of the Spanish infantry, and kept alive the embers of the revolution. The best kinds of horses are those that are bred in the lowlands, and brought to the mountains at about four years old, where they acquire hardihood by the ene of a colder climate, and their a ‘Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 15 custor ied only to soft beatares, are hardened on a stony beige su hoof, ac in The peed oF sep like that of Ilamas, is limited to the loftier region: of the Cordillera ; while goats multiply more readily on such parts. of the low country as are both hot and barren, as in the province of Coro, where they form the chief wealth of the in- habitants. But while nature facilitates the dispersion over the globe of certain species of animals, she seems to limit others by an impas- sible barrier. ‘The dog undergoes the fate of his European mas- ter; his sagacity and strength decay ina hot climate, and the breed dwindles rapidly into an animal totally inferior in habits and organization. The foresters accordingly, and the Indians of the lowlands, who are accustomed to the chase of the wild hog, bring dogs for the purpose from the mountains, where, though the Spaniards are by no means curious in this particular, a strong species of greyhound, more,or less degenerated, is to be met with, and is used in the highlands for stag-hunting. The influence of temperature, and consequently of local eleva- tion, on vegetable life, was first examined in Colombia by a na- tive of Bogota, the unfortunate and illustrious D. José Caldas, who fell a victim to the barbarity of Murillo in 1811, in conse- quence of which his numerous researches in natural history were almost entirely lost, with the exception of some papers published in the Seminario de Bogota in 1808, and fragments still existing in MS. or casually preserved and printed in Europe, to one of which I shall presently have occasion to refer. Humboldt trav- elled through South America about the same time that Caldas was directing the attention of his countrymen to physical science, and his investigations have fortunately been subjected to a less rigor- ous destiny. His admirable treatise, “ De distributione Planta- rum geographica,” has left for future observers little but to ébrroborate the accuracy of his views and multiply facts in illus- tration of his theories. When we begin our observations from the level of the sea, we find certain families of plants which scarcely ever rise to above 300 or 400 feet: the “Sandalo,” producing the balsam of Tolu, the Lecythis, the Coccoloba, the Bombaz, the Rhizophora Mangle, the Manchineel. A second and more numerous class push on to about 2,000 feet of elevation ; such are the Piinia, 16 Meteorological Observations made in the “ Copal,” the “ Anime,” the “ Dragon’s blood,” the mahoga- 4 ny tree, the “ Guayacan.” Among plants, the Cesalpinia, Tpo- mea quamoclet, most of the Bignonias, Portlandias, the Van-—4 illa, Cassia alata and riparia, the Pontaderia, which forms the ornament of tropical rivers. The palms ascend to the height of 5,000 feet; the arborescent ferns, from the level of the sea, amid the damp forest of Esmeraldas, to 7,000 feet. Of cultivated plants the Cacao and indigo are most limited as to elevation, nei- ther of which is cultivated with success at above 2,000 feet. An attempt to raise indigo at Mindo (3,960 feet) completely failed. It would seem that a dry climate is most favorable to indigo, such as is found in the valleys of Aragua near Valencia; while heat and moisture, as Humboldt observes, are particularly required for cacao. Yet cacao cultivated on lands which are flooded part of the year, as is the case with the greater part raised in Guayaquil, is of inferior quality, scarcely producing in the market a dollar percwt. That of Esmeraldas, on the contrary, where notwith- standing the moisture of the climate, the waters never settle on the soil, is of equal or superior quality to that of the valley of Tuy near Caraccas. In Canigue, at an elevation of about 1,000 feet, the trees are loaded with fruit in less than two years from the time of sowing the seed; while generally three years is the — period at which they are reckoned to commence bearing. Coffee is abundantly raised from the level of the sea to eleva- tions of 5,000 or 6,000 feet, or even higher in favorable situations. There are plantations near the valley of Banos in Quito at above 7,000 feet. Cotton requires, according to Humboldt, a mean temperature of not less than 64°—60°, which would bring it to the elevation of Loxa. The sugar cane is cultivated in Colombia from the level of the sea to an elevation, which may appear extraordinary, of 7,865 feet in the valley of Banos at the foot of Tunguragua, of 8,500 in the valley of Chillo below Quito, and of nearly 9,000 feet near the town of Hambato. It must be observed, however, with respect to the latter, that the vegas or nooks formed by the windings of the river, where alone it is raised, are so sheltered as to produce - almost an artificial temperature. A palm tree brought young from Guayaquil flourishes there, and “ Aguacates,” (the fruit of Laurus persea) ripen perfectly, with oranges, limes, and other ie ‘seat Berg Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 77 fruits which in general are not cultivated at above 6,000 feet. In proportion, however, to the elevation is the time required for ripening the sugar-cane, varying from nine months at the eleva- tion of 1,000 feet, to three years at the elevation above cited. Plastuins and maize are the principal articles of food in the lowlands or hot country, “ tzerra caliente,” to use the expression of the natives. The larger variety of plantain, “ Plantano har- ton,’ cannot be cultivated at elevations above 3,000 feet, while the smaller variety ‘“‘ Camburi,” will ascend to 6,000 feet, maize is perhaps the plant which, of all others, embraces the greatest variety of temperature and elevation. It is cultivated with equal advantage from the level of the ocean to the flanks of the Andes, 0 to 11,000 feet ; temperature 80°—59°. It is true, that in the lowlands it ripens in three months, whereas on the table lands of the Andes, it requires ten; but the grain is larger, and the ear fuller in the cold than in the hot country. The central or temperate zone of the Andes is distinguished by the Cinehonas, the arborescent ferns which precede and accom- pany the palms nearly, and in the moist forests of the Pacific; en- tirely to the level of the sea.* At the back of the Pichincha they first appear about 8,500 feet. The Alstremerias and Calceola- rias, peculiar to the New World, belong to this zone, though the former ascend to 11,000 feet wn the latter to 15,000. The Cerealia, with sleet all the varieties of European vege- tables, belong to this region. Humboldt observes a peculiarity that wheat is grown near Vittoria at the elevation of 1,700 feet, and in Cuba near the level of the sea; (Geo. Pl., p. 161) but it is probable that the reason why the cerealia are cultivated only at elevations where the Muse disappear, may be the natural inclin- ation of the inhabitants of the warm country to prefer the cultiva- tion of a plant which yields an equal abundance of food with infinitely less labor, not only in the mere cultivation, but in the subsequent preparation. The three great wheat districts in Co- lombia are the mountain chain of Merida, the elevation of which rarely reaches 5,000 feet ; with a general temperature of 72°; the plain of Pamplona, Tunja, and Bogota, elevation 8,000 to 10,000 feet ; temperature 58°; and the Quitenian Apdes of the same height and temperature. Humboldt has accurately observed, = Humboldt, who had not visited these forests, confines them to betwixt 800 and 260 hexap. De Geo. Pl., p. 185. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July—Oct., 1839. 3 is Meteorological Observations made in (Geo. Pl., p. 152) that a comparison betwixt annual mean tem- peratures of Europe and the elevated tropical regions would by no means give a correct state of the climate. Thus, though the mean temperature of the south of France and of Quito be the same, (about 59°) such fruits as peaches, apricots, pears, figs and grapes, which ripen in perfection in the former, although abun- dantly produced in the latter, never attain their proper size or flavor. The reason is, that the temperature is equal throughout the year. There is consequently no period, as in Europe, of summer heat sufficient to ripen fruit requiring at this season a mean temperature of 65° or 70°. As far, however, as the height of 7,000 feet all kinds of fruit are cultivated with success; and the markets of the colder country are thus constantly supplied from the neighboring valleys or “ calientes.” Humboldt is mis- taken in supposing the olive always barren (semper sterilis manet, p. 154.) On the Quitenian Andes near Hambato, it produces abundantly, though little attention is paid to its cultivation. hen we ascend above the extreme limit of cultivation, which may be placed at 11,500 feet, and pass the region of the Barnadesia, Hyperica, Thitandic, Gaultheria, Buddleia, and other coriaceous leaved shrubs which, at this elevation, form thick- ets of perpetual bloom and verdure, we enter the region of Par- _ amos (13,000 to 15,000 feet) properly so called, which present to the eye unvaried deserts clothed with long grass, constituting the pasture grounds of the Andes. Humboldt is inclined to fix below this region the limit of forest trees; (Geo. Pl., p. 148) and in fact very few are generally met with near this elevation on those flanks of the Cordillera which join the inhabited table lands. But I have observed on crossing the side of Pichincha, towards the uninhabited forests of Esmeraldas, that the forests occur nearly through the whole space which, on the eastern slope, is a naked paramo. Is this owing to a difference of climate? Or has the practice of burning the paramos, universal in the Andes, together with the demand for fire-wood in the vicinity of large towns, con- tributed to give this region the bare aspect it Lins at present ? Further observations on the mountain slopes towards Maynas and Macas are necessary to throw light on this point. It is certain from the present aspect of the inhabited plain of Quito, where we meet with a few scattered trees of Arayan (Myrtus) and ar- tificial plantations of Capuli, (Prunus saltesfolia ) we should con- he > cael oo Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. 19 clude that the region of forests had ae. osetia to the height of 8,000 feet, yet some of the houses of Quito: are still standing, built with timber cut on the spot. A circumstance which cannot have escaped the notice of those who have ascended towards the limit of perpetual snow, is the variety and luxuriance of the Flora at the very point where the powers of vegetation are on the brink of total suspension. At above 15,000 feet the ground is covered with Gentianas, purple, azure and scarlet ; the Drabas, the Alchemillas ; the Culatiwm rufescens with its woolly hood; the rich Ranunculas Gusmanni ; the Lupinus nanus with its cones of blue flowers enveloped in white down; the Sida Pichinchensis spotting the ground with purple ; the Chaqierts ca insignis ; all limited within a zone of about 500 feet, from whence they seem scarcely to be separated by any effort at artificial cultivation, Several attempts I have made to raise the Gentians, Sida, and other plants of the summits of the Andes, at the height of Quito, have been invariably unsuc- cessful. The attempts indeed to domesticate plants in a situation less elevated, is attended with greater difficulties than the trans- port of plants from one climate to another. Besides the differ- ence of atmospherie pressure, as Humboldt has observed, plants transferred from one elevation to another never meet, for a single day, with the mean temperature to which they have been accus- tomed; whereas, transferred from one latitude to another, the difference is rather in its duration than in its intensity. It is easier to accustom a plant of the lowlands to this elevation, than to bring down those of the paramos. Thus the orange and lem- on trees, Aguacates (Laurus persea) Ricinus communis, Datura arborea, all natives of the hot lowlands, grow and flourish, more or less at an elevation of 8,000 feet above the level of the sea, On the Method of Measuring Heights by Boiling Waiter. Ir will be observed in the following Journal, that the indication of heights is, in most cases, joined with that of boiling water. The former is in fact a deduction from the latter ; I had but a confused idea of this method, till, upon my arrival at Quito, [ met with a pamphlet of the late D. Francisco José Caldas, (one of the most eminent victims sacrificed by the barbarity of Mu- rillo on taking possession of Bogota in 1816, ) published in 1819 at Bourdeaux, in which he details the steps by which he arrived ve 20 Meteorological Observations made in at a knowledge of this principle, and the experiments by which he confirmed it. In the year 1801, during a scientific excursion in the neighborhood of Popayan, he happened to break his ther- mometer ; and in attempting to mend it he was led to observe the variability of the extremity of the scale corresponding to the heat of boiling water. His reflections on this subject led him, after various experiments, to the following conclusions: “The heat of boiling water is in proportion to the atmospherical pres- sure: the atmospherical pressure is in proportion to the height above the level of the sea; the atmospherical pressure follows the same law as the risings of the barometer, or, properly speak- ing, the barometer shows nothing more than the atmospherical pressure. Boiling water therefore shows it in the same manner as the barometer. It can consequently show the elevation of places in the same manner, and as exactly as this instrument.” Ensayo de una memoria sobre un nuevo ‘metodo de medir las montanas, etc. p. 10. His first experiment in Popayan gave b. w. 75°.7 of Reaumur, the height of the barometer being 22 in. 111. To find then the variation corresponding to one inch of the barometer : % 28in, —29in, 11). = 5°.1 or 61 lines. 80°—75°.7=4°.3. Then 2) G2, 49.3: 5198: : = 7 =0°.8. Then reversing the process 09.8 121,:74°.3 : —_ tt 5=5iAd Difference betwixt this result and ssn of the barometer 34 lines. Satisfied with this commencement, or dawning of a new theory, he began a series of experiments in the mountains near Popayan, taking this city as the centre of his labors, and fixing the eleva- tion of the barometer at 22i, 111. 2, and boiling water at 75°.65 of Reaumur. At aspot named Las Juntas I made my first observation. The barometer stood at 21i 9!, or 14! lower than at Popayan; the heat of boiling water was 74°.5 Reaumur. ‘Then Height of the barometer in Popayan 22: 11.2 B. W. 75°.65 at Las Juntas 21 9 742.50 1 22 19.15 Colombia between the Years 1820 and 1830. > oF 1 2.2=1412 ; 19.15:-12! a sole 5) 43 = 0°.971 of Reaumur for 12'. of the barometer. I ascended to Paisbamba, a small farm leagues south of Popayan. Barometer 20: 91.1. B. W. 73°. Barometer in Popayan 22i 111.2 i W. 75°.65 in Paisbamba 20 9.1 B. W. 73 .50 Differences 2° 2.1 2° 15 12 x2.15 2 2.1=261.1 ; 2°.15::12 96.1 = 9°-988 of Reaumur, for 12 lines of the barometer. I ascended a hill E. of Paisbamba called Sombreros. Barom- eter 19'. 6.5. B. W. 72°.4. Barometer in Popayan 22' 111.20. B. W. 75°.65 on Sombreros 19 9.05. B. W. 72 .40 Differences 3 5.15. we: ee 12x39 25 AllL15 3; 30, 2o:: ais =0.947 for 12 lines barometer. I ascended the hill of Tambores: barometer 18 111.6. B. W. 71°.75. Barometer in Popayan 22: 1112. B. W. 75°.65 on Tambores 18 11.6. BW TL 76 Differences 3 11 .6. 3 .90 2 A716 : 3°.9::12 ee =0.983 for 12! barometer. go Proof that above Io of Reaumur is the true exponent of one inch of the barometer. I then proceeded to take the observations of Las Juntas and Sombreros, and calculating the exponent anew. Barometer in Las Juntas 21 9 B. W. 74.60 in Sombreros 19 6.05 | 72.40 Differences 2.2.95 ; 2,2 12 x2.2 26.95 3 29.2: :12 26.95 =0°.979 Reaumur for 12 lines of the barometer. oe Meteorological Observations made in Barometer in Paisbamba 20 9.1. B. W. 73°.50 in Tambores 18 11.6. 71.75 Differences 1 9.5 Baga 1219.7 1.9.5=2115 ; 1°.75::12 —g7—5—=0°.976 of Reaumur for 12 lines of barometer. The mean of the six quotients is 0.974, which may be assumed as the exact exponent of 12 lines of the barometer. Given then the heat of boiling water in any place to find the corresponding elevation of the barometer, and consequently its height above the sea. As 0°.974: 12 lines, so is the difference of the heat of B. W. To ascertain at Popayan the number of inches, lines, é&c. of the barometer. Ex. in Tambores, B. W. 71°.15, to find the corres- ponding height of the barometer. B. W. in Popayan 75°.65 in'Tambores 71 .75 3 .90 3.9X12 0.974 : 12:: “O74 =481.05 = 4.0.05. As Tambores is above Popayan, deduct this quantity fromthe _ | height of the barometer in that city. Barometer in Popayan 22 11.20 Deduct 4 00.05 — - Remain 18 11.15 ht. of bar. in Tambores. Barometrical height observed 18 11.60 Do. by calculation of B. W. 18 11.15 Difference A5 a result as exact as can be desired. Upon this principle I calculated the elevation of the following eleven places: Popayan, Poblason, untas, Buenavista, Paisbamba, Hevradura, Sombreros, Pasto, Tambores, Quito. Estrellas, Memoria, Sc. p. 13. et seq. Colombia between the years 1820 and 1830. 23 Working upon the foregoing principle, Caldas adapted to his thermometer a barometrical scale. The product of 0°.974 of Reaumur by 19 is 18.506, or, in round numbers 18.5, i.e. 18°.5 of Reaumur corresponds to 19 inches of the barometer. Then measuring 18.5 from the summit, or 80° of Reaumur’s scale, he transferred it to the opposite side of the thermometer, dividing it into 19 equal parts, or inches of the barometer, subdividing these by a nonius into 24 each = half a line of the barometer. In this manner the elevation of the thermometer by boiling water indicates the corresponding elevation of the barometer under the same atmospheric pressure. Caldas observes that Humboldt, to whom he had communicated these ideas, when they met in Popayan, objected the variability of the heat of boiling water under the same atmospherical pressure ; to which he replies: ‘“ Long practice has taught me its invariability in this respect, using the requisite precautions in making the ex- periment: otherwise, how could there be equal thermometers ? Is not the invariability of the heat of boiling water under the pressure of twenty-eight inches, the foundation of the superior term of all thermometrical scales? It is true that boiling water does not immediately acquire its extreme heat, but pushing the Operation to its maximum its heat is always the same.” p. 24. Caldas did not consider an invariable exponent possible, on ac- count of the variability of atmospheric pressure. ‘The want, however, of a barometer induced me to make some experiments to this effect, by way of rendering this method of measuring el- evations still more simple, and of more general use. Is the va- riability of atmospheric pressure such as to make any important difference in these calculations? Does not water boil constantly at 212° at the level of the sea? At Quito I found the same re- sult as Caldas had several years before; and several times the same result in this and other parts of the Andes. The difference then, is scarcely perceptible in the th meter, and consequently unimportant in the results of a calculation founded on the heat of boiling water. The thermometer besides, immersed in boiling water, is less liable to a variety of atmospheric influences to which the mercury of the barometer is necessarily subject. Hence the great differences in different barometrical measure- ments of the same elevations, and the differences observed be- twixt different thermometers exposed to the air in the same place, 24 Meteorological Observations made in, Sc. 4 which I have observed on comparing three together to amount at often to 14°, and never to less than 4°. E 1 took the following method to obtain an exponent of the 4 value in feet of each degree of the diminished temperature % boiling water. 7 The elevation of Quito is, according to Boussingault, 95245 - and water boils at 1969.25; 212° —196°.25=15°.5. 9524 15.75=604 ft. 6. in. nearly. Nitectig the fraction as unite : portant, I assumed 604 for the value of the degree, and began my < observation on the conical hill of Javirac, which backs the city, ; ; and is calculated at 729 feetin height. Water boiled here by two. ~ thermometers at 195°. Then 1969.25 ~—195=1.25, difference ce of boiling water between the hill and the city; and 1.25x604= 755 feet ; difference 26 feet. I next ascended the volcano of ~ Pichincha, and found at the foot of the crater B. W. 186°.212° — 186°=26° x 604 = 15,730 feet ; and adding 246 feet, the differ- ence between this point and the summit, reckoned at 15,976. There could be little error in the calculation. I next applied this formula to the heights of several places calculated by Humboldt, and where the heat of boiling water had been ascertained by Thus Bogota, height according to Humboldt - 8694 ft. > B. W. according to Caldas 1979.6 - - - 8712 5 Difference —- - - 18 Popayan, according to Humboldt - = - 5823 Bi We2022.2 1k: <- . - - - 5922 Difference - - - 99 Paste according to Humboldt - - - 8572 B. W. .197°.6 - - - - 8712 Difference - ~ - 140 ft. The differences here are in four points 27 feet, 18, 99, 140. With respect to the hill of Javirac, commonly called Bl Pane- cillo, 1 suppose the measurement to have been made by the Ac- ademicians. But their calculations generally differ from those of Humboldt, as in the case of Quito; the former giving 9371 feet, the latter 9537 ; Pichincha 15 ,606 feet, Humboldt 15,976 ; Chim- borazo 20,583, Humboldt 21,414. But even a difference. of sites » = "water boil at 187° on the summit of Mont Blanc, being, accord- Remarks on the Trilobite. 25 is sufficient to account for the 27 feet on ground so unequal as that of Quito. The 18 feet in the height of Bogota is so trifling a difference, that it rather proves the exactness of my calculation. In Popayan we have 99 feet ; yet the different barometrical meas- urements of that city differ still more widely. Caldas observes, p. 31, “The Baron de Humboldt’s barometer stood in Popayan at 233.4, mine at 2211.2, and Bouguer’s at 2210.7.” The most accurate measurements of the peak of Teneriffe, selecting A out of 14, leaves a difference of 71 French toises, or rejecting the barometric measurements of Borda, of 18 toises. —Humboldt, s. Nar. v. 1, p. 160, 170. Saussure is said to have found ing to Humboldt, 15,660 ft. It is 90 ft. only below the point on Pichincha, where 1 found it to boil at 186°. The elevations nearly equal the difference cannot amount to a degree; and I consider the error less likely to be on my side, because I was aware of the probable cause of error, and had to deduce the height from the accuracy of the observation. Humboldt in the same manner suspects the accuracy of Lamouroux’s observation on the peak of Teneriffe——P. Nar. vol. i. p. 159. [To be continued.] Arr. Il.—Remarks on the Trilobite; by Jacos Green, M. D., Professor of Chemistry in the Jefferson Medical College, Phila- delphia. Remarks.—We are informed by the author that the present communication was written originally for this Journal ; but some peculiar circumstances induced him to publish it (March 16, 1839) in the Friend, a weekly Journal of Philadelphia. By the author’s request it is now republished with additions.—Z THE anatomical structure and, physiological history of the whole family of the trilobites are not only involved in great ob- scurity, but we can scarcely hope that the most persevering efforts of the naturalist will ever be able to penetrate the darkness, or unravel the mysteries, which involve the subject. No depart- ment in the science of organic remains has been pursued of late with more zeal and curiosity than this. ‘The trilobite furnishes Vad. xxxvur, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. = ..* Remarks on the nee the earliest “example of an articulated ar “pound — ss ancient inhabitants of our globe, and aletiagabs in some few existing genera we find certain points of analogy in their organization, the whole race probably became extinct after the subsidence of the great coal formation. Dr. Buckland remarks, “No trilobites have yet been found in any strata more recent that the carboniferous series ; and no other crustaceans, except three es which are also GrriGinitieieaeanie have been noticed in stré val with any of those that contain the remains of trilobites ; so ‘that during the — long periods that intervened between the deposition of the earliest , ; fossilliferous strata and the termination of the coal formation, the a trilobites appear to have been the chief representatives of a class which was largely multiplied into other orders ee owned after these earliest forms became extinct.” From the multitude of trilobites and frapeilite i trilobites which have been discovered in different parts of the world, most of which present nothing but portions of the upper shell of the fossil, the discovery of the figure of the under side of the animal, and of the form and arrangement of the organs of locomotion, seems almost hopeless. As the solid parts of the animal struc- ture alone are for the most part susceptible of petrifaction, it is not to be expected the softer portions would leave any traces — whatever in the rocks which have entombed and so perfectly — preserved these ancient inhabitants of our planet; for these rea- sons; and some others which we shall presently mention, the legs of the trilobite have been supposed to be soft and very perishable paddles. Although much controversy formerly existed as to the true na- ture of the trilobite, it is now admitted by all naturalists to occupy a place among crustaceous animals. The existing genera to which they are most analogous in their general structure are the serolis, the limulus, and the branchipus. In our monograph we announced the discovery of a recent trilobite in the southern Seas, near the F'alkland islands: this proves to be a species of the genus serolis established by Dr. Leach. In the configuration of its upper shell it approaches exceedingly near to that of some of the trilobites ; the chief difference between the recent and fossil animal Spoete in the crustaceous legs and antenne of the serolis. The analogies existing between the limulas and our fossil, as we mentioned in another place, have been shown by Dr. Dekay and others. narks on the Trilobite. 27 . In further illustr: of this subject, we here add, with some slight alterations, from Dr. Buckland’s admirable Bridgewater - treatise, a considerable part of his section on the trilobites, which exhibit’ in a very condensed form the facts and opinions which have any be. ring on thisinquiry. I have greater satisfaction and more confidence in referring to his remarks, than in attempting to offer any thing of a similar nature drawn up by myself. After mentioning 1 that ¢ ‘serolis is the nearest approach among living animals to the external form of trilobites, he adds, the next “ap- proximation to the character of trilobites occurs in the limulus or king grab, * a genus now most abundant in the seas of warm cli- mates, cl ¢ y in those of India, and of the coasts of America. The saiges of this genus is important, on account of its relation both to the existing and extinct forms of crustaceans ; in it there are but slight traces of antenn, and the shield wiels covers the anterior portion of the body, is expanded entirely over a series of crustaceous legs. Beneath the second, or abdominal portion of the shell, is placed a series of thin, horny, transverse plates, sup- porting the fibres of the branchiz, and at the same time acting as paddles for swimming. The same disposition of laminated bran- chiz is found also in the serolis. Thus while the serolis presents a union of antenne and crustaceous legs, with soft paddles bear- ing the branchiz, we have in the limulus a similar disposition of legs and paddles, and only slight traces of antenne ; in the bran- chipus we find antennz, but no crustaceous legs; while the tri- lobite being without antenne and having all its legs represented by soft paddles, is by the latter condition placed near branchipus * In my boyhood I was very familiar with the habits of this crustacean, called in the northern States, horse fish—or horse shoe fish, from its form On the fine hard sea beach at Fairfield in Connecticut, I was in the habit of taking these animals in great numbers, for the purpose of feeding ducks: the ova very abundant, and being greedily devoured by the young ducks, aft er the cending the bhelving beack, until they arrive in shallow water. The sailacii wea sea at Fairfield, rippling over siliceous sand, enabled me and my puerile compan- ions to see them through the waves, and by wading we easily secured them by seizing the spike or tail, their motion being too slow to admit of their escape. Hundreds oF them ees ve been caught at a single tide, of every size from nearly a foot in diamete: inch or less—these infants having also the power of travelling on the OT. —Sev. E 28 Remarks on the Trilobite. among the entomostracous crustaceans, in the order of branchio- pods, whose feet are represented by ciliated paddles, combining the functions of respiration and_natation. “In the comparison here made between four different families of crustaceans, for the purpose of illustrating the history of the long extinct trilobites, by the analogies we find in the serolis, lim= ulus, and branchipus; we have a beautiful example, taken from the extreme points of time of which geology takes cognizance, of that systematic and uniform arrangement of the animal kingdom, under which every family is nearly connected with adjacent and cognate families. Three of the families under consideration are among the present inhabitants.of the water, while the fourth has been long extinct, and occurs only in a fossil state. When we see the most ancient trilobites thus placed in immediate contact with our living crustaceans, we cannot but recognise them as forming part and parcel of one great system of creation, connected through its whole extent by perfect unity of design, and sustained in its minutest parts by uninterrupted harmonies of organization. “We have in the trilobites an example of that peculiar, and, as it is sometimes called, rudimentary development of the organs of locomotion in the class crustaceans, whereby the legs are made bias oe) en ol Sie 2M ic subservient to the double functions of paddles and lungs. The — advocate for the theory of the derivation of existing more perfect species, by successive changes from more simple ancient forms, might imagine that he sees in the trilobite the extinct parent stock, from which, by a series of developments, consecutive forms of more perfect crustaceans may, during the lapse of ages, have been derived; but according to this hypothesis, we ought no longer to find the same simple condition as that of the trilobite still retained in the living branchipus, nor should the primeval form of limulus have possessed such an intermediate charaeter, or have remained unadvanced in the scale of organization, from its first appearance in the carboniferous series, through the midway periods of the secondary formations, unto the present hour. “ Besides the above analogies between the trilobites and certain forms of living crustaceans, there remains a still more important point of resemblance in the structure of their eyes. This point deserves peculiar consideration, as it affords the most ancient, and almost the only example yet found in the fossil world, of the pre- servation of parts so delicate as the visual organs of animals that Remarks on the Trilobite. 29 ceased to live many thousands, and perhaps millions of years ago. We must regard these organs with feelings of no ordinary kind, when we recollect that we have before us the identical instru- ments of vision, through which the light of heaven was admitted to the sensorium of some of tl® ins created inhabitants of our planets. “'The discovery of such instruments in so perfect a state of preservation, after having been buried for incalculable ages in the early strata of the transition formation, is one of the most marvel- lous facts yet disclosed by geological researches ; and the struc- ture of these eyes supplies an argument, of high importance in connecting together the extreme points of the animal creation. An identity of mechanical arrangements, adapted to the construc- tion of an optical instrument, precisely similar to that which forms the eyes of existing insects and crustaceans, affords an ex- ample of agreement that seems utterly inexplicable without refer- ence to the exercise of one and the same Intelligent Creative Power. : “Professor Miller and Mr. Straus have ably and amply illus- trated the arrangements, by which the eyes of insects and crusta- ceans are adapted to produce distinct vision, through the medium of a number of minute facets, or lenses, placed at the extremity of an equal number of conical tubes, or microscopes; these amount sometimes, as in the butterfly, to the number of 35,000 facets in the two eyes, and in the dragon-fly to 14,000. “It appears that in eyes constructed on this principle, the image will be more distinct in proportion as the cones in a given portion of the eye are more numerous and long ; that, as compound eyes see only those objects which present themselves in the axes of the individual cones, the limit of their field of vision is greater or smaller as the exterior of the eye is more or less hemispherical. “If we examine the eyes of trilobites with a view to their prin- ciples of construction, we find both in their form, and i in the dis- position of the facets, obvious examples of optical tion. “In the asaphus caudatus each eye contains at least 400 nearly spherical lenses fixed in separate compartments on the surface of the cornea. ‘The form of the general cornea is peculiarly adapted to the uses of an animal destined to live at the bottom of the wa- ter: to look downwards was as much impossible as it was unne- cessary to a creature living at the bottom; but for horizontal vis- 30 Remarks on the Trilobite. ion in every direction the contrivance is complete. The form of each eye is nearly that of the frustrum of a cone, incomplete on that side only which is directly opposite to the corresponding side of the other eye, and in which, if facets were present, their chief range would be towards each otltr across the head, where no vis- ion was required. The exterior of each eye, like a circular bas- tion, ranges nearly round three fourths of a circle, each command- ing so much of the horizon, that where the distinct vision of one eye ceases, that of the other eye begins, so that in the horizontal direction the combined range of both eyes was panoramic. “If we compare this disposition of the eyes with that in the three cognate crustaceans,* by which we have been illustrating the general structure of the trilobites, we shall find the same mechanism pervading them all, modified by peculiar adaptations to the state and habits of each ; thus in the branchipus, which moves with rapidity in all directions through the water, and re- quires universal vision, each eye is nearly hemispherical, and placed on a peduncle, by which it is projected to the distance re- quisite to effect this purpose. . “In the serolis, the disposition of the eye, and its range of vis- ion, are similar to those in the trilobite, but the summit of the eye is less elevated ; as the flat back of this animal presents little ob- struction to the rays of light from surrounding objects. “Tn the limulus, where the side eyes are sessile, and do not command the space immediately before the head, two other sim- ple eyes are fixed in front, compensating for the want of range in the compound eyes over objects in that direction, “Tn the above comparison of the eyes of trilobites, with those of the limulus, serolis, and branchipus, we have placed side by side, examples of the construction of that most delicate and com- plex organ, the eye, selected from each extreme, and from a mid- way place in the progressive series of animal creations. We find in trilobites of the transition rocks, which were among the most ancient forms of animal life, the same modifications of this organ which are at the present time adapted to similar functions in the living serolis. The same kind of instrument was also employed in those middle periods of geological chronology, when the secondary strata were deposited at the bottom of a warm sea, * See annexed. the plates of Dr. Buckland, which being important to the just comprehension of the subject, we have caused to be copied.—Eps. % Remarks on the Trilobite. 31 inhabited by limuli, in the regions of Europe, which now form the elevated plains of central German “The results arising from these facta, are not confined to ani- mal physiology ; they give information also regarding the condi- tion of the ancient sea and ancient atmosphere, and the relations of both these media to light, at that remote period when the ear- liest marine animals were furnished with instruments of vision, in which the minute optical adaptations were the same that im- part the perception of light to crustaceans now living at the bot- tom of the sea “* With respect to the waters wherein the trilobites maintained their existence throughout the entire period of the transition for- mation, we conclude that they could not have been that imagin- ary turbid and compound chaotic fluid, from the precipitates of which some geologists have supposed that the materials of the surface of the earth to be derived; because the structure of the eyes of these animals is such, that any kind of fluid in which they could have been efficient at the bottom, must have been pure and transparent enough to allow the passage of light to organs of vision, the nature of which is so fully disclosed by the state of perfection in which they are preserved. “With regard to the atmosphere also we infer, that had it dif- fered materially from its actual condition, it might have so far affected the rays of light, that a corresponding difference from the eyes of existing crustaceans would have been found in the organs on which the impressions of such rays were then re- ceived. af “ Regarding light itself also, we learn from the resemblance of these most ancient organizations to existing eyes, that the mutual relations of light to the eye, and of the eye to light, were the same at the time when crustaceans endowed with the faculty of vision were first placed at the bottom of the —— seas, as at the present moment. “Thus we find among the earliest organic remains, an optical instrument of most curious construction, adapted to produce vis- ion of a peculiar kind, in the then existing representatives of one great class in the articulated division of the animal kingdom. We do not find this instrument passing onwards, as it were, through a series of experimental changes, from more simple into more complex forms ; it was created at the very first, in the full- 32 Remarks on the Trilobite. - Z ness of perfect adaptation to the uses and condition of the class — of creatures, to which this kind of eye has ever been, and is still — appropriate. “If we should discover a microscope, or telescope, in the hand of an Egyptian mummy, or beneath the ruins of Herculaneum, it would be impossible to deny that a knowledge of the principles of optics existed in the mind by which such an instrument has been contrived. The same inference follows, but with cumula- tive force, when we see nearly four hundred microscopic lenses set side by side, in the compound eye of a fossil trilobite ; and the weight of the argument is multiplied a thousand fold, when we look to the infinite variety of adaptations by which similar instruments have been modified, through endless genera and spe- cies, from the long lost trilobites, of the transition strata, through the extinct crustaceans of the secondary and tertiary formations, and thence onward throughout existing crustaceans, and the countless hosts of living insects. “Tt appears impossible to resist the conclusions as to unity of design ina common Author, which are thus attested by such cu- mulative evidences of Creative Intelligence and Power; both, as infinitely surpassing the most exalted faculties of the human — mind, asthe mechanisms of the natural world, when magnified — by the highest microscopes, are found to transcend the most per- fect productions of human art.” We now proceed to the more immediate object of this commu- nication, which is to describe a portion of the under side of the fossil animal, which we 2 have named in our monograph calymene bufo. Some time since, my attention was directed by Dr. J. J. Cohen, of Baltimore, to a number of fragments of the heads of this spe- cies, obtained from the vicinity of Berkley, Va., and which are still preserved in his cabinet. Three or four of these fragments seemed to disclose the configuration of the whole lower susie of the buckler, in a more or less perfect state. Within a few months, another friend brought for my examination, a fine large head of the same species, from the same locality, and which ex- hibited the under side or thorax, in quite a perfect state of pre- servation. All the fragments have precisely the same structure, 0 that there can be no doubt, we have now the external configura- tion of the entire head or buckler of the calymene bufo. Sie Beets Press) i aes Remarks on the Trilobite. a The anterior edge of the buckler of this species, as has been often observed, is marked by a deep groove or furrow, produced apparently by the junction of the upper and the under shell at this place, and which at first sight looks like the mouth of the animal ; indeed, Professor Brongniart calls the elevated ridges on each side of this groove the lips. The mouth was, however, placed no doubt much farther beneath. "These Zips, perhaps, indicate the separation of the shell, through which the trilobite crept out, and left his cast-off covering in the same manner as recent crustace- ans leave their exuvie. We know that the limulus polyphemus creeps through a somewhat similar opening, made along the whole anterior edge of his buckler.* In all our fragments, which exhibit the under surface of the buckler, the lower Jip is reflected beneath, so as to form a kind of scroll or rolled edge, extending from one side or angle of the head to the other. Beneath this, and passing backwards towards the tail, the surface of the shell is not flat and horizontal as in the isotelus and Limulus; but it swells up on each side, below the oculiferous prominences, into a kind of oval pouch, dirsdiitatainng in breadth as it recedes, and at last terminates in a rounded point, below the second articulation of the vertebral column. This is the position of the gullar pouch or plate, when the animal assumes a creeping or swimming atti- tude ; but when rolled up in the form of a ball, for the purpose of defence, then the gullar plate being composed of a single piece, and therefore not contractile, reached below the fourth ar- ticulation of the back. Some of our specimens illustrate this conformation in a very satisfactory manner. None of our frag- ments exhibit fairly the small surface on each side of the gullar plate, and the edge of the buckler beneath the eyes. This space was probably slightly concave, and occupied with the mandibles and their palpi, as in the genus serolis—the mouth being no doubt placed near the rounded termination of the gullar pouch. Thus we have at last discovered nearly the whole inferior sur- face of the buckler of the genus calymene, a portion which in- cludes about one third of the animal. Not the slightest impres- sion or other vestige of antennee can be perceived, and we may therefore pretty confidently conclude, that this genus of trilobites were destitute of those organs. Professor Demarest, in his his- * See Dr. Dekay. Annals of Natural History, vol. 1. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. ‘ 34 ~Remarks on the Trilobite. tory of fossil | erustacea, seems to have ascertained by his useful and ingenious researches, that the irregularities of the external shells in the living species of crustaceans have a constant relation to distinct compartments in their internal organization, and by the application of these distinctions to fossil species, he has been enabled to draw some highly curious, novel, and important con- clusions respecting their internal and general structure. From my limited knowledge of the anatomy and the habits of our living crabs, I would merely suggest, that the peculiar organ in the animal economy of the trilobite, which the gullar plate above described, was intended to model and protect, was perhaps the stomach, and that the spaces on each side covered the anterior portions of the liver. The upper shell of the genus calymene, like that of the iso- telus and depleuva, naturally and obviously divides itself into three parts, the buckler or shield—the abdomen and the caudal end. This last portion in the calymene is not covered with a thick epidermis, as in the two genera above mentioned, the ar- ticulations being all visible and somewhat difficult, in some spe- cies, to distinguish from those of the abdomen. These articula- tions, which are generally ten in number, are composed of a | variety of immovable plates as in the other genera. The infe- — rior surface of the caudal end of the trilobite had never been ¥ observed by any naturalist, till my friend#Dr. Cohen, obtained some fragments of the genus calymene from the neighborhood of Berkley Springs, in Virginia, in some of which that structure was developed. These were kindly sent to me for examination, along with those of the buckler just described. From our researches we have ascertained, that the inflexible margin which surrounds the caudal end or tail of the calymene bufo, is not reflected beneath the body of the animal, as might be expected, but that there is joined to it by a structure a slightly concave horizontal surface. This surface is lunate, being broader below the articulations of the vertebral column, gradually dimin- ishing on each side towards the horns of the crescent, which terminates just below the last articulations of the abdomen. This lunate surface is composed of a thick crustaceous plate or piece. Beyond this crescent shaped piece, directly below the vertebral column, there is a deep cavity in the under shell of the animal, which corresponds in figure and dimensions with the gullar pouch aes Remarks on the Tribbil. - ——s«SB’ or under surface of the buckler. By this peculiar mechani whenever the animal rolled itself into a ball, to give protection to the soft parts of the abdomen, the protuberance under the shield would be introduced into the cavity below the tail, and thus retain the whole shell in a fixed position. In this position, with the tail closed upon the buckler, the calymene is often found. Professor Wahlenberg considers those trilobites only as perfect animals, which are found rolled, the others being merely exuded or cast-off shells, and in such alone, he remarks, can we expect to discover the organization of the inferior surface. _ Most of the fragments from Berkley Springs, which have occasioned my pre- sent remarks, are found rolled up or partially coiled animals. All trilobites have not, however, this power ; indeed, it seems to be principally confined to those only whose extremities are rounded and nearly equal in size. The rolled position would afford to the paradoxides and to many of the asaphs, but little security against the attacks of their enemies, and we rarely if ever find them in this attitude. The remark of Professor Wahlenberg above cited, though illustrated by the specimens now under consideration, we think of far too general a nature. The deep cavity beneath the tail in the fragments which we are describing, reaches forward towards the head as far as the ninth articulation ofthe back ; in other words, a portion of it lies beneath the three last abdominal divisions. It will be recollected that the gullar pouch reaches below the fourth articulation of the back, and that the whole number of divisions in the vertebral column in the genus calymene, is twelve; we have therefore discovered in these fragments almost the whole of the inferior surface, except the portion which lies below the five articulations of the back commencing with the fifth from the buckler or shield ; what we shall offer in regard to this portion of the animal must be merely hypothetical, or founded on certain analogies of struc- ture which probably existed between living crustaceous animals and the fossil remains of such as inhabited the most ancient seas. Some of our fragments, we think, exhibit a transverse section of our trilobite, showing the position and figure of the abdominal cavity which once contained a portion of the viscera of the ani- mal. One of the sections is through and parallel with the sixth articulation of the back: by this means we have discovered that oe Remarks on the Tr s some of the viscera swere ‘placed i in aleylindrioal cavity running beneath the vertebral column, and that the sidelobes were onlya covering and protection to the soft paddles or feet placed below, Se as may be seen in a similar structure in the | serolis. Each of the five articulations of the abdomen, the Re side of which we 2 have not yet discovered, was probably furnished below, on each side of the abdominal cavity, with organs, which performed the double office of feet and lungs. Now, as our fragments develope all the inferior surface except the portion beneath these five ar- ticulations of the abdomen, it is probable that our trilobite was a decapodous animal. Professor Brongniart long ago imagined, - that the reason why no traces of these organs have yet been dis- covered, is that the trilobites held that place among crustaceous animals in which the antenne cieppe and the legs become transformed into soft paddles incapable o er Vv If this supposition be true, we shall in vain ‘look for ‘any further discove- ries below the upper shell of the trilobite. What affords, we think, increasing probability to the opinion we have just advanced with regard to the situation of the abdominal cavity, and the or- gans of locomotion below the five abdominal arches above men- tioned, is, that when the animal rolled itself up for protection, — this portion of the body would still retain nearly a rectilinear position ; thus no interference would occur in the ordinary fune- _ tions of the animal economy when the body was contracted. Besides the organs of locomotion and respiration beneath the abdominal arches of the genus calymene, it is probable that on each side of the deep cavity under the caudal end there was placed a series of thin transverse plates, which also performed the combined functions of breathing and swimming: a similar disposition of laminated branchiz may be observed also in the _limulus and in the serolis. Beneath this deep cavity the heart of the animal was also probably placed. What we have said with regard to the inferior mechanism of the trilobite, applies exclusively to the genus calymene. It is probable that this structure differs essentially in all the genera of this remarkable family. Dr. Dekay has described and figured in the first volume of the Annals of the Lyceum of Natural His- tory of New York, the under side of the buckler of the isotelus, which is very peculiar in its configuration ; he describes this in- ferior surface as being formed by the anterior part of the buckler ly - oie Triite. 37 low wid parents These horns are weir points are sharp and translucent. m Dr. Warder a specimen of this singular ‘ound, with other fragments of the isotelus, Springfield in _ Although it lies on the rock, unaccom- panied by any other fragment of the animal, its exact resemblance to the figure given by Dr. Dekay leaves no doubt that it once belonged to an isotelus. Among other conjectures respecting the uses of this. proscar ieala pees structure, it is observed that when the animal was attacked “it may roll itself up into a ball, as indeed it is often found, ‘and by some mechanism these processes may be inserted into the corresponding cavities in the tail, and thus retain permanently a rolled position, presenting sible but its calcareous covering to the enemy; or they may supply the place of antenne, for which their form and contiguity to the mouth and brain zould seem to render them peculiarly applica- ble.” The first conjecture above noticed was ingenious, and will no doubt be confirmed when the lower surface of the tail is dis- covered. The inferior organization of the calymene bufo has at any rate given great plausibility to this opinion. _ We have also carefully examined another fragment represent- ing a similar structure. The original fossil was found in Ohio, and is now in the possession of W. Wagner, Esq. of Philadel- phia. The rock on which it occurs is a gray limestone full of other petrifactions. This lunate structure differs essentially from the one noticed by Dr. Dekay; the points of the crescent are rounded and do not curve towards each other ; the terminations are not raised and translucent, but the whole surface is nearly flat. It however formed, undoubtedly, a portion of the under surface of some trilobite, whether that of an asaphus, an isotelus, or a dipleura, we are unable now to determine. In the Geol. Trans., No. 8, Vol. I, pl. 27, there is a figure by Mr. Stokes of what is said to be the under surface of the anterior portion of the shield of an asaphus platycephalus from Lake Huron. Dr. Buck- land, whose copy of the figure we have only seen, observes con- cerning it, that the entrance to the stomach of the animal was between these lunate processes ‘“ analogous to that in recent crabs.” The A. phatycephalus is synonymous with J. gigas of * 38 Renae on the Trilobite. Dr. Dekay ; and if Mr. Stokes’s drawing and Dr. Dekay’s figure be accurate representations of nature, we think they must be drawn from analogous fragments helongee to animals at least specifically distinct. In Mr. Wagner’s cabinent there is another fragment of the un- der surface with lunate processes, somewhat resembling the one just described ; but instead of being composed of a flat plate or surface, it forms one that is convex, very much resembling the figure given by Dr. Buckland from Mr. Stokes. From this frag- ment it is perfectly evident, that this lunate structure is composed of an upper and under plate, the one convex and the other plain or flat, so as to form, when united, a plano-concave, hollow, lu- nate box or cavity. The physiological relations of this struc- ture I am unable to suggest; but since the above remarks were penned, I have seen a copy of Murchison’s Silurian System, &c., from which the following extract is made, which may throw some light on this matter, and is otherwise interesting. “I have seen the work of Pander at too late a period to enable me to pro- fit much by his views concerning the original structure of the trilobite or the adaptations of the tegumentary skeleton of the an- imal to its habits, into the consideration of which he enters at length. He certainly throws some new light on the nature of — these creatures by exposing the interior or under surface—partic- ularly that of their heads, in which he points out several divis- ions, and considers them to be the thoracic plate and jaws. The central portion, or that which was formerly described by Mr. Stokes from a North American specimen, he considers to have been connected with the head by cartalage only, and to have served as a thoracic plate to protect the stomach, the form of which varies in the different genera of trilobites found in Russia. On referring this subject to my friend Mr. W. Mc Lay, whose knowl- edge of invertebrated animals is so profound; he assures me that this plate on the under side of the head, above alluded to, must be considered as the dabrum or upper lip. The trilobite is thus brought into close analogy with certain entomostracha such as the Apus Cancrirormis, &c.” We have called the fossil remain which has occasioned the present remarks respecting the organization of the under surface of the trilobite, calymene bufo, a name which we proposed some years since in our little work on these interesting reliques. Other Sat Remarks on the Trilobites. 39 writers have applied to it the term calymene macrophthalma, first given by Professor Brongniart, not only to this fossil, but to an- other, which differs essentially from it. He has given in his admirable work on this subject good figures of both animals, but his specific description refers only to plate 1, figure 4, A.B. He observes, “that the species is remarkable by the prolongation of the anterior portion of the buckler in the form of a snout, and that its middle lobe, or front, is marked on its sides by three oblique plice or wrinkles, like those on the C. tristani.” This descrip- tion applies very well to some reliques found in the Dudley rock, which we have examined, but it is perfectly obvious that the cal- ymene bufo, which has a rounded front, and is entirely destitute of plice or wrinkles, cannot be included in it. We therefore took the liberty in our little work of calling by the name of caly- mene bufo, the fossil represented on his first plate at figure 5, and which is so common in the United States; and of restricting the C. macrophthalma to the animals represented on the same plate at figure 4, which are specifically distinct, and if not so called, must still remain nameless. which I have named Calymene Bufo. There are several objections to this no- menclature. Ist, The C. Macrophthalma, Brong. was long ago divided into two species by me for the reasonabove stated. 2d, In M. Achille Comptés large pic- s figure 4, A. B.; naturalists therefore already know it under that name. The following are Mr. Murchison’s remarks on this subject: “I have separated the C. Macrophthalma, Brong. into two species, believing that his figure plate 1, figure 4, B, is our common large eyed species, and that his figure 4, A, of the same plate, judging from the ovate, accuminate head and the tubercles on the fore- head is our C. Downingiz. The last mentioned species is infinitely rarer than that to which I would restrict the name of Macrophthalma. That species is at once recognized by its bald, plain, rounded head, as is well exposed in the draw- ings of Mr. Stokes. See Brong. plate 1, figure5, A,B,C. I have named this spe- cies after Mrs. Downing, to whom I am indebted for the loan of it.” . 40 Description of a New Trilobite. Arr. IIL—Deseription of a New Trilobite; by Jacos Green, M. D, Prof. of Chemistry in the Jefferson Medical College, Philadelphia. Asaphus Diurus—Greren. Clypeo ? costis striatis, tuberculatis ; cauda bipartita; corpore depresso. = The fragments of this Asaph which I have examined, consist of nineteen articulations of the abdomen and tail. The costal arches of the lateral lobes are very peculiar. They are marked by a shallow groove, or impressed line on their upper surface, studded on each side with quite a regular row of bead-like granu- lations. On each division of the vertebral column, there is but a single row of pustulations. The lunate caudal end is more ex- panded than in the cognate species, the A. Selenurus, and the concave side of the cressent, is more regularly rounded; the whole animal is much more depressed, than that species, and the lateral lobes are much wider in proportion to the middle lobe of the back. There are two specimens of this fine species in the cabinet of William Wagner, Esq., of Philadelphia, both of which were found — in Green County, Ohio, in the neighborhood of Xenia. The largest which measures two inches long and two anda half inches _ wide, is a plaster cast from a weather beaten natural mould; the — other occurs in a grey, sparry, argillaceous limestone rock. It is perhaps worthy of remark, that all the specimens of the Asaph, with a lunate tail which I have noticed, were natural moulds, made by the animal in the rock, the shell or body having disap- peared. I was informed some time since, by Mr. Abraham Sager, of New York, that he had discovered several fine specimens of an Asaph with a lunate tail at the foot of the Helderberg mountains hear the Caves, in which the horns of crescent which forms the caudal termination were remarkably elongated and perfect. As the A. Selenurus is found at Glenn’s falls and at Becroft’s moun- tain near the city of Hudson, is quite a different rock from that which occurs at the Helderberg, and as this last formation seems analogous to the one in which the Asaphus Diurus is found, it is probable that Mr. Sager’s species may be the one now described. Tam indebted to the kindness of Mr. Wagner, for the opportu- nity of making out this species. 7 at es Natural History of Volcanos and Earthquakes. 4l Arr. IV.+On the Natural History of Volcanos and Earth- quakes ;* by Dr. Gustav Biscuor, Professor of Chemistry in the University of Bonn. Communicated by the Author. Con- cluded from Vol. xxxvi, No. 2, page EARTHQUAKES. Eartuaquakes, so closely connected with volcanic phenome- na, are undoubtedly owing to the same causes. That the pro- cesses by which they are produced must take place at a great depth, is evident from the simultaneous occurrence of earth- quakes at places far distant from one another. Some extraor- dinary examples in this respect are furnished by the memorable earthquake at Lisbon, on the 1st November 1755, which was not only felt over a great part of Hurope, but extended to the northern coast of Africa and the Antilles ; and farther, by the si- multaneous shocks felt on the 16th November 1827, and Ochotsk and Bogota, which places are 1900 geographical miles distant from each other, and are separated both by land and sea.t Parrott has calculated that about 700,000 German miles, that is, nearly one-twelfth of the whole surface of the earth, was shaken by the earthquake at Lisbon. Stukeley$ calculated _ from the extent of country over which earthquakes have been felt, that the force must, in some instances, be 200 English miles beneath the surface. But Daubeny]|| pointed out that we must not lay any stress on his remarks, because we have reason to be- lieve that the vibrations may be propagated latterly far beyond the immediate influence of the impelling force. In a former * From the Edinburgh New Philosophical Jour., Vol. xxvi, No. 52, April 1839. t Von Humboldt’s Reise, &c., vol. i, p. 497, sould vol. iii, p. 23a on Hoff, Verzeichniss Von Erdbeben, &c, in Poggendorff’s Ann. vol. xxi, p. 214. ¢ Physik der Erde, p. 289. See also Berghaus’ Almanack, 1837, p. 106, on the great extent of this extraordinary earthquake. With respect to this, it is worthy of remark, that Vesuvius, which was in some excitement on the morning of the The same happened during the earthquake in Calabria, The little voleano of which is continually active, subsided, and lino ceased smoking. § On ‘ie causes of earthquakes, Philos. Trans. for || Loco cit. p. 388. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839,.bis. 6 42 Natural History of Volcanos and Earthquakes. place, I have also shown, that the seat of volcanic action may be looked for at depths far less than Stukeley supposes. *But there is no reason to believe that earthquakes could go on at greater depths than volcanic actions. Supposing that the interior of the earth is still fluid, and that rents conducting water, extend from the surface to the fluid nucleus, it is easy to conceive that the ac- tions of the steam may be felt at very remote distances. We have already pointed out the close connection which ex- ists between earthquakes and volcanic eruptions. Von Hum- boldt, in his travels near the Equator, gives several examples of this. It may not be superfluous to refer here to what this illus- trious philosopher asserts generally with regard to these phenom- ena, at the end of the 4th chapter of the 2d volume of Part I, Book 2.* Every thing seems to show that earthquakes are caused by the effort of elastic fluids seeking an outlet. On the coasts of the South Sea their action is often communicated almost instan- taneously from Chil to the Gulf of Guayaquil, a distance of 600 geographical miles; and, what is very extraordinary, the shocks seem to be so much the stronger, the greater the distance from the active voleanos. The granite mountains of Calabria, the © limestone chain of the Apennines, the county of Pignerol, the — coast of Portugal and Greece, Peru, and the continent of Amer- ica, furnish striking proofs of this assertion.t It might be sup- posed that the earth would be more violently shaken, the fewer the openings on the surface which communicate with the inte- rior. At Naples and at Messina, at the foot of Cotopaxi, and the Tunguragua, earthquakes are dreaded only when vapors and flames do not issue from the mouth of the voleano. In the kingdom of Quito, the great catastrophe of Riobamba led many well informed persons to believe that this unfortunate country would be less often disturbed if the subterranean fire would succeed in destroying the dome of porphyry of Chimborazo, and if this colossal mountain should become an active volcano. At all times, analogous facts have given rise to similar hypoth- eses. he ancient Greeks, who, like us, attributed earthquakes * See also what Von Buch says on Vesuvius. Geognostische Beobacht. vol. ii, t Fleuriau de Bellevue, Journ. de Physique, t. Ixii, p. 261. Natural History of Volcanos and Earthquakes. 43 to the force of elastic fluids, brought forward, in support of their ° opinion, the total cessation of earthquakes in the island of H’u- bia, after the opening of a chasm in the Lelantic fields.* The intimate connection of earthquakes with volcanos is not less clearly proved by the direction which the former take. Wit the assistance of a simple instrament (the sismograph) invented by Cacciatore, and erected at Palermo, it was found in twenty- seven cases that the shock was propagated in a fixed linear di- rection, which coincided remarkably with the cardinal points. In nineteen cases the shocks were transmitted in a direction from east to west, corresponding with the situation of Mount Hina, the source of all these subterranean concussions, which lies di- rectly to the east of Palermo. In four cases it was from south to north; but, for want of corresponding observations, the seat of these shocks cannot be determined; and it certainly does not seem to have been the effect of chance, that three shocks, which were felt on the 9th February, 30th June, and 2d July 1831, traveled from the south-west to the north-east: for it was pre- cisely in that direction, at a distance of about 70 Italian miles, that the small new volcano suddenly appeared in the sea, prob- ably on the 2d July. The two latter shocks were also the very same that were felt with greater force at Sciacca, on the southern coast, opposite to the new volcano.t n the other hand, Boussingault{ asserts that the most mem- orable earthquakes in the New World, which ravaged the towns of Latacunga, Riobamba, Honda, Caraccas, Laguayra, Merida Barquisimeto, &c., do not coincide with any well oxtabliokid volcanic eruption. The oscillation of the surface, owing to an erruption, is, as it were, local; whilst an earthquake, which is not subject (at least apparently) to any volcanic eruption, extends to incredible distances, in which case it has also been remark that the shocks most commonly follow the direction of chains of mountains. In favor of the hypothesis, that earthquakes are produced by aqueous vapor|| penetrating to great depths, the following circum- * Strabo, lib. i, ed. Oxon. 1807, t. i, p. 85. i F. Hoffman in Poggend. Ann. t. xxiv, p. 63. t Annal. de Chim. et de Phys. t. lviii, p. 83. _ || Aremarkable case which has taken place at the iron-foundery at Sayn, proves, that shocks of the earth may be several times repeated by the effect of elastic flu- re A4 Natural History of Volcanos and Earthquakes. stances may be adduced. Firstly, as aqueous vapor is supposed to produce voleanic action, it must be presumed to be also the cause of earthquakes. Secondly, some hours before the first shock of the tremendous earthquake at Algiers and the neigh- borhood, the 2d to 5th March 1825, which entirely destroyed the town of Blisa, all the springs and wells are reported to have been dried up.* Thirdly, earthquakes, though undoubtedly felt even the centre of large continents, seem to produce their most fright- ful effects in countries not very far removed from the ocean. But perhaps, earthquakes may also be produced by gaseous exhala- tions in the interior of the globe. At least in many accounts of earthquakes, mention is made of the exhalation of gases from rents, produced by them,+ and the smell of sulphuric acid, and of sulphurous vapors, which indicate the presence of sulphuret- ids. to warrant the conclusion. that a mass of matter, containing these 2 geal in the nome indicated, aad united wit as much metallic iron as we know to exist in the state of an oxide in the generality of Javas, would form an ‘coven pos. pe xxxvil, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. ll 82 Reply of Dr. Daubeny to Prof. Bischof. sessing a higher a ern than that of the compound resulting from the oxi- dation of the en Let us take s a the analysis ise by Dr. Kennedy, of the lava from Etna, which he states to consist of Silica, 52 per cent X Sp. gr. 2.65 = 127.8 Alumina, 19 per cent X Sp. gr. 4.20 = 79.8 ime, 10 per cent X Sp. gr. 3.00 = 30.0 Oxide of Iron, 15 per cent X Sp. gr. 5.00 = 75.0 oda, 4 per cent X Sp. gr. 2.00 = 8.0 “100 320.6 as here find that 100 parts of this lava. have a specific gravity equal to 320.6, - ly that the = gravity of the | mass would be no more than 32, supposing it divested of w ow, let us contrast thie i the specific grav Ty of 100 parts of the metallic pees: which would give rise to a mineral possessing the above chemical compos Silica, 52, contains of base, 26 x Sp. gr. 2.0 = 52.0 Alumina, 19, contains of base, 10 % Sp. gr 2.0 = 20.0 Lime, i = Oxide of Iron, _15, contains of base, 12 X Sp. gr 7.8 = 93.6 Soda, = contains of base, 3 X Sp. gr. 1.0 = 3.0 58 196.6 ae as 58—196—100—340. Consequently the specific gravity of the whole would be no less than specific gravity of aluminium appears not to be ascertained, but probably 4 is not “ inferior to that of — which sinks in the strongest sulphuric acid, and there- fore is more than 1.83. aa: The theory, seks: we have been advocating, leaves the question, with re- spect to the cause of the Earth’s density, just on the same footing as before. Those who are of opinion, that the latter may be scplened by the mere conden- implies merely the existence of such a quantity of metallic ingredients, as would be sufficient to produce the materials ejected, leaving the constitution of the re- mainder just as open to conjecture as it was before. It is curious indeed, that whilst some have argued that the kind of materials found near the surface is inadequate to account for the density attributed to the Earth in general; others, as the late distinguished Professor Leslie, have con- tended, that these substances would have their specific gravity so much increased the enormous pressure from above, that void internal spaces must be neces- sarily s upposed. On this he has founded his singular hypothesis, that the centre of the Earth is filled only with light, the rarest substance known ; an idea, the Mere mention of which is sufficient to show how little we can be justified in re- Jecting an explanation of facts, merely because it appears to militate against the oes that may be conjured up with regard to the internal condition of our Reply of Dr. Daubeny to Prof. Bischof. 83 8th Objection.—If, according to Gay-Lussac, the hydrogen of the decomposed water goes to form muriatic acid with chlorine, the above mentioned acid ought to be general i in voleanos. Now, it is wanting, according to Boussingault, in the volcanos under the equator in the New World, and according to Bischof, in those near the Rhine. Answer.—I believe, that muriatic acid will be found pretty constantly present in volcanos now in activity. Sir H. Da found it at Vesuvius on both the occasions he visited that vol- cano, viz. 1815 and 1829. I myself in 1834, detected it there in great abundance; and in 1825, found it at the Solfatara, in the Island of Vulcano, and near Mount Etna. It has bien discovered also in the volcanos of Iceland; in those of Java, at Mount Idienne; and of South America, at Purace. The sal-ammonia which so abounds in the volcanos of Tartary, shows, that it is also present there ; and the existence of it in the trachytic rock of the Puy de Sarcouy in Auvergne, proves, that: it was a concomitant of = action in days that have gone by. All therefore that Bischof is warranted in inferring from its absence in the case of the volcanos of the Rhine and E.quatorial _ America, is, that it ceases to be disengaged when the action be- comes languid or extinct. Now there are many ways of account- ing for this. In the first place, granting the acid to be derived from the sea-salt present in the water which originated the vol- canic action, it would cease to be generated when this fluid no _ longer obtained admission ; or, when the heat was inadequate to cause the union of the alkali of the sea-salt with the earths present ; and even if it were still generated, it might be pre- vented from rising to the mouth of the crater, by combining in its way with the calcareous rocks through which it had to pass. Hence the carbonic acid, which Professor Bischof remarks as so abundantly evolved by the volcanos of the Rhine, may perhaps represent an equal volume of muriatic acid, by whose agency it had been evolved from the limestones that contained it. Thus have I replied seriatim to all the objections, which an acute and learned opponent has been able to adduce against the ‘chemical theory of volcanos; and having done so, might be ex- pected perhaps to proceed to some remarks on the one to which he himself has given the preference. 84 _ Mountains in New York. But in order not to occupy too much of your space, I will merely here remark, that Professor Bischof appears (at least in the portion of his memoir yet published) to pass over without any attempt at explanation, certain chemical phenomena of con- stant occurrence, which follow directly from the principles of he theory to which he has objected. These are, Ist, The evolution of sulphuretted sslcitrein in quantities far exceeding what are to be explained by the reac- tion of carbonaceous matter upon sulphates, or any of those other processes which sometimes produce it on the surface of the earth. 2dly, The disengagement of sal-ammoniac, for although one of the constituents of this compound, the muriatic acid, might arise from the decomposition of sea-salt by aqueous vapor, the other one, the ammonia, implies the presence of free hydrogen as well as of nitrogen gas, near the focus of the volcanic action. 3dly, The circumstance, which I have substantiated in so many cases, that I begin to believe it almost universally true, that the atmospheric air exhaled from volcanos, and indeed gene- rally from the interior of the earth, is deprived in a greater or less degree of its proper proportion of oxygen. That processes, there~ fore, by which this principle is abstracted, are going on exten- — sively within the globe cannot be denied, and hence I conceive that any theory, which attempts to account for volcanic action, without taking notice of so essential a phenomenon, ought to be regarded as imperfect and unsatisfactory. Art. VI —Mountains in New York ; by E. F. Jounson, Civil Engineer. In a report recently made, by the author of this article, of a survey of a route for the proposed Ogdensburgh and Champlain railway, the elevations above tide of the highest of each of the three distinct groups of mountains divided by the valleys of the Saranac and Au Sable rivers, are given as follows: Lyon Mountain, - - - - - - - 3,864 feet. Whiteface do. - - - - - ~ - 4,666 “ Mt. Marcy, eS ee ae ee STN ee 4,907 bt To this statement of elevations, the following note was appended : Mountains in New York. : se “The alieiee aoe Sivan were deduced from the angular ele- part gevisapl for the discrepancy be- tween the results above Pie and those contained in the geolo- gical report as derived from barometrical measurement.” Prof. Emmons, State Geologist for the Northern District of New York, in his last annual report, in reference to the above, has the following : “Tn a report to the Legislature this present session, Mr. E. F. Johnson, the Engineer of the Ogdensburgh and Champlain rail- road, questions the accuracy of the measurements of Mt. Marcy. In reply to his suggestions, I shall merely remark, that it is quite doubtful whether the mountain in question is distinguishable from those of the same group, especially by one who has never visited the interior of this section, and if visible, his measurement is not entitled to consideration except as a very imperfect approx- ME - The observations made by myself were taken, as stated, from an elevated point near Lake Champlain. _ The instrument used was of a superior kind, and, graduated, So as to give, with the aid of the nonius, fractions of degrees as small as 7$ seconds. On the day when the observations were made it was carefully adjusted. - Not only the peaks above mentioned, but the elevations of from 30 to 40 other points were observed, several of which had been previously measured. Among the latter number were the two most elevated peaks of the Green Mountains, Camels Hump and Mansfield ; these were found, the former to be 4,220 and the latter 4,359 feet above tide. These peaks, as measured barometrically by Capt. A. Partridge, (see Gazetteer of Vermont,) were found, the former to be 4,188 and the latter 4,279 feet above tide; dess in both cases than the results by trigonometrical menciiensclt: The barometrical ele- vations of Mt. Marcy and Whiteface, as given by Mr. Emmons, were on the contrary greater than the trigonometrical ; the former by 687 and the latter by 189 feet; the first being 5,594 and the second 4,855 feet above tide. It was this great discrepancy, that induced the remark of dis- trust, as to the entire correctness of Mr. Emmon’s barometrical 86 Mountains in New York. - measurement ; a discrepancy which cannot be attributed to any inaccuracy of adjustment in the instrument used by me, since if by any error in this respect, the angle of elevation was too great or too small in one case, it was also too great or too small in the other, producing a corresponding elevation or depression in both. Nei- ther can it be attributed toa difference in the estimated allowance for refraction, for this allowance was the same in both cases ; hence if too great or too small, the elevations of both were simi- aly affected and to the same amount. The observations were made from the same spot at nearly the same time of the same day ; hence there could probably be no great difference in the re- fractive power of the atmosphere. Again, so great a difference could not well result from an error in the distances, for although these were obtained as stated from the map, they were tested by comparing with known distances upon the same map, the latter having been projected on a large scale and compiled from actual surveys, with the positions of the several peaks, as is believed very accurately defined, that of Mt. Marcy in particular, coinciding very nearly with the location and. bearing of it from Whiteface and other points, as described by Mr. Emmons. That some other peak was taken for Mt. Marcy, oo me uct as is intimated by Mr. Emmons, is therefore scarcely possible, more especially as it is certain that the one observed was the highest of the group in which Mt. Marcy is situated. Had the peak in question been a lower instead of the highest one of the group, its not being “ distinguishable” — be urged by Mr. Emmons with more propriety. Assuming therefore, as is proper to do under these circumstan- ces, that the trigonometrical measurement exhibits very nearly the relative elevations of the high peaks in Vermont and New York, it follows, that to place Mr. Emmons’s barometrical meas- urements of Whiteface and Mt. Marcy upon a par, as it reg accuracy, with the barometrical measurements of Camels Hump and Mansfield, that the former should be reduced, the first about 290 and the second about 8U0 feet ; or in other words, these are the differences in the barometrical measurements by the two ob- servers. Both surely cannot be correct ; and it is equally certain also, that both may be incorrect. Until, therefore, Mr. Emmons shall have proved, that his measurements are entitled to a higher degree of confidence, he must submit to have their accuracy ques- - Mountains in New York. 87 tioned. It is granted that it is possible he may be after all nearest the truth, but so long as the evidence in the case is more against than for such a conclusion, his claim to superior accuracy cannot be allowed. Capt. Partridge has had perhaps more experience than any other individual in the United States in measuring mountain elevations with the barometer. In two measurements made by him of Mt. Washington in New Hampshire, the first gave 6,103 feet and the second 6,234 feet. The measurement of the same mountains by Prof. Bigelow, as computed by Prof. Farrar of Cambridge, gave as the height above tide 6,225 feet, a coincidence somewhat remarkable, considering the very great elevation of Mt. Washington. Mr. Emmons states that the distance from Mt. Marcy to White- face is about 16 miles, and that the depression of the latter from the former is 15 minutes of a degree. If the instrument used by Mr. Emmons in taking this angular depression was a suitable one and in a proper state of adjustment, and if he is correct as to the distance, the difference in elevation of those two summits would have been obtained therefrom with more accuracy than from the barometrical measurements. No one capable of appreciating all the causes of error in the two modes of measurement would prob- ably deny this. Assuming, therefore, the data above given as correct, of which I cannot but express some doubt, it gives a dif- ference in elevation of the two peaks of 578 feet, nearly, whereas the difference shown by Mr. Emmons’s barometrical measure- ments is 739 feet, or nearly 30 per cent. greater, being nearly as much greater as the result by my measurement is less, showing that, if the 578 feet is taken as the standard, there is about as near an approximation to the truth in the one case as in the other. The barometer I consider a very valuable instrament, and have made much use of it, as being a cheap and expeditious mode of arriving at an approximate knowledge of the general features of a country ; but that it will afford, by a single observation, in the hands of practiced or unpracticed observers, and under all circum- stances, results as much to be depended on for their accuracy as would be inferred from Mr. Emmons’s statement, cannot be con- ceded. The principal sources of error in the use of this instrument are its great liability, particularly the mountain barometer to get out of repair. The difficulty also of: arriving at a correct knowledge of the change of pressure, or condition of the atmospheric column 88 Mountains in New York. i which sustains the column of mercury, arising from fluctuations, that are independent of temperature, and for which no provision is made in most formulas, and the discrepancy in the results as given by different formulas, all claiming to be equally correct. Errors from these sources when they occur so as to affect the result differently, may neutralize each other, but when they ope- rate the same way, may produce a very considerable deviation from the truth. In the observations of Mr. Emmons, the barome- ter at Whiteface was compared with the barometer at Burlington and Albany, and if I rightly understand him, the mean of the two was taken, the difference being about 100 feet less at the former than at the latter. ‘The time of making the observations was 6, A. M. of the same day, Sept. 21. In the record which he gives of the state of the barometer at the two latter places at noon of the same day, the fact is made known that while the baromet- ric column fell at the one place it rose at the other, causing a difference equivalent to upwards of 100 feet of elevation. Com- puting the elevation of the place of observation at Burlington at 6, A. M. above tide from the observation at Albany at the time, and it gives 500 feet, nearly. Taking the observations made at the same places at 12, M. of the same day, and the re- sult is 390 feet, nearly. Which of these is correct, or whether either is only known from the fact that the elevation in question has been ascertained by the common mode of levelling to be 372 feet, nearly, giving a maximum deviation from the truth in two observations only, of 128 feet, nearly. In the case of the obser- vation on the summit of Whiteface, there exist no data by which the relative conditions of the atmospheric column as compare with the same column at Burlington and Albany can be ascer- tained. Whiteface is about 35 miles west of Burlington, the nearest of the points mentioned, but far enough, it is believed, for consider- able difference to exist. But one observation is recorded as hav- ing been made on its summit and that not under the most favor- able circumstances, since it is stated that the “ wind was strong from the northeast and cloudy.” ‘In the case of Mt. Marcy, the comparison was made with the barometer at Albany. In conse- quence of the greater distance of the places of observation, a much greater error might result than in the case of the observations at Whiteface and Burlington. That the greater discrepancy be- tween the barometric and trigonometric elevations of Mt. Marey Mountains in New York. 89 compared with Whiteface is attributable in some degree to this cause, it is most certainly not unreasonable to suppose. Again, a considerable discrepancy in barometric results may arise from the difference in the different formulas used in making the computations. Mr. Emmons makes the elevation of Mt. Marcy above tide 5,594 feet. Mr. Redfield, by another formula, makes it from the same observations 127 feet less, and by yet another formula which has been found by comparison with the known elevation of objects by levelling to give results quite near the truth, it is somewhat less than the elevation obtained by Mr. edfield. In the case of the Whiteface Mt. the elevation by this latter formula, computing from Mr. Emmons’s observations, is less than that given by him by about 290 feet, or about 100 feet lower than the elevation as derived from trigonometrical measurement. If these causes of error exist, and the tendency of all combined is to affect the altitude in the same way, of which there is no ev- idence to the contrary, it is not difficult to imagine, that Mr. Em- mons’s barometric measurement of Mt. Marcy may be farther from the truth than he is willing to admit. The propriety of this conclusion, independent of all other con- siderations, is I conceive most fully warranted in the great dis- crepancy of the relative barometric altitudes of the peaks in New York and Vermont already described, as shown by the trigonom- etrical measurement. The statement made by me in the report alluded to at the head of this article, was, I believe, clearly warranted by the circum- stances of the case, and as such was entitled to a degree of con- sideration in no respect inferior to that which can be reasonably claimed in behalf of Mr. Ekmmons’s measurement. It was most certainly no wish or intention of mine, in making that statement, to disparage, in the least, the labors of Mr. Emmons; and it was not imagined that he could consider the statement as having that tendency ; but since, from the tenor of his remarks, he has thought proper to construe it in that light and to pronounce so unequivocally (to use a very mild term) in respect to the superi- ority of his barometrical measurements, I am compelled, very re- luctantly, I confess, to state the facts in detail which influenced my judgment and which I believe ates justify me in all I have advanced upon the subject. New York, May, 1839. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 12 “ ‘= + 90 ~ Account of a Tornado. Arr. VI.—Account of a Tornado; by Wiis Gaytorp. Havine visited and examined the scene of the tornado, so well described by Mr. Willis Gaylord of Otisco, Onondaga Co., N. Y., in the Genesee Farmer, Nov. 10, 1838, we also can bear witness - to the tremendous devastation which that whirlwind produced. We were on the ground in September, about two months after the event. Before the tornado, a region of 4 or 500 acres had been covered by a dense forest of pine trees, many of them very tall au large; roads had been cut through this forest and a few sol! houses were planted in it, here and there. Now we looked in ‘Be vain over the whole tract for a single perfect tree. Those which — had not been uprooted or broken in two near the ground, were shivered and twisted off at different elevations, leaving only a portion of a shattered trunk, so that not a single tree top, hardly a single branch were found standing in the air: ners j were instead only mutilated stems, presenting a striking scene of desolation wherever our eyes ranged over the now almost empty aerial space. On the ground the appearances were still more I e- markable. The trees were interwoven in every possible way $0 as to form a truly military abattis of the most impassable kind, 2 nor immediately after the gale, could auy progress be in fact made through the gigantic thickets of entangled trunks and branches, without the labor of bands of pioneers, who cut off the innumer- able logs that choked every avenue. We had befure seen many avenues made through forests by winds, prostrating the trees and laying them down in the direction of its course: but never had we seen such a perfect desolation by a gyratory movement, before which the thick and lofty forest and the strongest framed build- ings vanished, in an instant, and their ruins were whirled irresist- ibly around like flying leaves or gossamer. Sull it was truly wonderful that people were buried in the ‘Tuins of their houses, and travellers with their horses and cattle, were exposed to this driving storm of trees which literally filled the air, and still not a single life was lost, although some persons Were wounded. We were assured that this wisi had marked a track of devas- _ tation for twenty miles or more, but this was the scene of its greatest ravages. Two or three miles from this place, we saw 4 % peek ve eo “Shae ae os Sas Account of a Tornado. 91 wing of a house which had been moved quite around so as to > was not broken.—E'ds. form a right angle with its former position, and still the building . = ‘‘On the afternoon of the 25th of July, 1838, (says Mr. Gay- lord, ) a violent tornado passed over part of the county of Allegany, N. Y., rarely equalled in its destructive effects, and giving a most striking illustration of the peculiar movements of the wind in these aerial currents. It was noticed in some of the journals at the time; but happening to cross its route, in passing up the xenesee valley in the succeeding month, we were so much in- — _ terested with the appearance as to be induced to prepare the fol- ~ Jowing sketch for the readers of the Farmer. “The first appearance of severe wind, was, as we learned, in the town of Rushford, some fifteen miles from the place where we observed its effects. "The day was hot and sultry, and the course of the gale was from the N. of W. to S. of East. At its ommencement in Rushford, it was only a violent thunder gust, ‘such as are frequently experienced, but it soon acquired such force as to sweep in places every thing before it. In its passage the same violence was not at all times exerted ; some places seem- ed wholly passed over, while in the same direction and at only a small distance whole forests were crushed. In the language of one who had suffered much from the gale, ‘it seemed to move by bounds, sometimes striking and sometimes receding from the earth,’ which indeed was most likely the case. “Tt passed the Genesee river in the town of Belfast, a few miles below Angelica, and its fury was here exerted on a space of coun- try perhaps a mile or a mile and a half in width. ‘The country here is settled and cleared along the river, but the road passes at a little distance from the river, and at this point wound through one of the finest pine woods to be found on the stream. Of course when it came over the higher lands from the N. W., the tornado crossed the river and the plain before encountering the groves of pine. In the space occupied by the central part of the tornado, say three-fourths of a mile.in width, nothing was able to resist its _ fury. Strong framed houses and barns were crushed in an instant, and their fragments and contents as quickly seattered to every — point of the compass ; while those out of the direct line were only unroofed, or more or less domaged. Large oaks and elms, were literally twisted off, or crushed like reeds. 92 — of a Tornado. from the oth approached the pine woods on what was the northern. verge of the tornado, and the first appearance of the country in front was that of eosdlands in which all the trees had been broken off at the height of 20 or 30 feet, leaving nothing but countless mutilated trunks. On entering the narrow passway, however, which with immense labor had been opened through the fallen trunks, it was perceived that much the largest part of the trees had been torn up by the roots, and lay piled across each other in the greatest apparent confusion imaginable. Fortunately for our view of the whole ground, a few days before our arrival, fire had been put in the ‘ windfall,’ and aided by the extreme dry weather, the whole was burned over so clean, that nothing but the blackened trunks of the trees were remaining, thus disclosing their condition and position, most perfectly. This position was such as to demonstrate beyond the possibility of a doubt, the fact that the tornado had a rotary motion against. the sun, and in perfect accordance with the course which we in a for- mer volume of the Farmer have ascribed to such electric aerial currents, a theory first developed by Mr. Redfield of New York. — “The first tree met with, prostrated by the tornado, was a large © pine, which lay with its top exactly to the N. of W. or precisely against the general course of the storm. Hundreds of others lay near in the same direction on the outer part of the whirl, but immediately after entering the fallen timber the heads of the trees began to incline to the centre of the space torn down, and south of this the inclination was directly the reverse until the outside of the whirl was reached, when they all lay with their tops to the east. This almost regular position of the fallen timber, was most distinct in the bottom courses, or that which was first blown down, those that resisted the longest, being, as was to be expected, pitched in the most diverse directions. That there was also an upward spiral motion, causing a determination of the rushing air to the centre of the whirl would appear probable from the fact that articles from the buildings destroyed were carried high in the air, and then apparently thrown out of the whirl, into the com- . Thon current; and also from the fact that a large majority of the trees both to ‘the south and the north of the centre of the gale, lay with their heads inclined to that point, while the centre was by the greatest confusion imaginable. A diagram formed of a continued succession of circles moving from the right to the ee Bra tee er ae? Meteoric Stones. 93 left would illustrate the position of the trees first uprooted, as these lay as when first crushed by the approach of the whirlwind. “Many curious facts illustrative of the force of the wind was related by the inhabitants in and near the place. A farmer at- tempted to drive his team of horses to the barn, but the tempest Was too soon upon him. When the rush was over, and it was but seemingly a moment, he found the barn torn to pieces} himself about thirty rods in one direction from it, and his horses as many rods the other, and what was most remarkable with scarcely a fragment of the harness upon them. A wagon was blown away, and a month afterwards one of the wheels had not been found. A house standing near the Genesee river, and a little out of the line of the gale, was completely covered with mud that must have been taken from the bed of the river. And appearances render it very evident that near the centre of the whirl the water was entirely taken from the channel.” Bee Re Arr. VIII.—On Meteoric Stones.*—From the Annual Account of the progress of Physics and Chemistry, by Berzexius, in the Annual Reports of the progress of the sciences by the members of the Royal Academy of Science in Sweden. Arsberattelser om Vetenskapernas Framsteg. D. 31. Mars, 1835. Stockholm. Translated for this Journal, by Rev. W. A. Larnep Merteoric stones, as inorganic masses occurring on the surface of the earth, present also an object for mineralogy, the more in- teresting since they give us information of the mineral products * Berzelius published a paper on Meteoric Stones in the ae of the Royal Academy of Science, for 1834, pp. 115—133 This was translated in sev- burgh Phil. Mag. vol. ix, pp. 429—441, from which an account of the fall of the meteoric stone at Blansko, and of its analysis, was published in this Journal, vol. xxx, pp. 175—176. sige crag — made an abstract of his paper in the Reports of the progress of the r 1835, pp. 230—238, which is here transla- ted entire. As a recent analysis ff meteoric iron from Clairborne, Ala., by Dr. C T. Jackson, published in this Journal, vol. xxxiv, pp. 332—337, made lati the existence of chlorine, and a still more recent one of meteoric iron from Ashville, N. C., by Prof. C. U. Shepard, detected not only chlorine, but also uncombined sili- con, neither of which are mentioned by Berzelius, it was thought a translation of the present paper would be interesting.—T7r. 94 - of other planetary = and of their likeness or unlikeness to - those of the earth. I have communicated in a paper addressed to the Royal Academy of Science,* examinations of various me- teoric stones, undertaken with the design of studying them as mineral species, and of thereby enabling myself to determine of what different minerals they are composed. The occasion of the investigation was afforded by the friendly commission which Reichenbach of Blansko gave me to examine the composition of a meteoric stone, whose glancing apparition within the atmos-_ phere of the earth, on the 25th of November, 1833, about 6 o’clock in the evening, he himself had witnessed, and of which, with very great expense and labor, he finally succeeded in collecting the scattered fragments in the region about Blansko. The me- teoric stones which I examined, have fallen near Blansko in Moravia, Chantonnay in France, Lautolax in Finland, Alais in France, and Ellenbogen in Bohemia, and I have also analyzed the meteoric iron made known by Pallas from the region between Ab- ekansk and Krasnojarsk in Siberia. From the analyses referred to, I believe I have discovered that the meteoric stones are mine= rals ; as it is absurd to suppose that minerals can be formed in the air out of the elements of the air, they cannot be atmospheric pro- ducts, and the less so, as many of them present cavities, which are lled with a mineral of another color and probably of a different composition, which it were a plain absurdity to consider as being possibly formed in them during the few moments the attraction of the earth would suffer so heavy a body to remain in the atmos- phere. They become such elsewhere. They are not cast out from the volcanos of the earth, for they fall everywhere, not merely nor oftenest in the near or remote neighborhood of a vol- cano ; their external appearance is unlike a terrestrial mineral, dinlike any thing which the volcanos eject. Their containing unoxidized malleable iron, proves that water is not found, and perhaps, not air, in their former abode. They must, therefore, come from some other planet, which has voleanos. ‘The one nearest us is the moon, and the moon has gigantic voleanos com- pared with the earth. The moon has no atmosphere to retard the volcanic projectiles. Collections of water do not appear to exist on it, in a word, among the probable sources, the moon is —— * Kongl. Vetensk. Acad. Handl. 1834, p. 115. Meteoric Stones. 95 the most probable. To get an idea of the elements of another planetary body, were it only the one lying nearest us, the moon, gives to such an examination an interest which in itself it Be be destitute of. The general results of my Sinseatentes have been, that me- teoric stones of two sorts have fallen on the earth. Those which belong to the same kind, have a like composition and appear to come from the same mountain. The one sort is rare. Hitherto there have not been observed more than three meteoric stones belonging to it, which fell in Stannern in Moravia, in Jonzae and Juvenas in France. -They are thus characterized; they do not contain metallic iron, the minerals of which they are composed are more distinctly crystalline, and magnesia is not a prevailing element of them. Of these I have not had any spe- cimen to examine. The other sort is made up of the great num- ber of meteoric stones, which have been hitherto examined. They are frequently so like one another in color and external appear- ance, that we might believe them to have been struck out of one piece. They contain malleable metallic iron in variable quan- tity. We have an example of an enormous block, which was constituted of a mere continuous web of iron, the cavities of which the mineral fill up, and which came down whole in the fall, solely because the iron-web held them together. Some are composed more of the mineral and less of iron, in which case they do not cohere, but burst apart from the heat, which the ex- treme compression of the atmosphere by means of their irresisti- ble velocity, moving with the rapidity of a heavenly body to- wards the earth, has produced in the few moments they are pass- ing through the air, and from which their outermost covering is continually melted to a black slag thinner than the thinnest post- paper. We may say then, that the meteoric stones supposed to proceed from the moon, come entirely from two unlike volcanos, the eruptions of one of which either take place oftener than the other, or are projected in such a direction as that they oftener reach the earth. Such a circumstance agrees well with the fact, that a certain part of the moon has the earth continually in the zenith and directs all its projectiles straight towards the earth, though they do not proceed straight thither, because they must also suf- fer the motion, which they had before as-parts of the moon. If that is the part of the moon which sends to us the meteoric iron masses, and if the other parts of the moon are not so full of iron, then we see a reason why that point turns continually towards the magnetic globe of the earth. The mineral portion of meteoric stones consists of various min- erals. 1. Olivine. It contains magnesia and protoxyd of iron, is colorless or grayish, but is sometimes streaked with yellow or green like all the terrestrial olivine. ‘This shows that oxygen is wanting for a higher oxidation of the iron. Like the terres- trial, it is soluble in acids, and leaves the silicious earth in the orm of gelatine. It céhtains like some of the terrestrial, a trace of oxyd of tin and oxyd of nickel. Olivine, however, in the me- teoric iron found by Pallas, makes an exception to this, for it is without nickel, and its color is yellow approaching to green; but it contains tin. Olivine comprises about one half the quantity of the unmagnetic minerals. Olivine separates by treating with acids, and the silicious earth is then set free by boiling in car- bonate of soda. Then there remain, 2. silicates of magnesia, lime, el of iron, protoryd of manganese, alumina, potash, and soda, which, are not separated by acids and in which the silicious earth con- tains two species of bisilicates. These are probably blended with more, which I was not able to separate. We may conjecture Mg a species of pyroxene (f > S2 and a species of leucite where C lime and magnesia in the first terms replace a portion of potash and soda. x S?+3AS?. The pyroxene not having so much K : color as the terrestrial, is to be attributed to the same cause as the want of color in meteoric olivine. 3. Chrome-iron.—This is contained in both kinds of meteoric stones, in both in like small quantity, is never wanting, and is the source of the chrome in meteoric iron. It can be obtained unde- composed if the unmagnetic portion of the meteoric stone is sepa- rated with biphkieBinorie acid, and is then, after all the silicious earth is removed, treated with sulphuric acid, after which the sulphates and the gypsum are boiled out, when the chrome iron remains in the form of a black burnt powder. This is the cause of the grey- ish color in meteoric stones when they are seen in the mass. 4 cya 4 ‘ Meteoric Stones. = mys 4. Oxyd of tin.—This is mixed with the chironié tet One can satisfy himself of its presence when the last named metal is separated by bi-sulphate of potassa, and the solution in water is treated with sulphuretted hydrogen, when the sulphuret of tin is thrown down. It has a trace of copper. 5. Magnetic Iron-ore.—This does not perhaps occur in all. It is taken out with the magnet, when it again manifests its property of dissolving in hydro-chloric-acid with a yellow color and with- out a disengagement of hydrogen. 6. Sulphuret of Iron.—This is found in all. It has been im- possible for me to separate any for a distinct examination. All the circumstances seem to show that it consists of one atom of each of the elements. A surplus of sulphur in a mass, where a surplus of iron prevails throughout, is not supposable. One part of it follows the magnet together with the iron, the other part remains in the powder of the stone, as nothing more is given up to the magnet. This is sometimes a larger percentage. Whether this is by a chemical union, as is the case, for example, with the sul- phuret of manganese in helvin, or is merely by adhesion to the powder of the stone, my researches could not decide; the latter is the more probable when Fe S is weakly magnetic, but the former is not impossible. The sulphuret of iron causes the pul- verized meteoric stone to develope sulphuretted hydrogen gas when it is mixed with hydro-chloric-acid. 7. Native Iron.—This iron is not pure, although it is altogether malleable. It contains carbon, sulphur, phosphorus, magnesia, manganese, nickel, cobalt, tin and copper. But it is moreover blended with small crystals within the mass, of a union of phos- phuret of iron with phosphuret of nickel, and phosphuret of man- ganese. ‘These are insoluble in hydro-chloric-acid and fall down while in the solution. Their quantity varies. The iron of El- lenbogen gives 2! per cent., but the Pallasian iron not } per cent. of it. A part is so finely divided in the mass of wae iron, that what falls down in the solution resembles a black powder. The cause of the Widmanstiattian* figures is, that the foreign metals are * This refers to figures of a crystalline shape on the surface of some meteoric iron, as of Agram, Siberia, Mexico, &c. first noticed by Widmanstatten. See Bey- trage zur Geschichte ond ae meteorischen Stein-und Metall-Massen von D. Carl von Schreibers. p. 7 Vol, xxxvm, No. 1 se 5 1839, bis. 13 98 Meteoric Stones. not equally blended, but separate into imperfectly formed crys- talline series. If the iron is dissolved in an acid solution of sul- phate of iron, the pure iron is set free almost by itself and its lam- inz fall down in flakes. The elementary bodies hitherto found in the meteoric stones make up just a third of those we are acquainted with, namely, oxygen, hydrogen, sulphur, phosphorus, carbon, silicon, chrome, potassium, sodium, calcium, magnesium, aluminium, iron, mah- ganese, nickel, cobalt, tin and copper. .. The illawing ——— of the meteoric iron may be cited ; some conducted at the same time by Wherle are added. Tron of Pallas. _ Iron of Ellenbogen. Berzelius. i. Wherle.* Tron, - - - - 88.042 89.90 Nickel, -—— = iU.toa 5 8.517 8.44 Cobalt, - - - 0.455 0.762 0.61 Magnesium, - 0.050 0.279 : Manganese, - - 0.132 98.95 Tin and copper 0.066 : Cahn. oe yinbiot 2 - a trace. pe Mobic Bhoephurets 0.480 2.211 = The metallic phosphurets were found to°contain : Of the Pallas Iron. Of the Ellenbogen. Tron, - - - - 48.67 68.11 Nickel, - = - 18.33 Magnesium, - >. 9,66 W772 Phosphorus, - - 18.47 14.17 95.13 100.00 This last result cannot possess entire precision, for the whole quantity of the metal, which I was able to take for analysis, was of the former only 3, and of the latter 2.8 centigrammes. Wherle’s analysis will be seen to agree more exactly with mine, _ when I add that he had in the iron the alloy of phosphorus and _ Manganese, and also of magnesia, Mid te as the ammonio- - phosphate of magnesia with the oxide of ir Wherle has cited (in the Phe Journal) still other analyses of meteoric iron which I here communicate. —— “eget * Baumgartners Zeitschrift IIT, 222. les Meteoric Stones. 99 Agram. _ Kap. Lenarto, Iron, 89.784 85.608 | 90.883 Nickel, 8.886 12.276 ~~ 8.450 Cobalt, 0.667 0.887 0.665 trace of copper. 99. 99.337 98.770. 99.998 Wherle has sought the constant proportions in the metals; this inquiry I regard as fruitless. But before I conclude this subject, perhaps already sufficiently long for my report, I must subjoin one result more of my exami- nation. 'The meteoric stone from Allais falls to pieces in water, to an earth, which smells of clay and hay and contains carbon in an nnkndwe union. -This shows that in the region of the me- teoric stones, minerals fall to pieces to a clay-like mixture as on the earth. Now arose the inquiry, whether this carboniferous earth from the surface of another planetary body contains the or- " ganized products, whether indeed organized bodies are thus dis- covered there, more or less analogous with those of. the earth. It is easy to conceive with what interest the answer would be sought. It was not in the affirmative, but to decide in the neg- ative would be to conclude more about it than we are author- - ized todo. The earth was found to be olivine, containing ferro- sulphate of nickel and of tin. 'The magnet took up the compound oxide of iron in black grains, along with which the microscope detected flitters of metallic iron. Water brought out sulphate of magnesia with small quantities of sulphate of nickel; but nothing organized, as none of the alkalies could be extracted. In a dry distillation were developed carbonic acid gas and water, together with a black gray sublimate, but no burnt oil, no carburetted hy- drogen; in a word, the carboniferous substance was not of the same nature as the soil on this earth. There were besides a car- bonate and black soot. The sublimate heated in oxygen gave no trace of carbonic acid or of water, and changed to a white, unerys- tallized, volatile body, soluble in water, which did not become acid in the process and was not. precipitated by nitrate of silver. What — this body is I did not know; it remains unknown to me. Isit | indeed an elementary body not originally pertaining to our planet? ee To answer this question in the affirmative would be too hasty. 100 Terrestrial Magnetism. Art. 1X.— Terrestrial Magnetism ; by J. Hamitron of Carlisle, Penn. In the 22d volume of this Journal 1 suggested the idea, that the magnetic poles coincided with the coldest points in the north- ern hemisphere, but did not assign the grounds for such a con- clusion. In 1837, Dr. Brewster published his Treatise on Magnetism at Edinburgh, originally prepared for the Encyclopedia Britanica, which contains very full details of the latest researches on that subject. _ In the 42d page of this Treatise it is stated, “the discovery of two poles of maximum cold on opposite sides of the north pole of the earth, which was announced by Sir David Brewster in 1820, led him and other authors to the opinion, that there might be . some connection between the magnetic poles, and those of maxi- mum cold.” The opinion advanced by Dr. Brewster, “ that there are two poles of greatest cold in the northern hemisphere,” it ap- pears, was published in the 9th volume of the Edinburgh Trans- actions of 1821, and Dr. Dalton in remarking on it, considers it as a probable supposition, and Mr. Kupffer in a memoir read in 1829 to the Russian Academy, explicitely adopts the opinion. Of all this I knew nothing when I wrote the letter above re- ferred to in 1832, nor until I met with Dr. Brewster’s Treastise published in 1837; but drew the inferences therein stated, from the views I entertained of the nature of light and heat,* and from observing a certain correspondence of climate at similar distances from the magnetic poles. I regard light and heat in the common acceptation of these words, as not only material in their nature, but as compounds of other simple elements, and suppose the magnetic fluids to be two of those simple substances which enter into their constitution. From the refined nature of light and heat, we cannot subject them to experiment like other forms of matter, and the difficulty would necessarily be increased, if we have to do with the simple elements of which they are here supposed to be compounded. That matter exists in such states of refined minuteness of atoms, as to be imperceptible to such senses as we possess, is * By the word “ heat” I always mean sensible heat, and not the unknown prin- ciple. Terrestrial Magnetism. 101 proved by the miasmata, which sometimes impregnate the at- mosphere, and yet baffle the skill of the chemist to detect them, although the disease which follows in their train establishes their existence. If we examine what are termed the soem fluids on the poles of the loadstone, it appears that we can neither see, feel, nor taste them, they are not easily disengaged from the particles of the iron, and the only proof of their existence is the attraction they exert.. May not this difficulty in perceiving them, arise from their atoms being so exceedingly small, as to be apprecia- ble only to a higher order of senses than we are endowed with. Light and heat will pass through transparent bodies without much difficulty, but Mr. Haldat has shown that the magnetic fluids will not only pass through transparent substances, but through all bodies, even the most dense ;—and from this I argue, that they are of greater tenuity than either light, heat, or electricity. The sun is continually emitting rays which reach the earth in se quantities, and the question has been significantly asked, but not so easily answered, if they are material bodies, what becomes of this flood of light and heat? They do not ac- cumulate on the earth’s surface like snow, but disappear as fast as they arrive. It may be said they become latent. This supposes that light and heat, as usually understood, are perceptions of the mind, and that the exciting causes of these sensations are un- known principles or substances, as evanescent and difficult to ap- prehend as the magnetic fluids themselves. Now, may it not be, that these substances hitherto incognita, are the identical ele- ments or fluids, whose attraction causes the phenomena of mag- netism, and that instead of light and heat being mere sensations, — excited by we know not what, they are real material bodies, com- pounded of these and other elamseta: I here suppose, that there are three elements; one of which is common to light and also to heat; that light and heat are each composed of two simple elements ; and that when the sun’s rays reach the earth, they are deconsposee by the attraction of the bodies on its surface, with which their elements unite, and from which they can be again extricated by different processes. We know that light and heat can be obtained from almost every form of matter, and the idea here offered to explain their disappearance and reappearance, by a decomposition into simpler é 102 Terrestrial Magnetism. elements, and a recombination of those elements through a play of attraction, is not an unphilosophical suggestion. Colomb has ascertained that “gold, silver, glass, wood, and all substances, whether organic or inorganic, obey the power of the magnet ;” so that all substances are susceptible of magnetism. Here then is a striking coincidence between light and heat, and the magnetic fluids ; they pervade or influence all terrestrial bod- ies, and friction will develope light and heat as well as magnetism. That the violet ray imparts the magnetic virtue to iron, is shown by the expermints of Mrs. Somerville, and by the still more striking experiments of Prof. Zautedeschi, who exposed a horse-shoe artificial loadstone, carrying 134 ounces, to a strong light of the sun, and after three days it carried an additional weight of three ounces, and ultimately its power was so increased as to carry 31 ounces. These experiments being repeated under an exhausted receiver did not succeed, hence a doubt has arisen as to the source whence the aR HOHE virtue was derived, but it must be conceded that the sun’s rays had some agency in evoly- ing the magnetism, let it come from what source it may, and this is saci explained if we suppose one or more of the magnetic fluids as entering into their composition. That a compound body should differ not only in its appearance, but in its most striking qualities, from either of the ingredients entering into its composition, is accordant with every day’s ob- servation of the chemist; it ought not therefore to be considered so extraordinary, that invisible fluids, such as we find on the poles of the magnet, should, whenscombined, produce radiant matter, such as either light or heat. In fact, what is the magnetic spark, unless it be the result of the union if the two fluids. But elec- tricity and galvanism also evolve light and heat; and may not there also be different combinations of the three elements, which would account for the evident connexion existing between gal- vanism, electricity, and magnetism, and also their relation to light and heat. It is said, however, that light and heat are evolved from the atmosphere by condensation, and this indeed cannot be contro- verted ; nor does it conflict with this hypothesis, for by conden- sing the air, these elements which are diffused throughout the atmosphere, are brought in contact, a union is effected, and light and heat are the result. The same effect would be produced by Pe ee Terrestrial Magnetism. 2 103 the rapid passage of one of the elements through the air, but with increased energy, for the element itself would enter into the com- bination. Still I contend that light and heat, or one of them, is the result of the combining of the fluids of either magnetism, elec- tricity, or galvanism, without the aid of any other body. This is shown by passing electricity through the exhausted receiver of an air pump, when we have beautiful displays of light, and the effect is the more striking, the more perfect the vacuum. If there are three simple elements such as I have here supposed, two of which are the fluids on the poles of the loadstone ; then let these three be so unequally diffused over and in the sath as severally to predominate, one at or near the north pole, ‘inbtldie at the magnetic equator, and the third at the south pole; each at- tracting the others, but repelling itself; and we have an elucida- tion af terrestrial magnetism. If one of the elements entering into the constitution of light, but not necessary to heat, aboniteds in the arctic regions, so as to” predominate i in all terrestrial forms to the exclusion of the ele- ments constituting heat, and this element is identical with one of. the fluids on the poles of the loadstone, then it must follow, that the poles of greatest cold would coincide with the magnetic pile and the isothermal lines have some accordance to the magnetic intensities of different latitude. The frequent occurrence of the aurora borealis in the northern — regions would be explained on this hypothesis, from one of the constituents of light predominating in the arctic circle ; and the reason of its affecting the needle be at once shown: so I think a solution may be afforded, for the curious facts, that heat while it imparts the magnetic virtue to soft iron, diminishes with its in- crease the power of the loadstone, whi a white heat entirely destroys it, and a red heat reverses the poles. I admit that these views are merely hypothetical, but they are of a more extended theory, which runs its ramifications through all the phenomena of nature, according with so many facts, that I cannot regard it as merely visionary ; but I admit that much deliberation and caution are requisite in advancing such positions, lest we should disturb science with unfounded specula- tions. ~ 104 Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. Art. X.—Eaplosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen, with remarks on Hemming’s Safety Tube; by Prof. J. W. Wessrer of Harvard University. Tue occurrence of several explosions of the compound blow- pipe of Dr. Hare, in the hands of experienced chemists, is well known; and the student can take up none of the modern chem- ical books without being made aware of the danger of using an imperfect or ill contrived form of the apparatus. In the use of two separate reservoirs for the gases, and the double concentric jet, it is impossible that explosion can oceur. But it has, as those accustomed to use this splendid instrument* are well aware, been modified in various ways, with the desire to render it more porta- ble, safe or convenient. The repetition of the early experiments of Dr. Hare and Prof. Silliman, by the late Dr. Clarke, of Cam- bridge, (Eng. ) and his disregard of the claims of these gentlemen, are also well known; but it is somewhat singular, that so many of the British chemical writers should still incline to give be credit of these brilliant results to him, who but repeated what had been long before accomplished in this country. As every chemist must deem the compound blow-pipe, in some form, an essential portion of his apparatus, and as it has even become one of the 7 constituent parts of the cheap, and too often imperfect, “sets of apparatus,” manufactured in all parts of the country, for the use of schools of all grades, not unfrequently to be used by begin- ners or inexperienced persons, it is highly important that every one should be aware of the danger of operating with the single vessel as a reservoir of the mixed gases. The convenience of transportation, and the small space it occupies, are great tempta- tions to make use of the single vessel and compressed gases, aS in the form first employed in England in the blow-pipe of Mr. Brooke. 'The tremendous explosions which took place with this instrument in the hands of Dr. Clarke, and of several others, the defences erected by the operators for personal protection, and the modifications in the jets, ad infinitum, with which the philoso- phical journals teemed, are too well known to be described. But * For this i ti distinguished countryman, Dr. Hare, has recently been most deservedly honored by the American Academy of Arts and Sciences with the Rumford medals. as Rs > Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. 105 the encomiums bestowed upon the contrivances of Gurney, the oil cylinder of Prof. Cumming, the layers of wire gauze as sug- gested by Wollaston, &c., have now given place to the safety tube of Mr. Hemming, which is in fact a modification of the faggot of capillary tubes proposed by Wollaston. This tube was first publicly exhibited by Mr. Hemming at the meeting of the British Association for the advancement of Science, in 1832, and is fully described in the published report. The description is quoted by the late Dr. Turner in his Ele- ments, with the remark that all previous modifications of the ap- paratus “are rendered unnecessary by the Safety Tube lately proposed by Mr. Hemming.” An authority like this, and one which has become the guide of so many, will undoubtedly lead to the employment of this tube, as well as to its construction, by inexperienced persons ; and without previous care to test its safety in the severest manner, its use may be attended with the destruc- tion, not only of apparatus, but of life. - Ihave been induced to make these remarks in consequence of a terrific explosion which occurred in my laboratory a few days since ; and to show how much care was taken to test the safety of the instrument before it was exhibited to my class, the fol- lowing notes of some of the test experiments are taken from my record. The tube was constructed of sheet brass, 6 inches in length and #ths of an inch in diameter, the size recommended by Hem- ming. This was closely packed with iron wire (No. 22), each wire extending through the entire length of the tube. The close approximation of the wires was increased by the introduc- tion of a pointed rod of the same metal and same length; this was driven forcibly through the centre of the bundle of wires. Thus the spaces between the wires were exceedingly minute, and it was with difficulty that air could be forced through by blowing with the mouth. It is hardly necessary to remark, that a large cooling surface was thus produced, and that flame ap- plied at one extremity would be far more effectually cooled down by it, than by the wire gauze when held over a gas flame, or when surrounding ignited gaseous matter, as in the safety lamp. The tube was terminated at each end by a female screw to receive stop cocks. In my first experiments, the Hemming’s tube was prolonged at each end by a leaden tube about four feet Vol. xxxvu1, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. ~ 14 106 Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. in length, to increase the cooling surface ; and bladders, contain- ing hydrogen and oxygen gases in the proportions that compose water, were attached to the two extremities. 'The stop cocks being opened, the gases were forced from one bladder into the other several times through the leaden tubes and that of Hem- ming’s interposed, thus ensuring their mixture both in the blad- ders and tubes. The apparatus was now placed in the open air, and an arrangement made which allowed me to explode one of the bladders and observe the effect without danger. ‘The one bladder alone exploded. ‘This experiment was repeated many times, shortening the leaden tubes each time, until they were en- tirely removed, and bladders were attached directly to the Hem- ming’s tube. One of them was then exploded, but the flame was arrested as completely as in the previous trials. Having repeated the experiment with the Safety Tube alone several times, and uniformly finding it impossible to explode both bladders, I now did not hesitate to hold the tube in my hand, and to apply a flame to one bladder ; this was repeated several times, and in no instance was explosion communicated from the one bladder to the other. Mr. Hemming is stated to have operated before the members of the British Association with the bladder — under his arm; and Dr. Hare in his letter to Dr. Dalton,* states _ that he has employed the mixed gases with safety, more than an hundred times, allowing them to explode as far into the tube of efflux as where the contrivance in questiont was interposed, without explosion extending beyond it. The safety of the tube having been so thoroughly tested with the bladders, I now substituted for one of them a strong globe 12 inches in diameter, made of 22 oz. copper; this, as well as the bladder was filled with the mixed gases. The apparatus was — placed out of doors, and, with the necessary precautions as to pel- sonal safety, the si atiee in the bladder was fired, but that in the copper globe did not explode. The same result always occurred in repeating this, and in no trial could I cause the flame to trav- erse the Hemming’s tube. My next experiments were made without the bladder. A small jet, having an orifice of about ,'; of an inch diameter, * Amer. Jour. Vol. xxx, p, 196. t Dr. Hare alludes to some improvement he has made in Hemming’s tube, but has not informed us in what it consists. Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. 107 was screwed into the tube, the mixed gases were condensed in the globe by a syringe, until on opening the stop cock they is- sued out with considerable velocity. The globe thus charged Was again placed in the open air, with arrangements for igniting the gases as they issued from the jet and for protection, should explosion occur. They were ignited without explosion, and con- tinued to burn quietly. The experiments were repeated with different proportions of the gases and under different pressures, always without explosion. The safety of the tube had thus been severely tested, and there Was apparently no cause to apprehend accident, so that I saw no objection to exhibit it to my class in connection with the usual illustrations of the properties of hydrogen gas and the compound blow-pipe. Accordingly, two bladders, filled as before, were at- tached to the two ends of the tube, the stop cocks opened, and one bladder being fired, the other did not explode. This latter, by applying a flame to an orifice and exploding it, was afterwards A few days after this, I exhibited the gases burning at the jet on the copper globe, to several gentlemen who happened to visit the laboratory ; and subsequently employed the same apparatus, filled with the mixed gases, before the audience usually attend- ing the lectures at the Cambridge Lyceum. It was used asa compound blow-pipe, and particularly for obtaining the intense light from lime in the focus of a reflector, as proposed by Lieut. Drummond. No accident or inconvenience occurred. On the following day, as the gases had not been entirely consumed, it was used on my lecture table before the class. It may be thought that unnecessary precaution was taken to ascertain the safety of an apparatus that had come to us with the sanctions I have already alluded to; but we cannot be too care- ful in experiments of danger, capecially with new apparatus, and when made in this country from description only, and by artists not always aware of its applications, or not prepared to put it to the test to which such instruments are usually subjected by the best English makers.* Se ee * An instance occurred under my own observ ation a few years since, where a ing air into a copper globe, made in _ — when it fac porn ——s burst, wounding the operator very severely in the hand and 108 Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. Having occasion to exhibit the compound blow-pipe in my lec- ture on the 16th of May, in addition to my usual method with two separate gas holders, and the double, concentric jet, the cop- per globe was charged with the mixed gases, but with a smaller proportion of hydrogen, viz. 1$ vols. to 1-vol. of oxygen, for the purpose of making some comparative experiments. After using the gases inthe separate vessels, I proceeded to operate with the new instrument; the jet was ignited and a few experiments made with confidence and safety. Having closed the stop cock, I removed (as I had often done before) a very short piece from the end of the jet for the purpose of obtaining a somewhat larger flame, to be directed upon a lump of magnesia. The orifice ex- posed was now {th of an inch in diameter and about 6 inches from the end of the Hemming’s tube, being at the extremity of a small brass tube bent upwards at an angle of 45°, the same which had been used in all the previous experiments. The globe was nearly in contact with my person, the jet and Hemming’s tube projecting horizontally in front of me from right to left. With the right hand the stop cock was opened, and the emission of the gases adjusted ; with the left the jet was ignited. The 2 slight crackling noise, which all must be familiar with who have Pe) operated with the compound blow-pipe, occurred several times, and the gases were extinguished, but no communication of flame or explosion of the gases in the globe took place. On again applying alighted paper to the jet, however, the copper globe exploded with tremendous noise and force, shatter- ing several glass vessels standing upon the table and shelves in the rear, and projecting the torn copper, stop cocks, and tubes, in different directions. My fingers, resting upon the stop cock, were bruised ; and the right shoulder severely, by a large fragment of the copper, which in its course robbed me of no small part of the coat sleeve, and the cuff was entirely carried away. The force of the explosion was exerted principally in the direction of the tube and jet in front of me, or I should not probably have escaped with so little injury. The noise and concussion were deafening, and my hearing was not perfectly restored for several hours. _ No one, fortunately, of the class was injured ; the usual good order and attention were but momentarily interrupted ; the lecture was proceeded with, and the remaining experiments per- formed. Me Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. 109 On examination afterwards, it appeared that a large fragment of the globe had been projected behind me, striking a shelf in which it caused a large indentation, and a fissure of more than two inches in length, and of nearly one indepth. One large piece of copper was projected over the heads of some persons present out of an open window several yards distant from the table. The windows being open, but one pane of glass was broken; but the sound was heard in all the college buildings, and at a very consid- erable distance beyond. The question now arises, how could this explosion have oc- curred with an apparatus which had been subjected to such ap- parently thorough and severe tests? I have carefully examined the tube and every fragment of the apparatus, and recalled all the circumstances and arrrangements, without being able to discover any imperfection or assignable cause. I have made experiments with the tube and bladders since the. accident, and with the same results as before the explosion: the tube is as perfect as ever, and as incapable of transmitting explosion. - That the stop cocks and every part of the globe were perfectly Gait, and allowed of no leakage by which a stream of the gases might have come in contact with the flame at the jet, I cannot but feel confident, as nothing of the kind was observable du- ring the condensation or in the previous trials. ‘The apparatus was new and very faithfully made. It was found by Mr. Hemming, that when the gases contained a portion of water mechanically suspended in them, the flame would return through the tube proposed by Mr. Gurney, where layers of wire gauze, &c. are employed, and even in its improved form, where layers of asbestos are interposed. But with the tube filled with wires, exhibited before the British Association, it is aaa to have been impossible to produce explosion, even when the gases were made to recede by withdrawing the pressure on the bladder. In the present case no recession could have taken place from diminution of pressure, as the compressed gases were rushing out with great velocity. : How far the compression of the gases may have aided the combination of their bases, we are unable to say ; but from the experiments of Biot, we know that it must be made suddenly and violently, for when gradually applied, as in the sinking of a mix- ture of the gases to the depth of one hundred and fifty fathoms, 110 Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. where the compression would be about thirty atmospheres, no such effect was produced. And in the present case, the conden- sation had been made rapidly, and two hours before the explosion occurred. It is not impossible that the state of compression and close approximation of the particles of the gases may have aided the rapid combination, and but a slight increase of temperature have been required to produce explosion, which may have been caused in the tube, by the slight explosions to which I have be- fore alluded as so often occurring in the jet. The capacity of the jet and stop cock, in front of the safety tube, was sufficient to contain but about one cubic inch of the gases, and the com- bustion of so small a quantity could have had but little influ- ence in raising the temperature of the safety tube ; probably none, when we consider that the compressed gases were expand- ing as they passed out, and no doubt attended with the usual effect, the absorption of caloric. a In a letter now before me, Dr. Hare has suggested the heat- ing effect of the previous slight explosions, as the most probable cause of the final explosion; but for the reasons just stated, I am constrained to seek for some more satisfactory explanation. _ Although it would be difficult, if not impossible, to prove that _ electricity, from the presence of the different metals entering = into the construction of the various parts of the apparatus, or de- veloped by, or evolved from the gases, or the products of their first partial combustions, was not the immediate cause of this explosion, it would be equally difficult, in the present state of our knowledge, to prove that it was. The ignition of platinum sponge, and the combination of oxygen and hydrogen which it effects, it is well known, were, when first observed, attributed by Dobereiner to electricity, which has not been disproved, or satis- factorily explained, even by the researches of Faraday. Having communicated to the distinguished inventor of the compound blow-pipe a brief notice of the occurrence which I have described, it will not, I trust, be deemed an undue liberty to remark, that in the letter above referred to, Dr. Hare appears to consider all explosions as dependent on “a mysterious electrical reversal of polarities,” and that we are not as yet able to deter- mine all the modes by which such reversals may be induced. From the first experiments made with the Hemming’s tube, it is obvious that it cannot be said that the wires were not of Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen. 111 sufficiently small size to arrest explosion. Neither can it be sup- posed that the outlet at the extremity of the jet was insufficient for the expansion of the exploding mixture, and that in conse- quence of that expansion, the inflamed gases were driven back into the copper globe. This expansion must have been far greater than 15 or 18 times, as deduced from Davy’s experi- ments, to have overcome the force exerted by the gases, which at the moment were issuing from the globe, under a pressure probably of nearly two atmospheres. The expansion of hydrogen and oxygen gases by explosion, has not, I think, been satisfactorily determined; and Davy, whose resultgeare most commonly adopted, does Hee appear to have deemed his own conclusive. I have made some experiments on the subject, and should not have offered the preceding re- marks until more satisfactory results had been obtained, had it not been necessary to defer the investigation to an interval of more ‘leisure. When water is mechanically suspended in the gases, the dan- er of retraction and explosion is undoubtedly increased, but the influence of the small quantity formed in the jet on the occurrence of the slight explosions already alluded to, must have been ina great measure, if not altogether, counteracted by the elasticity of the issuing gases. The cause of this explosion is certainly mysterious; but in whatever manner we may attempt to explain it, it must be re- garded as additional evidence of the danger of employing the gases in a state of previous mixture, and of the importance of adhering to the use of two separate vessels and the concentric jet. With these, although less convenient on some accounts, there are other advantages ; their perfect safety, however, is alone sufli- cient to induce us to recommend them, and them alone, to the chemical student. The trials with the tube of Hemming previous to the occur- rence of this explosion, seemed to warrant the statement in its favor which has been made ina note in the edition of my Manual of Chemistry, now passing through the press. Laboratory of Harvard University, Cambridge, June 5th, 1839. 112 ‘Greek Conjugations. Arr. XL—On the Greek Conjugations ; by Prof. J. W. Gunas. Tue conjugations found in our common grammars, have usually been formed by writers directing their attention to a single language, and are probably the best for merely practical purposes. It often happens, however, that there is another arrangement of the conjugations which enters more deeply into the nature of the verb, separates more closely between primary and derivative forms, and prepares the way for more successful comparisons with other languages. The classification to which I allude is based, for the most part, om the broad distinction between internal or strong inflection which takes place within the root itself, and external or weak inflection which consists in the addition of new syllables and leaves the root untouched. _ As the internal inflection, which consists principally im the change of the vowel or in the reduplication of initial letters, is found in rad- ical or primitive verbs, and has a manifest analogy in different lan- guages, it has of late engaged the attention of philologists. ; These remarks apply more or less to Greek, Latin, and Teutonic, including English, verbs. I shall confine my attention at present to the Greek. ay Strong Inflection. : Strong verbs in Greek are divided by philologists, for the sake of © exhibiting their vocalic changes, into four classes. The tenses chosen for the purpose of showing these vocalic chan- ges are the 2 aorist, which usually exhibits the radical vowel, the 2 perfect, and the present.. Class I. This class includes verbs whose radical vowel undergoes no change in inflection. 2 aor. éyoupny, perf. yéygaqa, pres. yo%go. 2 aor. evgor, perf. pres. ego, 2 aor. £gglpnyr, perf. Eggupe, pres. Git. 2 aor, éxdzny, perf. xéxoze, pres. xdzT0, Zaor. éxgiByr, perf, xézxgupea, pres. “gut, 2 aor. aor, perf. dda, pres. déo 2 aor. Zor, perf. dédvc, pres. dla 2 aor. éginy, perf. sépva, pres.. pio. Here belong a few verbs with « made and continued long by posi- tion, one verb with 7, and a few doubtful examples with ¢. Greek Conjugations. ee 2 aor. Euagrov, 2 perf. uéuagzre, pres. “dont, 2 aor. 7 2 perf. Addoure, pres. ddunw, 2 aor, éxhyyoy, 2 perf. aénhyya, | pres. ahijcow, 2 aor. Egtdor, 2 perf. PéforFa, pres. Sordw. The Latin language exhibits examples not only of a, but of other vowels, made and continued long by position ; as, dambo, pret. lambi ; verto, pret. verti ; mordi, pret. momordi ; curro, pret. cucurri, Class II. This class includes verbs whose radical vowel « is changed in the course of inflection into other vowels. 2 aor. e1ganov, _ 2 perf. tétg07a, pres. toé70. 2 aor. theyor, 2 perf. Aéhoya, pres. Aéyo. 2 aor. %agzor, 2 perf. dédogza, pres. dégzo. 2 aor. éorddny, 2 perf. gotola, pres. orédo. 2 aor. ?tauoy, 2 perf. téroua, pres. téuvo. 2 aor. ?xtavor, 2 perf. éxtova, pres. *relvw. — Raor. épFugny, 2 perf. éptoga, pres. piteigon _ This second class has a striking analogy to the I, and IL. Teutonic eoGiagations ; 3 as, CONJUGATION I. Goth. past brak, part. brukans, pres. brika. Germ. past brach, part. gebrochen, pres. breche. Eng. past brake, part. broken, pres. break. CONJUGATION II. Goth. past halp, part. hulpans, pres. hilpa. Germ. past half, part. gcholfen, pres. helfe. Eng. past holp, part. holpen, pres. help. This second class of Greek verbs, like the I. and Il. Teutonic con- jugations, has its radical vowel usually either preceded or followed by a liquid. Class II]. This class includes verbs whose radical vowel @, %, v, is lengthened or doubled in certain tenses, 7 being equivalent to double «. 2 aor. éxouyor, perf. xéxgaya, pres. xgdtor. 2 aor. xdayor, perf. xéziyye, pres. xAdtor, 2 aor. sriinyy, perf. tétyjza, pres. T7jxe, 2 aor. Wu&xor, perf. dédyx«, pres. dézvo. 2 aor. payor, perf. zépyve, pres. galvw. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 15 114 Greek Conjugations. 2 aor. 2ugtyor, © 2 aor. tBgizor, perf. BéBooye, pres. Sonya. 2 aor. Zutxor, perf. uéuoze, pres. oxo. This third class has a striking analogy to the IV. Teutonic conju gation, where however a has been changed into 6 or @; as, perf. xéxgtya, pres. lt. Goth. past sloh, part. slahans, pres. slaha. Germ. past schlug, part. geschlagen, _ pres. schlage. Eng. past slew, part. slain, es. slay. Class IV. This class includes verbs whose radical vowel +, v, is made a diph- thong by Guna in the perfect and present; as, 2 aor. tnvfor, perf. 2énovda, pres. edo 2 aor. tlior, perf. Adhounre, pres. Aeinw 2 aor. %pvyor, perf. zépevya, pres. ome 2 aor. étuzor, perf. tétevya, pres. In the first and second examples the radical vowel « is made 4 diphthong by prefixing ¢ or 0, as in Sanserit the same vowel is made a diphthong by prefixing a. In the third and fourth examples the radical vowel v is made a diphthong by prefixing ¢, as in Sanscrit the | same vowel is made a diphthong by prefixing a. This mode of form- " ing a diphthong out of i or w by prefixing a, is called Guna by the a Sanscrit grammarians. This fourth class has a striking analogy to the V. and VI. Teutonic conjugations ; as, Fae ees ee CONJUGATION V. Goth. past draib, part. dribans, pres. dreiba. Germ. past trieb, part. getrieben, pres. treibe. Eng. past drove, part. driven, pres. drive. CONJUGATION YI. Goth. past baug, part. bugans, pres. biuga. Germ. past bog, Eng. past bow, part. gebogen, art. bowed, pres. bowed. In Conj. V. the radical vowel i is made a diphthong in Gothic by prefixing @ore. In Conj. VI. the radical vowel uw is made a diph- thong by prefixing a or i, The fourth class of Greek verbs, like the V. and VI. Teutonic con- jugations, has the radical vowel usually followed by a single cons0- nant and that not a liquid. Greek Conjugations. _ 3 115 The verbs belonging to these four classes are all primary or radical verbs. ? Weak Inflection. Weak verbs in Greek, or verbs externally inflected, include some primary verbs whose root or theme ends with a vowel or diphthong, and all derivatives or secondary formations. Primary Verbs. pres. Jodm, fut. dodow, perf. dédgaxc. pres. 2Talo, fut. 2talow, perf. émtaxa. pres. Teo, fut. zaiow, perf. 7éxauxe. pres. dé, fut. dijow, perf. dédexe. pres. cel, fut. cEeico, perf. céceuxe. pres. veto, fut. vetoo, perf. vévevxe. pres. tia, fut. ticw, perf. tétuxa pres. fdw, fut. Saou, perf. BéBaxe _ pres. Joiw, fut. dotow, perf. Aélouxa —pres. 77h, fut. ztéco, perf. xéatuxe, Secondary Verbs. In &@ ; as, teudw from ty}, and this from tiw ; xoudw from *duy. In é@ ; as, wovéw from zévog, and this from 7évw ; xowaréw from xol- gavos. 4 In etw ; as, touzetw from zou77, and this from zéunw ; dovietw from doddos. In 60; as, oteparvdw from otégevos, and this from atégo; dovidw, from dotios. In tw ; as, taviw from telvo. In étw; as, orevéto from otéyw ; Swgedtw from Jagos. In itm; as, Partito from pértw; uyditm from “idos. In tf ; as, égrito from égzw. In abo; as, ojualyw from oie. In tw ; as, 70070 from ids. In @ directly, from nouns or adjectives ; as, movxiiio from morxlhos. 116 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. Arr, XII.—WNotice of Prof. Ehrenberg’s Discoveries in relation to Fossil Animalcules ; also Notices of Deceased Members of the Geological Society of London, being extracts from the Address of Rev. Winuiam Wuewe t, B. D. F. R. S., President of the Society ; delivered at the Annual Meeting, Feb. 15, 1839. T'we Council have adjudged the Wollaston medal for the pre- sent year to Prof. Ehrenberg, for his discoveries respecting fossil Infusoria and other microscopic objects contained in the materials of the earth’s strata. We all recollect the astonishment with which, nearly three years ago, we received the assertion, that large masses of rock, and even whole strata, are composed 0 the remains of microscopic animals. This assertion, made at that time by Professor Ehrenberg, has now not only been fully confirmed and very greatly extended by him, but it has assumed the character of one of the most important geological truths which have been brought to light in our time: for the connection of the present state of the earth with its condition at former per riods of its history, a problem now always present to the mind 0 the philosophical geologist, receives new and unexpected illustra- tion from these researches. Of about eighty species of fossil In- a fusoria which have been discovered in various strata, almost the half are species which still exist in the waters: and thus these forms of life, so long overlooked as invisible specks of brute mat- ter, have a constancy and durability through the revolutions of the earth’s surface which are denied to animals of a more con- spicuous size and organization. Again, we are so accustomed to receive new confirmations of our well-established geological doc- trines, that the occurrence of such an event produces in us little surprise; but if this were not so, we could not avoid being struck with one feature of Prof. Bbieobons s discoveries ;—that while the microscopic contents of the more recent strata are all freshwa- ter Infusoria, those of the chalk are bodies (Peridinium Xanthi- dium, Fucoides,) which must, or at least can, live in the waters of the ocean. Nor has Prof. Ehrenberg been content with examin- ing the rocks in which these objects occur. During the last two years he has been pursuing a highly interesting series of researches with a view of ascertaining in what manner these vast masses of minute animals can have been accumulated. And the result of AL id x Jit i So Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Mon: 117 his inquiries is,* that these creatures exist at nieseiit in oe abundance, under favorable circumstances, that the difficulty dis- appears. In the Public Garden at Berlin he found that workmen were employed for several days in removing in wheelbarrows masses which consisted entirely of fossil Infusoria. He produced from the living animals in masses, so large as to be expressed in pounds, tripoli and polishing slate similar to the rocks from which he had originally obtained the remains of such animals; and he declares that a small rise in the price of tripoli would make it worth while to manufacture it from the living animals as an arti- cle of commerce. ‘These results are only curious; but his spec- ulations, founded upon these and similar facts, with respect to the formation of such rocks, for example, polishing slate, the siliceous paste called keiselguhr, and the layers of flint in chalk, are re- plete with geological instruction. As the discoveries of Prof. Ehrenberg are thus full of interest for the geological speculator, so they have been the result, not of fortunate chance, but of great attainments, kuowiadae: and labor. The author of them had made that most obscure and difficult portion of natural history, the infusorial animals, his study for many years; had travelled to the shores of the Med- iterranean and the Red Sea in order to observe them; and had published (in conjunction with Prof. Miiller) a worl far eclipsing any thing which had previously appeared upon the sub- ject. It was in consequence of his being thus prepared, that when his attention was called to the subject of fossil Infusoria, (which was done in June, 1836, by M. Fischer) he was able to produce, not loose analogies and insecure conjectures, but a clear determination of many species, many of them already familiar to him, although hardly ever seen perhaps by any other eye. ‘The animals (for he has proved them to be animals, and not, as others had deemed them, plants) consist, in the greater number of exam- ples, of a staff-like siliceous case, with a number of transverse markings; and these cases appear in many instances to make up vast masses by mere accumulation without any change. Whole rocks are composed of these minute cuirasses of crystal heaped together. Prof. Ehrenberg himself has examined the microscopic products of fifteen localities, and is still employed in extending * Abhandl. Kon. Ak. Wissensch. Berlin. 1838. 118 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. his researches; and we already see researches of the same kind undertaken by others, to such an extent, as to show us that this -new path of investigation will exercise a powerful influence upon the pursuits of geologists. We are sure therefore that we have acted in a manner suitable to the wishes of the honored Donor of the medal, and to the interests of the science which we all in common seek to promote, in assigning the Wollaston medal to Prof. Ehrenberg for these discoveries. . Although it is not necessary as a ground for this adjudication, it is only justice to Prof. Ehrenberg to remark, that his services to geology are not confined to the researches which I have men- tioned. His observations, made in the Red Sea, upon the growth of corals, are of great value and interest ; and he was one of the distinguished band of scientific explorers who accompanied Baron von Humboldt in his expedition to the Ural Mountains. And I may further add, that even since the Council adjudged this med- al, Prof. Ehrenberg has announced to the Royal Academy of Sci- ences of Berlin new discoveries ; particularly his observations on the organic structure of chalk; on the freshwater Infusoria found neat Newcastle and Edinburgh, and on the marine animalcules ie Ne im igs observed near Dublin and Gravesend ; and, what cannot but give — rise to curious reflections, an account of meteoric paper which fell from the sky in Courland in 1686, and is found to be composed of Conferve and Infusoria. I now proceed to notice some of the most conspicuous names, both among our own countrymen and foreigners, which have been removed by death from our lists since last year. In Sir Abraham Hume the Society has lost a member who was at all times one of its most strenuous friends and most liberal sup- porters, and especially in its earliest periods, when such aid was of most value. Indeed he may in a peculiar manner be consid- ered as one of the Founders of the Society. English geology, 48 is well known, evolved itself out of the cultivation of mineralogy; —a study which was in no small degree promoted, at one time, by the fame of the mineralogical collections of Sir Abraham Hume and others. 'The Count de Bournon, exiled by the French revolution in 1790, brought to England new and striking views ~ of erystallography, resembling those which Haiiy was unfolding in France ; and was employed to arrange and describe the miner- alogical collections of Sir John St. Aubyn and Mr. Greville, and * Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. 119 especially the collection of diamonds of Sir Abraham Hume, of which a description, illustrated with plates, was published in 1816. Some years before this period a few lovers of mineralogy met at stated times at the house of Dr. Babington, whose influ- ence in preparing the way for the formation of this Society was mentioned with just acknowledgment in the President’s Address, in 1834, by Mr. Greenough ; and certainly he, more fitly perhaps than any other person, could speak of the merits and services of his fellow laborers. Of the number of these Sir Abraham Hume was one; although not, I believe, one of those who showed their zeal for the pursuits which associated them by holding their meetings at the hour of seven in the morning, the only time of the day which Dr. Babington’s professional engagements allowed him to devote to social enjoyments of this nature. Out of the meetings to which I refer this Society more imme- diately sprung. The connection of mineralogy with geology is somewhat of the nature of that of the nurse with the healthy child born to rank and fortune. The foster-mother, without being even connected by any close natural relationship with her charge, supplies it nutriment in its earliest years, and supports it in its first infantine steps; but is destined, it may be, to be afterwards left in comparative obscurity by the growth and progress of her vigorous nursling. Yet though geology now seeks more various and savoury food from other quarters, she can never cease to look back with regard and gratitude to the lap in which she first sat, and the hands that supplied her early wants. And our warm ac- knowledgments must on all due occasions be paid to those who zealously cultivated mineralogy, when geology as we now under- stand the term, hardly existed; and who, when the nobler and more expansive science came before them, freely and gladly trans- ferred to that their zeal and their munificence. The spirit which prevailed in the infancy of this Society, and to which the Society owed its permanent existence, was one which did not shrink from difficulties and sacrifices ; and among the persons who were animated by this spirit Sir Abraham Hume was eminent; his purse and his exertions being always at the service of the body. He gave his labors also to the Society by taking the office of Vice-President, which he discharged with diligence from 1809 to 1813. He died in March last at the great age of ninety, being then the oldest person both in this and in the Royal Society. - he 120 Ehrenberg’s Discoverves—Notices of Eminent Men. r. Benjamin Bevan was a civil engineer, and throughout his life hovet a great love of science, and considerable power of promoting its purposes. He instituted various researches, theo- retical and practical, on the strength of materials ;* and it was he who first proved by experiment the curious proposition, that the Modulus of Elasticity of water and of ice is the same. In 1821 he wrote a letter to the secretary of this Society, recommending that the form of the surface of this country should be determined by barometrical measurements of the heights of a great number of points in it,—the barometer which was to be used as a stand- ard being kept in London. Mr. Bevan and Mr. Webster were commissioned to procure a barometer, and Dr. Wollaston recom- mended one of Carey’s barometers, but it does not appear that any further steps were taken. I may remark that recent researches have further confirmed the wisdom of Mr. Bevan’s suggestion, that heights should be measured, as all other measurements are made, from some fixed conventional standard, instead of incurring the vagueness and inconsistency which result from assuming the existence of a natural standard, such as the level of the sea. Nathaniel John Winch was born at Hampton Court in the year 1769, and after a voyage into the Mediterranean, and travels” in| various countries in Europe, settled at Newcastle-upon-Tyne as @ merchant. He had early paid great attention to botany, which — he continued to cultivate during a long life, and kept up a corres- pondence with all the leading botanists in Europe. He was one of the earliest, and always one of the most active members of the Literary and Philosophical Society of Newcastle; and, in con- junction with a few of his friends, gave to that town a scientific and cultured character, which still distinguishes it. He was one of the honorary members of this Society; and contributed to its meetings, in 1814, “ Observations on the Geology of Northum- berland and Durham,” and in 1816, “‘ Observations on the Eastern Part of Yorkshire,”+ which were printed in the fourth and fifth * To Mr. Bevan our Journal is indebted for many valuable communications.— iu. Mag. t Hiecites these papers, Mr. Winch published: ** The Botanist’s Guide through the Counties of Northaisberland and Durham. By N. J. Winch, J. Thornhill, ne R. Waugh.” 2 vols. 1805.—“ Flora of - sbsear pire and Durham.” Transactions of the Newcastle Natural History Society, vol. 2.—* Essay on the Geographical Distribution of Plants through ii Counties of Northumberland, Dur- Piteiree vue er “ich oi Meee» Hf Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of E:minent:Men. 121 volumes of our Transactions. In these he stated his object to be to combine with his own observations much interesting informa- tion on the subjects of the quarries, and coal and lead mines, of those districts, which had long been accumulating, and was widely diffused among the professional conductors of the mines. And these memoirs, though not containing much of originality in their views and researches, were, at the time, of considerable utility. He died May 5th, 1838, and, by his will, left to this Society a very considerable and valuable mineralogical collection, now in our Museum. Mr. William Salmon of York, was one of the persons who was most zealously and actively engaged in the examination of the celebrated Kirkdale Cavern. He measured and explored new branches of the cave in addition to those first opened, and made large collections of the teeth and bones, from which he sent speci- mens to the Royal Institution of London, and to Cuvier at Paris. The bulk of his collection was deposited in the Philosophical Society at York, then newly established. I now proceed to notice our deceased Foreign Members. Francois-Dominique de Reynaud, Comte de Montlosier, was born at Clermont in Auvergne, -_ the 16th, 1755, the year of the celebrated earthquake of Lisbon. He was the youngest of twelve children of a family of the ae nobility of that prov- ince, and was remarkable at an early age for the zeal with which he pursued various branches of science and literature. Count Montlosier must ever be considered as one of the most striking writers in that great controversy respecting the origin of basaltic rocks, which occupied the attention of mineralogists du- ring the latter half of the last century ; and to which, in so large a degree, the progress and present state of geology are to be as- cribed. The theory of the extinct voleanos of Auvergne, the subject of his researches, was the speculation which gave the main impulse to scientific curiosity on this point. It is true that he was’ not the originator of the opinions which he so ably ex- pounded. Guettard, in 1751, had seen, vaguely and imperfectly, that which it now appears so impossible not to see, the evidences ham, and Cumberland.” First edition, 1820; second edition, 1825.—“ Contribu- tions to the Flora of Cumberland.” 1833.—“ Addenda to the Flora of Northum- berland and Durham.” Vol. xxxvir, No. 1. ely 1839, bis. 16 122 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. of igneous origin in the rocks of that district: and the elder Des- marest, whose examination of them began in 1763, had made that classification of them, which is the basis, and indeed the main substance, of the views still entertained with regard to the struc- ture of that most instructive region. His map of the district, pub- lished in 1774 (in the T tions of the Academy of Paris for 1771, according to a bad habit of that body still prevailing, ) ex- hibits the distinction of modern currents of lava, ancient currents, and rocks fused in the places where they now are, which distinc- tion supplies a key to the most extraordinary phenomena, while it reveals to us a history more wonderful still. But striking and persuasive as this view was, and fitted, apparently, to carry with it universal conviction, the theory which it implied, collected, as it seemed at the time, from one or two obscure spots in Europe, was for a while resisted and almost borne down by the opposite doctrine of the aqueous origin of basalt; which came from school of Freyberg, recommended by the power of a connected and comprehensive system,—a power jn’ science so mighty for good and for evil. Montlosier’s Essay on the Volcanos of Au- vergne, which appeared first in 1788, was, however, not written with any direct reference to this controversy, but was rather the exposition of the clear and lively views of an acute and sagacious — man, writing from the fullness of a perfect acquaintance with the country which he described, in which, indeed, his own estate and abode lay. In its main scheme, although Desmarest’s is mel- tioned with just praise,* the object of this Essay is to criticise and correct a work of M. Le Grand d’Aussy, entitled Voyage en Au- vergne. But as the main additions to sound theory which this work contains, (a point which here concerns us far more than its occasion and temporary effect,) we may, I think, note the mode in which he traces in detail the effects which the more recent eurrents of lava (those which follow the causes of the existing valleys) must have produced upon the courses of rivers and the position of lakes ; and the idea, at that time a very bold and, I believe, a novel one, that lofty insulated ridges and pinnacles of basalt, which tower over the valleys, have been cut into their present form by the long-continued action of fluviatile waters, ee a ccuntle Pea mentioning Guettard, he says, “‘ Les mémoires de M. Desmarest, publies quelques années aprés, entrainérent tout-afait opinion publique.” (p. 20.) goes. Par erence Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. 123 - aided by a configuration of the surface very different from the present. The striking and vivid pictures which Montlosier draws of such occurrences, are to the present day singularly instructing and convincing to those who look at that region with the geolo- gist’s eye. After publishing this essay, M. Montlosier, a man of varied and commanding talents, became involved in the political struggles of his time, and was an active member of the National Assembly, to which he was sent as Deputy of the Noblesse of Auvergne. In his place there he resisted in vain the proposals for the spoliation of the clergy; and one speech of his on this subject was very celebrated. After witnessing some of the chan- ges which his unhappy country had then to suffer, he became an exile, and resided in London, where for some years he was the editor of the Courter Francais, a royalist journal. Under the empire, he returned to France, and was employed in the Foreign Office of the Ministry, but recovered little of his property except a portion of a mountain, which was too ungrateful a soil to find another purchaser. The situation however could not but be con- genial to his geological feelings; for his habitation was in the ex- tinct crater of the Puysde Vaches. The traveller, in approaching the door of the philosopher of Randane, had to wade through sco- riz and ashes; and from the deep basin in which his house stood, a torrent of lava, still ragged and covered with cinders, has poured down the valley, and at the distance of a league, has formed a dike and barred up the waters which form the lake of Aidat ;— a spot celebrated by Sidonius Apollinaris, Bishop of Clermont in the fifth century, as the seat of his own beautiful residence, under the name of Avitacus. It is curious to remark that Sidonius does not overlook the resemblance between his own mountain and Vesuvius: | « 7Emula Baiano tolluntur culmina cono, Parque cothurnato vertice fulget apex.” In this most appropriate abode M. de Montlosier was, in his old age, visited at different times by several distinguished English geologists, some of whom are now present ; and invariably de- lighted them with his unfading interest in the geology of his own region, his hospitable reception, and I may add, his lofty and vig- orous presence, according well with his frank and chivalrous de- meanor. His ardor of character had shown itself in early age: “Fyom my first youth,” thus his Essay opens, “1 occupied my- “Sha : - * : 124 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries —Notices of Eminent Men. self with the natural history of my province, in spite of repli and ridicule.” The same spirit involved him in other struggles to the end of his life; and, indeed, we may almost say, beyond it. He took a prominent part in the political controversies of his day ; and few works on such subjects, which appeared in France in modern times, produced a greater fermentation than his “ Mé- moire a consulter” on the subject of the Jesuits. In this work he maintained that the position of the Jesuits in France was danger- ous and illegal ; and he must be considered as the originator of that movement in consequence of which their body was, a few years later, suppressed by the government. The expression of his opinions respecting the conduct and influence of the clergy of his country was condemned by the ecclesiastical authorities, and was deemed by them of a nature to exclude him from that recog nition of his being a son of the Catholic Church, which i is implied by the performance of the funeral rite according to its ordinances. This, however, did not prevent the inhabitants of the neighbor- hood and the-military stationed at Clermont from showing the = his sepulture in great numbers. viously selected by himself, in the crater of the extinct volcano in which his abode was, in the middle of the scenes which he - a had from his earliest years loved and studied, and taught others to feel a deep interest in. He died at the age of 83, on his way to Paris in order to take his seat in the Chamber of Peers, of which he was a member.* Anselme-Gaétan Desmarest, honorary member of the Roy al Academy of Medicine, and Profeasot of Zoology at the Royal Veterinary College of ‘Alfore: was the son of Nicolas Desmarest, who has just been mentioned as the predecessor of Montlosier in his theory of the volcanic origin of Auvergne. The son also em- tae himself upon the same district ; and published an enlarged * Besides his “ Essay on the Extinct Volcanos of Auvergne,’ M. de Montlosiet was the author of the following works: “* Mémoire 4 consulter sur un Systeme Religieux et Politique tendant A renverser la Religion, la Société et le Tréne”’ (1826.) “ Dénonciation aux Cours Royales rélativement au Systéme Religieux et | Politique signalé dans le Mémoire A consulter,”’ (1826.) “ Mémoires de M. 1 Comte Montlosier sur la Révolution Praacsise, le Consulat, l’Empire, et les ee cipaux Evénements qui ont suivis 1755-1830.” Of this work two volumes _ hale Sppeiel, which bring the narrative down to the author’s quitting the Na- tional Assembly in 1790. Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. 125 and improved edition of his father’s map of Auvergne ;—a work which is still spoken of with admiration, for its fidelity and skillful construction, by all who explore that country. But the labors of the younger Desmarest were principally bestowed upon the other parts of natural history. We possess in our Library, extracted from various journals, and presented us by the author, his “ Notes on the impression of marine bodies in the strata of Montmartre,” published in 1809; his ‘“‘ Memoir on the Gyrogonite,” published in 1810; to which he added, 1812, the recognition of the analogy of this fossil with the fruit of the Chara, pointed out by his brother-in-law M. Léman; his review of a work by M. Daudebard de Ferussac, on the Fossils of Freshwater Formations, in 1813 ; his memoir on T'wo Genera of Fossil Chambered Shells, in 1817 ; and his ‘“‘ Natural History of Proper Fossil Crustaceans,” published in 1822 along with M. Brongniart’s “ Natural History of Fossil Trilobites.” In the ‘“ Dictionnaire d’Histoire Naturelle,” the arti- cle Malacostracés, which contains a complete account and classi- fication of Crustaceans, is by M. Desmarest, with others on the same subject. In this work all the articles on Crustaceans had originally been assigned to Dr. Leach; but when the lamented illness of that distinguished naturalist prevented his finishing this task, it was committed to Desmarest, who carefully studied the labors of his predecessor ; and, with most laudable industry and self-denial, made it his business to follow his method as closely as possible. He also published a separate work on Crustaceans in 1825. Count Kaspar Sternberg was one of those persons, so valuable in every country, who employ the advantages of wealth and rank in the cultivation and encouragement of science. He belonged to a younger branch of one of the best and oldest families in Bo- — hemia; and was closely connected with the persons of most eleva- ted station in that country. He was born the 6th of January, 1761, and received a distinguished education at Prague ; not only, as was then common among the Bohemian nobility, through pri- vate tutors, but by following the public course of the university. He was created Canon of the Chapter of the metropolitan chureh at Ratisbon, which, obliging him to receive the lower degree of holy orders, bound him to celibacy. At Ratisbon, then a consid- erable place, and the seat of the Diet of the German empre, he .. formed friendships with several eminent persons, and especially — 126 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. with Count Bray (afterwards Bavarian minister at various courts,) a man of letters, and a distinguished botanist. Count Sternberg also cultivated botany, and became an active member of the Bo- tanical Society of Ratisbon. During the time that Germany was a prey to the miseries of war, he retired to his hereditary country seat Brzezina, in the circle of Pilsen, in the northwestern part of Bohemia. Here his attention was early drawn to the coal forma- tion, of which mineral he possessed an extensive estate at Radnitz. soon formed the intention of publishing representations of the fossil vegetables belonging to the coal strata. These had already begun to excite the attention of geologists. Some of these works, containing notices on such subjects, preceded the existence of sound geology, as the -Herbarium Diluvianum of Scheuchzer, the Sylva Subterranea of Beutinger, and the Lapis Diluvii Tes- tis of Knoor.* At the beginning of the present century, Faujas de St. Fond had published in the Annales du Muséum some im- pressions of leaves, not indeed belonging to the coal, but to a later formation. ‘These impressions were examined and determined by Count Sternberg, in the Botanical Journal of Ratisbor 1803. In the following year appeared the first truly scientific work on this subject, the “ Flora der Vorwelt” of Schlotheim, in — which the great problem which was supposed to demand a solu- tion was, Whether the vegetables of which the traces are thus ex- hibited belong to existing or to extinct kinds? Count Sternberg was in Paris when he received the work of Schlotheim, and he studied it carefully by the aid of the collections which exist in that metropolis. He published in the Annales du Muséum a no- tice on the analogies of these plants, but concluded with observ- ing, that a greater mass of facts was requisite ; and that, these once collected, the general views which belong to the subject would come out of themselves. Bearing in mind this remark of his own, when fortune, after the storming of Ratisbon in 1809, set him down in the midst of the great coal formations of Bohemia, he proceeded forthwith to man- age the working of his mines, so as to preserve as much as sible the most remarkable impressions of fossils. Combining bis . “To the earlier works on this =r we may add Martin’s Petrificata Derbien- sia, 1809; and Parkinson’s Organic Remains, (1804,) gout contains many plates of vegetables, a Be oe 5 A eS Be Teli Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. 127 own specimens with those found in other places, he began to publish, in 1820, his “Essay towards a Geognostic-botanical Representation of the Flora of the Pre-esisting World.” In this work he not only gave a great number of very beautiful colored engravings of vegetable fossils, but also attempted a systematic classification of them. But he stated, in the first portion of his work,* that the problems, important alike for botany and geology, which offered themselves, could only be solved by combined la- bors on a common plan; and after mentioning the various Euro- pean Societies to which he looked for assistance (among which he includes this Society,) he adds, ‘‘ Bohemia and the hereditary states of the Austrian empire, I am ready, with some friends of science, to make the subject of continued investigation.” The specimens of which he published representations, with many more, formed the Count’s collection at his castle of Brzezina; = he declared in the outset, that as soon as the National Bohe- ian Museum at Prague was provided with the: means of receiv- ide wad displaying this collection, the whole should be transferred from Brzezina to the capital. This was afterwards done; and in this and other ways he was one of the principal founders of the Museum at Prague. He also gave notice, that while the collec- tion continued in his own residence, it was open to the inspection of every lover of science, even in the absence of the Count himself. The publication of Sternberg’s Flora der Vorwelt went on till 1825, after which it was discontinued till 1838, when two parts appeared, terminating the work. In this last publication he states that he is compelled to give up this undertaking, having been in a great measure deprived of sight for two years, so that he was obliged to devolve the greater part of such labors upon MM. Cor- da and Presl. His hearing also failed him. He adds, however, that though thus no longer able to pursue the path which he has trodden for twenty years, he shall not fail to render to the science, of which he was one of the founders, any service which may be in his power. ‘This publication was the crowning labor of his life, for he did not long survive it; he retained, however, to the last the elasticity and activity of his mind. He died very suddenly at his country seat already mentioned, on the 20th of December, 1838, being carried off by apoplexy in his 78th year. * Erster Heft, p 16. 128 Ehrenberg’s Discoveries—Notices of Eminent Men. In his own country his influence was highly salutary: he di- rected his attention especially to the improvement of the national education ; and we cannot be surprised at finding such a person very soon at the head of nearly all the institutions for literary and public purposes. He founded the National Museum of Bohemia, of which he was the President ; gave to it his library and his va- rious collections, and further enriched it at various periods of his life. He was, indeed, zealous in all that concerned Bohemian nationality, and was an accomplished master of the language and ~ literature of his country : since his death I am assured that there is hardly one Bohemian of any class who does not mourn for him as for a most respected benefactor. Throughout Germany, he was looked to by all who felt an interest in science with a respect and regard which he well merited. The emperor Francis held him in the highest esteem ; he gave him the title of Privy Coun- cillor, and the Grand Cross of St. Leopold, held in that monarchy as a distinguished honor. In the preceding sketch I have mentioned Schlotheim as one of the predecessors of Count Sternberg in fossil botany. Although — this writer died in 1832, and was an honorary member of this 80-_ ciety, he has never been noticed in the annual address; I may therefore here add a few words with reference to him. Baron EB. — F. von Schlotheim was Privy Councillor and President of the Chamber at the court of Gotha, and his collection of Petrifactions has long been celebrated throughout Germany. Besides his Flora of a Former World, or Descriptions of remarkable Impressions of Plants, which appeared in 1804, he published, in 1820, ‘ Petrifac- tenkunde, or the Science of Petrifactions according to its present condition, illustrated by the Description of a Collection of petrified and fossil remains of the animal and vegetable kingdom of a for- mer world.’ And in 1822 and 1823 he published Appendixes to this work. His collection was also further made known by arti- cles in Leonhard’s Mineralogical Pocket Book and in the Isis. After his death a new description of this collection was announ- ced, but whether it appeared I am not able to say. Schlotheim’s introduction to his account of his collection contains some extel- Sive geological views. It is only justice to M. de Schlotheim to add here what is said of him by M. Adolphe Brongniart, whose own labors on fossil ve- getables have been of such inestimable value to the geologist, and i ae Hiretioy s Dee = Notices of Eminent Men. 129 are every year increasing it n interest. “ Almost half a century,” he says, “elapsed, during which no important work appeared on this subject. It was not till 1804 that the ‘Flora of the Ancient World’, by M. de Schlotheim, again turned the attention of nat- uralists to this branch of science. More perfect figures, descrip- tions given in detail and constructed with the precision of style which belongs to botany, and moreover some attempts at compar- ison with living vegetables, showed that this part of natural history was susceptible of being treated like the other branches of science: and we may say, that if the author had established a nomenclature for the vegetables which he described, his work would have become the basis of all the succeeding labors on the same subject.” The following gentlemen were elected, Feb. 15, 1839, Officers and Council of the Society for the year ensuing. President.—Rev. W. Buckland, D.D., Professor of Geology and Mineralogy in the University of Oxford. _ Vice-Presidents—G. B. Greenough, Esq. F.R.S. and L.S. ; Leonard Horner, Esq. F.R.S. L. & E.; Charles Lyell, jun. Fisd: F.R.S. & L.S.; Rev. Adam Bedewick, F.R.S. and L.S., Wood- _ wardian Fiofessor in the University of Cambridge. ; Secretaries.—Charles Darwin, Esq. F.R.S.; William John - Hamilton, Esq. Foreign Secretary.—H. T. De la Beche, Esq. F.R.S. & L.S. Treasurer.—John Taylor, Esq. F.R.S. Council.—Professor Daubeny, M.D. F.R.S. & L.S.; Sir P. Grey Egerton, Bart. M.P. F.R.S. ; W. H. Fitton, MD. F.R.S. & L.S.; Prof. Grant, M.D. F.R.S. ; Me Prof. Henslow, F.L.S. ; W. Hopkins; Esq. M.A. F.R.S.; Robert Hutton, Esq. M.P. M.R.1.A.; Sir Charles Lemon, Bart. M.P. F.R.S. ; Prof. Miller, M.A. ; R. I. Murchison, Esq. F.R.S. & L.S.; Richard Owen, Esq. PRS.: Sir Woodbine Parish, K.C.H. "BR.S. ; George Rennie, Esq. F. R.S.; Rev. Prof. Whewell, F.R.S. Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 17 130 _ Meteor of Dec. 14, 1837. Arr. XIU.—Account of a Meteor seen in Connecticut, December 14, 1837; with some considerations on the Meteorite which ex- ploded near Weston, Dec. 14, 1807; by Epwarp C. Herrick, Rec. Sec. Conn. Acad. : On the evening of Thursday, the 14th of December, 1837, a meteoric fire-ball of great splendor, was seen by many persons in this vicinity. At the time of its appearance, Mr, A. B. Haile and myself were abroad here, engaged in making observations on shooting stars in concert with Messrs. F’, A. P. Barnard, J. D. Dana, and J. H. Pettingell, in New York. ‘Our attention was exclu- sively directed to the northeastern part of the heavens, and the western quarter, in which the meteor appeared, was unfortunately concealed from view at our station by a contiguous building. brilliant flash suddenly illuminated the roof on which we stood, and concluding at once that: he unseen source of the light must be a meteor of uncommon splendor, we noted the time. It was. Th. 39m. 32s. P. M. 5 I was not able, after much inquiry, to, ascertain the position of the meteor at its first appearance. The testimony of two inde- pendent witnesses several rods distant from each other, near the middle of this city, coincided as to the azimuth of the point of — extinction, and furnished me with data for fixing it at 8. 89° W. The altitude was less certain, but appeared to be about 9°. The meteor was much more splendid than Venus. It was ap- parently, according to the estimates of different observers, from one fourth to three fourths as large as the full moon. It moved downwards from a point between S. and W.at an angle of from 30° to 50° with a vertical, to the point before indicated, where it appeared to explode, and to throw down one or more large frag- ments. The time of flight was 1 or 1.5 seconds. It was attended by a long and broad train of scintillations, some part of which re- mained visible for about ten seconds, and of course, long after the meteor was extinct. It is uncertain whether the report of the explosion was heard here. If audible at this distance, the sound would not have arrived until two or three minutes after the disap- pearance of the meteor, and unless very heavy, it might easily have passed unnoticed amidst the noise of the city. Vhs a Meteor of Dec. 14, 1837. 131 Thinking it probable that some portion of this meteor had fallen in the southwestern part of this State, I made inquiries by letter in various towns in that region. At Wilton, (28 miles, about W. by S. from this city,) the meteor was seen by several persons, and their testimony was kindly collected for me, by Mr. Hawley Olm- stead. Mr. Edward Baldwin, one of the observers at that place, has given me some additional dethils. For observations at a spot about seven miles S. W. from Wilton, I am indebted to Rev. Theophilus Smith of New Canaan. At Wilton, the meteor pas- sed a little south of the zenith, in a westerly direction. It grad- ually enlarged until just afore the explosion, and at the alee it was of “the magnitude of one fourth of the moon.” The liancy of the meteor was exceedingly great, and rendered vatiitte objects on the ground distinctly visible. Its light was so intense that it arrested the attention of a person engaged in study in his room with two candles burning before him. The train was long, and remained in sight several seconds after the explosion. When 25° or | 30° above the horizon, the meteor exploded with a heavy report, which, according to the mean of various estimates, reached the ear in about thirty seconds afterwards. One or more of the observers saw luminous fragments descend towards the ground. Most of the witnesses imagined that they heard a whizzing noise, as the meteor passed over their heads; but this could not have been noticed until several seconds after the meteor’s passage. After collecting numerous observations from witnesses in vari- ous places, I found that they were not sufficiently exact and con- cordant to enable me to give a satisfactory account of the meteor, and I was for some time uncertain whether it was worth while to an them. The following are the results which were ob- The direction of the path of the meteor while visible, was se pabsasty one or two degrees N. of W. and inclined down- wards. The length of its path, and its relative velocity, can only be roughly conjectured, as I do not find that any one saw the meteor at its earliest appearance. Its path while visible may have been from 15 to 20 mileslong. On account of the direction of the earth’s motion at the moment, the relative velocity of the meteor was probably less than the absolute, but how much less cannot be determined, as we do not know the angle which its path made with our horizon. When it exploded, it was three or four miles above the surface of the earth, and probably over the 132 — Weston Meteorite of Dec. 14, 1807. town of Poundridge, Westchester County, N. Y.* The fragments which fell, doubtless lie buried somewhere in that region,—to be discovered, perhaps, in future ages. he larger part of the me- teor appears to have passed on, in its path around ‘the sun. The ze of the meteor can be Seebetained | in the present instance with oe as much certainty as in most similar cases. Respecting this particular there is always abundant room for fallacious results. The observer is commonly too unskillful to make a just com- parison of the angular size of the meteor with that of any celes- tial body ; and he is moreover, without being conscious | of it, - often prone to exaggeration. He rarely sees the bare nt ie but only the envelope of flame and sparks, and that, is larged by irradiation. Hence, there is danger of making the size of the body much too large, especially when the calculation is | based on observations taken at the distance of 50 or 100 miles. he nearer the observer is to the meteor, the less is the probabil- ity of error in this respect. In the present instance, an estimate of the apparent size of the meteor by an observer at North Bran- ford, (nearly 40 miles from the place of explosion,) would make the diameter of the meteor ten or twelve times as great as tha sulting from the observations at Wilton, only about six miles from the place of explosion. The data from Wilton make the diameter of the meteor about 150 feet, and it was probably a little less than this. 'The distant observations on Ane pepreent size of the me- a teor must be rejected. 4 On the velocity of the Weston Meteorite. The meteor which cast down stones in several places in and about Weston in this State, on the morning of Monday, Decem- ber 14, 1807, excited uncommon attention far and wide, a and full accounts of its interesting phenomena, were published in the highly valuable memoirs of Professors Silliman and Kingsley,t and of Dr. Bowditch.t To the elaborate calculations of the lat- *I did not — in abinining any observations on this meteor from the State of New York, bu thorough inquiry in that quarter. t Trans. or Phil Soc. v1, 323; Mem. Conn. Acad. 1, 141; Med. Repos, 202. See also a paper in the ‘Churchinds* s Monthly Mag. New Haven, v, 35; @¢ count by Messrs Bronson ard Holley in N. Y. Spectator, Jan. 2, 1808; Med. x1, 418; ib. xiv, 194, (1811.) Mem. Ame r. Acad. in, 213, Weston Meteorite of Dee. 14, 1807 ; ‘ 133: ter we are indebted for our knowledge concerning its height, di- rection, velocity and magnitude. The ease of the Weston meteor is one of exceeding impor- en sient ntly well observed for the determination of its velo- city. This element is of great value, on account of its bearing on the relation between meteorites and shooting stars. There can indeed be no reasonable doubt, that many of the meteors “which have been seen and heard to senna and whose phenom- have been submitted to calculation, were true meteorites; < this is a case where there is absolute certainty. Dr. Bowditch ascertained that the course of the Weston me- teor “was about 8. 7° W., in a direction nearly parallel to the surface of the earth, and at the height of about eighteen miles.” It was about a mile foil from the earth’s surface when it ex- than when it first appeared. The length of its path from 2 it was first seen until it exploded, as determined from ‘pes Peiserrations made at Rutland, Vt., and at Weston, was at least 107 miles. This space being divided by the duration of the flight as estimated by two of the observers, viz. thirty seconds, we have for the meteor’s relative velocity, about three and a miles a second. ‘The observations made at Wenham, Mass., are probably less exact in this respect, and need not ‘i mentioned here. Every one accustomed to observations on meteors, knows how difficult it is accurately to determine the duration of their visible flight. An inexperienced observer, however intelligent, will frequently give the time, ten or even twenty fold too large. The apparent motion of the Weston meteor, was probably much slower than that of most meteors, but it seems to me highly im- probable that its visible flight could have exceeded fifteen. or twenty seconds. Mr. Page, the observer at Rutland, Vt., says,— “motion very rapid, probably thirty seconds in sight.” The arc traversed by the meteor as there seen, was not over 15 de- grees. Now it is scarcely credible that any man could consider as very rapid, the motion of a meteor at the rate of one degree in two seconds of time. It will perhaps be deemed improper to introduce here, at this distant period, the recollected observation of one not unversed in science, who saw the meteor from a spot a few miles northwest of this city, and who is confident that it could not have been in sight as long as ten seconds. ¢ 134 Weston Meleorite of Dec. 14, 1807. therefore make no further use of his testimony. There are, how- ever, two considerations which may throw some light on this point. 1. The meteor if a satellite, must have moved with a velo- city greater than three and a half miles per second, because if it did not, the earth’s attraction would soon have brought the whole mass to the ground. But it is certain that much the greater portion passed on. In order to have done this, through the air, at the height of eighteen miles, it must have had a velocity not less than five miles per second. ——— 2, According to Mr. E. Staples, (one of the observers at West- on,) “when the meteor disappeared, there were apparently three successive efforts or leaps of the fire-hall which grew more dim at every throe, and disappeared with the last.”* Soon after the meteor disappeared, were heard threé principal heavy reports, which “succeeded each other with as much rapidity as was con- sistent with distinctness, and all together, did not oceupy three seconds.” Professors Silliman and Kingsley, who thoroughly examined the region where the stones fell, a few days after the — event, say, “ We think we are able to point out three prin jipal places where stones have fallen, corresponding with the three loud cannon-like reports, and with the three leaps of the me teor.” The account given by Mr. Isaac Bronson, of an investiga- tion made Dec. 19, 1807, by himself and Rev. Horace Holley; confirms this position. : (1.) The most northerly fall was in Huntington, on the border of Weston, near the house of Mr. Merwin Burr. (2.) The see ond principal deposit was near the house of Mr. William Prince “in Weston, distant about five miles in a southerly direction from Mr. Burr’s.” (3.) The third and probably the largest col- lection, fell near the house of Mr. Elijah Seeley, “ at the dis- tance of about four miles from Mr. Prince’s.” Although it is not certain that these several masses came in the same direction from the meteoric body, yet until the contrary 4p" pears, it may, not unfairly, be assumed that they did; and con- sequently the interval of space at which they struck the earth, g. * Observers in Wallingford, Meriden, Cheshire, &c., “ all agree that its motion — Was not uniform either in velocity or direction, but that it seemed to bound, or as one of them expresses it, to move scolloping.”’ Ch. Mo. Mag., v. 36. This * probably due to the resistance of the air, which, in such cases, must be exceedingly ut 7) alas Weston Meteorite of Dec. 14, 1807. 135 furnishes some measure of the velocity of the meteor relative to the earth’s surface. The cma will permit us to allow not quite a second of time between each report, and we thus obtaina velocity as great as four or five miles a second. This result is of course no more than a rude approximation to the truth. The velocity thus far spoken of, is only the velocity relative to the earth. Here the question arises,—if the meteor was not a satellite of the earth, what was its absolute rate of motion? Now it will be noticed (p. 133, lines 14, 15) that the path of the meteor must have been nearly in the same direction with that of the earth at the time. Their directions in azimuth were almost iden- tical ; the direction of the meteor’s path in altitude, appears to have hese. a little below that of the earth. If the meteor was mov- ing around the sun, then nearly the whole of the earth’s velocity (at that season) of rather more than nineteen miles a second,— must be added to the meteor’s relative velocity to obtain the true velocity. In this view, its absolute rate of motion will be found to uve been at least twenty miles a second. ~ Itremains only to inquire, whether it is more probable that the ‘Weston meteorite was a satellite of the earth, or a primary body moving around the sun. If this meteor had passed the earth’s setae | in the direction opposite to that of the earth’s motion, with about the relative velocity which it exhibited, then we might be compelled to consider it a satellite of the earth - But the pe- culiar direction in which it moved, makes it an ambiguous case. We must therefore resort to other instances, for a solution of the question. Numerous observations on meteoric fire-balls which were without doubt real meteorites, have been made and com- puted. It has most generally been found, that whenever they come in a direetion more or less opposed to that of the earth’s motion, their velocity is greater than ten miles a second; which proves them to be in revolution about the sun and not about the earth. Their velocity has indeed more than once, exceeded thirty miles a second. It is then from analogy altogether prob- able that the Weston meteor was a body revolving around the sun, and that if it had approached the earth from the contrary direction, it would have been found moving with a relative velo- city of not less than forty miles a second. New Haven, Conn. 136 Notice of British Naturalists. Arr. XIV.—Some Notice of British Naturalists; by Rev. Cuartes Fox, Cor. Mem. of the N. Y. Lye. of Nat. Hist. Continued from Vol. xxxvi, No. 2, p. 230. Ray had two contemporaries whose names are still remembered with respect. 'T'o the first we owe the origin of British Con- chology. Martin Lister was descended from an old and respectable Yorkshire family ; “but his parents, having removed from their own county, had settled in Buckinghamshire, where he was born in 1638. His earlier education was superintended by his uncle, Sir Matthew Lister, Physician to King Charles I, and President of the Royal College of Physicans in London. At the usual age he entered the University ; and in 1658, being then but 20 oer of age, he took his degree at St. John’s College, Cambridge. = Ray he appears to have distinguished himself here by his abi ties and his classical attainments; and two years after, he Ee created by the royal mandate, a fellow of his College. The | ar fession which he now chose to pursue was that of medicine ; an having traveled for some time upon the continent, in order to per fect himself, as was then usual for persons of his education, about five years after he had become a fellow, he settled at York to practice as a physician. Whether he had heretofore, paid any at tention to the study of Natural History, further than his profession required, does not appear; but it was! not till 1671 that he first became an acknowledged writer upon” the subject. The only periodical work of importance, the pages of which were at this time open to accounts of miscellaneous scientific discoveries, was the Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of Lon- don. In this work we find Lister’s first paper,—“ Observations on an acid liquor obtained from ants and perhaps other insects.” After having thus once began, he was a frequent contributor ; and he appears to have been not only an acute observer, but likewise a careful collector of miscellaneous facts on a variety of subjects. His papers in the Philosophical Transactions amount, in the whole, to about forty ; several of which are upon antiquities, and ohe or two upon the anatomy of Testacea. But his princi and those upon which his fame and usefulness as an au- thor chiefly rest, ate—L Historie Animalium Anglia, tres 4 Notice of British Naturalists. 137 Tractaius ; Unus de Araneis } hig de Cochleis, tam terrestribus tam Lainie £3 — ~ Cochleis Marints. diem gniies est Geass han sag aginem fig uratis. London, 1678. Ato. II. Sairic, sive Synopsis Con- chyliorum quorum omnium Picture ad vivum delineate, exhiben- tur. Lond. 1685-92, and a third edition at Oxford, 1770. .This latter edition consists of 1059 plates, exclusive of the anatomical ones; but there is very little letter press connected with it. Mr. Granger informs us that the drawings were executed chiefly by his two daughters, Anna and Susanna, and some think that these ladies engraved the plates likewise. IIL. Evercitatio Anatomica de Cochleis maxime terrestribus et Limacibus. 1694. 8vo. IV. Ever. Anat. altera de buccinis flaviatilibus et marinis. 1695. S8vo. V. Ever. Anat. tertia Conchylorum bivalvium. 1696. Ato. The plates are remarkable for their fidelity and excellency. In is first work he confines himself chiefly to the shells of the “northern counties, and describes sixty-three species. In his second work a large number, not before noted, are added. His other writings, some of which are upon medicine, are numerous ; but may be said, in general, to beg igarked — : propenaily to bypass: and too strong an att He now became well known in the scientific world; his practice as a physician was constantly increasing ; and his fame was generally extended. In 1684 he was persuaded to remove to London, in order that he might enjoy the advantages which the metropolis alone could afford him ; and in 1698 he was sent on an embassy, with the Earl of Portland, to the Court of France. On his return he pub- lished an account of his journey, which ‘was severely satirized, as containing some things which were supposed to be puerile and frivolous. He was elected a fellow of the Royal College of Phy- sicians;-and in 1709 he was appointed Physician in Ordi t Queen Anne. This honor, however, he did not long live to en- joy; for he died February, 1711,—having reached the highest point in his profession. When we read over the list of his nu- merous writings, we are surprised at his great and unceasing indus- try. He isa remarkable instance of what a person may do who makes use of all his time; for Natural History seems to have been but a recreation to him ; and all he did on this subjecthe Vol, xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 18 138 _ Notice of British Naturalists. appears to have accomplished during his leisure hours. His pro- fessional practice was large; he was by no means unacquainted with the writings of preceding Physicians, and his information on general topics was such as might be expected from one hold- ing the high station in society which he did. What has been justly remarked of those among the ancients who wrote on Nat- ural History, we may apply, without much change, to Lister,— that they were men of enlarged minds, who were far from being confined to one study; that their views were elevated, and their knowledge various and profound ; and that while no object appear- ed too minute for their consideration, their depth of thought pre- served them from trifling or unimportant investigations. Lister may be said to be the father of Conchology in England; and his anatomical examinations prove how correct a view he took of the subject. In these writings he has displayed both great accuracy of observation, and indefatigable industry in detecting the most minute sertioutans of the economy of this part of creation ; and we may still refer to his works with profit, instruction, and i terest. 2 Sir Roserr Srppatp.—The principal source of information re- specting him, is from an autobiography written in 1695, recentlt published, with other scraps of Scottish history* under the title © “ Analecta Scotica.” He was descended from a noble family of Es great antiquity, and enjoyed the influence of a judicious and ex- cellent mother, who was very careful of his education. He was born at Edinburgh, April 15, 1641, and received his education in the high school and university of that city. He then spent two years and a half on the continent, studying medicine at Leyden and in Paris, and cultivating the acquaintance of the leading sa- vans ofthe day. Having obtained a French diploma of medicine he travelled in various parts of France, and returned through Eng- land to Edinburgh in October, 1662. There was in those days no public coach north of York, whence he travelled to Newcastle on horseback with a soide,. whom he retained through the re- mainder of his journey. On his return to his native country, he projected the plan for establishing a Royal College of Physicians in Edinburgh, and was active in carrying it into effect. In 1686 he is said to have embra- ced Popery; from which, in a few years, he again recanted. * Naturalist’s Library, vol. ix, p- 18. Notice of British Naturalists. 133 = His practice was extensive, and it was chiefly as a recreation from his severer duties that he pursued the study of Antiquities and Natural History. He was aman ofan active, investigating mind ; he had before him a field hitherto altogether unexplored, and i in his profession, as well as in these pursuits, he rose to eminence. In the latter part of his life he was knighted, and appointed Phy- sician in Ordinary to King Charles I. He died in 1712. His writings are numerous, as appears by the following list of his works: ; tel ol Medica de variis Tabis 7 gee he a Batavorum; 1661. 4to. Nun ‘itannus ; Edin. - An ‘Accoutiullthe Scottish Atlas ; ei n. Scotia — sive aaa too eats es Edin. 1684. Folio. Again. 1696. Phalainologia Nova, coe ; Edin. 1692. 4to. ; reprinted at the instigation of Pen- nant in An tewesiadeent anent the Xiphias, or Sword Fish, exposed at Edinburgh. AnE ay concerning the Thule of the Ancients; Edirbargh, 1693. 12mo. ’s Britan nnia, Additions to Aes: of I 695. Folio. manis en = Edin. 1696. Folio. ; Edin. 1697. 8vo. Provision for the Poor in, Time of Dearth, ee Edin. 1699. 8vo. An Advertisement anent a rare sort of Whale come in — aor ecaegee 1701. Coelii Sedulii Scoti poemata sacra ex MSS. &c.; Edin. 1 Georgii Sibbaldi, Regule bene et salubrita eet g &c. ; a 1701. 8vo. Commentarius in Vitam, G. Buchanani; Edin. 1702 The Liberty and Independence of the Kingdom and Charch of Scotland Asser- ted. Three Parts. Edin. 4to An reige to the Seoat ae to the Lord Bishop of Carlisle, &c.; Edin. 1704 In hipoerits legem et in ejus Epistolam ad Thessalum, &c.; Edin. 1706. 8vo. Historical Inquiries concerning the Roman Monuments, &c, in N. B.; Edin 1707. Folio The Histories, Pana pad Modern, of the Sheriffdoms of Linlithgow and Stirling ; Edin. 1 = unt of bes ities &ec. which treat of N. B. Two Parts. Edin. 1710. Fol Miscella anea quedam erudite wap toe &e. ; Edin. 1710. Vindiciz Prodromi Historie Naturalis Scotiz E History, Riseens and Modern, of ee Sheriffdoms of Fife and Kinross; Edin. 1710. Folio. Reprinted, Cupar Fife; 1803. 8vo. Commentarius in Julii Agricole Expeditiones; Edin. 1711. Folio. Conjectures concerning the Roman Ports, &c. in the Friths of Forth and Tay; Edin. 1711. Specimen Glosiarii de Populis et Locis N. B.; Penis 1711. Folio. Series rerum a Romanis, post avocatum Agricolam, &c.; Edin. 1711, Folio. Description of the Isles of Orkney and Se ae “Edin, 1611. Folio 140 Notice of British Naturalists. The “ Scotia Illustrated,” although the labor of twenty years, manifests but a small acquaintance with the natural arrangement of the subject ; and it contains many of the errors of system of the older writers. Each general term is not only strictly defined, but each genus and order are traced back to their original cause. Thus we find one chapter, to introduce an account of the Scotch rivers and brooks, headed, “ De aqué dulci”—“ On Fresh Wa- ter,” and informing us that “ the necessity for fresh water is very great, that both men and wild beasts, and even plants themselves, may drink thereof and be irrigated.” Another, the first chapter on animals, is headed, “ De hominum dignitate et prestantia,” and includes an account of the creation of man, and his superior worth and dignity in comparison with the inferior orders. But Sibbald was not only a naturalist, he was a physician by profession ; and it was not to be expected that he would omit all mention of a subject to which he had dedicated his life. At that time there was scarcely any ,production of the earth, m4 . eS n ce the air, or the water, which was not pressed into service. In tl respect, and in this department, we are perhaps more deeply — indebted to the new and enlightend laws of science, than in any others whatever. ” Absurd and ridiculous remedies were still in vogue in the time | of Sibbald. Inone instance, he recommends the foam of a horse, taken fresh from its mouth, and mixed with oil of roses, as a cure for the earache. In another, the liver of a mad dog eaten cooked, aS a preservative against the fear of water. Again he prescribes the skin of a mad dog in the same rabid state, prepared with galls and alum, as a preventive against the gout We do not think, that as a science, Natural History owes much to this work ; and it is not only an instance, how little can either be accomplished without iced principles ; but also of the many errors into which any one must fall, who for himself neglects to reflect upon his own observations. It is interesting to observe the then medical condition of Scotland, wheniso few appeared to see for themselves whatever is either beautiful or excellent in the world around them, and to form conclusions from their own experiments and remarks. He who has succeeded in exciting amore general attention to any given subject, has opened the way to improvement. When men are once induced to think, some will both reason correctly, and strike out new ideas. The great > Notice of British Naturalists. 141 difficulty is to fix their attention, and to give it a particular diree- tion ; this once done, the rest must naturally follow. On the patronage of the public, the progress of science must necessarily depend. If no one will buy books, none will write them, and where there is no reward, there will be no laborers. If we as @ nation aspire to eminence in science, and thus to com- mand the respect of the world, we must as a nation, cherish every species of scientific investigation, and the talents by which they are sustained. A nation is but a collection of individuals, and consequently a degree of this responsibility falls upon each person, in his own ap- propriate sphere. The aggregate of grains of sand forms the beach of the sea, and each globule of water contributes to form the resist- less wave, that breaks on the shore. It is true that ardent minds, impelled by their own innate energy, will sometimes advance in Science without assistance, and that thus talents of a high order and peculiar cast, may force their way into notice, notwithstanding all. discou ragements and difficulties ; and being wholy dedicated to one subject, will finally achieve great results. Intense desire may produce intense action; but minds capable of such excite- _ Ment and energy are rare ; and it cannot be doubted, that had they = been encouraged by efficient aid, and warmly cherished by favor, = they would have attained still more noble ends. The strength which would carry them successfully through their journey, is spent in overcoming the difficulties that thicken in the early part ofthe way. - But all the various degrees of mental power are ne- cessary in science ; sound and unpretending as well as brilliant minds may be usefully employed. Most men will however, labor only on such subjects as promise them final rewards. — Even genius may encounter peculiar discouragements ; and, necessity often directs its efforts to such pursuits as are most in request among mankind. It is probable, that even of those few who have, perseveringly labored against hope, there was not one whose imagination did not hold out to him, however delusively, honor, emolument or posthumuous fame, as his exceeding great reward ; nor perhaps could he without this support have continued to strug- gle with opposing difficulties. This country is full of active minds, and science commands a portion of them to labor in its cause. The names of Wilson, Bar- 142 Notice of British Naturalists. tram, Audubon, Say,* Conrad, Nutall and many others testify to our successful cultivation of Natural History, and the works which have been published within the last few years in the United States, evince an increasing taste for natural science. We now come to a new era in Natural History. In 1735 Lixnzxus published in Sweden the first edition of his ‘Systema Nature.’ 'The great and most obvious improvements which he made, were the introduction of the binomial nomencla- ture, and the natural classification of all departments of nature, —beginning with man and gradually descending as he could trace similitudes. And here he appears to have had some idea, but which he did not live fully to elucidate, of the circular theory, since brought more clearly into notice by Mr. Mac Leay, Mr. Vi- gors, and Mr. Swainson, of London. The discovery of new truths is the peculiar province of an origin- al genius. Linneeus, absorbed in the studies of nature, carefully reviewed all former systems, thus laying his foundations deep ; and collecting what he held to be true in each, he then digested, re- arranged, modified, and invented, according to one general plan. As the greatest genius is unavailing without strenuous industry, Linneus labored incessantly either in his closet or in the fields. The grandest as well as the most correct views, are those which have been gained by minute observations, and by the application of 2 all the more precise and accurate methods of study. He regarded all Nature asa grand unity, infinite in detail, but consistent in exe- eution and end ; and with Bacon for his guide, he examined each * The greater part of his library and collections he left, on his death, to the Acad- emy of Natural Sciences in Philadelphia. We are truly glad to find a late English writer speak as follows of this really excellent man: “ How few form an adequate idea of that ardent zeal, that untiring energy, that perserverance under the most de- pressing circumstances, that indefatigable industry in collecting, that Jaborious ac- with fondness by all who had once the happiness of calling him their friend.” Doubleday, in Mag. of Nat. Hist., No. xxvii, new series. : t Among the signs of this, which we rejoice to see, may be named the increasing demand in our great cities, and even in our smaller towns, for lectures. «« Not, a8 Dr. Channing justly observes, that th d other lil finst ion, are able of themselves to carry forward the hearer ;but they stir up many, who, but for such Seal might have slumbered to the end of life.” And they not only do, » 88 We find by experience, impel many on to deeper research, but they are forming an elevated national taste. . es in a Notice of British Naturalists. 143 species by itself, with the double view of noting its own pecu- liarities, and its connection with the one great whole. If, as has been said, he took the first hint of his zoological sys- tem from Ray, and if he owes to Aristotle and Aldrovandi man of his materials, he yet claims the praise of originally elucidating and fixing the most important principles of nature. What the in- ventor of the watch owes to the miner, and to the worker in metals, and to him who first observed the elasticity of the steel spring, so much does Linnzeus owe to those who preceded him. The material world lay before him, and he made himself its mas- ter, As regards eicna, his influence was at once perceptible and became ultimately very great. His pupils dispersed themselves over the world to collect specimens, and with their master’s sci- ence extended both his fame and their own. The Travels of these students were translated, and given to the British public as ean as 1771. The Amenitates Academica* were quickly prin- ted both in Holland and Germany, parts of them, being translated, ere ‘published i in England. A new interest in Natural History was thus created. It became not only the amusement of men of _ leisure, but the diligent pursuit of the learned ; and Societies and SS Professorships were every where instituted for its promotion. The _ Systema Nature now became the universal Text Book, and having been enlarged, although perhaps scarcely improved, by _ Professer Gmelin, it was used as a basis by contemporary and subsequent writers. In 1778 Linneus died, having produced a greater and more lasting effect upon the mind of Europe, and hav- ing roused in the world with more effectual energy than perhaps any literary man had ever done before or has done since. From this period we may date the general establishment of museums in England.* We do not mean to say there were no museums previous to that period. The first on record was form- ed about 1650, by John Tradescant, who was either a Fleming * The following extract from the paper * Cui bono,’ now rare, contains a fine, and, for those times, a very enlarged view of the subject :— * Tandem quoque ex contemplatione rerum creatarum, yisuri sumus » quod omnia creata ad nostram utilia sint necessitatem, licet non immediate, sed sepé per secun- dum et tertium. Immo ita imé nobis nocere putamus, sepe plarimom nobis expediat. Absque bie vita nostra longé nobis difficillima, aded ut, si cardui et spine non crescerent, terra nostra multd esset sterilior, &c. a. Notice of British Naturalists. or a Dutchman, and Gardener to King Charles I, of England. He travelled over a great part of Europe and Asia Minor, and into Barbary, Greece, and Egypt; chiefly with a view of improving himself in natural science. He introduced a considerable num- ber of exotic plants into England, and was the first to prove that they might be rendered useful, and made to thrive by due culti- | vation. He was followed in his pursuits by his son, John, who inherited the museum, and to which he made considerable addi- tions. On his death it was sold to Mr. Ashmole, “the greatest virtuoso and curioso that was ever known or read of in England.” We may form some idea of what it contained from the “ Museum Tradescantianum,” a catalogue of it, published in 1656, and which is divided into the following heads: 1. Birds with eggs. 2. Four footed Beasts. 3. Fish. 4. Shells. 5. Insects. 6. Min- erals. 7. Fruits, Drugs, &c. 8. Artificial curiosities. 9. Mis- cellaneous curiosities. 10. Warlike Instruments. 11. Habits. 12, Utensils and household stuff. 13. Coins. 14. Medals. Isaac Walton likewise makes mention of some of its contents his Complete Angler (part I, chap. I). “I know we Islanders | are averse to the belief of dens wonders ; but there be.so poe cant, and others added by my fricid, Elias Ashmole, Esq., W now keeps them carefully and methodically arranged at his honsé! at Lambeth, near London, as may get some belief of some of the wonders I mention. I will tell you some of these wonders that you may now see, and not till then falieve: unless you think fit, ‘You may see there the Hog-fish, the Dog-fish, the Dolphin, the Coney-fish, the Parrot-fish, the Bsek fish and not only other in- credible fish, but you may there see the Salamander ; several sorts of Barnacles; of Solan Geese ; the Bird of Paradise ; such sort of snakes, and ‘rio birds’ nests, ead of so various fonts and so won- amur, the celebrated French Naturalist, was the first person who formed an icine ealieetion of animals in France. He was born in 1683 and died in 1757; so that _ era of Museums in that country was nearly the same as in England. The wn Brisson, who was the keeper of his Museum, derived from it the prin- cael ates for his work on qua drupeds and birds. These last afierwards co- stituted the basis of the Royal Museum at Paris. The earliest considerable Muse- - um in this country owes its origin to the late Mr. Peale of Philadelphia. In this “Museu na eonplete skeleton of the mastodon. Many of Wilson's ; oe. and not a few of the animals procured in the ocky Mountains, being it has become classical from the frequent reference to these and other speci- Notice of British Naturalists 145 derfully made, as may beget vidlieee, amazement in any er holder,” &c. The Dodo was preserved in this collection. Mr. Ashmole presented the whole to the University of Oxford, where it still remains; and it has of late been much enlarged by the munificence of its present Curator, Mr. Duncan. The next collection was Dr. Woodward’s, which became the foundation of Sir Hans Sloane’s; and the whole was purchased, in 1753, by the British Parliament, and is now known as the Brit- ish Museum. Another collection, once much celebrated, was that in possession of Sir Ashton Lever,* who died in 1788, and which was sold by auction in lots, and dispersed in 1806. But still museums were very far from being common or popular in any part of Europe. London was, at the period we refer to, as now, a place of general resort for scientific men, anda large num- ber of such persons were collected there. The celebrated Bishop Horsley, the learned and able antagonist of Dr. Priestley, was an active member of the Royal Society. Sir Joseph Banks, ing the advantages not only of great abilities, but of fortune and a high station in society, constantly exerted himself in this cause. He and his friends, convinced that without extensive collections ‘it is very difficult, if not altogether impossible, to make any great _ progress in Natural History, were diligently employed in forming Societies, and in collecting specimens for examination from differ- ent countries. The eminent men of that day, likewise deeply felt the importance of bringing together those who pursue the same studies, and they understood that, especially in physics, union is power; that the first thoughts and more transient discoveries of individuals, made known to a circle of scientific friends, may, often do, both save the labor of many, and draw out the energies of many more, and that particular subjects being alloted to differ- ent observers, on the principle of the division of labor, the ex-, aminations are more exact and availing. The Royal Society had already proved the advantages of such meetings. We owe very much to the publication of their ‘ Transactions,’ in which, each contributing a little, where otherwise none would have contributed at all, the result is an immense mass of facts, thoughts, and experiments. And indeed the British Association for the Ad- * For a notice of this museum, see Journal of Travels in England, &c. 1805-6. Vol. I, by B. Silliman. Vol. xxxvit, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 19 146 Notice of British Naturalists. j vancement of Science may be said to be but the carrying out of this principle on a grander and more enlightened scale.* In this country much has been done both in forming scientific and popular museums and societies. It must, however, be al- lowed that few of our societies are efficient, and too many exist only in name; but the Philosophical Society, the Academy of Natural Sciences, of Philadelphia; the Lyceum of Natural His- tory, of New York ; similar institutions in Baltimore and Charles- ton ; the American Academy, and the Natural History Society, of Boston ; the Institute, of Albany ; the young Natural History So- cieties of Salemt and Yale College; and a still more youthful Society in Harvard University, evince that all are not asleep, or in a state of suspended animation. Several of these institutions have valuable collections, most of which arerapidly increasing. Among the most distinguished, are those of the Academy of Sciences and the Franklin Institute, of Philadelphia; of the Lyceum of Xs York, and the Natural History Soeiety, of Boston. : Among our popular Museums are several of great merit in 0 ur principal cities, at the head of which is deservedly placed the fin museum of the late venerable Peale—with its colonies in other cities,—and several others, in all our larger towns. Our living Naturalists are numerous. “Audubon, Nuttall, Har- ee. lan, Morton, and Torrey are not without coadjutors, and it would 7 require a Jee catalogue to enumerate them all. The early pub- a lication of Wilson’s Ornithology, with its continuation in later years, and of Holbrook’s Herpetology, still going on, affords suf- ficient proof that this country is alive to the claims of Natural His- tory. The next great writer upon British Zodlogy is Tuomas PEen- Nant. We should wish to depict Pennant’s character as that of * Among the earlier collections formed in England, the Wyckliffe Museum may be particularly noticed as one much celebrated in its day. It was formed and own- ed by Marmaduke Tunstall, an independent gentleman, of old family, at Wickliffe, in Yorkshire. He w ne-the friend and correspondent of the greatest naturalists of day. To this oa the writers of those times owe much ; and from unique Specimens contained in it, Edwards, Brown, Pennant, Latham, and Bewick, illus- trated their works. At ‘ie death it was sold ; and having passed through the hands of Mr. Alian, of Darlington, in the county of Durham, it became in 1822 the founda- of the ae collection in | Newel upon Tyne, where it still remains. «Bhs East ia Museum of Salem is an unique and most interesting collection 5 nd the pote um at Philadelphia, although having little relation to science; ierich asea all example, in illustrations of China. Notice of British Naturalists. 147 aman, a father, and a Christian, (for as such he appears eminent- _ ly to have fulfilled his duties,) rather than as merely a literary and scientific person; but unfortunately our materials are very scanty. The chief source from which all the biographies of Pen- nant have been drawn, is a work which was published by him in 1793, under the fanciful idea of writing after his death, ‘ T'he Literary Life of the uate Thomas Pennant ;’ and which con- tains a few circumstances of his private life, and peculiarly shows the bent and tone of his mind. He was born in 1726 at Downing, in Wales. His family was old and respectable, possessing some landed property, and having for some generations held honorable situations under Government. He appears to have been an only child. When properly pre- pared, and at the usual age, he entered Queen’s College, Oxford ; but afterwards he changed to Oriel, and on taking his degree, as- sumed the law gown. He is here described as conspicuous for his general intelligence, and for the progress he made in classical cnowledge. But his taste for Natural History was formed at a very early period, and long before he was able to indulge it to the extent which he afterwards did. It is, indeed, not uncommon that those who, when young, have evinced a taste for this sci- ence, neglect it altogether in after life ; their feelings being, in this respect, like those of children pleased with the first sight ofa beau- tiful object. It is extremely rare that a person who has neglected this study in youth, becomes fond of it in after years. Pennant says, “a present of the Ornithology of Francis Willoughby, when I was about twelve years of age, by my kinsman, John Salisbury (father of Mrs. Piozzi, known as the Biographer of Dr. Johnson, ) first gave me a taste for that study, and incidentally a love for Natural History in general, which I have since pursued with my constitutional ardor.” = eee On leaving college he probably returned to his home, and there pursued his studies in the law. In these, however, ‘he never made much progress. His station in life was one which is, per- haps of all others, the least adapted for nourishing common am- bition, or for stirring up a person to diligence in the business of life. It wasasaying of the late Lord Eldon, that if a man be desirous of rising to eminence in the legal professon, he should be dependent solely upon his own endeavors for a maintenance. Now the contrary was exactly Pennant’s case. He knew that he — _ Notice of British Naturalists. should inherit a handsome property on his father’s death ; and in the mean time his allowance was such, that while it afforded him a comfortable competence, it prevented his indulging in luxu- ries; or seeking, in a more expensive sphere, for a higher stand- ard of mind and action. The law he never practiced; anda few years after leaving college, he married, and settled down. asa quiet country gentleman. It was not till he was about forty years of age, that he came into possession of his patrimony. His mind however, was naturally active; and he was constantly employed in laying a foundation, in wher studies, for his future eminence in the walks of natural science. Intimate social inter course he appears particularly to have enjoyed. He was far from shutting himself out from the society of his friends; he mixed freely with such as his neighborhood afforded ; and with the marked politeness of the old school of manners, hs highly relished the company of the fair sex. He has left a few sonnets of his. own composing, which he addressed to “particular ladies ; and while the verse is neither very polished, nor manifests much study or care, the whole is marked by a pleasing play an enlightened conception of the beauties of nature, — (the constituents of poetry, ) and a high moral delicacy. During ‘ to the subject in his préface to British Zoology ;—“ Ata ume when the study of natural history seems to revive in Europe, — and the pens of several illustrious ‘foreigners have been employed — in enumerating the productions of their respective countries, We are unwilling that our island should remain insensible to its pe- culiar advantages ; we are destrous of diverting the astonishment of our countrymen at the gifts of nature bestowed on other king- doms, to a contemplation of those which (at least with equal bounty) she has enriched our &n. Why then should we neg- lect i inquiring into the various benefits that result from these in- of the wisdom of out Creator, which his divine munifi- 2 ‘cence ha has so liberally and so psnisognily placed before us ?””* = The Baty of the economical uses of natural history has been, hitherto, very ae ealticaied, and requires more cecil attention. As a true science it has, of art in natural connection with it; and the full elucidation of this art 18 The most obvious application of it is to agriculture, taking the widest sense ; but there is scarcely a pliyeipal subject of ordinary 0¢ Sens whi not be ee less indebted to it. The distribution of ya Notice of British Naturalists. ~. “549 Previous to 1757, his only publications of consequence were two papers in the Philosophical Transactions. In that year, Lin- nwus seeing one of the productions, was so much pleased with it as to procure his election as a member of the Royal Society of x In 1 own cost, and contained one hundred and thirty-two plates. shell-fish and other animals, of reptiles, and insects; the various important duties which they perform in the economy of the world and the possibility of procuring their assistance, or avoiding their ravages, are all subjects which have been very slightly investigated. Asa singular instance in point, we may mention the cul- tivation of figs in the island of Malta: «The peculiar process in the treatment of this fruit,is worthy of remark ; and the necessity of its adoption in some coun- is a subject which the curious may find inter- Where the figs are advancing towards maturity, in order to trying it with them into the female fig, produce that natural which is necessary for the effectual generation of the fruit.” Again, the 3 pposed to be least capable of any practical bene thi principle might be much extended, and greatly carried out; and if so, that then in others, universally confessed to be more capable of it, ‘it need not to be neglected for fear of failure. Natural science is, still, too little considered asa whole. It cannot be said by any means yet to have arrived at its climax; but when it is perfected, it will, it appears to us, combine in one grand circle, natural system- atical arrangement, founded on anatomical distinction ; a minute description of the generic, individual and social habits of each species; a knowledge of the uses. to which they may be made available; the purposes of their creation, and the place which each holds in the great chain of nature ; a vast mass of materials has been indeed collected; but much is still wanting to finish so great a work. Nature is still viewed not as a whole, but only limb by limb ; and the next great marked im- provement in this science, will probably be the conjunction of the different parts into one general intimate union; and the combination of the science with the art. * es e ; eg ba ee “* if cal * ats 3 al “tee has % 150 Notice of British Naturalists. The profits of it he had dedicated to a Welsh chariey school in London, of which he was the patron; but the expense of the undertaking was so great, and the sale comparatively so limited, that he lost considerably by the work. As the editions were mul- tiplied he added to it, and improved it ; and it was afterwards pub- lished in octavo with profit. The first one hundred pounds that he realized from it, he presented to the school. ‘T'wo years after this, his wife, to whom he appears to have been much at- — tached, and of whom he speaks in the warmest terms of affection, died; leaving him two young children; and to relieve his mind from the grief natural to such an event, he paid a visit to the continent. We may imagine with what pleasure Pennant, with a mind constituted as his was, found himself surrounded by the great naturalists and literati of his day... Among them he visited, and became intimate with Buffon, Voltaire, Baron Haller, the two Gesners, and Dr. Pallas. The intimacy thus formed, with P. Ia continued through life; their correspondence was frequent; amt Pennant tells us that to ‘tite gentleman he owed the first hint of his” Synopis of British quadrupeds. But Buffon was then the mo noted naturalist in that part of the continent ; and naturally there fore, the person in whom Pennant felt the greatest personal interes! He spent a week with him at his country residence. Buffon was - born in 1707, of a noble family, and at an early age inherited a large property. He dedicated his life _to the pursuit of science. In 1749 he began to publish his “ Histoire naturelle,” and comple- ted it in 1767. He died about 1780. His talents were original, and of high order; and by the beauty and eloquence of his style, the earnestness with which he insisted upon the advantages of this study; and the magnificence of his published works, he at tracted great attention to the science. Asa practical naturalist, he was, however, exceedingly deficient. He depended ina great measure upon the information afforded by others; and like Gold- smith, in a somewhat similar undertaking, his brilliant imagina- tion worked this up into an interesting and most popular book. He pursued no regular system, although he had his own peculiat views. Whether he already saw the danger which was likely ' arise from too servile an adherence to Linneus; or whether it ‘was Owing toa want of sufficient knowledge of scientific detail ; and an affected independence of mind, he merely grouped his Notice of British Naturalists. 161 subjects according to a coarse, outward resemblance ; and ridiculed a more accurate system of classification. = The mind of man is ever more inclined to follow some one leader, and to lean upon the labors of others, than to strike out truths for itself. Thus it has always happened, that a fondness for certain popular systems has chained down the general intellect to one point. Buffon perceiving the popularity of the writings of Linnzus, foreseeing to what it would lead, and endeavor- ing to avert this evil, in this way rushed into the contrary ex- treme ; he thus discarded all system but what he chose to call the natural one, “ ne seroit—il pas,” says he, “plus naturel, et plus vrai de dire qwun dne est un ane, et un chat, un chat que de vouloir, sans savoir pourquoi, qwun ane soit un cheval, et un chat un loup—cervier ?” On Pennant’s return home in 1767, he was elected a fellow of the Royal Society ; and in 1768, we find him engaged in pub- lishing a second edition of his British Zoology. Like Ray, he was, throughout life, celebrated for his frequent tours through Great Britain, accounts of which he published from time to time. His object in these journeys was to study natural history in the different parts of the country; but he paid attention to every = thing of interest ; and especially to antiquities. In 1770 he vis- ited Scotland, with the condition of which, strange as it may © seem at the present day, the English were ‘then almost unac- quainted. “I had the hardiness,” says he, “to venture on a journey to the remotest part of North Britain, a country almost as little known to its southern brothers as Kamtschatka. I brought home a favorable account of the land. Whether it will thank me or not, I cannot say, but from the report I made, and showing that it might be visited with safety, it has ever since been inondée with southern visitors.” In 1772, he made another visit to that country, and went as far as the Hebrides. His only companion in these journeys was a self taught artist, whom he supported, and who illustrated his different works with views, engraved in a very excellent style. Besides these trips to Scot- land, he visited Ireland, as well as the north of England and Wales, and published an account of the Topography of London. All these tours he performed on horseback ; a mode of travelling to which he attributed the excellent health which he enjoyed through life. By thus moving about, he acquired much information for his va- ° 152 Notice of British Naturalists. rious works; and he discovered many novelties, which perhaps were novelties only, because no one had hitherto taken the trouble to look for them. Since his day, England has been diligently explored, and he is fortunate who succeeds in discovering there any thing new. In this country there is altogether as good a field, if not better, for original discovery, as Pennant enjoyed ; and the experience of our travelling naturalists and of the scientific and exploring expeditions proves sufficiently, that he who takes the trouble of observing, will be fully rewarded for his pains. ‘The accounts which Pennant published of these tours, are perhaps the most instructive and interesting of the kind which we possess. It is a common remark, that the climates of both Europe and America are gradually changing. 'To decide whether this is the case or not, or whether the difference arises only from a higher state of cultivation, is a work of great difficulty. The data on which to proceed, are in a great measure wanting. Well con- ducted meteorological observations, although we now have some of great value, have not been recorded in numerous places and for a sufficient length of time, to form the basis of general con- clusions ; and without some such certain and well known experi .. ments, from which sound deductions may be drawn, it is not ae . sible to arrive at any satisfactory opinion. a It is a circumstance worthy of observation, that both in the United States, and in Great Britain, many birds appear to have changed their habitations within the last one hundred years. In his first tour to Scotland, Pennant visited the Fern Islands, 4 group of barren rocks off ‘the Coast of Northumberland, and there found the little Auk, (Mergulus alle, Selby,) and the Black Guil- lemot, (Uria Grylle, Lath,) not unfrequent ; while, according to Mr. Selby, the first does not now occur at all, and the latter is only occosionally met with in that location. Another instance is that of the Crane, ( Grus cinerea, Bechst. ») which, according to Ray, was in his time found, in some counties, in large flocks, but which now ranks among the rare visitors. Others again, once Scarce, have taken their. places, and become comparatively com mon ; among which we may particularly remark, as of very ! cent Bite: the Honey Buzzard, (Buteo Apivorus, Ray. ) A long list of such changes might be given. We must now revert afew years, to trace Pennant’s literary labors. ze eet ae = ; bs Notice of British Naturalists. 153 In 1769, he published a volume on British fishes ; and in the same year he began a work on Indian Zoology, pith however, proceeded only to twelve plates, and was afterwards republished in Saxony. Of this he observes:—“my mind was always in a progressive state; it could never stagnate ; this carried me fur- ther than the nae of my own Islands; and made me desirous of forming a zoology of some distant country, with which I might relieve my pen by the pleasure and variety of the subjects.” In 1770, he was elected a Fellow of the Royal Academy of Dron- theim. In 1771, the honorary degree of doctor of law, was con- ferred upon him ie the University of Oxford. About this period, he married a second wife ; the fortune he now possessed, allowed him to indulge his natusél taste for hospitality; and being thus comfortably settled, he entirely lost, as he informs us, his desire of rambling. In 1785, appeared ‘te great work on the “ Arctic Zoology ; which was shortly after translated both into German and French. He was now elected a member of the American Philosophical Society of Philadelphia, an attention which was peculiarly gratifying to him; and he observes on the occasion, that “there science of aoe kind began to flourish, and among others of natural history.” From this time he continued to print other occasional works ; among them a pamphlet entitled, ‘ American Annals ; an smb ment to Parliament men to inquire into the conduct of the com- manders in the American war ;’ and he was now much engaged in his duties as a magistrate anda landlord. His health continu- ed good till within two years of his death, when, in 1798, he quietly sank into the grave at the age of seventy-two. In person he was rather above the middle height, well proportioned, and somewhat inclined, in the latter part of his life, to corpulency. His complexion was fair; and his countenance peculiarly open and benignant. While many may stand higher in general estimation for their genius and abilities, few surpass Pennant in his unceasing indus- try and his continual endeavors to be useful to his fellow men. Mild and amiable in temper he avoided politics as far as he could, in an age peculiarly subject to political excitement ; and this, re- fined a disposition originally tender and gracious. He fulfilled his domestic duties ina manner truly exemplary ; and his writings abound in passages which prove oH he never forgot his con- Vol. xxxvi1, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 154 Notice of British Naturalists. stant dependence upon his Creator. The distresses in which his _ poor neighbors were involved, gave him unfeigned uneasiness; — and he endeavored to relieve them by every means in his power. His name was long remembered by them with love and respect. But we cannot do better than to let him speak for himself, as re- gards his occupations and character. “TI still haunt the bench of justices (1793). Iam now active in hastening levies of our gen- erous Britons into the field. However unequal, I still retain the same zeal in the services of my country, and have grown indig- nant at injuries offered to my native land; or have incited a vig- orous defence against the lunatic designs of enthusiastic tyranby, or the presumptuous. plans of fanatical atheists to spread their reign or force their tenets on the contented moral part of their fellow creatures.” “Iam often astonished at the multiplicity of my publications, especially when I reflect on the various duties which it has fallen to my lot to discharge, as a father of a fam- ily, landlord of a small but very numerous tenantry, and notan inactive magistrate. I had a great share of health during the lit- erary part of my days: much of this was owing to the riding eX: ercise of my extensive tours, to my manner of living, and to my temperance. I go to rest at ten; and rise, summer sind winter, at ‘ seven ; and shave regularly at the same iene I avoid the meal ol % excess—a supper; and my soul rises with vigor to its employ ments, and I hope does not disappoint the end of its Creator.” “Thus far has passed my active life, even to the present year, 1792, in which I have passed half way of my sixty-seventh year My body may have abated its wonted vigor, but my mind still retains its wonted power, its longing for improvements, its wish to receive new lights through chinks which nature has made.” In his zodlogical works he includes the whole of the British vertebrated animals—testacea, crustacea, &c. His arrangement is founded upon that of Linens: but he occasionally alters his plan to that which seemed to him Better adapted to the subject. instead of confining himself to mere deseription and classification, which was a prominent fault in previous works on natural history; and one which has not been avoided by succeeding British Natu- ralists, he, as far as he is able, both introduces notices of habits and manners, and indulges in detail: His writings are still con- Sidered as standard works, and are still constantly referred to and quoted. In some departments, very little has since been added, : z Baek ey | Notice of British Naturalists. 155 but of course in the more intricate subjects we can scarcely ex- pect to find him perfect. The plates are numerous, and executed with great fidelity. 'Those of the Testacea have seldom been surpassed, From his life we may learn that the busiest ‘station does not preclude attention to this study; and while it relieves and graces narrow circumstances, it adds increased lustre and honor to the highest stations. The British Conchologists of this period were Emanven Men- DES DA Costa, who published at London, in 1778, a very beauti- fully executed quarto volume under the title of ‘ Historia natu- ralis Testaceorum Britannia ; or the British Conchology, con- taining the descriptions, and other particulars of the Natural History of Great Britain and Ireland” The plates are very faithful, and are colored. The text is both in French and Eng- lish. His system was peculiar to himself, and has never been adopted. It was in conformity to a system which he had pro- posed shortly before in a thin octavo volume, called ‘ Elements of c onchology.’ His work is still often referred to for the plates, The other writer, who is less generally known, is WALKER, who published a volume in 1784, on the intricate subject of the minute British Shells. ‘ T'estacea minuta rariora.’ Ten years before Pennant’s death, in 1788, appears the first edition of Rev. Gutsert Wurre’s ‘ Natural History and Antiqui- ties of Selborne;’ a work which ever has been, and ever will be, read with pleasure. Born in 1720, at Selborne, a little country village, the surrounding scenery diversified with hills and woods, he passed through the ordinary routine of education ; and in due time became a Fellow of Oriel College, Oxford ; and one of the Senior Proctors of the Univerity. “ Being of an unambitious temper, and strongly attached to the charms of rural scenery, he early fixed his residence in his native village, where he spent the greater part of his life in literary occupation, and especially of the study of Nature. This he followed with patient assiduity, and a mind ever open to the lessons of piety and benevolence which such a study is so well calculated to afford. Though several occasions offered of settling upon a college living, he could never persuade himself to quit his beloved spot, which was indeed a peculiarly happy situation for an observer. He was much esteemed by a select society of intelligent and worthy friends, to whom he paid "156 Notice of British Naturalists. occasional visits. 'Thus his days passed tranquil and serene, with scarcely any other vicissitude than those of the seasons, till they closed at a mature age, on the 26th June, 1793.” His work, consisting of letters addressed to Mr. Pennant, and which, in the original edition, is a thick quarto volume, illustrated with plates, is a singular instance how much may be effected in a very small sphere by a joint habit of observation, and of noting down every thing as it occurs. We lose constantly many interesting par- ticulars, from neglecting to make a memorandum of them at the time ; they may at the moment appear to be of very slight im- portance, but each year will add to their value, and each separate circumstance connects the foregoing with some general principles. He who tries this plan is soon surprised to discover what a large mass of curious information he brings together. It is the founda- tion of the success of fictitious writings, that human nature, de- picted exactly as it is,—the manners and sayings either of indi- viduals or great classes of men, faithfully recorded—always prove highly interesting and popular. This, if the description be but graphic and faithful, is equally true as regards the habits and in- stincts of the inferior creatures ; and what White did, all persons — of any literary taste are equally capable of accomplishing. As a clergyman, confined to his parish, which he seldom appears to — have left, and diligently engaged in his duties, the only time in” which he could indulge this taste, was during the hours of re- laxation and exercise; and having once attained the habit of — daily making notes, the time required for doing so was very little and such as every one has at his disposal. It is to such observa- tions, rather than from the labors of professed naturalists, that for the present at least, we must look for the progress of natural history in this country. We must depend upon individual effort for combined results; and it is an encouragment that one need not be an accomplished naturalist, or one by profession, in order to make useful observations. Pennant, in a short essay attached to his zoélogy, has particularly pressed the attention of clergy- men to this study. There certainly is no reason why they should neglect, and there are many cogent reasons why they should cultivate it, Country clergymen often enjoy many facilities for its successful prosecution ; while classical knowledge and literary Mabits render them peculiarly fit for making discoveries and — 3 % "2 Pea ty * Notice of British Naturalists. — 157 improvements. It falls in very happily with their professional knowledge. 'The mysteries of the creation of God, as well as his attributes, and his government of the world in his dispen- sations to man, it is their duty to study and to exemplify ; but while they confine themselves to the revealed word alone, they shut out of sight a volume which speaks not less forcibly of the love and excellencies of the Creator, and of his mighty wisdom and perfections. ‘There is no reason why persons of this profession should be less sensible to, or less well informed in regard to phy- sical objects, than the other educated classes of society, but rather the contrary ; and the greater their knowledge is, the greater likewise will be their capabilities of fulfilling the end of their lives. ‘The Jesuits,* whose system of education is perhaps, as a means, one of the very best adapted for producing the required results, are very far from neglecting the study of these subjects ; and they have exemplified in practice, what the good George Her- bert has asserted in theory, that “‘the country parson is full of all knowledge. They say it is an ill mason that refuseth any stone : and there is no knowledge but in a skilful hand,—serves either positively as it is, or else to illustrate some other knowledge. He condescends even to the knowledge of tillage and pasturage, and makes great use of them in teaching, because people, by -what they understand, are best led to what they understand not.”’+ Some of the greatest living naturalists of Great Britain are clergyman, among whom we may mention Dr. John Fleming, minister of Flisk, Fifeshire, Rev. Leonard Jenyns, and Professors Buckland and Sedgwick, to whom Geology owes much of its present eminence. The following extracts from ie! s original preface, are not nite one of repetition :— «The author is also of opinion that if stationary men would pay some attention to the districts in which they reside, and would publish their thoughts on the objects which surround them, from such materials might be drawn the most complete county *¢ Sic etiam quoniam artes, vel Scientia Naturales ingenia disponunt ad Theo- logiam, et ad perfectam cognitionem et usum illius inserviant, et per eundels Ges m juvant; qua diligentia par est, et per eruditos Praceptores, in omni- bus sincere honorem et POR Dei quere endo, tractentur.” Societatis Jesu. 1558. Pars4. Cap. XII. § 3. + « A Priestin the Temple.” Chap. IV. ce bs Notice of British Naturalists. : i histories. which are still wanting in several parts of this country.”* “If the writer should at all appear to have induced any one of his readers to pay a more ready attention to the wonders of creation, too frequently overlooked as common occurrences ; or if he should, by any means, have lent a helping hand towards the boundaries of historical and topographical knowledge, his purpose will be fully answered. But if he should not have been successful in any of his intentions, yet there remains the consolation behind, that these pursuits, by keeping the body and mind employed, contributed. to much health and cheerfulness of spirit, even to old But while writers were thus arising on all sides, and were dil- igently employed in illustrating the zodlogy of their own country, this science could not yet be said to have become, in the proper sense of the word, popular. Illustrated books are peculiarly ne- cessary in the pursuit of this study. ‘Such were still expensive, and difficult of attainment. The works of Linneus were still concealed in the Latin tongue; and the majority, those for whom such a refining study is chiefly to be desired, were thus shut out from the most efficient means of acquiring a philosophical knowk edge of the subject. ‘This difficulty was now to be removed. In 1790, Tomas Bewicx first appeared conspicuously bela @ ete. hes ae oe the public, both as a naturalist, and the reviver of the art of en-_ graving on wood ; and we may justly be allowed to consider the publication of his works as an era in this science, so far as it ren- dered the subject more easily available to the mass of the people. In this year came out the first edition of his ‘ General History of Quadrupeds ; a book which went through nine editions before the year 1824. Although he does not confine himself to British animals, he gives, with his usual accuracy of delineation, engta- vings of all the species which were then known. The improve ment, however, which he afterwards made in his art, will be readily observed by those who compare his earlier style in this work, with the softness and spirit which characterize his birds in the later editions. 'Thomas Bewick was born in 1753, at Cherry- burn, in Northumberland. His parents were far fom being in ERIE tk. et Si : * The intelligence, een. and fullness of Sir John Sinclair's great work; The Statistical Hi. otland, are well known. It was formed on this prin- ae and the account s — carl and district contributed by its respective min- ee: a 4 K i re Notice of British Naturalists. 1 Hes affluence, and moved ina humble although respectable station of live. At an early age he was sent to a dame’s school, and he af- terwards completed his English education under a better instruc- tor. Here he strongly manifested his love for the picturesque, and his taste for drawing. So evident, indeed, were those traits of character, that his father was induced to bind him, at the age of fourteen, an apprentice to a copper-plate engraver, at Newcastle upon Tyne. Of this part of his life nothing particular is known, except his dislike to his business, which was chiefly the coarse and dirty work of cutting brass dial-faces for clocks; but he ap- pears to have worked industriously, and to have been steady and diligent in his habits. In 1770 he first proved his talents for wood-engraving, while his employer was engaged in executing the cuts for Hutton’s Mensuration. 'The mathematical dia- grams requiring greater correctness than could be attained by the use of the ordinary chisel, he invented a double-edged instrument which answered every purpose in making a very fine and straight i line - His attention once turned in this direction, he made rapid progress. Till 1787 he was employed in illustrating some vol- umes of fables, and other small books; and, as in such works, birds and animals were the frequent subjects of his graver, he ac- quired an excellent accuracy in their delineation. By degrees he improved. With this progress he made new experiments and in- ventions, and with the growing facility of execution, his mind was daily more fixed upon his subject. In 1786 he was married ; and in 1789 he published his cele- brated print of the Chillingham wild Bull, the largest and most highly finished wood engraving which he ever executed. In 1790 he published, as we have said, his work on quadrupeds ; and in 1797, after nearly six years of constant labor, the first vol- ume of his ‘ British Birds’; appeared. After the lapse of nearly a similar period, in 1804, the second volume, that on water birds, was presented to the public—the whole term proving, if any proof were wanting, his great perseverance, and that the work was not hastily nor crudely executed. The book went through six edi- tions before 1826. "The Wycliffe or Tunstall Museum, of which we have already made mention, was the occasion of this popu- lar work; for Mr. Tunstall perceiving Bewick’s great abilities as an engraver, first proposed the subject to him, and offered him all the facilities of which he afterwards made use. While this gen- tleman lived he was the constant and liberal patron of Bewick. eT: 160 Notice of British Naturalists. From this time he was chiefly occupied in adding to, improving, and catrying through the press the various editions of his works on natural history ; but he likewise found time to illustrate ma- ny smaller and less popular books for the publishers. He died in 1823, at the age of seventy-five. His character as a naturalist cannot be rated very high. Nearly all that he knew of natural history he derived from the observation of others ; and his education had not been such as to prepare his mind for pursu- ing the subject philosophically. He possessed a strong love for nature, but he expended it, in a great measure, on drawing and engraving the dead specimens. We owe but few original remarks to his works. For the greater part of his life he resided in Gates- head, the suburb of Newcastle upon Tyne, and consequently he had fewer opportunities of personal investigation, than if his life had been passed in the country. In appearance and character he was not unlike the celebrated Dr. Johnson. Large and uncouth in person, unpolished in his manners, and, at times unpleasantly rough in his demeanor ; he was yet possessed of strong good sense ; much perseverance and ingenuity ; and in all his actions and all he said, there were ap- = parent a sterling warm-heartedness, and a talent for wit and hu- mor which could not fail to please. ‘ When animated in conver-. sation, and he was seldom otherwise, his eye was peculiarly fine, and imparted a vivacity to his countenance very difficult to do- = scribe or forget. There was more of intelligent benevolence and candor init, than I ever saw in another; but it was mixed with an earnest gravity, almost bordering on severity when speaking in disapproval; and with the brightest animation, when discus sing the beauties and wonders of nature, or subjects of equal in- terest. His humanity was very extensive, cherishing continu- ally some scheme for the improvement of his fellow creatures, OF the better treatment of the animals intrusted to them. His lan- guage was extremely forcible ; and the words he made use of, those calculated in the plainest and most familiar manner to co- vey his meaning ; but unfortunately this love of simplicily, of- tentimes led to a degree of coarseness which no one could hear without reprobating.”* His dialect was broad Northumbrian. = RiGee Atkinson, in th 1 j ts iusodony ‘ e Transactions of the Natural History Society of Newcastle and Durham. Notice of British Naturalists. 161 Se. He mixed a rough, sound good sense, and some times an orig= inality of remark in his conversation, which always rendered what he said interesting. His pleasantries were less remarkable for true wit and delicacy, than for the union of strong sense and honest merriment. _— His engravings are distinguished by their extreme fidelity, and for the truth with which he has caught and transferred to paper the peculiar air and habit of his subject; while he reduced it from its natural size to a small wood cut. But his improvements in the art of cheap and correct engraving, have had a much more extensive influence than in natural history. Those who may remember, or have seen the books put into the hands of children during the last century, will perceive how much, in the present day, this all-important class of books owes to Bewick ; and how the distorted representations of nature, have given place to correct and graceful figures; and those who reflect upon the variety of subjects which now owe their illustrations to the art, will feel in- lined to give Bewick the credit of being truly a benefactor of mankind. He left several children. One of his sons is now an artist of no small ability. In 1800 appeared 'Turron’s translation of Gmelin’s edition of the Systema Nature of Linnzeus. This work is printed in seven thick octavo volumes; but at a comparatively low price ; and although it is now fallen both in value and estimation, yet at the time it did great good in opening the science to the mere En- glish reader. It has been accused, and justly, of faults, both de- rived from Gmelin, and from its own author. Varieties are given * as species, synonyms as distinct species, and hypothetical and fab- ulous animals are occasionally obtruded as existing. ‘Too much dependence was placed upon preceding writers. But eonsider- ing the vastness of the work; the difficulties to be encountered ; nd the doubt which hung over many parts of it, it is well exe- cuted. It is now of value only to the historian of science, the annalist, or the professed system maker ; being as faithful a record of the errors, as of the real science of its peri Wituiam Turton, M. D., was through life, a zealous naturalist ; and besides this book, he published some smaller volumes on con- chology. His favorite pursuit was the investigation of British shells. His industry and perseverance were great ; but his cir- cumstances being narrow, and he not possessing much originality Vol. xxxvu, No. 1,—July, 1839, bis. 21 ce a - ol Notice of British Naturalists. of thought, he was unable to take a high stand in the scictitide world. He died in Cornwall, where he had chiefly resided, about 1834, at an advanced age. In 1802, appeared the ‘ Oredtholaztont Dictionary,” of that most industrious observer and writer, Col. Georer Monracue, of Knoule House, Devonshire. We have in vain searched for any biographical notice or memoir of him; and it is much to be de- sired, if materials exist, that some account of his active and sci- entific life might be given to the public. This work is only upon British birds ; and the plan is well adapted for reference, as he threw his materials into the form of an alphabetical catalogue. He presents much original information, the greater part of which he collected himself. His object was to render the subject popu- lar; and he appears to have written expressly for “ such as might wade through columns, before they could find the object of their inquiry, but who are desirous of being better acquainted with the most beautiful part of the animal creation.” He corresponded with the most erninent naturalists of his day. He was the first to observe, as British, several birds which had previously beet overlooked; among which we remark the Macroramphus gris- eus,* (Laaeh: ) of the United States and the Ardea lentiginosa, _— Be sae (Mont.) which naturalists have hitherto been in the habit of con- sidering the Ardea minor, ( Wils.) likewise of this country. ; In 1813, Montague published a supplement to his dictionary, % which is nearly as large as the original book. But his great work was that on British conchology, “ T'estacea Britannica, or natural history of British shells, marine, land, and fr esh water, including the minute, &c,” a quarto volume of upwards of six hundred pages, and published in London, in 1803. This is an invaluable work. As a describer of shells, he probably stands at the head of English writers on the subject; and his book is still unsurpassed. He spared neither pains nor expense in procuring specimens; and he was enabled both to add many hew species, and clearly to distinguish between such as had hith- erto been considered merely as varieties. In 1808, he published a supplement, in which many new species are given. He fol- nee in general, the Linnean arrangement, but has made one neW enn * Scolopax Novoborocensis, (Wils.)—Eps. = ee uthe only other work of which he - to have been the author, is entitled,“‘ The Sportsman’s Dictionary, or Tractate on Gunpowder,” which we have never seen. His collection of shells, is, we believe, now deposited in the British Museum of London. In 1804, appeared the “ Natural History of British shells, including figures and descriptions of all the species hitherto dis- covered in Great Britain, systematically arranged in the Linn- aan manner, with scientific and general observations on each, by E. Doxovasil in five octavo siitiies: This is a beautiful work, and was among the first of the kind which was issued in pore icalnumbers. 'The figures are the size of life, well engraved on copper, and faithfully colored. The letter press is, however, of comparatively small value; and the volumes are chiefly referred to at present, for the plates. He describes in all, two hundred ind “nineteen species.* Shortly after, in 1808, there followed by the same author, « The Natural History of British fishes, including scientific and general descriptions of the most interesting species, §c.” This work is likewise in five octavo volumes; and as he appears to have limited it to that number, he axchided many of the com- moner species. The figures are one hundred and ten in all, whereas it is ascertained that two hundred and twenty-six exist in the British seas and rivers, The work is beautifully executed, and the same remarks as are made on the above may apply to this. * The researches of Lea, Conrad, Say, Totten, Morton, Vanuxem, Binney, Cou- thouy, Kirtland, Ward, Hildreth and others, in relation to our rec fossi sclosind most interesting treasures, and we ee _spprecinie their labors : while it is still much to be desired, that some ge ork on the conchology of this country were published ; were it but a list ir ramet has already o 3 ry) 4 fi 3 E = i—] > an ie 2 s & a a “g = ° 4 ry r F $ > | 2 og eat variety of transactions and journals must be searched through, to collect the scattered fragments, and as this is in the power of very few, an insur- ues barrier is thrown in the way of farther improvement. Upwards of 600 have, we believe, been described as belonging to the United States ; the sider the species he may find as new, or at present known. Would not such a work be patronized ? 164 Notice of British Naturalists. From this period, for several years, we have no great work es- pecially dedicated to British Zoology. In 1815, Lamarck, by — the publication in Paris, of his Histoire naturelle des animaux sans vertébres, created a new interest in this study, and placed conchology on a new basis; one, however, of which Lister pre- - viously appears to have seen the propriety. In 1817, appeared, likewise in Paris, Cuvier’s Regne Animal. So strong a hold, however, had the system of Linneus taken on the minds of the British naturalists, that neither of these great works was as. Cor dially received as they ought to have been; and it has required some years fully to attract attention to them; and to show the effect which they have produced on the stady of the natural sci- ences. While therefore, this study was re gaining ground in England; materials were being collected, and many provin- cial dimsepiinis and societies, were both formed, and maintained With spirit. We must pass on to the year 1825, when Mr. Prr peux Joun Sexsy, published the first volume of his magnificent work on British birds, It isin large folio. 'T'he plates are drawn from nature ; frequently from the living specimen, and are lith- — ographed. Where the dimensions will admit of it, the figures >. are‘of the size of life; and all are beautifully colored with much 2 precision and accuracy. Two volumes of letter press accompa — ny this work. ‘These are confined chiefly to the mere descrip- 7 tion and habitat; nor indeed, however much we may lament tiie: thededenirable sketches, which Mr. Selby is capable of giv- ing, should be omitted, was it intended to be otherwise. For he says in the preface, “I have contented myself with referring by occasional notes, to any anecdotes particularly interesting as to the species under consideration.” In the first edition of his first volume, he had chiefly followed the natural arrangement proposed by the celebrated French ornithologist, M. Temminck ; but finding it to be imperfect, and not adapted to the natural or- der, at least of British birds, in his second edition he has rewritten ors work, and had adopted that system which is proposed by Mr. igors. Mr. Selby is living, and is still ardent in his favorite pursuit. He is a gentleman of property and of education; and his untir- ing industry i is manifested by the various Works which he has — either edited or published, and the various papers which he has —— 3 Bee 3 ae E a ee Notice of British Naturalists. supplied for the transactions of different scientific bodies. Bat — he is scarcely less celebrated among those who knew him, for his thorough knowledge of British ornithology, than for his lib- erality of feeling ; and many of the museums of his neighbor- hood are indebted to him for valuable and rare donations. He resides at ‘'wizel House, Northumberland; a situation well adapted from its neighborhood to the sea, for observing and pro- curing rare birds. He established, two years since, in conjunc- tion with his brother-in-law, Sir William Jardine, Bart.—likewise a zealous naturalist,—the “ Magazine of Natural History,” a periodical work which has presented some valuable essays on the subject. He is also editor of the “ Library of Natural His- tory.” In 1828, appeared the “‘ History of British Animals,” by Joun Fiemine, D. D., minister of Flisk, Fifeshire, a synopsis, printed in one thick octavo volume, chiefly a compilation from previous writers.* « In 1835, Rev. Leonarp Jenyns of Swaffhaur Bulbeck, near Cambridge, published a “ Manual of British Vertebrate ani- mals, or descriptions of all the animals belonging to the classes Mammalia, Aves, Reptilia, Amphibia, and Pisces,’ &c. He had previously published in a pamphlet form, a “ Systematic cat- alogue,” containing the ground work of this larger book. , The materials are nearly all original; on the subject of classi- fication, no individual author has been rigidly adhered to; al- though he tends towards the opinion held by Mr. Mac Leay, of the circularity of natural groups. He was much assisted by Mr. Yarrell, as well as by Mr. Gray of the British museum, so that he had every facility for producing correctness, and performing the work ina good manner. Besides those species now found, he enumerates all the extinct species. “The object of the au- thor is to present naturalists with a manual in this department of our Fauna, adapted to the existing state of our knowledge, and such as shall be caleulated to meet the wants of science in that advanced age, to which it has attained since the publication of former works of this nature. In furtherance of the end, two * I should desire to speak particularly of this gentleman and his work, but am unable to find any particulars concerning him ; and I have it not in my power, to meet with a copy of the book at present. Itis, in part, superseded by the later work of Jenyns. 166 Notice of British Naturalists. - points appeared necessary to be attended to. One was to ascer-— tain, as far as practicable, the additions which had been made, of late years, to our list of British animals. * * * Theother — important point, was to take care that the descriptions should, as far as possible, be obtained from the animals themselves, and nothing inserted upon the credit of other writers, which was capa- ble of being verified by personal observation. The day is forever gone by, in which unscientific compilations will be thought to be of any service to Zoology; so far from advancing its progress, it may be said unhesitatingly, that they tend only to retard it.” Hitherto, however much the birds themselves might have been attended to, their eggs and nidification, had been ina great meas- ure neglected. Beautiful as are the former, and wonderful in their construction as are the nests ; no one had as yet thought this branch worthy of separate attention. A French writer had, we believe, attempted a work, on this portion of the natural his- tory of his own country ; but had never completed it ; and it was left to Mr. Witt1am Hewrrson, to present the public, with the first original and well executed book, on this interesting topic. About 1831, he began to publish by subscription, in numbers, — “ British Oology, being illustrations of the eggs of British a birds,” &c. It is in octavo, and consists of colored lithographic plates of the eggs, each one the natural size, and colored with - great fidelity. A short description of the nest and eggs, accom- panies each plate. ‘To draw an egg, so that on paper it may ap- pear natural, is no easy task, but being an excellent artist, he has accomplished his labors with great credit. The work now fin- ished, is in three thin volumes, and contains all the British eggs, With the exception of a few of the very rarest. Mr. Hewitson, who is still a young man, is descended from an old and highly respectable family in Neweastle upon Tyne. Whena mere child he manifested a strong taste for drawing, and was fond of copying the figures and vignettes in Bewick’s works. To these books, thus early put into his hands, he owes, we believe, his fondness for this science. He had the advantage of a liberal education, and became a civil engineer. Ashe grew up, his taste for drawing connected with natural history increased, and all his leisure hours he spent in the fields and woods. Like most boys _ he was fond of taking birds’ nests ; but unlike most boys, he be- _ came intimately acquainted with the species and varieties, and he & > Notice of British Naturalists. : 167 turned this knowledge toa good account. When he entered up-— on his profession, although his time was chiefly occupied with that, he yet found or made leisure not to neglect that which had afforded him so much satisfaction in his youth; and what time he could spare was spent in this absorbing pursuit. While enga- ged in publishing his work on Oology, he made a tour through Norway, for the purpose of procuring the eggs of such birds as are only migratory in Great Britain, and added several important facts to those with which we were already acquainted. Although, as we have seen, Pennant had figured and described many of the British fishes, Mr. Donovan had given about one half of the species, and Mr. Jonathan Couch, of Cornwall, had estab- lished a high reputation as the Ichthyologist of that county ; yet no one had hitherto treated this branch as one altogether national ; and this is the more surprizing, when we consider that this country is entirely surrounded by the sea, that these animals form a very important part of food, and that the coast is comparatively ~ For many years Mr. Witwiam Yarre.., of conden had been forming a collection of Fishes; and his possessing the advantage of being able to search the Londiin markets, put him in possession of all such species as are more common, and many of the rarer ones. In 1836 appeared the first number of his ‘History of British Fishes, which is completed in two thick octavo volumes. While this work is altogether popular, and the price moderate, as a scien- tific production it is invaluable ; and it contains all that is known upon the subject, including a great variety of curious, and origi- nal information. It is printed in the same shape and style as Bewick’s works, and each species is illustrated by a wood cut, executed in a manner perhaps unsurpassed in this art. _ Mr. Yarrell is still alive, and is well known, equally for, his ur- banity of manners, his connection. with science, his very valuable private collection in some branches of natural history, and his pa- pers in the Linnean and other Transactions. He is now engaged in publishing, in the same form as his volumes on fishes, a gen- eral work on British birds. About the same time Dr. Berti, of London, published in like form a volume on the ‘ British Quadrupeds’ which includes all that are known, with a great variety of information concerning them. “168 § —-_ Notice of British Naturalists. The last writer upon British Testacea is Mr. Josuva Atper, of Newcastle upon Tyne, in the Transactions of the Natural His- tory Society of Northumberland and Durham. He describes 71 species of land and fresh water shells as belonging to his neighbor- hood, many of which are new. | We have thus traced the gradual progress of natural science, as connected with Great Britain, from the days of Ray to ourown times. We have seen how by degrees it has gathered strength, and how accuracy and scientific power also advanced. . We have likewise seen that nearly all which has been accomplished has been done by those who had higher and more important duties to fulfil, but who, when weary, refreshed their minds by the observa- tion of the works of God, instead of wasting in idleness or frivo- lous amusement, these their leisure hours. A complete account of the higher order of the zoology of that country, it is now in the power of any one to possess; and as regards the mammalia and birds, little probably remains to be added. But when we consider how each successive writer has thought that he had ex- hausted the stores of nature; how Ray supposed that the world did not contain above 150 species of beasts and reptiles, 50 of birds, and 500 of fishes, although now, in our own days, we have described 1200 species of mammalia, 6500 of birds, 8000 fishes, and 1500 reptiles, we may justly suppose and hope, that many more both of shells and fishes may be added to the list of the British Fauna. And as regards the United States we may learn how much is to be accomplished ; although much has been done, ‘and from what we do know, we may be incited to additional en- deavors. Of this we may be assured, that as this study becomes more popular, so shall we see the mind of the people improving ; simplicity of heart, and love of the works of God multiplied ; and a thousand intellectual pleasures opened to those who, under Providence, are obliged to spend a larger part of their lives in hat- rassing and fatiguing employments. We shall find that this study forms a bond of union between the lower and the higher classes of society,—the practical mechanic and the man of sci- ence ; that it increases human happiness, by enlarging the sphere of intellectual pleasure; for every new development of intelli- gence is a source of pure enjoyment. The bond of union will be the love of knowledge. here is an equality in science, for the great quisite is not the amount of information, but the @& sere 0 Peet 7 ae Bux ae > ae =] i Miscellanies. MISCELLANIES. zt DOMESTIC AND FOREIGN. 1. Pictorial delineations by light; solar, lunar, stellar, and artificial, called Photogenic and the art Photography. Remark.—T he great interest excited by this subject induces us to post- pone the greater part of the miscellany which we had prepared and even set up for the present number, that we may make room for general notices from foreign Journals—detailing the history of the processes as far as known, and the most perfect state of the art, as far as it has gone. I. Photogenic Drawings.* Public attention has been called of late to a mode of drawing said to have been invented at Paris by M. Daguerre, and by which he fixes upon a metallic plate the lights and shadows of a landscape or figure solely by the action of the solar light. The interest thus excited has been increased by the publication of a series of experiments made by our countryman — . Talbot, directed towards the same object, and producing nearly simi- lar results. In describing this interesting invention it will be well to commence with the first discoveries made by Mr. Wedgwood about the year 1800, and afterwards extended by Sir Humphry Davy. The attention of these two eminent chemists was directed to the sub- ject by the extraordinary effect produced by light upon the nitrate of silver, which led them to hope that the purposes of the artist might be assisted by the susceptibility of the metallic oxide. The first experiment was made by Mr. Wedgwood for the purpose of copying paintings upon glass, and was eminently successful ; the copy obtained possessing all the fig- ures of the original, in their native shades and colors; it was also in a high degree permanent, so long as it was preserved from the action of the light. The same gentleman discovered that the shadow of an opaque ob- ject thrown upon the paper was copied in outline with great correctness ; but though both these celebrated chemists were constant and persevering in their endeavors to render the drawing permanent, they were e unsuccessful; the lighter shades darkening by exposures and thus oblit- erating the impression. : Their failure in this important object was published with their experi- ments in the Philosophical Transactions, and both having givén up the attempt, their discoveries have since remained unimproved. But in the meanwhile M. Daguerre, it appears, struck by some hints he had received from a friend, has steadily pursued his experiments for the last twenty * Foreign Quarterly Review, No. 81. oth Vol. xxxvn, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 22 aati a: eo Miscellanies. years, and having at length attained his object has declared his discove- ries and claimed the invention as his own. Full and satisfactory descrip- tions are promised by M. Arago and two other scientific engineers ap- pointed to report on the subject, and in the interval a slight outline has been given in the French papers, fiom which the following account is taken. A polished metallic plate is the substance made use of, and being pla- ced within the apparatus is in a few minutes removed and finished by a slight mechanical operation. The sketch thus produced is in appearance something similar to aquatint, but greatly superior in delicacy ; and such is the extraordinary precision of the detail that the most powerful micros- cope serves but to display the perfection of the copy. The first efforts of the inventor were directed towards architectural subjects, and a view of the Louvre and Notre Dame are among the most admired of these engra- vings. In foliage he is less successful ; the constant motion in the leaves rendering his landscape confused and unmeaning; and the same objection m7 necessarily applies to all moving objects, which can never be properly de- lineated without the aid of memory. But in the execution of any Y 2 : ary subject, buildings, statues, flowers, the leaves of plants, or the bod! of animals, the fac-simile is perfect; and the value of the invention may therefore be easily conceived. 2 Several eminent artists have examined the designs, and were equally — delighted with the precision and delicacy of the representation. Among the sketches exhibited by the projector was a marble bas-relief and plas soa 2 ter imitation ; the first glance was sufficient to detect the difference be- tween these two; and in three views of a monument taken in the morn-_ ing, noon, and evening, the spectators easily distinguished the hours at which they were executed, by the difference of the light, though in the first and last instances, the sun was at an equal altitude. But perhaps the anatomist or zoologist will derive the greatest advan- tages from the discovery, the form of the animal being as easily studied from the drawing as from the original, and the most powerful microscopes not having hitherto detected the smallest deficiency in the details. Nor is the invention devoid of interest to the astronomer, for the light of the moon is sufficient to produce the usual results, requiring only additional time for its operations. The following extract from “Le Commerce” is sufficient to substantiate its value in this respect -—** The experiments on the light of Sirius have confirmed the testimony of natural philosophy, and abundantly proved that the stars are bodies of the same nature as the sun ; at the request of M. Biot, M. Daguerre has submitted his apparatus to the influence of the light of the moon, and has succeeded in fixing the image of that luminary. We observed that the image had a trail of light some- thing like the t i comet, and we ascribe it to the movement of the , which is of much longer duration than that by Miscellanies. In the spring of 1834, Mr. Talbot began a series of experiments ts, with the hope of turning to useful account the singular susceptibility evinced by the nitrate of silver when exposed to the rays of a powerful light ; but not being acquainted with the researches of former chemists on the su bject, he commenced with the same disadvantages which had baffled the skill and perseverance of Sir Humphry Davy. The plan he at first proposed was, to receive a well-defined shadow upon a sheet of paper covered with a solution of nitrate of silver, by which means the part shaded would re- main white, while the surrounding portion was blackened by exposure to the light. But he was well aware that the sketch thus obtained would re- quire to be protected from the rays of the sun, and examined only by an artificial light. -He had carried these inquiries to some extent, and be- come possessed of several curious results before he learned the steps which others had taken to attain the same object: and the decided terms in which Sir Humphry Davy expresses his failure might perhaps have dis- couraged his less experienced follower, had he not fortunately already conquered the — which had destroyed the hopes of the former chemists. -Mr. Talbot continues :—“ In the course of my experiments directed to that end, I have been astonished at the variety of effects which I have found produced by a very limited number of different processes when com- bined in various ways; and also at the length of time which sometimes elapses before the full effect of these manifests itself with certainty. For I have found that images formed in this manner, which have appeared in good preservation at the end of the twelve months from their formation, have nevertheless somewhat altered during the second year.” He was induced from this circumstance to watch more closely the progress of this change, fearing that in process of time all his pictures might be found to deteriorate ; this, however, was not the case, and several have withstood the action of the light for more than five years. _ The images obtained by this process are themselves white, but the ground is differently and agreeably colored ; and by slightly varying the proportions, and some trifling details of mappsipulaGont any of the San colors were readily obtained :—light blue, Lagi pink, brown, a dark green nearly approaching to blac The first objects to which this sania was pa were leaves and flowers, which it rendered with extraordinary fidelity, representing even the veins and minute hairs with which they were covered, and which were frequently imperceptible without the aid of a microscope. Mr. Tal- bot goes on to mention that the following considerations led him to con- ceive the possibility of discovering a preservative process. Nitrate of sil- ver, which has become darkened by exposure to the light, is no longer the same chemical substance as before; therefore, if chemical re-agents be applied to a picture obtained in the manner sey be rae a dark- pair ro Miscellanies. ened parts will be acted upon in a different manner from those which re- tain their original color, and after such action they will probably be no” longer affected by the rays of the sun, or, at all events, will have no ten- dency to assimilate by such exposure; and if they remain dissimilar, the picture will continue distinct, and the great difficulty be overcome. The first trials of the inventor to destroy the susceptibility of the metal- lic oxide were entirely abortive; but he has at length succeeded to an extent equal to his most sanguine expectations. ‘The paper employed by Mr. Talbot is superfine writing paper; this is dipped into a weak solution of common salt, and dried with a towel till the salt is evenly distributed over the surface: a solution of nitrate of silver, is then laid over one side of the paper, and the whole is dried by the heat of the fire. It is how- ever, necessary to ascertain by experiment the exact degree of strength requisite in both the ingredients, for if the salt predominates, the sensi- bility of the paper gradually diminishes, in proportion to this excess, till the effect almost entirely disappears. In endeavoring to remedy this evil, Mr. Talbot discovered that a re- newed application of the nitrate not only obviated the difficulty, but ren- dered the preparation more sensitive than ever: and by a repetition of the, Same process the mutability of the paper will increase to such a degree, as to darken of itself without exposure to the light. This shows that the attempt has been carried too far, and the object of’ the experimen! list must be to approach, without attaining this condition. Having pre- — immoveable. Numerous experiments have shown the inventor that t depth of these tints depends on the strength of the solution of salt; he . also mentions that those prepared by iodide become a bright yellow under the influence of heat, and regain their original color on cooling. Without the application of one of these preservatives the image will disappear by the action of the sun; but if inclosed in a portfolio, will be in no danger : of alteration: this, Mr. Talbot remarks, will render it extremely conve- Best to the traveller, who may take a copy of any object he desires, and the ive at his leisure. In this respect Mr. Talbot’s syste™ that of M. Daguerre, since it would be scarcely pos- - ‘ t Miscellanies. sible for a traveller to burden himself with a number of metallic am, which in the latter process are indispensable. An advantage of equal importance exists in the rapidity with which Mr. Talbot’s Pictures are executed; for which half a second is con- has not thought it necessary to adorn his invention with his own name, nor to keep it a secret till he could sell it to advantage, his claim to origi- nality is equal to M. Daguerre’s, and can only be rivalled by that of Mr. Wedgewood, the real discoverer and originator of the art. Since the publication of the above discoveries, numerous candidates have appeared in the field, all claiming the palm of originality, while philosophers of every grade and county have eagerly pursued the investi- gation of the subject. The first we shall notice is M. Niepce, who claims priority even over M. Daguerre ; and the account he publishes, if correct, will undoubtedly determine the question in his favor. A letter from M. Bauer is the principal evidence for M. Niepce, who it appears mentioned his discovery to this gentleman in the year 1827, while on a visit at Kew, and by the advice of his friend he drew up a memoir on the subject, and caused it to be forwarded to the Royal Society. This document was, however, returned, it being contrary to the rules of the Association to receive accounts of scientific discoveries unless they detailed the process employed. M. Neipce shortly afterwards returned to France, having pre- sented to his friend several specimens of the newly discovered art, which are still in the possession of M. Bauer. The pictures taken, are of two kinds, copies from engravings, and coptes‘from nature; the best of the pester’ is in the possession of M. Cussel, and is considered nearly equal to those of M. Daguerre, with suitable allowance for twelve years’ expo- sure; the specimen taken from nature, is however, by no means so suc- cell and is considered inferior to the earliest attempts of his country- e can be little doubt that the principle of both processes is ee ie same, saa bane improved by diligent experiments, the material employed in each being a metallic plate, apparently covered with nt varnish ; sae whether deci to receive or to fix sion is not at present made public. We now come to a statement of M. Bauer, which, if not founded on error, will raise the invention of Niepce far above those of both his rivals; he distinctly asserts that he possessed copies of engravings produced solely by the action of light, which were capable of being multiplied in the same manner as an ordinary copper- plate ; if this be the case, the greatest secret still remains unknown, even to M. Daguerre himself. It is much to be regretted that M. Niepce did not at once publish his extraordinary discovery, with a full detail of the process employed, as he would then have retained the indisputable right to the merit of the invention, but having preserved the secret so long, and JP, ~ a a. 174 Miscellanies. any way interferes with the position of Mr. Talbot. 4 We must leave this question and now proceed to analyze the claims of two of our countrymen, Messrs. Havell and Wellmore, who are said to have introduced an important addition to the process pursued by Mr. Talbot, a full description of which is contained in a letter to the editor of the Liter- ary Gazette. The first attempt of this gentleman was directed towards an etching, by Rembrandt, of an old man reading, and the result was a rever- sed fac-simile ; a negro face surmounted by locks of silver ; the disappoin- ted artist discovered that a second transfer entirely destroyed the spirit of the picture. To remedy this evil he had recourse to a new process, by which this defect was indeed removed, but the great merit of the art, name- ly, self-acting power, was lost. A thin plate of glass was laid on the subject to be copied, upon which the high lights were painted with a mixture of white lead and copal varnish, the proportion of varnish being increased for the darker shading of the picture. The next day Mr. Havell removed the white ground with the point of a penknife, to represent the dark etched lines of the original, and a sheet of prepared paper having been placed behind the glass and thus exposed to the light, a tolerable impression was produced ; the half tints had, however, absorbed too much of the violet the process being in every respect so different, we cannot see that it in Ibo ray, an imperfection which was remedied by painting the parts over with | black on the other side of the glass; if allowed to remain too long exposed to the sun’s rays the middle tints became too dark, and destroyed the ef- eS fect of the sketch ; about ten minutes in a powerful sun was consid- ered sufficient. Another method employed by Mr. Havell was to spread a ground composed of white lead, sugar of lead, and copal varnish, over @ — plate of glass, and having transferred a pencil drawing in the usual man- ner, to work it out with the etching point till it bore the appearance of a spiti- ted ink drawing, or in the hands of an engraver a highly finished engra- ving. The above process Mr. Havell made public under the impression that it had been hitherto overlooked, but Mr. Talbot, hearing that he was about to apply for a patent, laid claim to the improvement as his own, and not only pointed out some parts of his former memorial where it was dis- tinctly mentioned, but also produced several drawings made precisely in the manner described; he has also laid before the Royal Society a new . method of preparing the sensitive paper, which consists in immersing ~ . in a solution of nitrate of silver, and after washing it with bromide of po- “fassium, the nitrate of silver is again applied, the preparation being _ dried-by the fire between each operation ; the paper thus treated is eX _ tremely sensitive, changing with the feeblest daylight, first to a bluish -€reen then to olive green, and finally to black. a letter to Mr. Talbot from his friend M. Biot has also been published, _ andcontains many interesting experiments. After commenting on the ¥alue of the discovery, he continues—“ The interest with which I viewed are Miscellanies. this circumstance, engaged me to make some experiments upon your pre- paration, in order to vary its application to the researches in which I am =a : thus obtained a dry solid coating upon the porcelain, which I shut up in a dark place until the morning. In the morning I took it out, and found tassium with that of nitrate of silver ; a precipitate fell, which I spread on a porcelain plate and left it to dry in the dark; the next day I wrapped it in several folds'of paper, and brought it into another room to show it to a friend; but having taken off the covers in a dark corner of the room in order to exhibit the original color, pale lemon yellow, instantly we saw its tint become green, and I had hardly time to present it to a window opening to the north before its color had passed to dark olive green, after which it almost immediately became nearly black. I do not think it pos- sible to find any substance more sensitive to light.” Had M. Daguerre or M. Niepce published their experiments at the commencement, Mr. Talbot would have appeared merely as an improver of a foreign discovery, __ We must notice here that, by possibility, this art may not be altogether unknown to jugglers in India. It is many years since an offer was made, in our presence, by one of them, to show any gentleman his portrait taken by a single look alone. The master of the house, however, deeming the proposal an insult on the credulity of the company, ordered the man of science to be instantly expelled with the rattan. Il. Photographic processes, by Andrew Fyfe,* M. D., F. R.S. E., §c:- Photography may be divided into three parts: the preparation of the paper,—taking the impressions,—and preserving them, 1, Methods of preparing the Paper. ae Though paper besmeared with solution of lunar caustic is darkened _ by exposure to light, it is by no means sensitive; other methods have therefore been recommended for preparing it for photographic purpo-_ ses. That originally given by Mr. Talbot is to soak it firstin a weak * Read before Soc. of Arts Edinb. Mar. and Apr. 1839. From the New Edinb. : Phil. Jour. April to July,1839. | “ 5 we oe solution of sea-salt, and when dry, to rub it over on one side with so- f lution of lunar caustic, by which chloride of silver is formed, and adheres to the paper. As thus prepared, it acquires a dark color on exposure to light; the depth of color depending on the strength of the solutions ; hence it may vary from lilac to deep purple, approaching to black. In preparing paper by this method, it is very difficult to get the chlo- ride uniformly spread over the surface, and accordingly, when exposed to light, it often gives a variety of shades; indeed, in many places it continues white. It was this that induced me to try the use of other salts of silver; and the one which I have found to answer best is the phosphate, procured in the usual way, by the addition of the phosphate of soda to the solution of lunar caustic. In preparing the paper by this method, I generally employ one part of phosphate of soda dissol- ved in about eight of water, and the nitrate of silver dissolved in about six of water. The paper is first soaked in the phosphate, and then dried, after which the nitrate is put on on one side by a brush, the pa- per again dried and afterwards again put through the salt, by which any excess of silver is converted to phosphate. As thus prepared, it acquires aeyellow tinge, which becomes black by exposure to light. It is equally sensitive as the chloride, and, in my opinion, gives 4 much more pleasing variety of shades. es Instead of preparing the paper by the process described, I frequently — = employ the phosphate precipitated before applying it, for which pur- pose the nitrate solution is dropped into that of the phosphate of soda, the yellow precipitate is allowed to fall to the bottom, and the super- natant fluid is poured off; what remains must be kept in stone bottles or in a dark place, as it is extremely sensitive to light. In preparing the paper with it, it is put on with a broad flat brush, and then dried in : the usual way. Though there is a little difficulty at first in getting the phosphate uniformly spread over the surface, yet by a little practice a uniform ground is easily given, and when once acquired, the method has the advantage of being much cheaper than those previously re- commended. I sometimes add a little mucilage to the fluid, which keeps the phosphate suspended in it. There are other methods of preparing the paper, which though they do not give it so sensitive, yet as Va . are cheaper than those stated; I allude to the use of the phosphate in Solution in ammonia, or, which is cheaper, in the carbonate of ammo- nia which is procured by adding concentrated solution of carbonate of ammonia to the phosphate collected by precipitation as already de- scribed. A still cheaper fluid may be prepared by adding a strong s0- Aution of nitrate of silver to a concentrated solution of carbonate of Onia, by which a carbonate of silver is obtained in solution, af Miscellanies. which can be applied to the paper on one side by means of a brush. Paper thus prepared is white; it has the advantage of being easily prepared, and of giving, on exposure to light, a uniform ground which is of a brownish color.* 2. Methods of taking the Impressions. From what has been already stated, it must be evident that the most direct mode of taking the impressions is, by placing on the paper the object, the delineation of which is wished, and then exposing it to the light. For this purpose it ought to be kept as close as possible on the paper, and the best method of doing so is to place it in a frame with glass in front, and a stuffed cushion behind it. The time required de- pends, of course, on the intensity of the light, and the density of the object; and it is of the utmost consequence to take care that it is long enough exposed, and that, at the same time, the exposure is not too long continued, for if not long enough, though the outline will be given, yet the representation will not be distinct in all its parts; if too long continued, the fainter parts begin to darken, e ¢ m scura.—The use of the camera obscura for photo- graphic purposes, has been described by Mr. Talbot. Though repre- sentations may be got in this way, yet, so far as I have found, they have not the minute distinctness of those got by the method already noticed. Owing to the interference of the lens, the light does not act — nearly so powerfully on the paper, as when it has to permeate merely a frame of glass. The same is the case when the light is reflected, * Instead of purchasing lunar caustic of commerce, a cheaper method of procuring it is to dissolve pure silver in nitric acid diluted with its own bulk of water, taking care to have in the vessel more silver than the acid can dissolve; and after it has taken up as much as it can, to dilute the solution with four or five parts of water, or thereabouts, according to the color required. : Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 23 ‘ 178 Miscellanies. and hence the necessity of getting quit of the mirror placed in cameras, for throwing the representation in such a way as to allow of its being — traced by the artist. Hence, in taking impressions by the camera, the prepared paper must be fixed on the back of the bor, directly opposed — to the lens, and the focus properly adjusted. I have found great ad- vantage, in taking impressions by the camera, in using the paper moist, and keeping it so all the time it is exposed. For this purpose, after moistening it, I place it between a cushion and a pane of glass, tied tightly together, to prevent, as much as possible, the escape of mois- ture. In this way I have succeeded in a few minutes in getting a faint outline of the object exposed to the lens. : I may here mention that the camera affords a good method of ta- king profiles from busts, not by the reflected light from the bust, but by interposing it between the lens and the source of light. The bust, for instance, may.be placed, during sunshine, at an open window, and the image from it thrown on the prepared paper; using the precau- tion, of having the face slightly inclined towards the source of light, 80 as to give its outline as distinctly as possible. se Etchings.—A method of taking impressions of etchings on glass by the photographic process was described by Havell of London. For this purpose the glass is covered with etching varnish, and after the figure is etched on it, it is smoked, so as to darken the varnish to prevent the transmission of light; of course, the smoke does not adhere F to those parts of the glass exposed by the etching needle, and is there- “fore easily wiped off with a cloth, thus leaving the etching free for the light to pass through. On exposing this with the prepared paper Dé hind it, a beautifulimpression istaken. In taking impressions in this way, the varnished side must be placed nezt the paper, which must be kept close upon the etching by means of a cushion, otherwise the impression is not well defined. When the glass side is next the pape? the impression is very indistinct, owing to the light, when it passes through the exposed parts of the glass, being diffused, and by which the lines run into each other. : | From the ease with which impressions can be got in this way, it 0¢ curred to me that the process might be still farther extended, so as t0 _ enable us to take copies of oil paintings, or of drawings on boards, through which the light does not penetrate, and for this purpos® : have followed different methods. One of these is to cover the glass with a transparent varnish, as with a thin solution of Canada balsam in oil of turpentine, and, after laying it down on the oil painting, '0 etch it out on the varnish, in the usual way; after this, the glass is 10 be slig y heated, so as to soften the varnish, which is then to be smoked, by holding it in the flame of an argand gas lamp, taking care i xt ai a Miscellanies. 179 not to soften the varnish too much; when cold, the smoke is wiped off with a cloth from the parts of the glass exposed by the etching needle. Another method is to cover one side of the glass with starch solution, of such strength, that when dry it is transparent, and it is then to be laid down with the glass side next the paintings, which can be traced with a pencil on the starch, and then etched on the other side, as al- ready described. From glass etchings thus procured, impressions are taken in the usual way. This process of transparent etching is applicable to the camera obscura; for, instead of using ground glass, as is commonly done, the representation may be thrown on starched glass, on which it is traced and then etched on the other side, as above described. Before finishing this part of the subject, I may here allude toa method of taking the impressions, by which I have succeeded in giv- ing them a resemblance to oil paintings. F By the method noticed, paper, or some absorbing substance, is used. I have already stated that the phosphate suspended-in water may be employed, which suggested to me the use of the same substance along with a varnish, in the hopes of being able to take the impression on panel-board or metal. I have found this to answer as well as with - paper. The varnish I have used is Canada balsam and turpentine, with which the phosphate, dried by the cautious application of heat, and excluded from light, is thoroughly incorporated; with this the panel-board, previously prepared as for an oil painting, is varnished ; when dry, the impression is taken on it in the usual way. It willbe found to have all the richness of an oil painting. By this process, impressions equally distinct and brilliant may be ta- kenon metal. Perhaps this may be of service in saving engravers the time and trouble of laying down on_the metal the figure to be en- graved. The impressions received by the modes now described are taken by exposure to the solarray. It is well known that the paper may be darkened by other means, as by the oxyhydrogen blowpipe; but there is no necessity for having recourse to so intense an artificial light. I have found that, by concentrating the light of a common fire by me- tallic mirrors, the paper is darkened, and the same also occurs with the flame of a gas lamp. Of course, the time required is much longer than when exposed to sunshine. In this way I have succeeded in get- ting impressions of dried leaves almost as distinet as by solar light; indeed we may dispense altogether with the mirror, for, by exposing the paper with the leaf on it, ina frame, to the light ofa common fish- tail gas-burner, at the distance of a few inches, I have procured speci- mens, some of which, though on a small scale, have all the richness of those taken by solar light. ie. : 180 Miscellanies. The concentration of the rays by a metallic mirror, soas to get quit — of the interference of the lens, would no doubt be a great improvement in the camera obscura, provided it could be accomplished. May not something of this kind be the method followed by Daguerre in getting his camera representations ? ; 3. Preservation of the Impressions. It is evident that, as the impression is produced by the agency of light on the compound ofsilver, when the paper is again exposed, the light will begin to act, and ultimately darken the whole, thus effacing the impression; hence the necessity of a preservative process. ‘Two methods have been tecommended by Mr. Talbot, as applicable to the chloride, one*by the iodide of potassium, the other by sea-salt. When solution of iodide of potassium is added to that of lunar caustic, a yel- low iodide of silver is thrown down. The same is the case when the iodide is put on paper, previously covered with the chloride, and, provided the Solution is strong, it acts also on the chloride when dark- ened, thus converting it to yellow iodide, which is not in the least af- fected by light; hence, by putting the paper with the impression through solution of the iodide, provided it is weak, the white chloride only is acted on, and being converted to iodide, is no longer liable o. change. As, however, the iodide will act on the dark chloride, itis of a the utmost consequence to attend to the strength of the solution, which should be such that it will not attack the faint parts of the impres- sion. After the paper is passed through it, it should be kept for some time in water, to wash off the superfluous iodide of potassium, which, if left on, would gradually destroy the whole of the impression; in- — deed, even with this precaution, I find it extremely difficult to preserve them. The second method recommended by Mr. Talbot is merely immersing the paper in solution of sea-salt. This process does not, however, seem to answer well; I have repeatedly failed in preserving the specimens in this way, and even when they are preserved, they are completely altered in their appearance, and deprived of their original brilliancy. I have already stated, that I prefer the phosphate of silver for t@- king the impressions, not only because it is equally sensitive as the chloride, but gives a greater variety of shades. In addition to theses it has another advantage ; the impressions are easily preserved. Af- ter various fruitless attempts, I at last found that the darkened phos- phate is not soluble in ammonia, though, as is well known, the yellow Phosphate is easily dissolved. I had, therefore, recourse to this for their preservation, and though I did not completely succeed at first, yet Lat last did so, by attending to the precaution of washing off he ammoniacal solution, because, when left on, the impression gradu Pract eee 62 Miscellanies. ally becomes darker and darker, and is ultimately destroyed, owing to the action of the light on it. The method I now follow is to put the paper into a diluted solution of water of ammonia (one of the spirit of hartshorn to about six of water,) and leave it there till the yellow parts become white, showing that the phosphate is dissolved, after . which it is washed with water to carry off the whole of the ammoni- acal solution. Itshould then, when nearly dry, be subjected to pres- sure till dried, by which it is prevented from wrinkling, and the im- pression retains its original sharpness, which, unless this is done, it is apt to lose, by the fibre of the paper being raised by the repeated moistening. ; Though the phosphate specimens may be preserved in this way, yet they do not retain exactly their original appearance, Those parts whitened by the ammonia, owing to part of the silver being united with the paper, gradually acquire a faint reddish tinge,—but, though altering the appearance, it does not affect the brilliancy; indeed, in some cases it rather improves it, by giving a pleasing tint, which con- trasis well with the darker parts, and gives the appearance of color- ing. Ihave also found that carbonate of ammonia answers equally well, and, being much cheaper, it will of course be preferred. I gen- erally employ a solution, prepared by dissolving one part of salt in about four of water, in which the paper is kept for a minute or so, and then afterwards washed, and subjected to pressure, as already noticed. Impressions thus preserved acquire the same reddish tinge as those acted on by ammonia. I have before stated that the paper may be prepared by washing it over with a solution, procured by adding nitrate of silver to carbonate of ammonia. The impressions taken with that paper are easily pre- served by merely washing them with water, to carry off the part not acted on by the light, which is another advantage, in addition to those stated, for using the carbonate solution. Like the phosphate speci- mens, they also acquire a reddish tint. ‘ Other preservative methods have been recommended, as, by cover- ing the impressions with a yellow color, to prevent, as much as possi- ble, the transmission of the chemical ray of the light ; but those above stated, particularly when the phosphate or carbonate is used, are so simple and efficacious that it is unnecessary to allude to them. Before finishing this part of the subject, I may here allude to a val- uable practical application of photography, in diminishing the labors of the lithographer. In communicating the impression of any object to the stone, as of a dried plant, or in copying an engraving, it is ne- cessary to trace them on paper, and after again tracing them with the transfer ink, transfer them to the stone. Now, by receiving the im- pression on paper by the photographic process, all the labor of the 182 : Miscellanies. first tracing is avoided. But there is no necessity for using paper, as the impression may at once be communicated to the stone, which ea- sily receives the phosphate, and which may therefore be prepared in the same way as the papers, and the impression also taken in the usual manner, after which it is traced over with the transfer ink. By this process not only is a great deal of labor saved, but the representation must be much more exact than when traced ; for though by the latter’ the outline is correct, yet much is left to be afterwards filled in by the eye, whereas, by the photographic process, every, even the most mi- nute filament, is distinctly and accurately laid down on the stone.* Method of taking Impressions in which the lights and shades are not reversed, . By the different methods now described for getting photographic impressions, the lights and shades are always reversed, because, a5 it is by the action of the light that the compound of silver is darkened, wherever it is prevented from penetrating, the paper retains its ori- ginal color. Though the impressions thus procured are accurate as to outlines, yet in many cases the representation is far from being pleas- . . ing; it is therefore a great desideratum to have a method of getting. impressions in which there is no reverse; in fact, to give a true repre- sentation of the object, and in this I have succeeded by the use of the © iodide of potassium. I have already stated, that when the darkened ie phosphate is exposed to the iodide, it is instantly converted to yellow, — provided the solution is of sufficient strength ; if weak, the action goes on slowly. In some impressions which I had attempted to preserve in this way, | observed that when exposed to light they began to fade, which induced me to try the effect of light on darkened paper, soaked in solution of iodide, of such strength that it just failed to attack it instantly. In my first attempt I succeeded in bleaching the pape but in my nextI failed. On considering the circumstances under which these trials were made, I found that the only difference between them was, that in the first the paper was moist, in the last it was dry: Accordingly, on repeating the experiment with the paper moist, I again succeeded in getting a delineation of the object placed on the pa- per, as distinct and altogether as brilliant as those obtained by the other process. 5: oe eetN a ods * For this method of applying the photographic process I am indebted to Mr. Nichol, lithographer, by whom lithographic impressions, thus taken, were exhibited iety of Arts. As a proof of the value of this process, I may also mention, that on the evening of the 17th of April, when I exhibited a photographic sf cimen of dried ferns, it was, by Mr. Forrester, lithographed, and impressions taken from it, in the course of two hours ; had this been done in the usual way, it would have Sais many hours of labor, and after all not have given such accurate delinea- as. 2 77 Miscellanies. 183 _ The method which I now follow is, after preparing the phosphate paper, to darken it, then immerse it in solution of iodide of potassium, of such strength that it does not act instantaneously, and, when still moist, to expose it to light with the object on it, and continue the ex- posure till the exposed part of the paper becomes yellow. In this case, there is a tendency in the iodide to convert the dark phosphate to yellow iodide, which go on slowly, but is hastened by the light ; of course, if the object on the paper is impervious to light, the impres- sion is black throughout, but ifit is of different density, so as to allow the light to be differently transmitted, the impression presents the lights and shades as in the object itself; because those places behind the dense pieces retain their original blaekness, while those behind the less dense are more or less bleached, just according to the trans- mission of the light. Whenimpressions thus procured are kept, they begin to fade, owing to the slow but continued action of the iodide of potassium; hence the necessity of a preservative process. After re- peated trials, I have found, that by far the simplest and the best is merely immersion in water, so as to carry off the whole of the iodide of potassium notacted on by the phosphate, and by which any farther action is completely prevented. By this method, the specimens do not Jose in the least their original beauty, and they may be exposed to continued sunshine without undergoing the slightest alteration. I have succeeded also in taking impressions with the chloride in the same way—but it is necessary for the success of the process, to use the solution of the iodide much weaker than for the phosphate, be- cause the chloride is more easily acted on. In both cases it ought to be made of such strength that it just acts, and then, before using it, it must be weakened by the addition of a little water. For the phos- phate, it will be found, in gerieral, that 1 of salt to 10 of water, and for the chloride, that about 30 of water, will give a solution of the requisite strength. Of course, in preserving the specimens, the pre- cautions as to washing and pressure must be attended to. Ill. Perfection of the Art, as stated in Notes on Daguerre’s Pho- tography. By Sir Joun Rozison.* Sir—In compliance with the request, that I should commit to wri- ting and put into your hands the substance of what I communicated to the Society of Arts in reply to the questions put to me at the last meeting, I beg to state, that circumstances having led to my be- ing included in a small party of English gentlemen who were lately in- * Secretary to Royal Society of Edinburgh, &c. &c. (Communicated by the inb. Jour. Society of Arts.) Edinb 184 Miscellanies. vited to visit the studio of M. Daguerre, to see the results of his discov- ery, I had an opportunity of satisfying myself, that the pictures pro- duced by his process have no resemblance to any thing which, as far as I know, has yet been produced in this country ; and that, excepting in the absence of color, they are as perfect images of the objects they represent, as are those which are seen by reflection from a highly pol- ished surface. The perfection and fidelity of the pictures are such, that on examining them by microscopic power, details are discovered which are not perceivable to the naked eye in the original objects, but which, when searched for there by the aid of optical instruments, are found in perfect accordance: a crack in plaster, a withered leaf lying ona projecting cornice, or an accumulation of dust in a hollow moulding of a distant building, when they exist in the original, are faithfully copied in these wonderful pictures. The subjects of most of the numerous specimens which I saw, were views of streets, boulevards, and buildings, with a considerable num- ber of what may be termed interiors with still life; among the latter were various groups made up of plaster-casts and other works of art. It is difficult to express intelligibly a reason for the charm which is felt in beholding these pictures ; but I think it must arise, in some measures — from finding that so much of the effect which we attribute to color, is 5 preserved in the picture, although it consist only in light and shade; eG these, however, are given with such accuracy, that, in consequence ob different materials reflecting light differently, it is easy to recognize those of which the different objects in the groups are formed. Awork in white marble is at once distinguished from one in plaster-of-Paris by the translucency of the edges of the one, and the opacity of the other. Among the views of buildings, the following were remarkable: A @ set of three pictures of the same group of houses, one taken soon after sunrise, one at noon, and one in the evening; in these the change of. aspect produced by the variations in the distribution of light, was €X emplified in a way which art could never attain to. One specimen was remarkable from its showing the progress made by light in producing the picture. A plate having been exposed dur- ing 30 seconds to the action of the light and then removed, the appe@™ ance of the view was that of the earliest dawn of day ; there was @ grey sky, and a few corners of buildings and other objects beginning to be visible through the deep black in which all the rest of the picture was involved. _ The absence of figures from the streets, and the perfect way in bok ich the stones of the causeway and the foot-pavements are ren* dered, is, at first sight, rather puzzling, though a little reflection satis- fies one that passing objects do not remain long enough to make any Miscellanies. 185 perceptible impression, and that (interfering only for a moment with the light reflected from the road,) they do not prevent a nearly accu- rate picture of it being produced. * Vacillating objects make indistinct pictures, e. g.a person getting his boot cleaned by a decrotteur gave a good picture, except that hay- ing moved his head in speaking to the shoe-black, his hat was out of shape, and the decrotteur’s right arm and brush were represented by a half-tinted blot, through which the foot of the gentleman was partially visible. There can be no doubt that when M. Daguerre’s process is known to the public, it will be immediately applied to numberless useful purposes, as by means of it, accurate views of architecture, ma- chinery, &c., may be taken, which being transferred to copper or to stone, may be disseminated ata cheap rate; and useful books on ma- ny subjects may be got up with copious illustrations, which are now too costly to be attainable: even the fine arts will gain, for the, eyes accustomed to the accuracy of Daguerrotype pictures, will no _ longer be satisfied with bad drawing, however splendidly it may be colored. In one department, it will give valuable facility. Anatom- ical and surgical drawings, so difficult to make with the fidelity which it is desirable they should possess, will then be easily produced by a little skill and practice in the disposition of the subjects and of the lights. It is a curious circumstance that, at the same time that M. Da- guerre has made this beautiful and useful discovery in the art of deline- ation, another Parisian artist® has discovered a process by which he makes solid casts in plaster of small animals or other objects, without seams or repairs, and without destroying the model, (Moulage d’une seule piéce, sans couture ni reparage, et avec conservation parfaite du modele). Tam in possession of several specimens of his work, among which are casts of the hand of an infant of six months, so delicately executed, that the skin shows evident marks of being affected by some slight eruptive disease. I am, dear Sir, very faithfully yours, Joun Rosison. James Top, Esq., Secretary to the Society of Arts. Edinburgh, Ist June, 1839. 2. Correction of an error—Cinnabar not found in Michigan.—In Vol. I, at page 33, of this Journal, it is stated in a letter to Dr. J. L. Comstock by B. F. Stickney, that “‘a black and garnet colored sand is found on the shores of Lake Erie and Michigan which is a sulphuret of mercury and yields about 60 per cent. of that metal.” No confirmation of this too * Hippolyte Vincent, Mouleur, Rue Neuve St. Francois No. 14 (au Marai). Vol. xxxvu, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 24 = ix ae “ 186 Miscellanies. hastily accredited report having been given, we have long supposed that it was a mistake, and that credence had been too easily given by us to a result which if true, would have been extremely important, and which we confess we ought not to have admitted without the most rigorous oof. It is now in our power to settle this matter on the authority of Mr. Stickney himself, and through the kindness of our friend Josiah Thomp- son of Philadelphia, from whom we have received a letter dated June 29, ult., and covering a letter to him from Mr. Stickney dated Dec. 21, 1831, thirteen years after the first publication of the supposed discovery of ¢in- nabar. Mr. Thompson remarks: ‘‘ When in the west some years ago I. visited the localities mentioned, (on the shores of lakes St. Clair and Erie,) and soon found that the sand in question contained no mercury, but was probably composed of garnets either broken up or in very small crystals. I afterwards wrote on the subject to Mr. Stickney who gave me the su stance of his subsequent researches in the annexed communication.” “T should not have thought of reviving the thing at so late a period had I not heard it alluded to by a very distinguished scientific lecturer, whose authority for the assertions had been derived from the communications originally appearing in your widely circulated Journal, and which have been transferred to several standard works both American and European.” We now quote Mr. Stickney’s statement: “ Some nine or ten years since I lay wind bound on the western shore of Lake Erie, with a small craft for several days, near the mouth of Outer Creek, a little south of Pleasant Bay, where the black and garnet colored, _ sand is abundant. It struck me as probable, that it was a sulphuret of mercury. I levigated a few grains of the latter between two stones; te bright, opaque, red appearance when broken tended to confirm me in the opinion. Having no other employment, I mixed clay, water, and sand, A with my hands and formed it into a retort and receiver; dried them mm the sun ; and afterwards baked them in the hot sand and ashes when we had a fire on the beach. I then introduced a small portion of the red sand into the retort; it could be but a small portion, as it did not hold more than half a pint. I set up my apparatus with small stones; fitting on and luting the receiver with some of the same clay and sand. as prepared, I put charcoal from our fire into the little furnace, and blowed them with a blowpipe made of a hollow weed. After continuing it for 4 time at a low red heat and permitting it to cool moderately, I broke the te ceiver, and discovered, as I then conceived, minute globules of mercury. I now concluded I had determined the presence of mercury in the sand. I took with me quantities of the sand; and when I returned home I sub- : Initted some of the red sand pulverised to nitro-muriatic acid, and precip _ tating the solution with carbonate of potash, I had a copious white precip ais ite. I weighed the sand; but having accidentally spilled some of the , n, T did not weigh the result. I made minutes at the time which he a ‘ Miscellanies. =k S7 T now refer to. About eighteen months since, making some experiments On iron ore, I obtained a white precipitate,* so near resembling that from the sand, that I was led to suspect my mistake. I now undertook another and more minute examination of the sand. TI obtained the same white precipitate, and submitted it to sublimation, but found no mercury, but _ €very appearance of iron. I have examined the sand with the magnet and glasses. The black I think is a rich iron ore, highly magnetic; the red and reddish we may consider, and perhaps with safety, garnet and carnelian. In some places about the shores of these lakes there are large quantities of the black and red sand; some nearly all black, and others mostly red. I have specimens from Lake Michigan that are all black and all magnetic. When we commit an error, it is more important that it should be corrected than to develope a new truth. I therefore have a desire that this correction should be as extensively known as the error.” 3. “ An Essay on the Development and Modifications of the Ex- ternal Organs of Plants. Compiled chiefly from the writings of J. Wolfgang Von Goethe, for a public lecture to the class of the Chester County Cabinet of Natural Science. By William Darlington, M. D.” West Chester, Penn. 1839. 12mo. pp. 38.—The object of this es- say, is, in the words of its author, to give “an exposition of the views which are entertained by some of the most eminent naturalists of the age, respecting the successive development and modification, or trans- formation, of the external organs of Plants; showing that all their ap- pendages,—from the crude cotelydons of the germinating seed, to the most delicate component parts of the perfect flower,—are nothing but modified forms of that expansive tissue which envelopes the tender shoots of plants, and is the principal seat of vegetable life; or, in other words, that the organized covering, called the bark of plants, is the ori- ginal raw material, (if I may so term it,) from which are formed and elaborated all those multiform organs, or appendages to the stem and branches, known by the names of Leaves, Stipules, Bracts, Involucres, Glumes, Calyces, Corollas, Nectaries, Stamens and Pistils.” The germ of this doctrine is found in the writings of Linnzus, but it was first fully developed in 1790, by Goethe, whose fame asa poet has eclipsed his reputation as a naturalist. ‘The labors of succeeding bot- anists have established its truth. Dr. Darlington has presented this curious subject in an interesting and lucid manner, and with his accus- tomed scientific accuracy. 4, Journal of the Essex County (Mass.) Natural History Society, Svo., Salem.—The first number of this Journal was published in 1836, * An equivocal inconclusive result.— Eds. 188 Miscellanies. pages. : John L. Russell, M.D.; the Act of Incorporation, Constitution and Bye- Laws of the Society; Catalogues of its Officers and Books, and of the Donors to the Library and Cabinet. The second number was published a few weeks since, and extends from page 45 to page 108. It comprises the following papers: 1. Familiar notice of some of the shells found in the limits of Essex County, Mass., with reference to descriptions and figures ; by John L. Russell, page 47 to page 76. : 2. Notice of the occnrrence of specimens of Vespertilio pruinosus, Say, (Hoary Bat;) by H. Wheatland. 76,77. . 3. A sketch of the Geology and Mineralogy of the southern part of Essex County in Mass. communicated to the Essex Co. Nat. Hist. Soc. April 24, 1839; by Wm: Prescott. 78—91. 4. Two new species of Musci, with figures ; by John L. Russell. 92,93. . ‘ 5. Remarks on Hyla femoralis, observed in the north parish of Danvers, Mass. ; by Andrew Nichols. 93—96. Be 6. Notice of rare plants; with a description of a curious variety of Cladonia Un- cialis; by John L. Russell. 96—100. 5 : . + Remarks upon Scarabeus Goliatus and other African beetles allied to it} by Thaddeus Wm. Harris. 101—107. The Society was incorporated in February, 1836, by the Legislature of and comprises 44 pages. Its contents are: Anniversary Address, by Massachusetts. From the prefatory remarks in the second number it e pears that the institution is in a prosperous condition, and has already collected a considerable cabinet and library. Of the industry and ability of the members, we have good evidence in the numbers before us. We gladly welcome every new laborer in American Natural History ; for not- withstanding what has been already accomplished, the field of discovery is yet very far from being exhausted, and we hope that the honor of gath- ering in the harvest may not pass from our own shores, July, 1839, ; 5. “ Transactions of the American Philosophical Society; held at Philadelphia for promoting useful knowledge. Part 2, of Vol. 6, new series (or Vol. 12, of the entire series) :—p. 155 to p. 337. to. Philadelphia, 1839. This part of the Transactions of our most ancient and active scien- tific body has just made its appearance. It contains several papers of much importance, and well sustains the high character of the Society from which it emanates. We annex a list of all the communications comprised in it. Art. II. D _ already desc _ ~p. 470. pp. 155—190. zoe H. Notice of a Vein of Bituminous Coal, recently explored in the vicinity of the a, in the i By Richard Cowling Taylor, and Thomas & ~ x, ot tes | Miscellanies. 189 IV. Observations on the changes of color in Birds and Qaadrupete. By John Bachman, D. D. 197—239. ve Detertuinetek of the Longitude of several stations near the Northern Bound- ary of Ohio, from Transits of the Moon, and Moon-culminating Stars, observed in 1835, by Capt. Andrew Talcott. By Sours C. Walker. 241—266. - Ou the magnetic Dip at several places in the Siate of Ohio, and on the rela- tive Hoswoatal Magnetic Intensities of Cincinnati and London. By Prof. John 7— VII. New formule relative to Comets. By E Nu ulty. 275—295. VIII. Account of a Tornado, which, towards the end of August, 1838, passed over the suburbs of the city af Providence, in the State of Rhode island, and after- wards overa part of the village of Somerset. Also an extract ofa letter on the same subject from Zachariah Allen, of the city of Providence. Communicated by Rob- ert Hare, 297—301 IX. Contributidii to Electricity and Magnetism, No. Iff. On Electro-Dynamic Induction. By Joseph Henry. 303—337. 6. Notice of the “ Journal of the Statistical Society of London.” 8vo. 18s. per year.—This society was established at London in the spring of 1834, ie has prosecuted with great vigor the objects for which it was instituted The journal of the society, (the first number of which ap- peared in May 1838) is published monthly, and contains an account of the proceedings of the Statistical Society of London, and of other socie- ties, communications on statistical subjects; queries aad tabular forms for prosecuting original inquiries; copies or abstracts of parliamentary re- ports and papers relating to statistics; reviews and lists of new statistical works, &c. The work is in our judgment, one of very great value: as a specimen of the papers contained in it, we may mention the following: Account of the changes and present state of the population of New Zeal- and; Statistics of the copper mines of Cornwall, England; Statistical Illustrations of the principal Universities of Great Britain and Ireland ; Statistical table of crime in Ireland; Moral Statistics of three parishes in the city of Westminster; Account of Algeria, or the French provinces in Africa; Statistics of the city of New York. It is not necessary to say anything here of the importance of ase statistics to all classes of philosophic inquirers and men of business. To these the work in ques- tion cannot fail to be highly ene and useful, “We none it may gain . a general circulation throughout our country. 7. Progress of the U. States Exploring Expedition—The exploring squadron, of which we have given accounts in Vols. 35 and 36, ee at Orange Harbor, Terra del Fuego, on the 17th of February, 1839, i forty days from Rio Janeiro. Commt. Wilkes then transferred Saar from the Vincennes to the brig Porpoise, in which, attended by the schooner Sea Gull, he sailed from Orange Harbor on the 25th February, 1839, with the intention of penetrating as far south as circumstances * 190 . Miscellanies. might permit. The Peacock, commanded by Lieut. Hudson, attended by the schooner Flying Fish, departed at the same time, on a similar voy- age, but by a different route. No tidings concerning their success have yet teached us. The Vincennes, under command of Licut. Craven, is to be employed during their absence, in surveying in the vicinity of Orange Harbor. The Relief, having on board several members of the scientific corps, was dispatched for a like period, on a cruise through the straits of Magellan, but in making the attempt to enter by the Cockburn Channel, she encountered a succession of violent winds, and about the last of March, narrowly escaped shipwreck in a storm near Noir Island. On this occasion the Relief lost four anchors. For this reason she did not continue the cruise, but sailed for Valparaiso, where she arrived on the 15th April, 1839. Throughout the squadron, health and harmony have prevailed, among both officers and men. 8. Cold Bokkeveld Metcorites—Our last number contained a brief ac- count of the fall of a large meteorite at Cold Bokkeveld, near the Cape of Good Hope, October 13, 1838, By notices in the Lond. and Ed. Phil. Mag. May, 1839, it appears that instead of a single meteoric mass, great numbers of stones were thrown down, and according to one statement they were scattered in one line of direction throughout the space of 150 miles. The explosion was “ louder and more appalling than the strongest —_ artillery, causing the air to vibrate for upwards of 80 miles in every direc- — tion.” The following analysis by Sir M. Faraday, of a piece of one ot these meteorites forwarded to Sir J. F. W. Herschel, was communicated a by the latter to the Royal Society, at its session of March 21, 1839. : “The stone is stated as being soft, porous and hy when dry, the specific gravity of 2.94 of magnetic power irregularly dispersed through it. One hundred parts of the stone, in its natural State, were found to consist of the following constituents, namely : Ww ater, - - - 659 Alumina, - = = 522 Sulphur,- - .~ 424 me Ss .. 8 Silica, - - . 9899 Oxide of Nickel, 82 Protox. of Iron, 33.22 Oxide of Chromium, .70 Magnesia, - - 19.99 Cobalt and Soda, a trace. ; Some of them also are filled with a greenish to the Olivine of Pallas. No traces whatever Miscellanies. 191 of fusion appear, although the mineral evidently indicates the action of a high temperature. The tenacity of this iron is extremely great, but it is readily hammered and filed. It does not oxidize even when exposed to a moist atmosphere. Its specific gravity is 7.736. The mean of three analyses Segoe by M. Morren give us its ae ron, a 90.241 Nickel, - - 9.759—100. This iron is reesarkibe on account of the large quantity of nickel; no trace either of copper, cobalt or manganese was discoverable. The spe- cimen is deposited in the museum of Angers.—Chronique Scientifique, 24 Feb. 1839, in Lond. and Ed. Phil. Mag. May, 1839. 10. Encke’s Comet.—During its recent return to the perihelion, this comet has been carefully watched by observers in various parts of Europe. At Breslau, it was first detected as early as the 19th of August, 1838, by M. Boguslawski. At Berlin, it was first seen on the 16th of September, and in England and France about the same time. At Marseilles, M. ee observed with much attention the changes of the comet’s dimen- : He estimates its volume on the 10th of October to have been 826 ieee as great as on 24th of November following. He obtained a view of the body as late as the morning of the 12th of December, two days before its perihelion passage. The differences between the observed and the. calculated places of the comet have been found very slight. According to Gautier, they indicate that the mass of Mercury was assumed too large by M. Encke. 11. Remains of the Mastodon in Missouri—In various parts of this vast continent, remains of the Mastodon have been occasionally disin- terred.* I have recently obtained an uncommonly large, entire, head of the Mastodon, together with many = the other bones. The circumstan-~ ces attending its discovery are these A few weeks since, receiving infegrebktied from a friend that many large bones were found on the land of Captain Palmer & Co., about through the politeness and encouragement of Captain Palmer, commenced. operations, which proved more successful than my most sanguine antici- pations. The outside formation and peculiar construction of the upper part of the head is different from that of any quadruped in Natural - History that I am acquainted with. It is composed of small cells about three quarters of an inch square, and about three inches deep, covered by a thin cranium; attached to the upper jaw is the snout which projects a * We have puitieaka a few lines in this place as being erroneous in fact, since several entire skeletons zl been made up, and an entire head is described and figured in our Vol. 36, page 1 A eral by the usual process, duced M. Mosan, Se 192 7 Misceliaintes. about eighteen inches over the lower jaw, and which has never been de- sg a of the tusks in the head, has been a subject of aa among Naturalists, and they have been placed in the same manner a = of the Elephant. It gives me pleasure to state, that I can ae iS aioe question—for in the head which I discovered, I found a tusk firm ts planted in the socket, and had it conveyed with great care to my ee é but owing to the ignorance and carelessness of a laborer, in sie! = a up stairs, it was broken off, but its position can be proved by a = Bee gentlemen of the highest respectability. The tusks are nt Be the same position as those of the Elephant, as was suppose : y Be ‘They diverge outwards from the head with the convexity forward, : pe point turning backwards in the same plane with the head; the tus ie in the head measures ten feet one inch, from the base to the tip, fo — : the outside of the curvature, and two feet in circumference near be socket. ‘The other tusk measures only nine feet—part of the e wanting. When placed in the head in their original position, the ma tance from tip to tip, measures sixteen feet. -I may add, that it requi ¢ two stout men to carry the largest tusk, and two yoke of oxen to carry th head and tusks from the place of disinterment to the museum. * front part is entirely different; and until it is recognized or proved to have been previously discovered, I shall name it Koch’s Missourian, wae honor of the State it is discovered in, and imtend, in a very short ma to a give a minute description of it, as well as of a great many relics not herein mentioned. A. Kocn, Proprietor of the St. Louis Museum. St. Louis Com. Bulletin of June 25, quoted in Phil, Nor. Am. July 11, 1889. 12. Latanium, a new metal. Berzelius, in a letter to M. Pelouze, dated Feb. 22, 1839 the oxide of the new metal » merely altered by the presence of the ce-_ rium, and which, so to speak, is hidden by it. This consideration in- oder to give the new metal the name of datane. ot ed by calcining the nitrate of cerium, mixed with nitrate is prepar ~~ n@ oxide of cerium loses its solubility in weak acids» Miscellanies. 193 and the oxide of latanium, hich: isa very strong base, may be sepa- rated by nitric acid, mixed with 100 parts of water. Oxide of Jatanium is not reduced by potassium ; but by the action of potassium on the chloride of latanium, a gray metallic powder is obtained, which oxidises in water with the evolution of hydrogen gas, and is converted into a white hydrate. The sulphuret of latanium may be produced by heating the oxide strongly in the vapor of oxide [sulphuret?] of carbon. Itis of a pale yellow color, decomposes water with the evolution of hydrosulphuric acid, and is converted into a hydrate. The oxide of latanium is of a brick-red color, which does not appear to be owing to the presence of oxide of cerium. It is converted by hot water into a white hydrate, which destroys the blue color of lit- mus paper reddened by an acid; it is rapidly dissolved even by very dilute acids ; and when it is used in excess, itis converted into a sub- salt. The salts have an astringent taste, without any mixture of sweet- - ness; the crystals are wholly of a rose-red color. The sulphate of potash does not precipitate them, unless they are mixed with salts of cerium. When digested in a solution of hydrochlorate of ammonia, the oxide of latanium dissolves, with the evolution of ammonia. The atomic weight of Jatanium is smaller than that assigned to cerium; that is to say, to a mixture of the two metals. Berzelius has repeated and verified the experiments of M. Mosan- der.—L’ Institui, May 14, 1839. Lond. and Ed. Phil. Mag., May, 1839. 13. Biography of Scientific Men.—Professor Webster of Harvard Uni- versity has nearly ready, from the press, a selection from the biographies of eminent scientific men in Europe, more particularly of those who have largely contributed to the progress of chemical science. The work will comprise translations from the admirable ‘“ Eloges” delivered before the French Academy of Sciences, by Cuvier, Arago, &c., and from the me- moirs published in the various philosophical Journals and Transactions of other learned societies in Euro A copious list of the writings of the individuals will be connected with the biography of each, and great ities be thus afforded to the student for reference to original papers. The size of the volame will be between four and five handred pipes, and the price not to exceed three dollars. We cannot doubt that this work will prove both valuable and interesting. Few persons in this country can have access to the original sources of information ; and Prof. Web- ster is therefore performing an acceptable service by bringing the history, he labors, and the personal traits of many eminent men before the Amer- ican public, It is superfluous to add that he will acquit himself with good Vol, xxxvi1, No. 1.—July, 1839, bis. 25 194 = Miscellanies. judgment and ability ; and we wish him that full success which we trust he will obtain as he deserves it well. Subscribers’ names will be received by the editor of this Journal, by James Munroe & Co., booksellers, Boston, and 8S. Colman, 8 Astor House, New York. The volume will contain biographical notices of—Ray, Priestley, Four- croy, Wollaston, Cuvier, Leslie, Van Swinden, Knight, Young, Henry, Peron, Hutton, Playfair, Piazzi, Fraunhofer, Breguet, Fourier, Herschel, Pallas, Count Romford, Vauquelin, Volta, &c. &c. 14. Note by Mr. E. F. Johnson, Civil Engineer—In the article in the present number of this Journal, entitled ‘ Mountains in New York,” the angular depression of Whiteface Mountain from Mt. Marcy is quoted erro- neously from the report of Prof. Emmons at 15. The depression of 15’ applies according to Prof. E. to Whiteface as seen from Dial Mountain, a high peak situated a short distance S. E. from Mt. Marcy. At the time of writing the article I had not access to the report of Prof. Emmons. The error originated in the use of some rough and imperfect notes in pencil made nearly a year since, and which were in consequence partially defaced. The depression of 15’ of Whiteface from Dial Mt. corresponds very nearly with the difference (234 ft.) in elevation of those two peaks, comparing the height of the latter as given “ approximately by levelling’, by Prof. E., and the former as determined trigonometrically by myself. 15. A Northern Lynx taken in Connecticut—A wild animal of the genus Felis, was trapped at Southington, Conn., during the night of March 21, 1839, and was shot the next morning by the person who found it in the trap. It weighs thirty-two pounds. Its length is nearly three feet; tail about four inches long and tipped with black. The species to which it belongs is probably the F. borealis, Temm., although it does not en- tirely agree with the description given in Richardson’s Fanua Boreali- Americana. Further investigation is requisite to settle the species satis- eter ily, especially as the Lynxes of North America are not yet well de- termined. he animal in question, doubtless strayed from the north, and its like is rarely seen within the limits of this State, C. 16. Preservation of animal fat for Soap Making, by D. Tomlinson, Schenectady , July, 1838.—Fat saved for making soap soon passes, eSpe- cially in hot weather, to a spoiled and offensive condition; sometimes with the loss, in this manner, of the fat, or it is devoured by rats. None of these occurrences happen in my house : nor is the fat boiled in lye to make soft Soap. The fat, as it is saved from time to time, is put into 4 Prepared cask, and strong lye is added to it. As it accumulates in a lye is added, and occasionally stirred by a stick. When the full, the soap is already made and ready for use. The lye cask Miscellanies. 195 is filled with ashes for leaching, and the lye is drawn off to add to the soap cask, and more water is added; and thus by filling water and draining, the solution becomes weak, when it is used for bleaching, &c. When the lye cask is emptied, it is filled immediately with ashes, to be used as above mentioned, so that the cask is always in use; by which means it is kept in-order, and lasts many years. When left empty, as some persons practice, it shrinks and soon becomes useless. Some quick lime put into the ash cask, near the bottom, causes the lye to be more caustic. Cedar and white pine make the best casks for lye or soap. The pine should be free from knots and resin, as the lye will incorporate with the resin, convert it to soap, and leave the wood porous and leaky. When soap has accumulated beyond the wants for soft soap, it is con- verted into hard soap, by adding one quart of salt to three gallons of soap ; it is then boiled and put into tubs, &c., to cool. It is then cut into pieces, the froth scraped off—then melted again to a boiling heat, leaving out the lye at bottom, put it in a box to cool, and cut into bars for drying. oa rosin or turpentine added before boiling, improves the color and uality of the hard soap. N. B. In winter, the leach tub should be set in the cellar, or where it will not freeze—or, when filled, the ashes should be only dampened with Water, not to freeze, and it should stand till spring, before it is leached, to prevent freezing. I omitted to say, that this mode of making soap relieves from the Pagan practice of boiling soap at a certain state of the moon. 17. Notice of Vespertilio pruinosus* and Icterus Pheeniceus.—Sir :—I improve this opportunity to inform you that on the Sth inst., (J uly, 1839,) I obtained in my garden the Vespertilio pruinosus, (Hoary Bat,) of Say, and answering perfectly to the description of Dr. Godman in his | Natural History, Vol. I, page 68. It is the first instance that I have learned of its being found north of Pennsylvania.t One was captured by some years since near Philadelphia and presented to the museum in that city. “ Mr. T. Nuttall also observed it at Council Bluffs.” Upon capturing the animal, I found to my surprise, two young ones attached to ~ the breasts of the mother, nearly equal to her in size. It indeed required a number of violent efforts to shake them off, and they then again immedi- ately attached themselves to the breasts of the mother as before. The latter measured 43 inches in length and 113 inches in alar extent. The * Extract of a letter from Rev. James H. Linsley, to the junior editor, dated Stratford, July 22d, 1839 e iii our correspondent has not seen the Journal of the Essex Co. Nat. Hist. Soc. No. ii, where a similar occurrence is recorded Vid. this No. p. 187-8, E ie “ Miscellanies. 196 young measured each 83 inches in length and 3 inches across the wings. The old was a light yellow, and the young about the color of the chin- chilla, of S. A. I immediately prepared the three for my cabinet, and while so doing, noticed that the stomachs of the young were remarkably distended with milk. _. Before I close this article, allow me to add that I have observed the red wing (Icterus Pheeniceus) to be carnivorous. No writer that I have seen makes any mention of flesh in describing the food of the red wing. “A friend assures me that while riding out the first week in June last, he saw a female bird. of this species feeding very intently on the ground, and as he passed near she laid hold of something nearly as long as her own body, and made several unsuccessful attempts to rise with it in her bill. It proved to be the skeleton of a bird completely cleaned of flesh, which = by a few of the primaries attached to the wings, appears to have been the semi-palmated Ringed Plover. : 18. Malaria.—Thomas Hopkins, Esq., at the conclusion of a me- moir read before the Lit. and Phil. Society of Manchester, England, Nov. 15, 1838, presents the following summary of the effects of wa- ter in generating malaria. 4 Aes It may be presumed that in those parts of the world which have a high temperature, malaria will be found, and especially when the air has been sometime stagnant, in the following situations, viz: 1. Over the open sea. It will be mild here, because the tempera- ture is not very high. a 2. Over slowly moving rivers. They will be somewhat more heat- ed by the sun than the sea is, and will therefore evaporate more freely: 3. Over meadows and woods. The great extent of moist surfaces — admits of great evaporation from these. 4, Over shallow stagnant water. The temperature of the water will be high, and evaporation consequently great. 5. Over tide sands and muds. These become very hot, and con- sequently evaporate copiously. » Over marshes. These combin evaporation, and abundant moisture The author proposes that hygrometrical, barometrical and thermo- metrical tables should be kept at various places, in order to judge how far moisture and heat with variations of pressure affect the pro- duction of malaria. He gives the following table of mortality to il lustrate local agencies on health. “A Table of the Deaths per 1000 of Strength, and the portion of those _ who died of Fever, per Annum, of the White Troops in the West Indies, being the average of the returns for the Twenty Years i ce: e great heat, extensive surface for Miscellanies. ey 197 from 1817 to 1836, arranged in the order of the Mortality. Ta- ken from the Official cs from Peppatieiyen Stations. Deaths in — Ma 1000. i. Wheaten fire-— readily with the electric spark. As the ie, on of pure damp rises above a sixth, the 1 | 1 less: blue to yellow or brown. The phen omena receive a ‘ready Ee from the well known principles established by wae sonal services in collecting the sae gas, = making such Eee oe ; as will secure —— conveyance to London | unadulterated. : ” I have the ae to be, &0. &e. LLIaM Hutton, Sera “To Robert William Brandling, Esq The Coal Trade Committee ae adopted the suggcstion, and pias John Buddle, George Johnson, and Nicholas Wood, Esq’rs, to make the pt a aang for collecting the specimens of gas. * Extract of a nied from Majo “tamge Lid tg eee, to Mr. ee dated Hull, 19th February, 1836. he se I send at the “pllowi from a I fi Dr Dalton of the 13th. As regards Wallsend Pitt t, they : are important, and to me conclusive. bottles Mr. Bouts had eres for me about three months agc ly, and soon after opened the bottles under water. e air in eack much ake, It was constituted of some two or three per cent. SOF ca about one tenth common air rather short of oxygen, and the rest, about eighty five soluble matter, chiefly ooeminan wat, with some curonie acid, sulphurous acid, Rvceatd hydropen and lim [t See Phil. Mag. First Series “yk xlvi, p. 448.] 204 Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. The analysis of fire-damp was performed by detonation with oxygen gas over mercury. In successful analysis with all the gases, the diminution in volume subsequent on detonation with ie electric spark, and due to gaseous matter condensed as water, was precisely twice the volume of carbonic acid gas which was generated, and equal to the oxygen gas which disappeared. 'The volume of carbonic acid gas sometimes fell short of half the dim- inution due to production of water, but this only took place when the combustion was incomplete. Sometimes the gaseous mixture, after detonation, was more or less obscured by a deposit of carbon- aceous matter, and in such instances, as already remarked by Dr. ‘Henry, there is always a deficiency of carbonic acid gas, which deficiency is less considerable the more completely the mixture at the moment of detonation approximates to perfect transparency. I have occasionally observed this cloud, even when ample oxygen for complete combustion was present; but with a decided excess of oxygen it generally does not occur at all, or at most in so slight a degree as not to be appreciable. ‘To show the course of the inquiry, I quote three analyses, in the first of which an error, from deposited carbon, is apparent. © 1. Analysis of fire-damp from Jarrow Colliery, which issued Srom a seam of coal eleven fathoms below the Bensham seam. _ Specific gravity as found by weighing the gas=0-6209. Tes- ted by hitrous gas it was found in one experiment to contain 2-25 per cent. of oxygen, and in a second 2-1 per cent., indicating as a mean 2-2 per cent. of oxygen, equivalent to 11 per cent. of air. __ This gas, which was quite free from carbonic acid gas, may be considered as a mixture of 89 measures of real marsh gas with 11 measures of air. A gas so constituted, and assuming 0°5595 __ as the specific gravity of marsh gas, should have a specific gravi- ty 0°6079; for 0:5595 +0°89+0:11=0-6079. Of this gas 123 measures, containing 0-3 of oxygen and 11 of real marsh gas, __ Were fired with 32-7 measures of a sample of oxygen gas, which _ contained 31 of real oxygen gas :— ae __ Loss due to condensed water eS 8 aes RS ‘Carbonic acid gas generated and absorbed by potassa = 9-4 Risidual oxygen, determined by firing with hydrogen a _ Deducting 10-5+49.4, the oxygen above accounted _~ for, from 31:3, the whole oxygen gas originally ee Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. 205 present, there remain, as Oxygen gas which went to the production of water =11-4 Il. Analysis of a gas from the Benshivns san} nadie, Jarrow Pia collected from a blower, woh caused the accident in 7 gravity actually obederyt. =A 6381, >; This gas was quite free from carbonic acid gas. Intwo icalge with nitrous gas, it was found to contain 3.7 per cent. of oxygen, apenas to 185 of air. A gaseous mixture of 18-5 air, and 81:5 eal marsh gas, should have a specific gravity of 0: 641, since 0-55054.0- 815-+0-185=0-641. Of this gas 13-5 measures, inferred from the idea premises f to contain 0.5 of oxygen and 11 of real marsh gas, were fired with . 30 measures of oxygen, which contained 28°8 of real ones an ‘ Loss of volume due to production of water 228 Carbonic acid gas generated ere. ieee es Tes ae _- Risidual o oxygen s eee ee | 2 PB dncting: ‘4176 from 29°3 there reminiiy, as Oxygen , gas which went to the production of water.» . =11-7 III. Analysis of a gas from the Eppleton Jane Pit, Hutton Seam, Hetton Colliery, collected aia" of. 175 Sathoms bene the surface. Sect? SBME ces fies Specific gravity actually obse ed =0-78. ee This gas was quite free from carbonic acid. Two experiments with nitrous gas agreed in indicating the presence of 4-6 per cent. — of oxygen, equivalent to 23 measures of air. Analysis indicated, . the presence of 50 per cent. of: real marsh gas, leaving 27 per cent . as nitrogen, eee of that already considered as po ag = pheric air. . a Of this gas 11- measures, containing 0:5 of oxygen, were fired. with 28 of oxygen which contained 26-9 of ain Loss of volume due t othe ca * vies 9 - Carbonic?acid gas generated = Residual oxygen me a ae Deducting 5-5+16:-4=21°9 Pate a7: 4 there remain as =~ xg s = * @pggen gas which went to the formation of water = 55 A gaseous mixture, consisting of 50 measures of real marsh gas, 23 of air, and 27 of nitrogen, should have a specific gravity of. _ 0-724, since 0-5595-++-0.5-+.0-23-+.0-9727 +027 =0-7724. The first of the foregoing analyses supplies an instance where. the loss of carbon was Getixe. In the second and third, as i in~ et an oe 206 Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. the whole series of successful analyses, the carbonic acid gas may be taken as exactly equal to half the condensation due to the formation of water, and as containing half the oxygen which was required for complete combustion. The quantity of marsh gas present was equal to half the oxygen required for its complete combustion, to half the condensation due to generated water, and to the volume of carbonic acid gas which was produced. _As this was a uniform result in all the samples, it is manifest that the con- stitution.of the inflammable principle of fire-damp is identical with that of marsh gas or light carburetted hydrogen. The proportion of carbon and hydrogen indicated by analysis, sufficiently de- _ nstrate the absence of such gases as hydrogen, carbonic oxide, and olefiant gas. Their absence, however, was proved by other methods. A portion of fire-damp was mixed in a tube with chlo- rine of known purity, and the mixture kept for a quarter of an hour in a dark place, when the chlorine was absorbed by milk of lime ; the original quantity of fire-damp was always recovered, except a slight loss due to the mere washing to absorb the chlo- tine. The absence of olefiant and carbonic oxide gases was also proved by means of spongy platinum. In 1824, soon after the curious action of spongy platinum in causing the combination of oxygen and hydrogen gases was made known by Debereiner, both Dr. Henry and myself pointed our the obstacles to that ac- ion, occasioned by carbonic oxide, olefiant gas, and some other gases.* (Philosophical Transactions, and Edinburgh Philosophi- cal Jour. for 1824.) And Dr. Henry at the same time showed that marsh gas differs remarkably in this respect from carbonic oxide and olefiant gases, as it offers scarcely any impediment to the ac- tion of platinum. Agreeably to those researches, it follows that, if _ fire-damp contained merely marsh gas, oxygen and nitrogen, Ver! a = ip deagmea ee nS Re ee cee z spongy platinum introduced at common temperature, or even heated to 300° Fahr., would not produce any sensible effect ; and that if a small quantity of an explosive mixture} made with one measure of oxygen and two measures of hydrogen gases, were added to the fire-damp, spongy platinum should cause a produc- cca ae a * = PS “et {[* Dr. Henry's paper on this subject, from the Philosophical Transactions, will be “found in Phil, Mag. First Series, yol. Ixv, p. 269.—Epir. Par. M . AG. é eos ; xture made with expression “ explosive mixture,” I hereafter mean a mi one measure of oxygen and two measures of hydrogen gases. Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. 207 tion of water corresponding to the quantity of explosive mixture so introduced, without the production of any carbonic acid. But if carbonic oxide or olefiant gas were present, then cold spongy pla- tinum would not act at all, a small proportion of explosive mixture being employed; and if the action were forced by using hot spongy platinum, or by the free introduction of explosive mixture, then would carbonic acid as well as water be generated. _ To apply these facts to the case in point, some very active pla- tinum balls, of the size of peas, were made froma mixt clay, spongy platinum and the yellow. ammoniacal ch platinum, the materials being mixed with water so as to form a plastic mass, which after receiving the required size and form, was gently dried, and ignited for an instant before the blow-pipe,* and were iandnced into the gaseous mixture over mercury, sometimes cold and at others warm, ten or twenty seconds after incandescence. Their action on all the samples of fire-damp was precisely of the same character with fire-damp, oxygen | being pre- viously added or not ; the platinum balls, whether cold or warm, were completely foantive: On adding some explosive mixture to the fire-damp, the platinum balls acted — to their full ex- tent. ‘To give some instances: __ I. With fire-damp from the yard coal seam Burraton Colliery, the specific gravity of which was With 46:5 measures of this gas, gx 12°5 of explosive mixture, a platinum ball, nearly cold, caused in ten minutes a loss of vol- ume equal to 12 measure. In a second trial the loss in ten minutes was 13°6 in a mixture of 49 measures of fire-damp, and 14-1 of explosive mixture. Il. With fire-damp from the Bensham coal seam, Wallsend Colliery, the specific gravity of which was 0-6024. In a mixture made with 34-3 measures of fire-damp, and 13-1 of explosive mixture, a platinum ball introduced warm, oes. six minutes a loss of volume equal to 12-4 measures. - With 43-5 measures of the same gas, and 22-9 of exniaee mixture, the loss in eight minutes was 21-7, the platinum ball. being introduced warm. With 55 measures of the same gas, and 7 of explosive mixt a cold aes ball caused a loss of 6°3 in six minutes. * Before use the little balls were always Be oa +. = #n, = = — a ~ e i £55 ot” ee eo ts a re Bi # a ae a 208 Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. — The action was equally rapid with the other gases; nearly the whole explosive mixture disappearing within the first or second minute after the introduction of the platinum ball, whether warm or cold. Inno instance did barytic water, subsequently admitted, detect in the residue a trace of carbonic acid gas. When to any specimen of fire-damp hydrogen was added, the action of platinum always revealed the presence of air. When the quantity of air was small, the action of platinum was of course slow ; nor did it in that case indicate with fidelity the quantity of air present, a portion of oxygen not uniting with hydrogen. Thus in the fire-damp from the yard coal seam, Burraton Colliery, nitrous gas, indicated the presence of 6:2 per cent. of air, and pla- tinum only 3:3 per cent. In the gas from the Bensham Seam, Wallsend Colliery, nitrous gas indicated the presence of 9 per cent. of air; whereas platinum detected only five per cent. in one trial, 8-5 per cent. in a second, and 6 per cent. ina third. A certain degree of impediment to the action of platinum by marsh gas is thus rendered apparent. But when the fire-damp was free- ly mixed with air, then after the hydrogen gas platinum acted freely ; and I have found under such circumstances the indica- tions from platinum to coincide with those from nitrous gas. Thus in fire-damp from the low main coal seam, Killingworth “Colliery, of specific gravity 0-8226, platinum and hydrogen indi- cated 9-4 per cent. of oxygen, equivalent to 46-5 of air; and in two experiments with nitrous gas precisely the same result was obtained. A ball of platinum may hence be applied to determine the air in fire-damp, even when its quantity is small, by first dilu- ting the gas with a known quantity of air, or enlivening the ac- tion of the platinum by adding some explosive mixture. To those chemists who chance to be practically conversant with the action of platinum on gaseous mixtures, the evidence above adduced as to the freedom of fire-damp from hydrogen, carbonic oxide, olefiant gas, sulpheretted hydrogen, and similar inflammable gases, will, I doubt not, be quite satisfactory. ‘To myself they do not leave the shadow of a doubt on the question. Those who are not familiar with such researches, may be warn¢ that, in repeating my experiments, they will certainly fail of wit- ~ hessing the same phenomena, unless they are very scrupulous 1n aving pure gases, and in employing platinum balls with their full energy. The influence of platinum on gases is modified by = a _ Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. 209 such very slight circumstances, that a small matter will cause a ball to be wholly inert which would otherwise have acted with effect. In applying nitrous gas to determine the quantity of oxygen in fire-damp, I employed the method of Dr. Dalton, as described by Dr. Henry’s Elements of Chemistry. A measured quantity of fire-damp was added to the nitrous gas contained in a graduated tube half an inch wide, and the gases were allowed to act on each other over water, without agitation. The diminution of ‘volume had attained its maximum in five or six minutes, and in general much sooner. Of the total loss, 18th were taken as oxy- gen. ‘This method is not in all cases rigidly correct, but its in- dications were sufliciently exact for my purpose, controlled as they were by the action of platinum, by the analysis of the gas by detonation with oxygen, and by the specific gravity of the ases. Before relying at all on this method, however, I applied it in the analysis of gaseous mixtures containing known quanti- ties of oxygen gas. On applying it to the analysis of atmospheric air it indicated 20-4 per cent. of oxygen. On agitating the air and nitrous gas, just after admitting them into the same tube, the diminution in volume was excessive. In a specimen of nitrogen gas, to which so much air was admitted that the whole mixture contained 3 per cent. of oxygen, nitrous gas indicated 3:3 per cent. of oxygen in one experiment, and 3-2 ina second. With nitro- gen, which contained 3-6 per cent. of oxygen, nitrous gas indica- ted 4-4 in one trial, and in a second 4:1 per cent. of oxygen. In nitrogen gas, with 4-7 per cent. of oxygen, nitrous gas indicated 4.7 per cent. in one trial, and 5-2in the second. In nitrogen containing 7-3 per cent. of oxygen gas, nitrous gas indicated 7-4 in the first experiment, and 8-4 in the second. In the last case a large excess of nitrous gas was employed. In nitrogen gas in one experiment, and 11-5 in a second.* In this last case also hitrous gas was used in large excess. In these experiments the error is very uniformly such, that more oxygen was indicated than was actually present. The causes of error appear to be especially twofold,—agitation, and a large excess of nitrous gas. By permitting the action to ensue tranquilly, and avoiding much excess from nitrous gas, the indi- 2 iy . There appears to be some omission here.—Epir. Pai. Mac. Vol, xxxvi1, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 27 210 Chemical Examination of the Fire-Damp. cations in my trials were uniform, and very nearly true. Apply- ing the same method to fire-damp, I found that in two or more trials with the same gas the indications hardly ever differed so much as 1 per cent. of oxygen; and in general, as in several in- stances already given, the coincidence in different experiments was exact. Having now mentioned all that appears necessary to elucidate the chemical nature of the different samples of fire-damp from the mines of Newcastle, I conclude this account of the ex- amination by inserting a tabular view of the compost of all the gases which have been analysed. oe “oA £ aera P : | ot Six. ; a ities i Wites ns Ge was collected. — Gravity. 2 | Air. | 5 § | Carb served Cale}, SS 2 ™ \acid. 1. | Bensham Coal — Wallsend —_ | 0-6024! 05991) 91 9} 0)-0 2.! Yard Coal Sea am, Burraton Colliery, 0-600 | 0-5903 9 TT U7 8 3. High Main Seam, Killingsworth Col- | |0-6196 0-6236 85 | 8} 7| 0 4 ted yee Seam, " Killingworth Col- f= liery, 0:8226 0-8325, 37 |46:5,16-5) 0 5. Marae? of Londonderry’ s Pensher Col- liery, from the Hutton Seam Waste, 125 fathoms deep, . 0-966 |0-9662, 7 | 82} 11] 0 6. Marquis of Londonderry’ sPittingtonCol-| liery, Adelaide Pit, Hutton Se eam, 0 45 eee elow the surface, _. {0866 |0-8755, 28 |67-5,4:5 7. | Eppleton Jane Pit, Hutton Sea am, Het- : ton Colliery, 175 fathoms below the 0 surface 0-747 | 0-7677, 50} 6 | 44 } Be ‘Bicaadin Bit Main Coal Seam, Hetton Colliery, 100 tard below the s face, i 0-78 | 09-7724! 50 | 93 | 27) 0 9.| Bensham 1 Seam, “Jarrow Colliery, 0°6381 0641 81-5}18.5) 0 0 10. | a oe Colliery Scam, 11 fathoms be- | : oh ati |0-6209 0-6079| 89 | 11 | 0| 0 1 tow Willington cin | vey fashowet from the fans al oe 0-7175| 68 | 28-7) 0 | 33 12. E 1 0 ss 0 |- ee Ra GRE CTE Te Te ee See eee The gas, No, 12, proved to be unmixed air. I have no re- marks to offer respecting the nitrogen found in some samples of the fire-damp beyond what will readily occur to other chemists, who, I apprehend, will consider its presence as a simple conse- quence of oxidizing processes, especially of metallic sulphurets, abstracting oxygen from atmospheric air. Geology of the Trinity Country, Tevras. 211 Arr. Il.— Observations on the Geology of the Trinity Country, Texas, made during an excursion there in April and May, 1839. By J. L. Rippext, M. D., Professor of Chemistry in the Medical College of Louisiana. Ir is well known that, as you proceed inland from the Gulf of Mexico in Eastern Texas, to the distance of eighty or ninety miles, the face of the country presents a general plain, almost as level as the surface of the ocean. As it is elevated thirty or forty feet above tide water, it is necessarily furrowed by water courses; but its most remarkable feature where prairies prevail is the exis- tence of multitudes of wet places, each covering from a few roods to an acre or two in extent, and having a depression of one or two feet below the general level ; while always around the margins of these low places are several rounded mounds, having a base of ten or twelve feet, and a height perhaps one fourth as great. Compared with the age of the main American continent, all this land may be considered as having quite recently emerged from the dominion of the sea. It is essentially a vast deposit of sea sand, so completely identical in all its characters with the sands of the present shores and shallows of the gulf, that its ori- gin cannot well be mistaken. Occasionally it embraces extensive beds of a red earthy marl. For instance, this marl may be seen in great abundance where excavations have been made for con- structing a road in the bank, near a hundred yards northwest of the steamboat landing at Houston. By chemical examination I find a sample of this marl to consist mainly of carbonate of lime, red oxide of iron and silex. I believe it may be found of incal~ culable value to the city of Houston, and to the whole country above alluded to, inasmuch as limestone; is not therein known to occur. This marl, if calcined after the manner of amioa lime, will be. come converted intd a very good quicklime, of a reddish brown col- or. Nothing can be more efficient as the calcareous ingredient in all kinds of mortar, for laying bricks, making underground water ‘tanks, and plastering houses internally and externally, where the color is no objection to its use. In fact it might be universally substituted for white lime, the iron or coloring material having only the effect to render it more hard and enduring than it other- wise would be. ro * a 212 Geology of the Trinity Country, Texas. _ The arable soil in this region consists of a basis of marine sand, ‘ened superficially with vegetable mould, but destitute of lime or saline matter. The application of this marl could not fail of - greatly increasing its productiveness; and as the marl appears to be pretty generally distributed over the country, it will no doubt hereafter prove a cheap and efficient means of ameliorating the soil. In travelling north from Houston, immediately after crossing Spring Creek, -shirtpdaiiles distant, we come into a region gently rolling. Here we meet with small, rounded diluvial pebbles ‘interspersed in the soil, some of jasper, others of quartz, flint, sonable: &e. In my excursion, which extended as far north ang prairie, eighteen miles above Robbin’s ferry, on on Trinity, these pebbles constantly presented themselves in the hills, but I saw none of greater size than a pigeon’s egg. They _ are perhaps indicative of the nature of the rocks in the mountain- ous districts lying to the northwest, having been transported ud worn by ancient marine currents. The eminences of the ion rise from one hundred to three hundred feet above the valleys. — It is evidently of more ancient formation than the level region just described ; nevertheless its outline or contour is most obviously the same im when the ocean left it, excepting the harrow gorges usually from ten to thirty feet dexp, occupied by the present fresh water streams. Many of the high rolling prai- ries have aces, especially their southern declivities, curi- _ Ously mark vith ridges and furrows five or six feet broad, ve though they Saul been rudely tilled by some former race of plowmen. 'Theyhave received the euphonical appellation of 2 wallow prairies. Those who have observed the small, regular ripple marks, impressed by the waves on the sands of a shallow bay, or seen fluted and indented sandstone strata, high, dry, hard. and a thousand miles inland perhaps,—the petrified ripple marks of an ancient sea, will have a correct idea in miniature of the appearance in question. | May not these ridges and depressions in the sandy soil be the remains of successive ridges thrown up by the waves of a former sea? If not, whence came they? Still more ancient than the beds of diluvial sand and pebbles, a formation of sandstone here and there presents itself at the sur- face, yet obviously underlying the whole of the rolling country. In Some situations it has the hardness and all the other good quali- ties of a freestone, most valuable for building purposes. In other + # Geology of the Trinity Country, Teras. 213 places it passes insensibly to the condition of incoherent sand. Often on the banks of the Trinity, the indurated sandstone alter- hates with mere sand beds. Several valuable quarries of free- stone on and near the Trinity river, as at New Cincinnati and at the site of Osceola above the mouth of Bidais creek. At the latter place a most excellent building stone, of a light gray color and homogeneous texture, coming out in large oblong blocks, presents itself in a high bluff overhanging the river, in quantity apparently inexhaustible. The strata dip very slightly to the northwest, perhaps one foot in thirty. As large flat-boats may easily be laden with the free stone, and floated securely down the Trinity, it is not improbable that the future city of Galveston may be largely indebted to these and other neighboring localities for the materials of construction. In reference to its geological age, I may here remark, that between the limits of high and low. water mark of the Trinity, this formation embraces extensive beds of lignite or brown coal, in which the woody structure is obvious. In places, huge logs and branches of opalized wood also occur, as do likewise the imperfect impressions of minor cauline * plants. Those conversant with geology will therefore perceive e that the Trinity sandstone belongs to the Tertiary series of form- ations. oo _ ‘The Trinity country, when its resources are developed, will in my opinion prove to be especially rich in salt springs. Only two localities came under my inspection; one of these is on Mr. Young’s plantation, east side of the Trinity, near two miles” higher than the mouth of Bidais creek; the other, similar to it but apparently more extensive, is on the Salinilla creek, a branch of Salt creek, west side of the Trinity, some four or five miles higher up, on the lands belonging to Dr. F. B. Page. Here are the unerring indications of an extensive subterranean deposit salt or saliferous strata. “Many acres of sand are here so ar ly imbued with the saline transudation from below, as to be par- tially denuded of the usual vegetation, preaonsinifiniiged there those succulent plants peculiar to salt marshes and other saline districts. If in some places a depression of a foot or so be made in the sand, a strong brine soon collects therein. I tasted of water thus procured, and it seemed to me to be nearly saturated with salt. I regret I had not the means of ascertaining its exact strength. “I have visited several salt works in Ohio, Pennsylvania ~— # 214 Geology of the Trinity Country, Texas. and New York. This salt water I think was more concentrated than even the Salina water; and no doubt wells of a moderate depth would command an inexhaustible supply of brine. ‘The manufacture of salt in this place would of course prove exceed- ingly lucrative ; for the country is well wooded, and the river banks, less than a mile distant, contain vast quantities of brown coal. The concentration might be accomplished with wood, or by solar evaporation upon the spot, or the water might be conveyed in a leaden tube to the banks of the Trinity, where the brown coal might easily be quarried out for supplying the furnaces with fuel. The salt could then, with very little expense, be floated down the river to Galveston, where it must always beara fair price. This region is well supplied with perennial springs, many of them seemingly pure as the water which falls from the clouds near the close of a rain storm, and many others imbued with di- verse mineral qualities. A variety of mineral springs occur near Carolina and New Cincinnati, generally in wild ravines or em- bowered in picturesque groves; but those which I most partic- ularly examined, rise on the Salinilla creek in an elevated and beautiful situation, in the midst of the singular saline prairie be- fore mentioned, with the forest clad banks of the Trinity, halfa mile or so to the east, and a noble prospect of high rolling prairie _ lawn and woodland, bearing away to the southwest. The Sa- linilla carbonated spring is sufficiently copious to yield nearly half oe a barrel per minute. ‘Though its temperature as carefullyascer- tained is but 68° Fahr., yet it has some claim to be called a boil- ing spring, on account of the incessant bubbling up of nitrogen and carbonic acid gases; with which latter, the water itself is strongly impregnated. I find the specific gravity of this water at 60° Fahr., to be 1.00 67. Four parts in a thousand by weight — are saline mineral matter which can be obtained by evaporation. By means of numerous careful experiments with chemical re agents, I find the water to contain the following ingredients, v12- carbonic acid, chlorine, iodine, soda, lime, magnesia, organic matter a trace. We may therefore infer, that the gaseous and mineral contents of the spring are, Carbonic acid, Nitrogen, Muriate of soda, Geology of the Trinity Country, Texas. 215 Muriate of magnesia, Bicarbonate of soda, Bicarbonate of lime, Hydriodate of soda. Experiments indicate the absence of sulphuric acid, iron and potash. ‘The presence of iodine confers upon this water medi- cinal qualities of a most valuable kind. The same element has been detected in the Saratoga water, New York. 'The taste of the Salinilla water is unusually grateful and pleasant. Near a quarter of a mile lower down the Salinilla creek, isa small sulphur spring, in the water of which [ detected Sulphuretted hydrogen, Carbonic acid, Muriate of soda, Muriate of magnesia, ete of iron, mere ae, The dark sediment which subsides from this water upon stand- ing, is mainly sulphuret of iron. The specific gravity of the water is 1.00 66. By lie i Se 1000 grains of water, a salingy residue is obtained weighing 2 54, grains. Embellished as this site is with the most beautiful of T’exas scenery, it may some day become a place of fashionable resort. To me the whole seemed like a landscape garden. The prairies - where presented a bewildering variety of flowers, rare, — pesatifal and nameless. Deer, and wild turkeys are numerous in the surrounding solitudes, and the clear lakes a few miles to the south abound with fine large fish. In the banks of the Trinity, I often noticed deposits of a red- dish brown iron stone, apparently a good iron ore; but my inves- tigations respecting its extent or abundance, aca the facilities which it might offer for the manufacture of iron, were not such as to allow me to speak decisively.. Most of the small fountains which issue at frequent intervals from the steep banks of the river, above the brown coal formations, are strongly tinctured with iron, a circumstance which would seem to indicate abun- dance of iron ore. : This whole region abounds to an extent perhaps unexampled in silicified or opalized wood :—wood changed to stone. Small oblong pieces are constantly met with on the higher portions of 216 Geology of the Trinity Country, Teras. land, while in the banks of the Trinity, associated with the iron ore, and overlying the brown coal whole trees and fragments of trees, piled sometimes one upon another, present themselves com- pletely transformed to stone. In some logs a diversified meta- morphosis is observable: one portion of the vegetable structure having been replaced with silex, another with brown oxide of iron, and a third is bitumenized or converted to coal. In concert with Dr. F. B. Page, I took considerable pains — in the exploration of the Trinity brown coal formation. As no excavations for working have yet been made, the best places for inspecting the formation, are where the Trinity cuts its way through the high lands, or where its banks present themselves in bold high bluffs, as at New Cincinnati, and near the site of the projected town of Osceola. The coal lies in horizontal strata, dipping about one foot in thirty to the northwest. The main stratum at the latter place, just above Bidais creek, is represented by the concurrent statements of W. C. Brookfield, surveyor, Mr. James 8. Hunter of Huntsville, Texas, Dr. Page, and some other whom I consulted, as between six and seven feet in thickness, the lower portion being three or four feet above low water mark. Unfortunately, during my sojourn there, the river was unusually high and turbid for the season of the year; I or Hot se me verify the same by personal observations : surements. The most considerable coal beds which I lly to inspect, were in the Trinity bluffs, “e , at New Cincinnati, six miles lower down, an just below: the mouth of Salt creek, near six miles above. ‘The workable stratum of brown ‘coal in each of these localities is about five feet thick, and situated some fifteen feet or so above low water mark. In quality it is said to be precisely similar to the coal of the seven feet bed. Specimens of average quality which I took from the bed near the mouth of Salt creek, have a specific gravity of 1.326. The pro- portion of carbon or coke, is forty seven parts in one hundred (avo) The volatile portion consists of bitumen, creosote, page og acid and water. Upon burning 100 parts of the coal, there re- mains a trifle more than one part by weight of white ashes. The color of this coal is a dark umber brown, nearly black. Its ligni- form structure is almost always easily discernible. It is readily ignited, burns with a pleasant flame, and with almost the same = Geology of the Trinity Country, Texas. 217 facility as charcoal. Although it has much less bitumen in its composition than the Pittsburgh or cannal-coal, it will yet prove valuable for nearly all purposes to which coal is applied ; such as parlor use, the reduction of ore, and the generation of steam power. It is however ill adapted for the manufacture of inflam- able gas. This sort of coal is denominated brown coal or brown lignite by mineralogists. Sometimes it is called Bovey coal, because a thick bed of it has long been wrought at Bovey near Exeter in England. It occurs in many parts of the world, in some places in vast abundance, but generally in beds of far less extent than those of the Trinity. It is worthy of remark, that iron pyrites commonly so abundant and detrimental in coal, is here unusually scarce. In estimating the value of these beds of lignite, it must be re- membered, that the Trinity is a navigable stream, and almost the only one in Texas, which at this time deserves to be so ranked: that the city of Galveston, now with a population of 2000 and rapidly increasing, is situated on an island virtually destitute of timber. Hence Galveston needs fuel, and nothing is more prob- able than that the Trinity country will supply her. Each steam- ship plying between Galveston and New Orleans, consumes dur- ing the voyage both ways near one thousand barrels of coal, which at present costs thent in New Orleans, an average of seventy or eighty cents a barrel. During twelve months past, the steamship Columbia is said to have expended $25,000 for coal alone. It is by no means improbable that coal might be profitably furnished to steam vessels at Galveston, from the Trinity, at one third or even one fourth this cost. If the demand can be supplied, Gal- veston will be one of the best coal markets in the world; for be- sides the requirements of ordinary commerce, steamships of war - eruizing in the Gulf =! Mexico, will Segeys find it a convenient place to lay in fuel. — ee New Orleans, July 15, 1839. ao Vol, xxxvi, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 23 a 218 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. _ Art. TL.—E tracts Jrom the Anniversary Address of the Rev. Wma. Wuewett, before the Geological Society of London.— Continued from p. 129 of this volume. In attempting a sketch of the subjects which have occupied the attention of the Society during the year, I should wish to retain that distribution of the science of geology according to which I arranged my remarks in the Address which I had last year the honor of reading to the Society ; I mean the primary division into Descriptive Geology and Geological Dynamics ; the former imply- ing a description of the rocks of the earth’s surface according to an established classification of strata and formations; and the latter dealing with the study of those general laws and causes of change by which we hope to understand and account for the facts which Descriptive Geology brings before us ; in short, the present con- dition and the past history of the earth’s crust. But as the laws of permanence and change, with regard to organized beings, differ very widely from the dynamics of brute matter, we may conven- iently make a separate study of the relations of organic life to which geology conducts us, and may mark it by the name Pal- @ontology, by which it is commonly known. _ I will add, that it still appears to me convenient, for the present, to divide Descrip- tive Geology into two portions,—the Home circuit, in which the order of superposition has already been established with great continuity and detail; and the Foreign region, in which we are only just beginning to trace such an order. I shall also, as before, take the ascending order of strata. According to this arrange- ment of the science, I shall venture to bring to your recollection a few of the points to which our attention has mainly been called during the past year. DESCRIPTIVE GEOLOGY. 1. Home (North European) Geology.—When 1 stated that Descriptive Geology has for its task the reference of the rocks of some portions of the earth’s surface to an established classification into strata and formations, it was implied that the more common employment of the descriptive geologist must be to refer the rocks _ which he examines to some classes already fixed and recognized but it could hardly fail to occur to you, that from time to time the 4 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 219 leaders in this study will be called upon to execute a more weighty and elevated office, in framing the classifications which other observers are to apply ; in drawing the great lines of division and subdivision which fix the form of the subject ; in setting up the type with which examples are to be compared ; in constructing the language in which others are to narrate their facts. Steps of this kind have formed, and must form, the great epochs in the progress of all sciences of classification, and especially in ours; and I need not remind you how great the importance and the ~ influence of such steps amongst you have been, to pronounce at once upon the success of such steps must always be in some de- gree hazardous ; since their success is in fact this, that they influ- ence permanently and powerfully the researches, descriptions, and speculations of future writers ; and there are few of us who can pretend to the foresight which might enable us to say, in any Special case, how far this will be so. Yet the great works of Messrs. Murchison and Sedgwick, tending to the establishment of a classification of the strata below the old red sandstone (works which, on all accounts, we must consider asa joint undertaking), appear already to offer an augury which can hardly be doubtful, of this influence and permanence. Mr. Murchison’s appellation of the “Silurian System” has already been adopted by MM. Elie de Beaumont and Dufresnoy, who have given it currency on the continent: M. Bone and M. de Verneuil announce the diffusion of “Silurian” rocks in Servia and the adjacent parts of Turkey in Europe ; ourown members, Mr. Hamilton and Mr. Strickland, have extended their range to the Thracian Bosphorus ; M. Forch- hammer, of Copenhagen, visited the “Silurian region” to en- deavor to recognize the rocks of Scandinavia ; and MM. Omalius D’Halloy and Dumont have just explored it, to establish a par- allel between its deposits and those of Belgium. It will be ob- served that some of the districts thus mentioned are out of the limits of our geological Home circuit ; and if the identification be really and permanently established in these cases, will extend the limits within which the parallelism of geological series can be asserted: and this is, in effect, what we have a right to look for, sooner or later, in the progress of geological science. As we must be careful not to apply our domestic types without modification to other regions, so must we take care not to despair of modifying our scheme, so that it shall be far more extensively applicable 220 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. than it at first appeared to be. Of this progress of things exam- ples are too obvious and too recent to require to be pointed out. The labors of Professor Sedgwick refer to the “Cambrian Sys- tem,” which les beneath the Silurian System, occupying much of North Wales, Cumberland, and a great part of Scotland; while the Silurian System spreads over a great part of South Wales and the adjoining English counties. The classification of the rocks of this portion of our island to which Professor Sedgwick has been led, though laid before you only at a recent meeting, is the fruit of the vigorous and obstinate struggles of many years, to mould into system a portion of geology which appeared almost too refractory for the philosopher’s hands ; and which Professor Sedg- wick grappled with the more resolutely, in proportion as others shrank away from the task perplexed and wearied. I need not attempt any detailed view of his system: his First Class of Pri- mary Stratified Rocks occupies the Highlands of Scotland and the ‘Hebrides, and appears in Anglesea and Caernarvonshire; the crystalline slates Skiddaw Forest, and the Upper Skiddaw slate series come next. Above these is his Second Class, or Cambrian and Silurian. The Cambrian is divided into lower and Upper Cambrian, of which the former includes all the Welsh series un- der the Bala limestone; the two great groups of green roofing slate and porphyry on the north and south sides of the mineral axis of the Cambrian mountains (of which sroups the position had previously been misunderstood), and parts of Cornwall and South Devon. The Upper Cambrian System contains a large part of the Lammermuir chain ; a part of the Cambrian hills, commencing with the caleareous slates of Coniston and Windermere ; the system of the Berwyns and South Wales; — all the North Devon, and a part of the South Devon and Oor- nish series. Ascending thus through a series of formations dis- tinguished and reduced to order by the indefatigable exertions and wide views of Professor Sedgwick, we arrive at the Silurian system ; and here we must seek our subdivisions from the rich results of the labors of Mr. Murchison. 'These subdivisions were published in the summer of 1833. Like the Cambrian, the Silu- rian is divided into a Lower and an Upper System, the former including the Llandeilo flags and the Caradoc sandstones; the Upper Silurian Rocks being the Wenlock shale and limestone, the Lower Ludlow, the Aymestry limestone, and the Upper Ludlow, Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 221 which finally conducts us to the Tilestones or bottom beds of the Old Red Sandstone. 2 ” That these various series of Cambrian and Silurian rocks are really superposed on one another; that they are justly separated into these groups; and that the smaller groups are truly of a sub- ordinate nature, divided by lines less broad than those which bound the great series of formations ;—these are points, of which the evidence must be sought in the works to whichIrefer. The evidence produced by Prof. Sedgwick is mainly to be found in the great fact of superposition, supported by the circumstances of dip, strike, cleavage, mineral character, and all the great incidents of mountain masses. To proofs of this kind Mr. Murchison is able to add the testimony of organic fossils, of which a vast and - Inost instructive collection is figured in his work. These fossils of the Silurian system, amounting in all to about 350 species, are essentially distinct from those of the Carboniferous System and Old Red Sandstone. This being so, the establishment of these great divisions is supported by that geological evidence which properly belongs to the subject. In detecting order and system among the monuments of the most obscure and remote periods of the earth’s history ; it may easily be supposed that it has been necessary to employ and to improve all the best methods of geological investigation. Prof. Sedgwick’s classification of the oldest rocks which form the sur- face of this island has of course been obtained by a careful atten- tion to the position and superposition of the mineral masses, and by tracing the geographical continuity of the strata, almost mile by mile, from Cape Wrath to the Land’s End. In this manner _ he has connected the rocks of Scotland with those of Cumberland ; these again with those of Wales; and the Welsh series, though more obscurely, with that of Devonshire and Cornwall. In this survey he has constantly kept before his eyes a distinction, known indeed before, but never before so carefully and systematically employed, between the slaty cleavage of rocks and their stratifica- tion ; for the directions of these two planes, though each wonder- fully persistent over large tracts, never, except by accident, coin- cide. He has taken for his main guide the direction of the strata, or, as it is called, the strike of the beds; and in such a course, the theory of Elie de Beaumont respecting the parallelism of contem- poraneous elevations, whether true or false, could not fail to give ‘ re ~ 222 Society :—Anniversary of 1839. an additional Wires to geological researches, conducted on so large a scale as those of Prof. Sedgwick. Mr. Murchison’s mode of investigation may be described thus: that he has applied, for the first time, to the rocks below the Old Red Sandstone, the method of classification previously employed with so much suc- cess for the Oolites. It is truly remarkable, that Nature has placed in this our corner of the world, series, probably the most complete which exist, of both these groups of strata; and as the Oolites of England have long been the type of that portion of European geology, the Silurians of Wales may perhaps soon be recognized, as the jdard members of a still more extensive range of deposits. As if Nature wished to imitate our geological has placed in the corner of Europe our island, contain- “maps, she ing an Index Series of European formation in full detail. The Carboniferous, Old Red, Silurian, and Cambrian systems shave, by many writers, up to the present time, been all compre- hended in the term “transition rocks,” so fer as that term has been used with any definite application at all. The analysisof this vague group into these distinct portions removes the confusion | and perplexity which have hitherto prevailed in this province of geology. Prof. Sedgwick has further proposed to apply the term Paleozoic, and Mr. Murchison that of Protozoic, to the rocks ich constitute the Cambrian and Siluriangifbterte: wh ae How far these appellations are useful, we shall see when we oe have had speculations presented to us in ‘whieh they are familiarly “used ; for necessity is the best apology, and convenience the best rule, of innovations in scientific language. In the names apie to the members of the Silurian system, Mr. Murchison, following — those examples of geological nomenclature which have been most _ clearly understood and most generally adopted, has borrowed his terms from localities in which standard types of each stratum oc- cur. If the Silurian system be as exclusively diffused as some indications seem to imply, we may find the Ludlow Rocks in Scandinavia, and the Caradoc Sandstone even in Patagonia. Whether a like identification of the more ancient rocks of the Cambrian series with the lowest formations of other countries be possible, may perhaps be (for the present) more doubtful. -Lhave spoken of Mr. Murchison’s work as if it had formed part of our Proceedings, as indeed almost every part of it has done, although it now appears in a separate form. And I will sat: Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 223 add, that it is impossible not to look with pleasure upon the form in which the work appears, enriched as it is in the most liberal manner, with every illustration, map and section, picturesque view and well marked fossil, which can aid in bringing vividly before the reader, all the instructive and interesting features of the formations there described. The book must be looked upon as an admirable example of the sober and useful splendor which may grace a geological monograph. Having been tempted to dwell so long on this subject from my _ conviction of its importance, I must.the more rapidly proceed with the remainder of my survey. Mr. Bowman sent us, “Notes ona small patch of Silurian Rocks to the west of Abergele.” In this investigation, which is interesting to us as the first appli- cation of Mr. Murchison’s Silurian System, the author found ~~ strata of which some could be, by means of fossils, identified “ss with the Ludlow rocks. Mr. Malcolmson has, by the remains of fossil fishes, shown that the calciferous conglomerate of Elgin ‘ represents the old red sandstone of Clashbinnie, as the Rev. G. Gordon had already supposed. Finally, Seeeceeding to higher strata, we have to notice a trait of the fossil history of the coal strata near Bolton-le-Moors, contributed by Dr. Black. 1 of a tree thirty feet long, and inclined at an angle of 18° in adi- rection opposite the strata, was discovered, having upon it a Sternbergia, about an inch in diameter, éxiBinding the whole length of the stem, which had been, while Liste, a parasite plant, like the mighty existing creepers of the tropical regions. — The most curious addition to our fossil characters of strata, are the footsteps discovered on the surface of beds of the new -. red sandstone. It is well known that several years ago such — marks were discovered at Corncockle Muir, in Dumfries-shire. Since that time similar discoveries have been made at various places, and especially in 1834, in the quarries of Hesseberg near Hilbergshausen ; and to the animal which had produced the i im- pressions then discovered, the name of Chirotherium was provis- ionally applied by Professor Kaup. In the quarries of Storeton Hill, in the peninsula of Worrall, between the Mersey and the Dee, marks were discovered strongly resembling the footsteps of the Chirotherium of Kaup: these were described by a committee — of the Natural History Society of Liverpool, and drawn by J. Cunningham, Esq. Mr. James Yates has also described foot- * a , * : the notion of protruded strata between. The Wealden strata | wick in the Isle of Skye. ees 224 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. steps of four other animals from the same quarries; and Sir Philip Egerton has given us a description of truly gigantic foot- steps of the same kind, which he terms the Aenean Her- lis. Mr. Strickland gave us a notice of some remarkable dikes of calcareous grit which occur in the lias schist at Ethie in Ross- shire, and which had already been remarked by Mr. Murchison, in his examination of the coast of Scotland, in 1826. ‘They appear not to have been injected from below, but filled in from above. Mr. Williamson’s “View of the Distribution of Organic Re- mains in part of the Oolitic Series on the Coast of Yorkshire,” was the welcome continuation of a labor of the same kind al- ready executed for the lower portions of the series, and promised to be continued for the upper. Among the contributions to the fossil history of the oolites, we must also place Dr. Buckland’s “Discovery of the fossil bdo of an unknown Neuropterous In- sect in the Stonesfield slate.” This stratum, the Stonesfield slate, has, during the past + cupied the Society in the con- sideration of its fossils in no per | degree ; but the speculations thus suggested belonging to Paleontology rather than Deserip- tive Geology. Mr. Murchinson’s notice. of a specimen ¢ of the Oar’s rock, which stands in the sea off the coast of Sussex, nine miles south of Little Hampton, Shaws it to agree with some of the rocks in the greensand or eds: and: its thus elong- ing to the strata below the chalk fa falls in whichthe Aiasah -of its occurring between the parallels of disturbances whicli-t traverse a -ahe the Wealden of Sussex on the north, and the Isle of Wight a % the south ; for these disturbances and other facts agree well themselves have been observed by ‘MreMalcolmson, at Lanks- field, near Elgin. It is remarkable, that these strata had already, very unexpectedly, been found by Messrs. Murchison id Sedg- e also to notice Dr. Buckland’s account of hobdiacoy a “of fossil fishes in the Bagshot pan at Goldworth Hill, ne: Guilford. os : emble le those of the London ¢ t Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 225 The fresh water beds of the Isle of Wight, which had already supplied specimens of some of the Pachydermata of the Paris basin, have furnished an additional supply of rich fossils, which have been examined by Mr. Owen. He has found Ehiom to con- tain bones of four species of Paleotherium, and two species of Anoplotherium ; also a jaw of the Cheeropotamus, a fossil genus established by Cuvier ; and another jaw closely resembling that of a Musk Deer, which Mr. Owen refers to the genus Dicobune, a genus also established by Cuvier upon the fossils of the Paris basin. Such discoveries, falling in with the conclusions obtained by the researches of previous philosophers respecting the tertiary _ period of the earth’s history, and supplying what they left imper- fect, cannot fail to give us great confidence in the results of those investigations, and to enhance. our admiration of the sagacity which opened to us this path of discovery. Dr. ae gave an account of his attempts to trace the drift — from t alk and strata below the chalk, as it exists in the coun- — ties of Norf , Suffolk, Kssex, Cambridge, Huntingdon, Bed- ford, Hertford, and Middlesex. This drift I had occasion to no- tice in my Miarécs last year, in reference to Mr. ase 8 elaborate geological s survey of pial it is ai re Dr. M ich Boe s shown that this Mic qoait is of greater eel we were before aware. But still to determine with a its pineal TAREES, total extent, and local modifi- ogy.—In the survey of the prog ors whic fe to ° your notice last year, I stated, that in proceeding b 2yond t _ Alps, and I might have added the Pyrenees, weno | longer fin that multiplied series of strata, so “greg continuo and Vol. oe No. 2.—July—October, 1839. © a ; é < ; & ‘ ; + me 226 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. similar, when their identity is properly traced, with which we have been familiar in our home circuit. Yet the investigations of Mr. Hamilton and Mr. Strickland appear to show, that we may recognize, even in Asia Minor, the great formations, oceupy- ing the lowest sud highest positions of the series, which are well marked by fossils, namely, the Silurian and Tertiary forma-— tions ; and also an intermediate formation corresponding in gen- eral with the Secondary rocks of the north, but not as yet re- duced to any parallelism with them in the order of its members. Besides these sedimentary rocks, in this as in most other coun- tries, there are found vast collections of igneous rocks of various kinds, which interrupt and modify, and may mask and over- whelm, the fossiliferous strata. A paper has been communicated to us by Mr. Hamilton, “Ona part of Asia Minor,” namely, the country extending from the foot of Hassan Dagh, to the great salt lake of Toozla, and thence eastwards to Caesarea and Mount seagseUs, and thus occupying a part of the ancient Cappadocia. It appears that in this district the igneous rocks occupy a large portion of the surface, and the sedimentary strata which are as- sociated with these are not easily identified with those which occur in countries already examined. The district examined by Mr. Hamilton contains a limestone belonging to the vast calcare- ous lacustrine formation of the central part of Asia Minor, and beneath this, a system of highly inclined beds of red sandstone, conglome erates, and marls, which are perhaps connected with the saliferous deposits of Pontus and Galatia; but which could not be satisfactorily compared \ with the beds of the south of Europe, for want of the occurrence of organic remains. In only one in- : stance did Mr. Hamilton observe the trace of organic the sandstone ; these were impressions resembling — “similar to those found in the Alpine limestone near ‘I Hamilton ascended to the summit of Mount Agen not previously been reached by any traveller, which 1 ab- ruptly from the alluvial plain of Cxsarea to the srt of oe feet. We have another contribution to the geology of the countries exterior to the Alps and Pyrenees in Mr. Sharpe’s memoir on the seecloey of Portugal. He has examined with great care the - heighborhood of Lisbon, and has traced the superposition of the ia naming the most conspicuous of them from the places in , =e i : i X Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. — 227 which they are well exhibited. His series (exclusive of igneous rocks) consists of San Pedro limestone (which rests upon the granite,) slate clay and shale, Espichel limestone, red sandstone, hippurite limestone, and lower tertiary conglomerate, the Almada beds, and the upper tertiary sand. In the Memoirs of the Royal Academy of Sciences of Lisbon, for 1831, Baron Eschwege had examined a geological section taken across the mouth of the 'T'a- gus, and passing from the granite of the Serra of Cintra, to that of the Serra of Arrabida. But his identifications of the Portu- guese beds do not agree with those of Mr. Sharp, and have in- deed the air of proceeding on the arbitrary assumption of a cor- respondence between this and other parts of Europe. Thus Baron Eschwege has referred both the San Pedro and the Espi- chel limestones to the magnesian limestone ; the red sandstone formation he considers as Bunter Samdgteitt; while Mr. Sharpe refers it to the age of our Oolites: the hippurite limestone (now acknowledged to be the equivalent of our chalk and greensand) M. Esetiwege makes to be the Jura limestone; and the Almada beds he would have to be Plastic Clay and ‘Calenien Grossier. Mr. Sharpe is very properly attempting, by a further study of the organic fossils which he has procured, to confirm or correct the identifications to which he has been led. It is only by thus _ starting from different. points, and tracing ‘strata by their conti- nuity, that we can hope to cover the map of Europe, and finally the world, with eetjogieal symbols of a meaning fully under- stood. * am PALEONTOLOGY. ‘¢. jthe, fomtiont of our subject a CA Paleontology, logy rather than of ice it is concerned —_ the forms and anatomy of animals, and differs from the usual studies of the zoologist only in seeking its materials in the strata of the earth’s crust instead of upon its surface. Yet a moment’s thought shows us how es- sential a part of our science the zoology of extinct animals is; for in order to learn the history of the revolutions which the earth has undergone, we must seek for general laws of succes- sion in the remains of organic life which it presents, as well as in the position and structure of its brute masses. And since such general laws must necessarily be expressed in terms of zoology, 4 228 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. it becomes our business to define those terms, so that they shall be capable of expressing truths which include in their circuit the past as well as the present animal and vegetable population of the world. An example of this process has occupied a large portion of our attention during the past year. It appeared to be a proposition s universally true, that the oldest strata of the earth’s surface con- tained cold-blooded animals only ; and that creatures of the class mammalia only began to exist on the surface after the chalk stra- ta had been deposited and elevated. And when, to a rule of this tempting generality, a seeming exception was brought under our notice, it became proper to examine, whether the anatomical line, which enables us to separate hot-blooded from cold-blooded ani- mals, had really been rightly drawn; and whether, by rectifying the supposed characteristic distinction, the exception might not _ be eliminated. The exception on which this very instructive point was tried consisted ina few jaw-bones of a fossil animal, which, though occurring in the Stonesfield slate near Oxford, a bed belonging to the oolite formation, had been referred by Cu- vier to the genus Didelphys, and thus placed among marsupial mammals. In August last, M. de Blainville stated to the Acad- emy of Sciences of Paris, his reasons for doubting the justice of of the place thus assigned to the fossil animal. Founding his views principally upon the number and nature of the teeth of the fossil, he ssserted that the animal, if a mammal, must come nearest the phocee ; but he rather inclined to believe it a saurian reptile ; following, as he conceived, the analogies offered by a supposed fossil saurian described by Dr. Harlan of Philadelphia, — and termed by him Basilosaurus. M. Valenciennes, on the other hand, asserted the propriety of the place assigned by Cuvier to the fossil animal, although he made it a new genus; and gave to the species the name T'hylacotherium Prevostii. The contro- versy at Paris had its interest augmented when Dr. Buckland in September carried thither the specimens in question. From Paris the controversy was transferred hither in November, and principally occupied our attention at our meetings till the middle of January. One advantage resulting from the ample discussion to which the question has thus been subjected, has been, that even those of us who were previously ignorant of the marks by which 200- . ex Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 229 logists recognize such distinctions as were in this case in question, have been put fully in possession of the rules and the leading examples which apply to such cases. And hence it will not I trust be deemed presumptuous, if, without pretending to any power of deciding a question of zoology, I venture to state the result of these discussions. It appears, then, that some of the marks by which the under jaws of Mammals are distinguished from those of Saurians are the following: (1) a convex ec a (2) a broad and generally elevated coronoid process, (: ing near the condyle ; (4) the jaw in one piece ; (5) the teeth multi- cuspid, and (6) of varied forms, (7) with double fangs, (8) in- serted in distinct sockets, but (9) loose and not anchylosed with the jaw. In all these respects the Saurians differ; having, for instance, instead of a simple jaw, one composed of six bones with peculiar forms and relations, and marked by Cuvier with distinct names ; having the teeth with an expanded and simple fang, or anchylosed in a groove, and so on. Of course, it will be supposed, by any one acquainted with the usual character of natural groups, that this line of distinction will not be quite sharp and unbroken, but that there will be apparent transgressions of the rule, while yet the unity of the group is indubitable. Thus _ the Indian Monitor and the Iguana, though Saurians, violate th ‘ot second character, having an elevated coronoid process; but then it is narrow, and this seeming defect in our second character is further remedied by the third; for in those Saurians there is a depressed space between the condyle and the coronoid process quite different from that which a mammal jaw exhibits. Again, the teeth of Crocodiles, Plesiosaurus, and the like, are inserted in distinct sockets; but then they have not double fangs. The Basilosaurus was supposed to be a saurian with double fanged teeth, but that exception was disposed of afterwards. And as there are thus saurians which trench upon the characters of mam- mals, there are mammals in which some of the above characters are wanting : thus the condyle is slightly or not at all convex in the Ruminantia; there is no elevated coronoid process in the Edentata; the Dolphin and Porpois have not multicuspid teeth ; the Armadillo has not varied forms of teeth, nor has it double fangs to its teeth, which also the fossil Megatherium has not. Still, upon the whole, the above appears to be the general line of distinction. Even if one or two of the above nine marks were , ' 230 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. wanting to prove the animal a mammal, still if the great majority of them were present, our judgment could not but be decided by the preponderance of characters. But if all the above characters of mammals are present, and all those of saurians absent, it seems to be a wanton skepticism to doubt that the animal was really warm blooded. Now it was asserted by Mr. Owen, who brought this subject before us, that this is the case; that all the characters which have enumerated above exist in the Stonesfield jaws. If we satisfy ourselves that this is the case, Ido not see how we can ‘avoid assenting to his opinion,—that the animal belonged to the class Mammalia. Every such question of classification must resolve itself into two; that of the value, and that of the evistence of the charac- ters. If we assent to Mr. Owen in his view of the former, we are then led to consider the Jatter. M. de Blainville, at least in his first examination, had labored under the disadvantage of forming his judgments from casts and — drawings only of the Stonesfield bones. Under these circum- stances, he had denied several of the above characters; he had held that the teeth in the Thylacotherium are uniform ; and that they are confluent with the jaw ; and that the jaw is compound. These statements Mr. Owen, resting upon a careful examination of the specimens, contradicts. ‘The assertion of the compoun nature of the jaw is occasioned by a groove near the lower mar- gin of the jaw, which however, is not so situated as to represent the saurian sutures, but is completely explained by supposing it to be a vascular canal, such as exists in the Wombat, Didelphys, Opossum, and similar animals. Another specimen, at that time the property of Mr. Broderip, but now very properly placed in the British Museum, exhibits 4 jaw similar indeed to the Thylacothere, but belonging to 4 differ- | ent genus; and to this species Mr. Owen has given the name Phascolatheriwm Bucklandi. Both these generic names imply that the animals are pouched animals; and in addition to the rea sons which led Cuvier to this opinion, Mr. Owen has noticed in the fossils an inflection of the lower edge of the jaw, which, 80 far as has been hitherto observed, occurs in Marsupials, and 12 them alone. ; | 3 5 ole Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 231 As if this question had been destined to be settled at this time, the only remaining doubt with regard to the possible existence of double fangs in the teeth of a saurian was removed by the arrival in London of Dr. Harlan with his “ Basilosaurus.” That gentle- man, with great liberality and candor, allowed sections of the fos- sil to be made in such a manner as to expose the structure of the teeth. And these being examined by Mr. Owen, and ‘compared with the general laws of dental structure which he has latley discovered, it appeared that Dr. Harlan’s fossil was by no means a saurian, but an animal nearly allied to the Dugong, to which Mr. Owen proposes to apply the generic name of Zeuglodon, ex- pressing the conjoined form of its teet I have not hesitated to lay before you the view of this subject to which I have been led by the discussions in which we have been engaged, notwithstanding the very great authorities which incline to the other side of the balance. Among these I hardly w whether I am to reckon Mr. Ogilby, who laid before us a very instructive communication, in which, without deciding the point, he pointed out the difficulties wisi appear to him to em- barrass both views, and especially to contradict the onan of the marsupial nature of the animal. I have dwelt the longer on this controversy, since it Gavilvée considerations of the most comprehensive interest to geologists, and, we may add, of the most vital importance. For—de summé reipublice agitur—the battle was concerning the foundations of our philosophical constitution; concerning the validity of the reat Cuverian maxim—that from the fragment of a bone we can reconstruct the skeleton of the animal. This doctrine of final causes in animal structures, as it is the guiding principle of the zoologist’s reasonings, is the basis of the geologist’s views of the organic history of the world; and, that destroyed, one half of his edifice crumbles into dust. If we cannot reason from the analo- gies of the existing, to the events of the past world, we have no Bnndation for our science; and you, Gentlemen, have all along been applying your vigorous talents, your persevering toil, your ardent aspirations, idly and in vain. Besides the important investigations thus referred to, we owe to Mr. Owen other paleontological contributions. The genus Cheropotamus, established by Cuvier from an imperfect fragment of the bone of a skull, was asserted by him to be a Pachyderm 232 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. most nearly allied to the Peccari. A fragment of a lower jaw of — the same genus, found by Mr. Darwin Fox in the Isle of Wight, _ confirms this view, but indicates in some points an approach to the carnivorous type. And it was remarked as interesting, that the living genus of the hog tribe which most resembles the Chee- ropotamus, the Peccari, exists in South America, where the Ta- pir, the nearest living analogue of the Anoplothere and Paleo- there, the associates of the Cheropotamus, also occur. Another jaw, found by Mr. Pratt in the Binstead quarries in 1830, and re- sembling that of the Musk Deer, Mr. Owen refers to a new species of Cuvier’s genus Dicobune, under the name Dichobune cervi- num. Mr. Owen has also given us a description of Lord Cole’s specimen of Plesiosaurus macrocephalus, which he compares with Mr. Conybeare’s Plesiosaurus Dolichodeirus, by establish- ing an intermediate species, founded upon a specimen existing in the British Museum, and termed by him Plesiosaurus Hawkinsit. Besides mace the analogies which connect these with each pa hem with the two great modifications of C odiles and the lizards, Mr. Owen pre- sented his Seite on the form of the Plesiosaurian vertebre, founding them upon a general view of noes of which all vertebre are constituted. To the communications thus made to us, we nay aes Mr. Owen’s determination of another animal, of which t ans: brought from the neighborhood of Buenos Ayres, are among the pire this: kind which we owe to Sir Woodbine Pa- animal, of gigantic dimensions, appears to have been aed to the Megatherium, but with closer affinities to the Arma- dillos; and it probably possessed the characteristic armor, of which, in the Megatherium, the-existence is perhaps problemati- cal. Mr. Owen has termed it Gilyptodon, from the furrowed shape of its teeth. In another communication, Mr. _ Owen endeavored to account for the dislocation of the tail of the Ichthyosaurus at a certaill point, which is observable in many of the fossil skeletons of that animal. This circumstance, so remarkable from its general oc- currence, and whieh Mr. Owen was the first to observe, he is dis- posed to account for, by supposing a broad tegumentary fin to have been attached to the tail for a portion of its length, the posi- tion of which fin must, he conceives, have been vertical. eee Ree oa Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. 233 I cannot close my enumeration of the valuable contributions for which we are indebted to Mr. Owen, without remarking how our anticipations have been verified, when, in awarding him ‘the Wollaston medal last year, we ebaiidered the labors which we thus distinguished as only the beginning of an enlarged series of scientific successes; and how well also Mr. Owen’s own de- claration, that he should lose no available time or opportunity which could be applied to palzont borne out by the services he has science. In the remainder of my review of what has been done among us in Paleontology, I must necessarily be very brief. I have already mentioned the discovery of fossil fishes in Bagshot sand. These fishes have supplied three new genera, which Dr. Buckland has distinguished and has named E'daphodon, Passalodon, and Ameibodon ; of which the two first offer combinations of the char- acters of bony and cartilaginous fishes. Mr. Stokes | has given us his views of the structure of the animal to which belonged those fossils with which we are so familiar unt r the name of Orthoce- ratites. He is of opinion, that these. fossil in their a ng conde tion, existed as a shell, enveloped within t { 4 ich he assigns the names ora Orm d Eh The Marquis of Northampton also has exam- ed those minute spiral shells which occur in + re and chalk flints, and have been termed Spirolinites.. d, finally, under this head I must mention Mr. Alfred Smee’s ae the state in which animal matter is usually found in fossils. = Mr. Austen’s hypothesis of the origin of the limestone of Devon, though belonging in some measure to Geological Dynamics, may be mentioned here, since he explains the position of those beds by reference to the mt of, the coral animal. Mr. Austen constructing goologianly ma 58 Sirequining no ’ talents and temper, he has earned our ee We shall therefore not be thought, I trust, to depreciate his labors if we aa with less confidence, speculations in their nature ae doubtful. As we can hardly suppose the caleareous beds of Devon ‘to have os an origin different from those of other countries, ‘we cannot help receiving with some suspicion, a at which would subvert Von. rxxvu1, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 2 &. 234 Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. almost the whole of our existing knowledge of the. relations of —, beds of limestone. hat part of geology which I have termed Geological Dyna- mics, a which investigates and applies those causes of change by which we may hope to explain geological phenomena, we may still observe that fundamental antithesis of opinion which has long existed on the subject ;—the division of our geological spec- wlators into Catastrophists and Uniformitarians ;—into those who read in the rocks of the globe the evidence of vast revolu- tions, of an order different from any which those of man has sur- vived ;—and those who see in the condition of the earth the re- sult of a series of changes which are still going on without decay, the same powers which produced the existing valleys and mount- ains being yet at work about us. Both these opinions have re- ceived their contributions during the preceding year: Mr. Darwin having laid before us his views of the formation of mountain chains and volcanos, which he conceives to be the effect of a gradual, small, and occasional elevation of continental masses of the earth’s erast #. w hile Mr. Murchison gathers from the re- searches in which he has been engaged, the belief of a former state of paroxysmal turbulence, of much deeper rooted intensity and wider range than any that are to be found in our own peri and M. de Beaumont, in France, has endeavored to prove that Ktna and many other mountains must have been ee « some gigantic and extraordinary convulsion of the earth. Mr. Darwin and M. de Beaumont refer to the same le and while M. de Beaumont conceives that the cones of the Aide must have been formed by an abrupt élevation, caused by subter- ranean force, Mr. Darwin has maintained the opinion, that these lofty summits have been gradually thrust into the place which they oceupy by a series of successive injections of molten matter from below, each intruded portion of fluid having time to harden into rock before it was burst and again injected by the next mol- ten mass. For how otherwise, he asks, can we conceive the strata to be thrust into a vertical position by a liquid from below, without the very bowels of the earth gushing out? Without attempting to answer this question, we may observe, that when re eee ject iniae daw ae * An abstract of Mr. Darwin’s ned was given in L. and E. Phil. Mag., vol. xil, p. 564, Geological Society :—Anniversary of 1839. _ 235 we suppose, as Mr. Darwin supposes, a vast portion of the earth’s crust, the whole territory of Chili for example, to rest on a lake of sablten stone, there is considerable force in M. de Beaumont’s argument -—that when such a fluid is raised to the top of a moun- tain ten or twenty thousand feet high, the pressure upon the crust which is in contact with the fluid must be more than a thousand atmospheres; and who, he too asks, flatters himself that he knows enough of the interior machinery of volcanos, to be certain that this vast pressure, acting upon a large surface, may not, by some derangement of its safety valve, the voleanic vent, produce effects to which we cannot assign any limit ? In speaking of Mr. Darwin’s researches I cannot refrain from expressing for myself, and I am sure I may add for you, our dis- appointment and regret that the publication of Mr. Darwin’s jour- nal has not yet taken place. Knowing, as we do, that this jour- nal contains many valuable contributions to science, we cannot help lamenting, that the customs of the Service by which the survey was conducted have not yet allowed - this portion of the account of its results to be given to the world. Although not communicated to us, but to our Alma Mater the Royal “Shear I may notice Mr. Hopkin’s endeavors to throw light upon such subjects as this by the aid of mathematical rea- aa force from below would produce upon a portion of the earth’s crust, have already interested you, and would be of still greater value if the directions of faults and fissures which result from his theory did not depend very much upon that which in most cases we cannot expect to know, the form of the area sub- jected to such strain. Mr. Hopkins has since been employing himself in iening. the consequences of anginer idea, truly ingeni- the resources of mathentaties could alone | l with. the effects which the sun and moon produce upon the earth (as the precession and nutation ,) include the attraction of those. bod- ies upon the interior portion of the earth, and have hitherto been deduced from the theory by mathematicians, upon the supposition that the earth is solid. But what if the central portion of the earth were fluid! What if it appeared, by calculation, that the fluid internal condition would make the amount of the precession of the equinoxes, or of the nutation of the axis, different from 4 _ that which the is would give? What if it appeared _. that the precession and nutation thus calculated for a fluid interior eal better with observation than the result hitherto obtained ot supposing the earth solid? If this were so, we should have evidence of the earth’s interior fluidity, evidence, too, of a per- “foipsovel and most striking nature. But to answer these ee ~ tions is far from an easy task; the precession of the solid earth a problem in which Newton eared and in which the greates mathematicians of modern times have not found their greatest . “strength superfluous. Yet how incomparably more difficult in : i i It may, tion of the problem can be pained. Mr. Hopkins has attacked it by the aid of certain hypotheses, and the result is, so far, not favorable to the decisiveness of this test of the interior condition of the earth; but notwithstanding this state of things, I venture to say on your behalf, Gentlemen, that an idea so full of promise, of that which we so much desire, and which seems to be 80 - utterly out of our reach, the knowled centre of the earth,—that such an ide: doned.* M. Necker of Geneva, offered an addition to the causes of g 2 of the condition of the is not to be lightly aban- vulsions of the earth, which are ene: by our Geological * The following - the results at which Mr. Hopkins has arrived, supposing the earth to consist o a homogeneous spheroidal shell filled with a fluid mass of the same density as ea shell :— 1. The precession will be the same, whatever be the thickness of the shell, as if the whole earth were solid. 2. The lunar nutation will be the same as for the solid spheroid; to such a de- gree of approximation, that the difference would be inappreciable to observation. The solar nutation will be sensibly the same as for the solid spheroid ; unless the thickness of the shell be very nearly of a certain. value, something less than one fourth the earth’s radius, in which case this nutation might become much greater than for the solid iphensia. 4. In addition to the above motions of pemcconie and nutation, the pole of the goats would have a small circular motion , depending paged on the internal flu- ity. The radius of the circle thus deste would be the greatest when the thickness of the shell should be least ; but the inequality wach produced, would not, for the smallest thickness of the shell, exceed a quantity of the same order as the solar nutation; and for any but the, most incosiderabe fossa of she shell, would be a inappreciable to observat a Mr. Hopkins intends hereafter to consider ikea case wi variable density. {See our present volume, p. 364.—Ep. Lon. and Ed. Phil. Sate * = Geological Society :—Anniversa y Dynamics, in a paper in which he aser took _— in the southern prov ince = oaaiile such a may observe it does not pear likely that shea Boul b 4 ee sn ced simultaneously, Phe greater effects than those which are known to ia arose from the falling in of unsupported mines; and the While geologists are thus looking in a i direetionStior causes which may produce the phenomena which they study, it is natu-— ral that the powerful, but as yet mysterious influences of elec- tricity should draw their attention. Mr. Robert Were Fox has endeavored to show, that by voltaic agency, a laminated struc- ture, and deposits of metal in cracks, resembling metallic veins, may be produced in masses of clay. The experiments are of an in pees: oe a — ; ‘i 242, On the Temperature of Lake Ontario. south ; it does not underlie all of this area, because the surface is not every where of this polished rock, but it may underlie no small portion of it, and cover hundreds of acres. The surface of this polished rock is often marked with grooves, as if arough and heavy body had moved over it and left deep traces. These are nearly parallel with each other, and on the west side of the river are found to lie nearly from N. E. to S. W. in the rock at the rapids. On the east side of the river below the falls, the direction is but little different from the other, but some degrees more towards the west. Such are the facts: what can be the cause? The surface was not made thus originally ; it has been done artificially, though by nature, by some mighty power. The rock often presents the same appearance as that of a board planed only on one edge or towards one side. There is the same kind of evidence that the one has been planed, and the other polished. There is on some of the darker surfaces a glazed appearance, although nothing can be removed from the stone without destroying the polish, aud is owing to the bitumen in the stone. To the eye the appearance is, that it has been polished like our common marbie; by the fric- tion of a hard and smooth surface upon it. The friction of the water and earth in the Genesee wears some- what smooth surfaces on the same rock, but nothing like the polished surface now described. What is the power or cause which could have moved any hard body so as to have produced this result ? It is said that the polished surface has been found over a much larger district, but I have not the evidence to offer. Rochester, Aug. 9th, 1839, ts V.—On the Temperature of Lake Ontario; by Prof. CuestTerR Dewey. In Vol. xxxmt, p. 403, of this Journal, I gave some account of the temperature of this lake during the warm months of 1837. The results were so curious that I began to repeat them the next year. The results so perfectly agreed, that the observations were = ve On the Polished Limestone of Rochester. 243 repeated only twice. The water was a little colder in 1838 than at the same time in 1837. ‘The following are the observations. They were made at each shore, and from five to seven miles dis- tant across the lake, by the same individual, Mr. McAnslan. Obs 1838. | _ No May 14. May 21 F 1 $ At, 55° | 72° | American shore in the morning. ; Air, 39 46 In 1837, about the middle of Water, | 37 _|_38 September, the temperature of 6. ; Air, 39 | 44 the lake was about 60° at most of the points across it. On Oct.16th, t. re sae ee 9 it was colder at the shore than i; - 10 | 43 in the middle of the lake. a : Water, | 37 | 38 od g, § Au, AO 42 “2 |Water, | 38 38 "10. § Air, 42 AT Water, | 40 42 li ‘Air, A5 | 46 \Water, | 44 | 44 12. ; oe = ! eo Coburg on the Canada shore. ater, : ‘The mean temperature of the 14th at Rochester, was 59° ee cc 2 Als “ 72 It is hardly necessary to remark that the observations were taken from the mouth of the Genesee, in a nearly direct line to Coburg on the Canada shore. The influence of so great a body of water as that of Lake Ontario, at so low a temperature as 36°, or only 4° above the freezing point in the middle of May, must be palpable on the adjacent country. . > « s 244 On the Effects of Light and Air. Arr. VI.—On the Effects of Light and Air in restoring the faded Colors of the Raphael Tapestries ; by Mr. TRuut,—communi- cated by Michael Faraday, Esq., D.C.L., F.R.S.* April 21, 1839. To the Editors of the Philosophical Magazine and Journal : GentTLemeNn,—You probably fbabie an exhibition in July last of certain Raphael Tapestries in the Haymarket, and the ex- traordinary effect the exposure to light and air had had in restor- ing and altering colors which had facta during centuries of ex- clusion from these mighty agents. I have sacanied letters from the proprietor Mr. Trull, and if you think parts of them worth publication at this time, when the action of light in the service of the fine arts is so much dwelt upon, they are entirely at your service. Iam, Gentlemen, yours, &c., Micuaen F'arapay. Warwick-row, Coventry, March 12, 1839. To Professor Faraday : 1,—The interest you took in observing the changes of color in the Raphael Tapestries, after being exposed to light in London last July, made me anxious to communicate to you the extraordi- nary effects since produced, by the simple means suggested by yourself and other scientific gentlemen, of a more Rerfect €Xpos- ure to light and air, which have for the last seven months been obtained, in a finely situated factory here. I feared to trespass on your valuable time, but could not resist, after hearing of the great public interest now excited by the new process, called, I believe, “sun painting.” Light and air have done wonders for my tapestries, in dispell- ing the damp, clearing up the colors, and reproducing others, ob- scured by the effects of many years’ close packing up in boxes. I regret not to be able to make scientific remarks on the progress of the -srelapl £ which others acquainted with chemistry might have done. The results cannot fully be appreciated but by those who re- eollect the work when up in — where the first effects of nT unexpectedly commenc Fhe greens had all become ‘leas you, Sir, anticipated a return ia ginal tints, which has, sitet throughout, taken place. “ From the Lon. and Edin. Phil. Mag. and Jour. of Science, June, 1839. On the Effects of Light and Air. 245 The robes and full colors generally had become dull and heavy ; this has gradually gone off, and left a brillianey of color and beauty of effect hardly to be excelled. The gold also, as you hinted, has become more clear and bright. The flesh parts of the figures, which had become pallid, almost to white, have recovered the high tint and deep shadow, and the strong anatomical effect of Raphael. A renewed freshness now reigns over the whole, and the clear- ing up of the light in many of the landscape parts is most extra- ordinary, giving a depth and breadth the cartoons themselves do not now convey, particularly in the Keys to St. Peter, St. Paul at Athens, and the Death of Ananias; where extensive landscape, ranges of buildings, and foliage have sprung up, like magic, on parts quite obscured when up in London eight months back, much of which is either worn, or torn out of Raphael’s patterns at Hamp- ton, and meat ee and known only oe the means of these Leo Tapes I should mi tae pleasure in giving you any further infor- mation on the subject I am capable of, or in showing the works to any persons taking an interest in them. I am, &e. Wom. Bia =< Coventry, April 17, 1839. My former oy in regard to the extraordinary changes the Raphael Tapestries had undergone the last seventh months, use as you think proper. I regret not being able to give youa scien- tific description from the first, and the progress; and the absence of a gentleman acquainted with the chemical effects of light and air, to have noted the changes, is much to be regretted both for Science and art. The works themselves being unique, and of above three centuries, so placed for so many years in continued damp to effect such mischief to the colors, are circumstances hever to occur again. Some colors entirely Rep a others in confusion and appa- rently gone, yet by the mere effects of light and air, slowly and quietly resume the chief of their original tints!’ Flesh reap ear: hair on the head starts up; the grand muscular effect and uniq power of expression, only found in Raphael and Michael Angelo, are finely developed where a few months back appeared a plain surface! Here are the works, and the facts may be now ascer- tained. 246 Reaction of Sulphuric Acid. I have applied to the directors of the British Institutions, Pall Mall, to permit one or two of these Tapestries to be exhibited with the old masters in June; thus those who saw them last year, may be able to see what they now are, and both science and art may be served ; for a comparison has never yet been made, since the Cartoons were repaired and painted upon, with the tapestry. I think, Sir, you will recollect my subject of the stoning St. Stephen, the large masses of blue cloud-like appearance hanging about and over Jerusalem: these have nearly disappeared, and mountain scenery taken the place! The olive grove, which only showed a few trees in front all blue, and a heavy blue-like cur- tain was over all of the grove; the curtain has disappeared, and a fine deep grove is now seen ; the natural green and mossy bank have nearly taken their original state ; fresh lights keep breaking out and showing even deeper in the grove! and throughout the works, the original lights are working their way, from the heavier colong< =< remain, Sir, yours, &c., =. Wm. Tru. Arr. VII.—Of the Reaction of Sulphuric Acid with the Essential Oil of Hemlock ; by Cuarx Hare, of Philadelphia.* Ir equal parts of sulphuric acid and oil of hemlock be mingled together, refrigeration being employed to prevent too great a rise of temperature, a black acid resinous mass results. By the addi- tion of carbonate of lead and water, the unaltered sulphuric acid, present in great quantity, is converted into an insoluble sulphate, which, mingling with the resin, gives rise to a yellow mass re- sembling putty in its consistency, while there will be found dis- solved in the water two soluble salts of lead. The presence of a very large quantity of coloring matter, inter- feres with the examination of these salts. This, however, ina great measure disappears on precipitating the lead by sulphydric acid gas, resaturating the liberated acids by the carbonate, and again throwing down the lead in the state of a sulphide. The partially decolorized acids thus obtained may then be saturated ‘with barytes, and the resulting salts evaporated to dryness, when they assume the a —— an amorphous mass. By washing * Eldest son of Dr. Hare. i Reaction of Sulphuric Acid. 247 with absolute alcohol, one of the salts present in this mass is dis- solved. On the solution of the other in water, and subsequent crystallization, it proves to be the acetate of barytes. The salt dissolved in the alcohol does not appear susceptible of crystallization, probably on account of its extreme solubility. On drying it assumes a gummy appearance, and by still farther de- siccation, may be obtained in the state of a dry mass destitute of cohesion, and susceptible of being with facility reduced to the state of a powder When exposed to heat in a retort, this salt resists an elevated temperature without alteration, but at length, if heated rapidly, carbonizes, giving off sulphurous acid and a small quantity of essen- tial oil and water. There remain in the retort a spongy carbona- ceous substance, anda large quantity of sulphite of barytes. As this result proved the acid united with the barytes to consist of organic matter, combined with sulphuric acid and modifying its properties, in order to ascertain the quantity of the latter present, barytes was precipitated by carbonate of potash, the precipitate weighed and the resulting potash salt evaporated to dryness. It was then intimately mingled with the black oxide of copper and nitrate of potash, nitric acid added, and the whole mass gradually heated to redness. Red fumes are given off during the whole of the process, and while the nitric acid at the beginning of the o ration prevents the deoxidation of any portion of the sulphuric acid ; at the end, the oxide of copper prevents the explosive reac- tion whiéh would ensue, were nitric acid and nitrate of potash alone present. The result of two experiments made in this manner, the mass after ignition being washed with diluted chlorohydric acid, and the solution precipitated by barytes, was as follows :— Carbonate of barytes 12} gr’s. Sulphate of barytes 16: gr’s. Carbonate of barytes 13} gr’s. Sulphate of barytes 16: gr’s. _ The quantity of sulphuric acid as calculated from the quantity of sulphate precipitated, is in each case, 5.59 gr’s., while as calculated from the precipitate of carbonate of barytes, on the supposition that one atom of it is present in the barytes salt for each atom of base, it would be 5 gr’s. in the first instance, and 5.3 gr’s. in the second. It will therefore be perceived that in both experiments the quantity of sulphuric acid, as calculated from the results, exceeds the quantity necessary for forming an equivalent with 248 Reaction of Sulphuric Acid. the base present. This must be attributed either to some inaccu- xOCy: in performing the analysis, or to the presence of a small quan- tity of some sulpho-organic acid, containing in its neutral salts, two atoms of sulphuric acid for each atom of base. The former explanation is by far the most likely to be true, and it seems pro- bable that the composition of a neutral salt of this acid may be represented by one atom of sulphuric acid, one atom of organic matter, and one atom of base. - discovered, consisting of an ea of sulphur modi by some orga ae substa These compounds may be divided into 0 el In on e are comprised those acids which are com- sed of two atoms of sulphuric acid, united to one of organic matter acting asa base, and which consequently, in forming neu- tral salts, unite with but one additional atom of base. In the neu- tral salts formed by the other class, two atoms of sulphur are also esent for each atom of organic matter and each atom of base, but are combined with oxygen in such proportion as to form hyposulphuric acid, so that | the organic matter present cannot be considered as acting'the part of abase. Under the first of these - heads may be enumerated the sulphovinic, sulphetheric, sulpho- methylic, and sulphocetic acids; under the second the benzosul- BbUrGs sulphonapthalic and. prob: bly the sulphovegetic and several _ other: or the acids con in the first class, custom seems have assigned as a nomenclature, a name derived from the composition, modified so as to terminate in ic and having the term sulpho prefixed. For the second, no fixed rule seems to have been laid down. The Ger- emist who discovered one of the two acids whose com- positionhar Ties ascertained with sufficient accuracy to enable us with certainty to place them under this head, gave to it the name of pe ot while the other acid still retains thea: pella of sul tina upthalic which apie when its composi- Hon and pr erties were still supposed to. be analagous to those of the sulphovinic and other acids whieh belong to the first class. The agids: ed in this ; ut the view iven of its com- ee be correct, must be consider das longing to a division less by the sulphindi-, he he sulphuric, as in the other sent one atom of an oxacid of sul- ae - % Reaction of Sulphuric Acid. ' 249 phur modified by an atom of organic matter which does not, as in the first class, act as a base, or diminish the saturating power of the acid. If, therefore, we should adopt the nomenclature of the German chemists, with the change of sulphuric into hypo- sulphuric as necessary to designate with precision the acid of sul- phur in question, for the acids of the second class, calling them benzohyposulphuric and napthalohyposulphuric ; and applying the e same idea to the acid described in this article, name it hem- olatlane would perhaps be as eel answered, as is practicable with- out departing too widely from established custom. Hemlosulphuric acid possesses a sour taste and peugliel her It does not appear susceptible of crystallization, either when free or as far as I have examined its compounds, when combined with bases. The salts which it forms with potash lime and barytes leave in the mouth a decided and long continued impression of sweetness. 'Though extremely soluble they are not deliquescent. If the hemlosulphate of barytes be kept for a length of time at a temperature between 500° and 600°, the sulphate of barytes and organic matter of which it is composed separate, the latter in the shape of a resinous powder insoluble in water, though soluble in alcohol and ether. ‘This seems a singular instance of a bod very soluble in water, affording by the mere separation of its con- stituents, two others eminently insoluble in that liquid: In the resinous yellow mass into which the greater part of the hemlock oil is converted by the action of the sulphuric acid, there is present a yellow oil which contains sulphuric acid combined with it in a neutralized state. By the action of ether, this oil may be dissolved, and by subsequent evaporatio deposited, but when thus stitaivied: it is contaminated by so t resin that though the presence of sulphuric acid may aeniomnine’ it is impossible to determine the atomi From the reaction of sulphuric: ing more appears to be produced t ai —— ee * It is well known that by the reaction between itibeclipdie acid and pure oil of turpentine, i of artificial campho r are generated, one solid, the other , liquid. Having obtained of these compounds a few years since, Dr. H ~ subjected the oil z hemlock coe See acid by the same process, but al not thus obtain any concrete cam hor. That which he = Sapa Vol. xxxvit, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 2 ¥ ae oe pe 4 250 On Water Spouts. though a different result might have been anticipated from the close analogy which appears to exist between this essential ole and that of hemlock. Caoutchouchine, however, reacts with sul- phuric acid in a manner quite analogous to the oil of hemlock, giving rise to a yellow resin and an acid compound of sulphurie acid and organic matter, which forms soluble salts with lead and barytes. An oil, however, separates and floats on top, which appears inguabipsible of farther attack from the acid. pee Arr. VIII— On Water-Spouts ; by Hans ee CERstTeD, Professor of Natural — in the University of Copen- hagen.*¥ =~ Au naturalists, except those who have themselves proposed Fe an explanation of the water-spouts,t are agreed in thinking that science has hitherto given us but little satisfactory information on. the phenomenon. This may, in some measure, long conti to be the case, if we desire a perfect explation of the first change 2° in our atmosphere “by means of which a water-spout is caused. _ It appears, that, owing to the overstrained regard paid to this higher demand, which must so often be left unsatisfied, the sim- pler but yet fruitful labor has been neglected, of bringing together the remarkable appearances with which observations on the sub- ject have furnished us, and by this means ascend gradually from te the effect to the proximate cause, until at last we may perhaps succeed in ascertaining clearly the beariugs of the whole mat ie although, at the same time, much in reference to the ultimate eS cause, may still remain wanting to satisfy our desire of i infor- y mation. It appears to me, that, by following this less ambitious course, we may advance nearly as far in our knowledge of water- spouts as we have done in respect to thunder-storms, wind, rain, and many other natural phenomena; inasmuch as we. can pro ably specify with tolerable certainty the power by which they are produced, although we cannot accurately determine all the im ciples by which the ac-— _ tion is caused at a given place withkad ven ee of intensity. - me Edinb. Journal, yoy, 1839. a exactly cquivaloahé he ee Getaaas Wettersaule, of water-spout in its place, throughaat. the present ss “S : aah ee 3 Li ae oa On Water-Spouts. 251 __ I have collected the chief features for my description of the - phenomenon, from numerous scattered descriptions, for which we are indebted to observers in different ages and in different quar- ters of the globe ; and I venture to hope that the combination of _ facts thus elicited will keep us free from many errors, in whi most of those have been involved, who have hitheto endeavored — to explain water-spouts. It is quite possible that I may have overlooked circumstances which would tend to explain the sub- - ject, or that I may have misunderstood some of the facts con- tained in the descriptions ; but this can easily be remedied by the obliging communications of others, whenever we possess a gen- eral analysis of the facts. General Nature of Water Spouts—The water-spout is a strongly agitated mass of air, which moves over the surface of the earth, and revolves on an axis, of which one extremity is on the earth and the other ina cloud. From this cloud a continua- tion proceeds downwards, which forms the upper portion of the water-spout ; while the lower portion, besides air, consists some- _ times of water, sometimes of solid portions, according as the _ ‘Water-spout passes over land or over water. Some have sep- arated water-spouts over the land and over the water from each other, but this or nates + confusion, for water-spouts have hich wer were forme: ormed over water and advance over “we have accounts of water-spouts which - were formed over land, and afterwards were suspended over the = Ba tsce of water. They have also been seen cutting right across : = ariver, and then continuing their course over the land; or cross- as straight over an island, ond then proceeding over pa sea. The hitherto generally employed term wasserhose (water-spout ) seems : — to be not altogether a correct one, and I have therefore made cas use of the less common one “ wetterséule” (literally storm-pillar, ) : although perhaps the name wirbelstule (whirl-pillar) or luftwirbel (whirlwind, air-whirl or -vortex) might be equally appropriate. Form of the Water-Spout. —The uppermost portion is almost Ye wider abov ‘than below ; and has sometimes the form of an inverted ‘cone, sometimes of a funnel, and sometimes of a somewhat twisted I horn. The middle portion is commonly much narrower, is frequer ly. bent, and sometimes exhibits opposite sin- - but teas ned, ey ~ apparently so, owing to the portions of water and og & fa 252 On Water-Spouts. earth hurled round itself by the vortex. Occasionally water- pouts at expansions or contractions, but these instances are only exceptions | from the general rule. Generally there is only one water-spout suspended from one cloud, and it is only now and then that there are several; on one occasion no less than fourteen were noticed, all of which seemed to belong to one and the same cloud. Dimensions of Water-Spouts.—The height of water-spouts has been very variously estimated. I have been able to meet with no actual measurements, and have only seen accounts founded on mere calculations by the eye. A height of from 1500 to 2000 feet has been assigned to most water-spouts; but some have been seen at such distances, that the height cannot have been less than from 5000 to 6000 feet. Some observers have given a low estimate of the height, reducing it even to 30 feet ; but, in such cases, the lower part of the pillar has been un- doubtedly mistaken for the whole. This might easily happen to a person who was not possessed of proper information regarding the phenomenon; for when a water-spout begins to be formed, especially over water, there is often seen a pillar of water or of _drops of water, rising from the surface, without a particular con- nection with a cloud being observable; but this connection is to be found, if it is sought for, and supposing we do not imagine that the cloud must necessarily be perpendicularly above the water-spout. Should such a water-spout in the act of formation _ be afterwards interrupted in its development, its base might easily be mistaken for the whole. It is apparent from all the circum- stantial accounts we possess of water-spouts, that their upper por- tion is a cloud. ; The diameter of water-spouts is very various. "The lower portion has generally a diameter of some hundred sometimes above a thousand feet, but often much less. The vortex of drops or solid particles which the water-spout whirls along with it, has however, been sometimes included in the mass forming the lower portion. But those cases are to be regarded as exceptions where the diameter of wee teonts has been measured by the hollows they have formed in the earth, which afford a much less consid- erable size. The diameter of the middle portion is often esti- mated at only a few feet, but this has been chiefly by inexperi- enced observers. ‘It will be made probable from what is to follow, On Water-Spouts. 253 whirlwind, which does not allow of obs containing no opaque particles. Color and Transparency of Water-Sp , 1e ids most frequently assigned to water-spouts is grey, aR also dark brown, and fire red; from which it would seem that the colors are the same which the clouds assume in their different states of illumination. : The middle portion of water-spouts is often transparent, but this holds good only in those which occur over water. One water-spout was noticed whose middle portion was opaque while it traversed the land, but became transparent when it proceeded over ariver. The transparency of this portion at the sea has sometimes been observed to so great an extent, as to allow of those clouds being seen through it which were lighted up by the sun. When an opaque water-spout begins to become feeble, the cloud-like portions, which had descended into it, retire, and as the drops of water, the foam, the dust, &c. which caused the opacity, are no longer driven upwards to so great a height, the middle portion becomes transparent. that the middle portion of the water-spout is surrounded bya Duration and Movements of Water-Spouts. Waterson’ ‘ generally last longer the larger they are ; but they rarely continue for half an hour, and there is hardly one example of an hour’s duration. Water-spouts seldom, if ever, remain the whole time at one place. There is great inconstancy in their rapidity and direc- tion. They sometimes have so great a rapidity as to move seven or eight German miles (thirty two to thirty seven English miles) in an hour ; at other times they advance so slowly, that pedestri- ‘ans can anny follow them, and occasionally they remain quite stationary foratime. Their course is sometimes quite straight for a long distance, but not unfrequently it is interrupted; in some instances it is zig-zag. Their course, however, has for the most part a principal direction or bearing. It has been asserted that the direction of water-spouts is most frequently from south- West to northeast, and certainly the data ee collected go to ‘confirm this opinion. Water-spouts do not remain onibgely: at ‘the surface of the earth, but alternately rise and fall ; and hence v we see, that, dur- ing their progress, they have in some places, torn up trees by the 254 On Water-Spouts. roots, in others, only torn away the upper portions, and that at some points they have not touched them at all. This alternate rising and sinking often becomes very evident when a water- spout traverses a plain or the sea. circular rapidity of water-spouts is also very variable, for fre ently the eye can hardly follow it, while at other times their motion is not so violent. Almost all sinned expressly mention this circular movement, and I do not find that its existence is con- tradicted by any one who have themselves seen the phenomenon. It is true that two American naturalists, who examined the traces left by a destructive water-spout, declared that these traces exhib- ited no circular movement, whereas Professor Hare mentions that there was an indication of rotary motion on a chimney. We shall see, however, in the prosecution of our investigation, that the lower part of the water-spout has no circular movement, so long as it does not touch the ground. There has also been noticed an ascending and a descending movement of water-spouts, the one being, of course, nearer the middle than the other. In respect to the directions observed, there prevailed some apparent contradictions, but these will be explained in the sequel. Many observers have distinctly seen windings like those of # screw ; and not unfrequently, some of these spiral windings are tuteed right and some of them left, one winding being nearer the middle than the other. Friedrich Rabe, who observed a water- spout in Laaland, saw straw, leaves, and other light objects, raised in spiral windings without the water-spout. Power of Water-Spouts.—The power with which water-spouts act is often very great. 'They have been known to move heavy cannons, and to tear up large trees by their roots. A water-spout has been seen to transport a large tree to a distance of a> fe eet. They sometimes unroof houses, nay, even overthrow the he ae themselves. Beams employed in the support of roofs, have ue carried to a distance of 1400 feet; and entire houses, composed of wood, have been raised up and removed to new positions. On one occasion, a water-spout was seen to roll up moist linen on a bleaching ground, and to transport it, together wit a beam Se Satlly: enveloped in it, the whole weighing upwards of B00,” . , over a house forty feet high, and to a distance of 150° me feet. Objects of little weight are carried to very great distances ; ge ‘On Water-Spouts. 255 thus, a eatin has been known to transport a sewing-bag about seven English miles, and a letter upwards of twenty Eng- _ lish miles. A fish-pond has been emptied by a water-spout, and the fish scattered round its margin. On Christiansée, a water- spout emptied the harbor to such an extent, that the greater por- tion of the bottom was uncovered. But the action is ee, so violent. They have occasionally passed over small vessels without doing them much harm. On land, men have been ear- ried up by them, and yet let down again unbartheat An indi- vidual, who had the curiosity and boldness to follow a water- spout, was involved in one of its spiral windings, but escaped without injury. It is probable that, in some of the cases, where a fall of seeds, animals, and other similar objects from the atmosphere, has been noticed, the phenomenon is to be ascribed to water-spouts. The amoles already given, prove clearly that there is an ele- vating power in water-spouts, and it would be easy to multiply them to a great extent, if we had not, at another part of this essay, to adduce many similar ones for other reasons. I shall here no- tice only one other instance, which is of consequence, from the eare with which it was observed. On the 19th of June, 1835, a great water-spout passed over New Brunswick in North America. Three days afterwards, its effects were carefully investigated by three scientific men, and more especially with reference to the direction of those displays of violent action which had been ex- hibited. Of course, such an investigation could only discover the direction in the immediate vicinity of the earth. The water- spout followed a course from west to east, and traversed a space of about thirty five English miles in less than fifty minutes. It ad that those trees which were overturned in the middle "its course or near it, lay with the tops towards the east, so that th xg = was thus shown of a current of air having the same direction as that taken by the water-spout. On the other hand, those trees which had fallen further out on either side, lay, it is true, with their tops towards the east, but not directly so, being at the same time turned towards the centre of the course of the | Materapotll It was also discovered, that at first, an opposite di- nee, viz. from east to west, must have been Tllonuat at every as >, for rotten and brittle trees, which must have been first “overthrown, lay under the others, and were turned to that direc- a 4 * * ee 256 On Water-Spouts. tion whence the water-spout came. This is easily explained by the supposition that currents of air, near the earth’s surface, move every where towards the centre of that place in which the water- spout is for the moment; whence it follows, that, round the an- terior half of the latter, streams of air must occur in which the east is the prevalent direction, while the western direction is the predominant one in the currents round the posterior half. In some places, where it appeared that the water-spout had receded ‘for some time, and had again descended, it was ascertained, that the overturned trees were turned with distr summits to a com- mon center. Many circumstances also demonstrated to the ob- " crab that a rarefaction of the air in the interior of the water- spout, and one of great extent, had occurred. Not only were — ; roofs and the upper coverings of houses removed, but even floors were broken up; a phenomenon not easily explained, unless we assume that the pressure of the air from without had become very rapidly and greatly diminished, so that the expansive force of the inclosed air must have acquired a very considerable pre- ponderance. Many other effects of this same water-spout con- firm this belief. Walls and windows were often thrown or broken outwards. In one house which had suffered much from the water-spout, a bed cover was pressed into a crack in the wall, and remained as firmly fixed as though it had been intentionally thrust into it; a pocket handkerchief likewise was found in a crack of the oppiaite wall. Those objects which had been trans- ported by the water-spout, were conveyed to the north side, and to a greater or less distance, according to their greater or less weight. Sound and Smell of Water-Spouts. —Water-spouts are often accompanied by a violent noise, which, for the most part, has been compared to the sound of many heavily laden waggons mov- ing over a stone pavement, or to the breaking of the waves of an agitated sea against the coast; but, by some, has been said to resemble the roar of a great waterfall. Besides these great En a whistling or piping sound has not unfrequently been ear Water-spouts often leave behind a sulphureous smell, and there are examples of a disagreeable smell remaining along the whole tract traversed by them. One individual, however, who became — ina aie gael perceived no dor. ~ Sie ee = - On Water-Spouts. 257 Situations and Circumstances in which Water-Spouts occur.— Water-spouts do not oceur with equal frequency in all situations. They are more abundant on the sea than on the land; more fre- quent on coasts than far out at sea, or at a distance in the interior of the dry land; and they have been more often noticed in warm regions than in cold ones. ‘They seem to occur more especially at places where calms frequently alternate with storms. Water-spouts take place for the most part in still weather, and during unsteady winds. In the greater number of instances, storm clouds have been remarked in the sky before their appear- _ ance. Most frequently several occur, either at the same time, or immediately after one another; and often there is observed a hew one forming where another disappeared a short time pre- viously. - ad We seldom read accounts of water-spouts without finding also _ % that electrical phenomena were noticed at the same time. Light- ning is almost never wanting; thunder is likewise often con- nected with them, and it has been remarked that the loud noise which follows water-spouts easily prevents feeble peals of thun- der from being heard. Now and then, a more widely dispersed light has been seen ; so that people imagined that the corn in the fields was on fire, but afterwards to their joyful astonishment found it uninjured. It has been reported of one water-spout that fire balls proceeded from it, of which one was accompanied by a report like that of a musket. Probably, however, in this in- stance, electric sparks caused a deception. Frequently, great storms follow the occurrence of water-spouts ; sometimes they precede them. : _ Water-spouts are often accompanied by hail ; also by rain in large drops either during the period of their occurrence, or shortly afterwards. ‘The pressure of the atmosphere has been very rarely recorded by those who have described this phenomenon. In my notes [ find only one instance of the height of the quicksilver in the barometer being mentioned, and this is in the observation of a water-spout which, on the 16th of June 1775, traversed the neighborhood of the town of Eu. The height of the barometer for three days had been 28 In. 5 L. (=30.28 English,) but fell at 7 o’clock in the morning 24 L. (=.22 English.) At8 o’elock the water-spout made its appearance, and about noon the quick- silver had risen to the same height at which it stood in the morn- Vol. xxxv1, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 33 B\, i at ih = « : 258 On Water-Spouts. ing. This result is sufficiently remarkable to make us desirous of possessing further observations of a similar nature ; but, as I have already said, my notes contain no others; and on referee to the books in my possession, I have found me information on this subject. Formation and Phenomena of Water-Spouts. —In most ac- counts it is stated that water-spouts are formed from above. Some observers, however, expressly say, that they have seen them in the act of being formed from below. Michaud, who in 1789, rved some water-spouts in the harbor of Nice, laid much stress 0 on Re commencement from the surface of the sea ; it will oh Es i: what's is to follow, that this only seems to s from the circumstance that the whirl of wind which fords it, so long at it is not impregnated with va- . por or drops of water is not visible. a When a water-spout begins to be formed over the sea, there is iy to be observed a circular portion of the surface of which w neven, and has a black appearance. © Soon after, the water is _ elevated in the form of a pillar, in which a violent internal move- ment is observable, the height being several fathoms. It foams, and produces drops of water,above, which it scatters in great quantity on all sides, so that it distinctly exhibits an ascending anda ‘descending course, which moves in parabolic curves, like Spring water ascending in a slanting direction. ‘The intérail movement has been compared to boiling, and it has been believ- ed that this idea was corifirmed by the mass of vapor and fog whieh generally floats above the water-spout. De la Nux, how- ever, who, for forty years, lived in the Island Bourbon, where water-spouts are extremely common, maintains that this vapor is only apparent, and that it proceeds from the great number of drops of water spurted about. He also says, that, in order to be convinced of this, it is only necessary to see the phenomenon in a proper light, it would, however, be to bold too assert that this is always the case. It is not impossible that vapors may be formed around the agitated water, if that water possessed jer tem- eee than the air and thus cooled the moisture ¢ alnec n , the nature of the ng ofthe fom Tei ewe ! easily allow to see the beginning of the forma = owe ewe ont Ris. = pe i . ee Ts & On Water-Spouts. : 259 part of a water-spout; and accordingly, I find no data on the subject in the published descriptions. 'The upper part is always described as proceeding asif from a thick cloud. There is often remarked only a very slight increase of size of the cloud, which, however, is gradually extended, and presents the leoutheued funnel-shaped portion. Over the sea, the upper part of the water- spout has been seen to stand far from the place which lay perpen- dicularly over the lower portion, until its line of union approach- ed more nearly tothe perpendicular position. . in. Both on land and water, there has often been seen, in the ur 3 és per part of a water-spout, a thin streak of vapor which seemed . to sink downwards from the cloud, and afterwards maintained ~ itself in the fully developed water-spout. This is most easily _ ~~ at sea, when the lower portion is. generally transpar- Se ent. Such a streak is naturally removed from observation “when * +m “a water-spout is opaque. It was remarked on one oc “4 that it became visible wile a land ee was ae river. We can hardly assunigethat ‘the top of the water-spout is. at that point, where, to the inattentive eye, it appears to lose itself in the clouds. ‘Shortly before the appearance of that water-spout which occurred:in the neighborhood of Eu, it was observed that the clouds separated, and that some went in an opposite direction from the rest, a 1 fact which seemed to indicate a consequent turn- inground. A careful observer, Holm, remarked during a water- spout near Copenhagen, through the openings in the lower strata of clouds, a rotatory movement in those lying above. From the upper portion of the water-spout, there proceeded white x which had a whirling motion like the water-spont itself. When the dissolution of the water-spout approaches, the middle portion, especially that part nearest the earth, becomes more and more transparent. ‘The water-spout gosseally. breaks the middle. The upper Paglen shrinks and disappears in cording to what has been already mentioned, regard- servations of Holm, it is evident, that the clouds, after ns g movement. It was at the same time remarked, t that clouds which formed the upper portion of the ut also the rest at some distance, possessed a cir- 260 On Water-Spouts. On the actual nature of a Water-Spout.—If now, after all this, we ask, what a water-spout really is; the answer would be: it is a whirlwind (Luftwirbel.) By itself, a water-spout is not more visible than air itself, but those portions which are mixed either with vapor, drops of water, or solid matter, become Vis- ible. The source of this vortex is not to be sought in the lower re- gions. There is no peculiarity of the earth’s crust with which the phenomena of water-spouts seems to be connected ; for, they occur in countries of the most diversified constitution, as, for ex- ‘ample, in volcanic, as well as in non-voleanic districts: In the ~ sea also, there seems to be no condition of the water or of the bot- 3 o* tom, on which their occurrence is dependent. Just as little can these vortices be produced by the winds prevailing at the earth’s : “surface, for they take place most frequently in the midst of a se- -. rene atmosphere. They must, therefore, have their origin in the mapper regions. Owing to the sled motion of water-spouts, all the parts ex- it a centrifugal action towards the circumference.’ This force is, as is well known, a necessary consequence of | nature of ro- tatory motion. But any one even who is not acquainted with the laws of circular motion, can form a perfect idea of this matter, by taking a transparent vessel, as for example a flask, filled with a mixture of sand and water, and by some means or other turning it round on a perpendicular axis. The heavier portions will then be observed on the outside, and the lighter in the middle. Those portions which are carried to the greatest distance from the mid- dle, are at the same time upwards; this takes place because the agency which drives them outwards finds a limit at the cireum- ference, which forces the particles that are in motion to ascend, the only direction in which they can yield to the pressure. We may be easily convinced that this action also takes place in the open air, by distributing smoke in the air, from a tobacco pipe for example, and then, at a distance of one or two feet, producing a rapid rotatory movement, when the extension of the whirlwind becomes apparent by means of the smoke. _» Owing to the rotatory motion, the particles in the middle must also have a centrifugal action, and there must thus arise a _ great rarefaction of the air at the centre. So long as the whirl-- wind does not reach the earth, the air must ascend, to fill up the are ry * On Water-Spouts. 261 vacant space which has been left by the particles of air sii. ing outwards. The air must therefore stream in anew from all directions, so that, when it has no particularly great progressive rapidity, those objects which are carried round by it must be di- rected to a common centre; but when the progressive rapidity is great, the influence of both forces on the direction mustbe per- ceptible. The rotatory movement does not affect those currents flowing inwards, inasmuch as it is taken for granted i in this case, that the water-spout, although very near the earth, has not touched it ; for, in the latter case, the centrifugal force would also. drive uit wartls the particles of air near the earth. So fo as the past water-spout does not reach the earth’s surface, an ascending cur- — - rent must prevail in its interior, which here constitutes the ele- * vating power. When it strikes buildings, it may very often happen that the inward flowing currents from below become = either entirely or almost altogether stopped. There thus arises a» great rarefaction of the air around and over the building, so that the included air must drive the windows and walls out wards, and must at the same time force upwards roofs, and other ohigets which have air under them. A tube of the ci formed by the centrifugal force of the % * » A portion ‘of the cloudy mass must hence descend into fhe v vortex. It is naturally the portions near- est the middle which are driven with the greatest force down- wards ; nay, in a certain state of matters, the portions in sinking will be altogether stopped by the centrifugal force. We can easily understand from all this the funnel-like shape of the upper portion of the water-spout. On the other hand, the great atten- uation near the middle, may very easily give rise to the descend- ing stripes of cloud which we so often notice in water-spouts. If the whirl of air is immediately over the sea, the water ‘must ascend under it, partly owing to the rarefaction of the air above it, and partly owing to the air streaming in from all sides. Be- sides, the air contained in the water must get out, and must force itself towards the less filled space above, as always happens when the pressure of the atmosphere is diminished over water, and es- pecially when there is rapid motion. We therefore find that the Water, when the whirlwind approaches, rises up, foams, and is agitated. The greater or less proximity of the vortex must have great influence on the extent of the action. 262 On Water-Spouts. When the whirlwind comes entirely in contact with the sur- face, whether it be on dry land or water, the particles of air must be sent outwards by the centrifugal force, and the currents to- wards the spout must consequently cease. The motion of the air is also communicated to all easily moved solid as well as liquid particles which come in contact with the vortex. They thus ac- quire, not only a movement outwards, but also a movement in- This occurs in the following manner: The circular mo- tion extends itself downwards, and thus throws outwards towards the circumference, solid particles or water, according as the wa- - ter-spout is over land or water; but, on the direct course out- - _ wards, such particles experience great resistance from the sur- rounding mass, so that they must ascend as they retire from the ‘middle. This is shown in the excavation left when the water- spout passes over loose soil, and also by the uncovering of the _ bottom when it traverses shallose water. It cannot be doubted, that a deepening of the sea also takes place, but this cannot be so easily observed. 1 water, the combined movements upwards and outwards can be seen in great perfection, for, round the foot of the water- spout, water is thrown out in parabolic curves ; nay, one observer has remarked water round the base in the Sri of a reversed ba- sin. Upon the whole, it may be said that the water round the base of the water-spout forms a great wreath of elevated water, with a bubbling and foaming surface. - The particles carried up in the water-spout at the same time acquire a spiral motion, owing to the whirling which is combined with it. ‘The falling particles, as, for example, drops, or minute solid substances, which, ere the water-spout reached the earth, had been driven upwards, or de- ¢ A scending rain-drops and hailstones, must also enter windings, which, however, cross the windings already mentioned; for movements which tenimetnding and descending, and hich are directed to one and the same side, must cross each her as ab and ed in the accompanying figure. Hence there are generally two spiral movements in a -transpa- Tent t, one to the right and another to the left. a a on t~ On Water-Spouts. oa 263 It has been said that water-spouts over water are for the most part transparent, because they contain water; but experience proves, as well as the very nature of the thing, that in the inte- rior there is no connected mass of water. It would be more cor- rect to say that water-spouts which come over sea are more rarely opaque, because they can contain no dust, and hence can only be so far opaque that they include numerous minute drops, or, what is most usual, a portion of the fog-like cloudy mass. We can, therefore, easily understand why the lower part of the mid- dle portion of a water-spout becomes generally transparent at last, viz., because the whirling movement becomes weakened, and the | cloud-funnel is hence shortened. an.” We have seen that the air which is immediately above a wa- ter-spout, must descend into that portion of it in which the air is attenuated, and, therefore, in the vicinity of the axis more é€spe- cially. If now, as we suppose, the whirlwind extends upwards, far above the cloudy mass, in which mere observation would as- sign its commencement, the descending air, coming from colder regions, must condense the vapors which it meets with on its path, and partly produce large drops and partly hailstones. We can thus easily imagine that the frozen particles, during all these movements, are sometimes out of contact with warmer and moist air, and also that they are again equally often brought back to situations where they meet them, so that alternately they become so much cooled that the water by which they are coated becomes ice, or they meet moist air in which they acquire a new covering of water. Hence large hailstones may be formed, composed of various layers, the one including the other. All this corresponds in the most remarkable manner with the facts observed. Great storms of hail and violent showers of rain almost invariably accompany water-spouts. It may, perhaps, not be too bold to suppose, that the great falls of hail, which so fre- quently devastate long but narrow tracts of fruitful land, are pro- duced by great air-vortices in the higher regions of the atmos- phere, or, if I may be allowed so to express myself, by water- spouts which extend beyond the lower strata of clouds. . So far as I can judge, no circumstance occurs during great showers of hail, which does not harmonize with this idea. Electricity, which accompanies most hailstorms as well as water-spouts, may perhaps contribute by causing a greater variety of movements " = 264 * On Water-Spouts. than those which arise from vortices, and thus assisting the for- mation of hail, so that Volta’s supposition, that electricity co-op- erates in producing hail, here finds an application ; but we should not wish to see ourselves forced to assume this co-operation, in case the presence of electricity should not show itself so distinctly in all these formations of hail. In the axis of water-spouts, and near it, there must also, with- out doubt, be a portion of watery vapor condensed. From this source, probably, is derived the rain which falls in large drops on ships that encounter water-spouts, and which has been found to consist of fresh water. The water-spout mentioned above, whose effects were so carefully noticed in North America, must also have contained water, as all objects it met with were sprinkled with mould on the west, that is the side from which it came. . When moisture is rapidly condensed, electricity is produced, and we have an opportunity of sheerting this sufficiently well in storms. Hence water-spouts must also be accompanied by thun- der and lightning. By means of the electricity developed in water-spouts, we may, perhaps, explain the power by which, as has been occasionally observed, water-spouts alternately repel and again attract small cloudy masses. That they should be attracted by a different portion from that which repelled them, agrees pre- cisely with the natural laws of electricity. Although we are certain that the formation of water-spouts is lectrical action, yet we are not therefore entitled to conclude that electricity is cheir cause. Distinguished natu- ralists have expressed this opinion, but without explaining the manifold peculiarities of water-spouts. But still, even more re- cently, it has been attempted to explain by this cause their rota- tory movement, by assuming in them, the existence of a strong electrical current, which, by means of the magnetism of the earth, received its circular movement. It appears to me, how- ever, that there is much to contradict this opinion. Although we possess the clearest proofs of the electrical nature of water- _ Spouts, yet it seems to me not at all proved by any of the effects noticed, that they contain an actual electrical current.. Individuals “who have been in contact with water-spouts, never felt an elec~ af se eal shock, or should a shock actually have been experienced in any instance without our being aware of it, yet there have been many cases in which it was not the case, although the human ee ee a ¥ oe On Water-Spouts. a 265 body can neither enter nor quit an “electric current vithent re- ceiving ashock. A decisive argument, in my opinion, which can be opposed to such a view, is, that a water-spout, whose elec- tricity should be of such a description that the magnetism of the earth could communicate a stronger circular movement, must act very violently on the magnetic needle; now this has never been noticed in any one of the numerous vessels which have been in the vicinity of water-spouts. Even though it were to happen that on one occasion the needle should be affected by the approach of a water-spout, still this would by no means afford sufficient proof, for such an electric current as that assumed to exist by the theory must always throw the magnetic needle into considerable agitation. Hence it seems cgiclent, tome that the electricity of. the water-spout as well as that of the thunder storm, is not the cause but the effect of the natural phenomenon. ; The sulphureous smell which has been perceived after a aa ter-spout, would seem to be of the same nature as that remarked after a stroke of lightning. The sound which so often accompanies a Wwater-spout may be produced by the striking together of the hailstones; for this must here be very violent, and, on account of the ceonineiits much more easily heard than the rattling of more remote hail-clouds. The hissing noise must occur when the air is streaming into the water-spout from beneath. The circumstance that many water-spouts are often suspended from one cloud must doubtless be explained in this way, that the cloud is not simple, but contains as many vortices as there are water-spouts exhibited. This agrees also with Holm’s observa- tions made at Stockholm in 1779, when he saw several clouds turned ro’ rape J in one vortex. It is plain that the whirlwind must not protoxide of mercury. This precipitate when ell ( d to constitute a powder capable of fulmin- ate Process for a Fulminating Powder, &c. : 269 Isolation of calcium by the deflagration in a receiver of ditt. cated hydrogen, of the compound Jormed by igniting in a close ves- sel, bieyanide of mercury with pure quick lim By exposing the compound of cyanogen With calcium, ob- tained as above mentioned, either in vacuo or in an atmos- phere of desiccated hydivicen to a current from two hundred | pairs of Cruikshank plates, each comprising 100 square inches of zine surface, the calcium appeared to be isolated. Particles dis- playing fhictallic characteristics under the burnisher, and which - effervesced in water, were observed, while the gas escaping had an odor resembling that of silicurettod hydrogen evolved by silicuret of potassium under like circumstances. Deflagration of phosphuret of calcium.—By exposure of the phosphuret of calcium to the current from the deflagrators, as above described, calcium containing a trace of phosphorus ap- peared to remain. The phospherus was condensed upon the receiver in sufficient quantity to obscure the glass. The residual mass thrown into water effervesced extricating hydrogen slightly phosphoric in its odor. When compounds of carbon with calcium were similarly exposed, the residue had a metallic appearance, but did not decompose water. On one occasion a portion of the charcoal forming the anode was fused into a globule, having the consistency and other char- acteristics of plumbago. It appeared more compact than the globules obtained by us many years since of which ame was forwarded to Dr. Hare at the time. Of Sisk Daniell’s adoption of Dr. Hare's method of. genitine _ gunpowder by galvanic i ignition sobre the summer of 1831, a method of igniting gunpowder anism was contrived by Dr. E suggested by the abortive efforts o name of Shaw, to effect this object by n mechanical. electricity. Of the apparatus desentbet for the ‘purpose in question by Dr. Hare, engravings and descriptions were published in this Journal in n the Autumn of 1833. We advert to these facts now, in consequei of the recent publication of analogous experiments by Prof. eke iell of Kings’ College, who in this case, as well as in that of his “re-invention” of a hydro-oxygen blowpipe of Dr. Hare, was no “doubt ignorant that he had been anticipated. % 270 Boracice Acid Lagoons of Tuscany. In performing his experiments, it would seems that Prof. Dan- iell used his ingenious apparatus, known as the sustaining bat- tery, which, although peculiarly qualified for the production of a durable current, is, as we think, far less competent than the calo- rimotor of Dr. Hare, to produce a transient intense ignition such as would be the most efficacious in igniting gunpowder. Arr. XIL—On the Boracic Acid Lagoons of Tuscany; by Joun Bowrine, LL. D.* Tur borax lagoons of Tuscany are entitled to a detailed de- scription. 'They are unique in Europe, if not in the world ; and their produce is become an article of equal importance to Great Britain as an import, and to Tuscany as an export. They are spread over a surface of about 30 miles, and exhibit from the dis- tance columns of vapor, more or less according to the season of the year and state of the weather, which rise in large volumes among the recesses of the mountains. As you approach the lagoons, the earth seems to pour out boil- ing water as if from volcanos of various sizes, in a variety of soil, but principally of chalk and sand. ‘The heat in the immediate jacency is intolerable, and you are drenched by the vapor, which im es the atmosphere with a strong and somewhat sulphurous smell. 'The whole scene is one of terrible violence and confusion—the noisy outbreak of the boiling element—the rugged and agitated surface—the volumes of vapor—the impreg- nated atmosphere—the rush of waters—among bleak and soli- Boracie Acid Lagoons of Tuscany. 271 cano still bear the name of*Monte Cerboli (Mons Cerberi). The peasantry never passed by the spot without terror, counting their beads, and praying for the protection of the Virgin. The borax lagoons have been brought into their present profit- able action within avery few years. Scattered over an exten- sive district, they are become the property of an active individ- ual, M. Larderel, to whom they are a source of wealth, more valuable perhaps, and certainly less capricious, than any mine of silver that Mexico or Peru possesses. The process of manufac- ture is simple, and is effected by those instruments which the lo- calities themselves present. . The soffioni, or vapors, break forth violently in different parts of the mountain recesses. ‘They only produce boracie acid when they burst with a fierce explosion. In these spots artificial lagoons are formed by the introduction of the mountain streams. ‘The hot vapor keeps the water perpetually in ebullition ; and after it has received its impregnation du- ring twenty four hours at the most elevated lagoon, the contents are allowed to descend to the second lagoon, where a second im- pregnation takes place, and then to the third, and so forth, till it reaches the lowest receptacle ; and having thus passed through from six to eight lagoons, it has gathered one half per cent. of the boracic acid. It is then transferred to the reservoirs, from whence, after a few hours rest, it is conveyed to the evaporating pans, where the hot vapor concentrates the strength of the acid by passing under shallow leaden vessels from the boiling fountains above, which is quite at a heat of 80° of Reaumur,* and is dis- charged at a heat of 60° There are from ten to twenty pans, in each of which the concentration becomes greater at every de- scent till it passes to the crystallizing vessels, from whence it is carried to the drying rooms, where, after two or three hours, it becomes ready to be packed for exportation. — ~ The number of establishments is nine.{ The whole amount produced varies from 7000 to 8000 pounds (of 12 ounces) per day. The produce does not appear susceptible of much exten- sion, as the whole of the water is turned to account ; the atmos- phere has, however, some influence on the result. In brigh and * The boiling point. ‘ + 167° of Fahrenheit. t The principal are Monte Cerboli, Monte Rotondo, Susso, Serazzono and Cas- Pe “ telnuovo, . oe i ee a ; 7 a we a os er rt be 272 Boracie Acid Lagoons of Tuscany. clear weather, whether in winter or summer, the vapors are less dense, but the depositions of boracic acid in the lagoons are infallible barometers to the neighborhood, even ata great dis- tance, serving to regulate the proceedings of the peasantry in their agricultural pursuits. It had been long supposed that the boracie acid was not to be found in the vapors of the lagoons ; and when it is seen how small the proportion of acid must origifially be, it will not be wondered at that its presence should have escaped attention. In the lowest of the lagoons, after five, six, and in some cases a greater number of impregnations, the gannnsy of boracic acid given out does not exceed one half per cent. ; thus if the pro- duce be estimated at 750U pounds per day, the quantity of sat- urated water daily discharged is a million and a half of Tuscan pounds, or five hundred tons English. The lagoons are ordinarily excavated by the mountaineers of Lombardy, who emigrate into Tuscany during the winter season, when their native Apennines are covered with snow. They gain about one Tuscan lira per day. But the works are con-_ ducted, when in operation, by natives, all of whom are mar- ried, and who occupy houses attached to the evaporating pans. They wear a common uniform, and their health is generally good. A great improvement in the cultivation, and a great increase n the value of the neighboring soil, has naturally ee the i unt th ic acid. A rise of labor ; much land irections given to the streams of smaller rivers. Before the bone lakes were turned to profitable account, their fetid smell, their frightful appearance, agitating the earth around them by the ceaseless explosions of boiling water, and not less the terrors with which superstition invested them,* made the lagoons themselves to be ss san as So unwilling were the peasants to settle in these abe that very extraordi- nary Race ments were —. out to them. In = commune of Monte Cerboli, je small to promise 3 3 ‘Vol. xxxvui, No. 2—July—October, 1839. 35 Boracic Acid Lagoons of Tuscany. 273 public nuisances, and gave to the surrounding country a charac- ter which alienated all attempts at improvement. Nor were the lagoons without real and positive dangers, foe the loss of life was certain where man or beast had the misfor- tune to fall into any of those boiling baths. Cases frequently occurred in which cattle perished ; and one chemist, of consid- erable eminence, met with a horrible death by being precipitated into one of the lagoons. Legs were not unfrequently lost by a false step into the smaller pits (putizze), where, before the foot could be withdrawn, the flesh would be separated from the bone. That these lagoons, now a source of immense revenue, should have remained for ages unproductive ; that they should have been so frequently visited by scientific men, to none of whom. (for ages at least) did the thought occur that they contained in them mines of wealth, is a curious phenomenon ; nor is it less remarkable, that it was left fora man, whose name and occupa- tion are wholly disassociated from science, to convert these fugi- tive vapors into substantial wealth. Though to the present proprietor (the Chevalier Larderel*) the merit attaches of having given to the boracic lagoons the im- mense importance they now , a succession of adventurers had made many experiments, and had produced a considerable uantity of boracic acid, but at a cost (from the expenditure of combustible) which left but little profit.+ The small value that was attached to them may be seen in the fact, that the largest and most productive district of the lagoons, that of Monte Cerboli, ground- rent of £T. 2002. ‘or Bl. 13s. 4d. per annum, though it now pro- the ercant, who leaves fallow zing teniba of the land. In the district of “Ripar- bella the landlords and cultiv come to a sensible pe ste emt by appor- tioning the lands in equal moie etie, Many mineral waters are in ihe neighborhood of the lagoons, some of which possess medical virtues, and are visited by the Tuscans in the bathing season. * While these sheets have been passing through the press the Grand Duke of Tuscany has conferred on M. Larderel the title of Count de Pomerance. © _» ¢ Hoefer first announced the presence of boracic acid in the Maremman analia and Mascagni in his Commentaries suggests the manufacture of borax as an object worthy of attention. Professor Gazzeri in 1807, made experiments, which how- r seemed to show that the quantity of boracic acid contained in the waters was id e much success. aa ‘Tuscany. aes at te Set RN Q7A ic Acid Lagoons of Tuscany. | . was duces several Metcarid pounds ~- gees The immense increase in their value arose from the e simplest of improvements, the abandonment of the use of charcoal, and the application of the heat of the lagoons or soffioni to the evaporation of their own wa- ters. Improvements, however, and very important ones, particu- larly by subjecting the waters to a succession of maess- had been gradually introduced by a Signor Ciaschi, and the portation of boracic acid from Tuscany into France, before 1817, had been between 7000 and 8000 pounds, of a quality gradually increasing in purity: but Ciaschi perished miserably, in conse- quence of falling into one of the lagoons which he himself had excavated, leaving his family in a state of extreme poverty. His death (which happened in 1816) naturally threw a damp upon adventure. The experiments were resumed in the following year, and in the midst of violent claims and controversies, M. Lar derel has become the monopolist of the boracic productions of - With the increased productions of boracic acid has arisen an increased demand, growing out of the more extensive application — of it to manufacturing purposes. In about four years the quan- tity has been quadrupled by superior modes of extraction, and by greater care employed in the collection of the boracic vapor. Igy 3 1833 about 650,000 Tuscan pounds were obtained, in 1836 two” a millions and a half. va But it appears itis the powers and riches of these extra- "pags pares: districts remain yet to be fully developed. They exhibit an immense number of mighty steam-engines, furnished by na- e at no cost, and applicable to the production of an infinite va- y of o bjects. In the progress of time this vast machinery of =) force will probably become the moving central point of * “extensive manufacturing estalishments. The steam, which has “been so ingeniously applied to the concentration and evaporation of the boracic acid, will probably hereafter, instead of wasting itself in the air, be employed to move huge engines, which will be directed to the infinite variety of production which engages the attention of laboring and intelligent artisans; and thus, in the ~ urse of time, there can be little doubt, that diese lagoons, which 2 fled from as objects of danger and terror by uninstructed ill gather round them a large intelligent population, and es of prosperity to innumerable individuals through es ia 4 +. io nit hit a i # % me en Ie power, but does not afford so delicate a test of weak 1 Magneio-Electric Multiplier. — 275 eee ker ; ;. by Caries G. Pace, Arr. XII.—Magneto-Electrie Mu M. D. Washington City, D. C. electric power of an electro-magnet. The instrument oes repre- ° sented —— 1,) was invented about the same time with the former, Fig. 1. $ Ts Do. . mS ae, se previous adjustment much, until it indicated nearly the . pees “These processes were stiecessively repeated, until the errors, saving such as result from the imperfection of the circles, were fou und, upon making all possible reversions, to be Se: than the frebable errors of observation. : ‘This method may be pS bin tiga in is fina increase the liability of the adjustments to deran at. The value of the process results from the difficulty of re ing manufactured and tempered steel devoid of magenetism. — correctness of principle is obvious from the impossibility of cor- rect indications in two different positions of the needle, except ~ when the centre of gravity coinciding with the axis of motion, the influence of this force becomes nothing in all cases. making these adjustments, it is better that the magnetism be of feeble intensity, provided that it be sufficient to overcome 278 Experiments on the Vibrations of Pendulums. inertia and friction, as, in this case, the influence of any other force is more obvious. Any two different planes or even the same might be employed by a little modification of the process, but those specified are most eligible, as in them the forces affect- ins the position of the needle Sts the greatest disparity. . Ship Independence, Jan. 28, 1 ot Deine at 2 Arr. XIV.—Results of Experiments on the Vibrations of Pendu- lums, with different suspending springs; being the substance of a paper by W. J. Frovsuaw, F. R. S., read before the Royal Society, June 21, 1838. Forwarded for inbertion in this Journal. Tne experiments of which I am about to give an account, and from which I propose to draw some practical conclusions, were ~ undertaken with a view to determine whether some particular » condition of the suspending spring of the pendulum, with respect ? sither to its length, its strength, or both, might not cause it, with - Eos lighter maintaining power, to produce a given are of vibration, or, with a given maintaining power, to produce a greater arc of vibration than any other; and at the same time to ascertain ™ whether some practical means might not be devised for making ~ unequal arcs of vibration in the ordinary pendulum, correspond to equal intervals of time. My attention was drawn to the subject many years ago, when, having replaced the spring of a turret-clock by a stronger one, I ' found the arc of vibration materially altered. + = Having often reflected upon the subject, I at length resolved to ie ut fourteen pounds weight, a cylindrical rod passing through —- a with a nut working on a screw at the lower end, and support- - ing the bob. __ The upper end of the rod was slit to receive the spring ; and the spring and the rod were attached to each other by a pin pass- ing through a hole in both. But before fixing the pin, what I call an isochronal piece was slid over the top of the rod, and if this part of the apparatus had served ‘only to attach the rod sid spring miore firmly together, and prevent any ‘wavering, motion of the pendulum, it would have rendered ey ee 4 Experiments on the Vibrations of Pendulums. 279 an important service. ene however, was but a secondary and incidental effect of its application. The piece, which I have so named, is a brass tube about five inches long, fitting the pendulum rod very nicely, and slit to form a spring for about an inch at the bottom, so as to slide rather stiffly on the rod. At the upper end of the tube is a clip, which is made to embrace the suspending spring firmly by means of two screws; so that after the pendulum has been brought to the proper length by the adjusting nut at the lower end of the rod, the length of the acting part of the suspending spring may be va- ried at pleasure, fithout in the least altering the length of the pendulum, by merely sliding the isochronal piece up or down the rod, and tightening the screws of the clip. I also provided five springs of different degrees of strength, and a silken string, by which, in the first experiments, the pendulum was suspended. aG5 SP af ‘The pendulum used was an uncompensated one, but in eacl ey experiment it was adjusted to nearly the proper length for meat time. ni ; Commencing with the silken thread, or rather two parallel threads, one behind the other, I suspend the pendulum within the case of a clock, perfectly detached from the works, no main- taining power being applied. Each degree of the scale on which the ares of vibration were noted, was nearly ‘8 of an inch in length, and a degree was sub- dlivided into twenty equal parts. I drew the bob aside 2°, and leaving it to vibrate by its own gravity, I found the are of vibration was reduced from 2° to 1°, 2 q and from 1° to 4°, in the times noted as under :— Z . Are of vibration from 2° to 1° in a =e ek C3 7 Do. do. to $ ee On repeating the experiment, the results were :— a es Are of vibration from = to 1° in 21m. Os. Do. to 4 24m. Os. Drawing the pendulum aside 1°, I found from five successive trials that the arc of vibration was reduced to half a degree in the times following :— * Ye Sg SS Hegde eS? ss . The mean of the two preced Neg eS tied 12s. The difference may be saielibtadily accounted for, by the difficulty of setting off the pendulum at the precise point intended, and of noting the time when the are is diminished to the propo- sed quantity. It is apparent from these experiments, that when a pendulum is freely suspended, and left to vibrate from its own gravity, the arc of vibration is sooner reduced from 2° to 1°, than from 1° to $°, as might indeed be anticipated from the increased resistance “7 _ experienced by the bob, while moving through a greater space in the same time. TL attached the pendulum, suspended as before, to a clock, with a maintaining power of 6lb. 80z., but the clock stopped in 39 minutes; and setting it off again, it stopped in 43 minutes; but on applying a weight of 6lb. 11oz., thus showing that a weight of 6lb. 1loz. was sufiicient to keep the pendulum in vibration, while one only 3o0z. lighter was not. preceding experiments being The arcs of vibration in - smaller than is desirable in with heavier weights, the pendulum being still sus; the clock continued to go; stice, I proceeded. to experiment ed by the parallel silk threads, noting in each case the are of vibration and the rate of the clock, viz., its gain or loss in 24 hours. In the following experiments each succeeding pair is to be con- sidered as giving the results for two consecutive days, though more than one day occasionally elapsed between the times at which the sets were taken. Are of Vibration. 3’ Weight. 141b 14 8 11 8 = 19 oor Nn oom a We mW wring 30 ae Pe ee ee Se ea : ee, See ze = oa * a hs “= i 2 Pa Experiments } the Vibrations of Pendulums. 281 4 5 + a wast hence appears, that rite a pendulum is suspended by a ~“fexible string, a heavier weight and a consequent greater are of vibration, causes the clock to lose. The folloging are the dimensions of the springs which were experimen ith :— Number. _ Phickness. 1 3 = 001 inch. 2 BO FS 002 3 - 396 .--. - 003 4 - 395 - - “004 5 - “400 - - 005 The pendulum being suspended by the weakest spring, No. 1, the times were noted as before, in which the arcs of vibisitiend were reduced from 2° to 1°, and from 1° to $°, no maintaining power being applied. Are reduced from 2° to 1° in ih. 58m. i Do. do. 1 57 a Do. 1 tog z 3&8 ; Do. do. ¥ 2 10 With the same spring, and a maintaining power of 4lb. loz. and 2b. 2oz., the following arcs of vibration and rate of the clock resulted fous two consecutive days, the effective length of the spring being -92 inches. Weig re Rate Alb. loz a ee — 9s. 6 2 2 I 30 -—6 ‘1 The pendulum being suspended with spring No. 2, and clipped at ‘92 inch, without maintaining power, the ares of vibration were reduced as follows :— From 2° to 1° in 2h. 20m. Os. Do 2 —1—2 20 44 Do 1—4 —2 26 0 Applying Alb. loz. and 2lb. 20z. in succession, as a maintain- ing power, I found as under :-— xt = Weight. Are. Rate. ; _ Alb. 1oz go — Os. A pcooecag 42 5 “xxvHn, 1, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 36 With spring No. 3, dnd adeatennt r results were obtained on two consecutive cats Weight. res Rate Alb. loz wy 2° 1S aye; eee 29 Figt 39 3 ge Reducing the effective length of the spring to ‘80 inch, the fol- lowing results were obtained on consecutive days :— Weight. Arc. Rate Alb. loz ae os: .0 ‘ ae | 1 30 0: 4 1 %-9 —0 5 | 1 30 —-0:.2 . Hai 4 eats —0 2 Hence, with either of these lengths of this spring, the rate does not appear to be perceptibly influenced by the extent of the arcs of vibration. In fact, the vibrations of the pendulum may, for all _ practical parrot be considered as isochronous. ‘The effective length of the spring was then increased to ‘92 inch, and the following results were noted, without maintaining power :— Arc reduced from 2° to 1° in 2h. 26m. Os. 25 45 Do. do. Do. do, Sa ee ae Oe Do. do. a D.. .9°°85 . 40 On three other occasions, with the same spring, and effective length, ‘92 inch, the following comparative results were ob- tained :-— Weight. re. Rate Alb. loz 2° 15/ —As. ‘0 2 1. 39 — 1 a ie 2 15 —5 0 2 2 1 39 —§ 2 . L 2 15 —§ 0 1 2.15 —65 of a that even ‘eith different songihe of this springs . the | selma ap be considere red as:isochron ferent arc 1 Applying maintaining power of 4lb. loz. and 2Ib. 2oz. respec- tively, with -97 inch effective length of the following results were noted :— Weight. Are, Rate. Alb. loz. e ¢ —2s. ‘2 2 2 1 30 +1 2 Even with this comparatively stiff spring, the arc of vibration is greater with a maintaining power of Alb. loz., than it was with 14lb. 60z., when the pendulum was suspended by two parallel silk threads, But the rate appears to vary more with the arc of vibration, than it did when No. 3 was used. Redacine the length of this spring to -66 inch, the following results were obtained :— Weight. ; Alb. loz. 90° ‘3 is. ‘1 z: .2 «4 —11 ‘5 eAliding up the isochronal piece still further, till the length of the effective part of the spring was reduced to ‘50 inch, the fol- lowing were the results : Weight. Are. Rate. Alb. loz. eee 3 —18s. ‘0 B23 5 ee —14 5 This further horining of the spring appears to haved had a per- _ ceptible effect on the are of vibration, sang Ahe lighter weight was applied. I lastly attached the strongest spring, No. 5, ‘and witty edfoctive & Rate. : wait san ue te - > = , 284 | Experiments on the Frat f Pts = 5 _ Weight. : os “6b. 30Zz. ~ _ “ts ‘6 7 ae —12 A Sliding up the isochronal piece still further, till the length of the effective part of the spring was reduced to ‘50 inch, the fol- lowing were the results: Weight. Rate. Alb. 130z. — 12s. 0 2 2 10 we 8, :42 5 oe The lighter weight, 2lb. 20z. employed on experimenting with the weaker springs, was found insufficient to keep the pendulum in vibration with No. 5; 2ib. 100z. was found adequate to the purpose, and it was thorelSre employed. In experimenting with this spring, the arcs of vibration were not noted, as I found that both it and No. 4 were too strong for the weight of the bob I was using, and to which the experiments indicate that No. 3 was excellently adapted. e arc of vibration with the spring, No. 3, (viz. 2° 15’) using a weight of Alb. loz., required 19lb. weight to produce it when the pendulum was suspended by the silken threads. It appears then, from the preceding experiments on suspending springs differing in length and strength, that there is one which, with a given maintaining power, produces a greater arc of vibra- tion than others, and gives the same arc to vibration with a smaller maintaining power; and, further, that with this same spring the vibrations may, in point of time, be all considered as isochronous, whether the arcs are large or small. And with the aid of the isochronal piece, a spring of the proper length and thickess may easily be selected in a very few trials. It may be noticed too, that unless the pendulum is first isoch- ronized by some such method as that which has been pointed out, anamalies may be imputed to imperfect compensation, which have their origin in a very different source. In fine, it may be stated in conclusion, that if the pendulums of astronomical clocks were furnished with what I have called an isochronal piece, any person possessing a few springs of different a, of strength, may with very little difficulty determine ee is best adapted to the weight of the pendulum, and wt of the spring may be most advantageously em-— Ne he in action ; ; and I shall not think that the attention es 2 me See oe" : rig ps oe I have given to this Bs has hin misspent, if any thing that I have done may contribute to the advancement of an art to which I have been professionally devoted during the whole of my life. * London, March, 1839. ~ V.—On Coins and Medals, with a notice of the Medal has been recently struck to commemorate the settlement Be New Haven, Connecticut. Communicated at the request of the editors, by Mr. Joun Attan of New York. As to the question, at what period of the world the study of coins and medals commenced, or at what precise time they were first fabricated, we are ignorant, although several writers have endeavored to trace their origin to a very remote antiquity. The states of Italy were the first, after the revival of literature and the fine arts, to commence the study and striking of coins and medals; and the modern governments of Europe have all, more or less, followed their example. = Medals have been admired by many of the wisest and best of -. ancient and modern times; by Pliny, z , Petrarch, Cambden, _ . Selden, and others; for they have beauties inherently theirown, <: which eis founded on the immutable principles of human na- os ture, must ever afford delight to the human mind. "i Novelty, beauty and sublimity are the three great sources of moral and intellectual pleasure, and the incitements to these are well supplied by medals, They display the usages of society, and the habits and forms of persons, with whom history having made us acquainted, we “ to see the faces on which their minds and characters were 4 impressed. From a similar feeling we are delighted - aie, the — exhibition of the battles, edifices, religious rites, innumerable other interesting circumstances belonging to the : age, or illustrating the characters and actions of eminent individuals. Hence Greece and Rome, the noblest states in ancient times were most distinguished for their attachment to, and - production of coins and medals. A vast number of these have been spared by the destroyer time, to attest the pains and success with which - they were executed, thus evicning the high importance attached n in those ages, not only as commemorating passing 286 On Coins and Medals. events, but as gratifying the ardent wish of posterity, to look ck into remote times, and thus to obtain the most important aids to history. No adequate conception can be formed by persons who have paid no attention to the subject, how highly subservient medals may be made to the gratification of private taste, to the perpetua- tion of the memory of objects of personal history, of domestic en- dearment, and individual honor ; to the illustration of the success ccess. of well laid plans of public samc to the commer D marriages and births, to perpetuating the knowledge of new in ventions, and of the memory of.men eminent for ie Sind * talent, and for public as well as private virtues As medals are the least petishable of all the materials upon which the artist displays his powers, they continue current. on the tide of time when the productions of all other arts have sunk into oblivion. A desire to possess modern as well as ancient medals exists, at present, in the most distinguished academies, and among individ- uals of all enligtened countries: medals are eagerly sought for 4a. po bli ibraries, and museums, and governments employ the mint = - in striking medals and coins to heighten the splendor of the exist- Be: ing administration and to extend and perpetuate their civil and oid mili renown. . nother source of pleasure and amusement which attends t ae study of medals, is the finish and beauty displayed in their wo' tail We have already remarked that the statis of Italy were the first after the revival of literature to commence the study and striking of medals. 2 ed The. papal medals form a magnificent series. Germany pos- sesses many cabinets of coins and medals and many books which have been, written on the subject in that country. Russi Sweden have each a series of medals in honor of national -victories. Holland has a similar series, commemo- rating her struggles for liberty, and her final emancipation from the Spanish yoke. France has an immense national collection. land, till lately, was behind the continent in her medallic his- 8 sharal fine medals were struck by the celebrated Simon, — ‘in Gromwell’ time ; and a very excellent series by Crocker to te the victories of Bench 2 in the Se of Queen Ann. 1d + * 4 un (ut ~ On Coins and Medals. 287 A series of English sovereigns was engraved and struck by Dassin, a native of Geneva, in the reign of George the first— and recetitly.2 an additional series consisting of forty, has been struck to commemorate the national achievements during the late war with France, and the powers on the continent. But many elegant private medals of individuals in Britain have been executed ; of men who have been eminent in various walks of 4 struck ; j* but where is the medal in honor of Fulton ?—where is that in ‘hélior of Whitney? The most distinguished collection of medals of the present day, is the Napoleon series of one hundred and sixty, commem- orating the civil and military actions of that extraordinary man ; they were done chiefly from the designs, and under the disaiétion of the celebrated Denon. Most of them are beautiful in design and execution, and unequalled by any of modern times. Several medals were struck at Paris to commemorate ines aS American revolution. Congress, some years since, made an a propriation to have the whole series placed in the national li at Washington ; the vessel that had them in charge (if I recolect as right) was lost, and whether any further action has neon any progress since made, I am ignorant. “Aeae J gis : ~ A medal was struck on Commodore Truxton’s victory, _& another on the war with Tripoli under Commodore Preble. _ Medals also were struck by order of Congress, to carry down to posterity the naval victories of the United States, in the late war baa Papier se ‘Britain. In 1817, a medal was struck to commemo- he union of Lake Erie with the Atlantic, by the great canal. _ Since that time, no medals worthy of commemoration have been executed either by individuals, or any of th te of the United States, till lately, New Haven in the s : necticut, has taken the lead, and on the return of the se cond tennial anniversary of the founding of the colony by Eaton and Davenport, has had a medal engraved and struck to commemorate the first settlement of the City. 'The medal does honor to Fg th the designer and engraver, as well as to those. patriotic citiz New Haven, at whose instance it was done. é om je e ~— ie * The writer has one. ae *% < Ce . 5 —— . ae SS On Coins and Medals. . a ‘ = On the obverse i is a view of the place New Haven now ; stands, 2 as it ‘was in April, 1638, with e band o pilgrim settlers ~~ under a tree, listening to a sermon the first ‘Sabbath in the wilderness, from the Rev. John —— ‘their oe while the npreings on the opposite a bi rd’s eye view of the publie: ‘square 2 OF re r > of the poh with the different churches, es ee: desert shall rejoi “New euiis town and some the deo ia ‘may every = Re: s.—An eminent artist has pronounced that this medal ‘is th the best hitherto executed in this country. 1 has been struck - both i in bronze and in silver. The medal is‘ es in diame- : ex ter; the silver $ inch thick; the bronze 7 inch thick. ‘The “kin r medal weighs 1 oz. all seventeen and a half pwts., and sells . dollars. The bronze 3 oz. and two pwts., and sells ~~ for three dollars.» The impression of the medal isin high relief, ey : S most minute lines are exceedingly sharp and well defined. . The omens and manner and even the features of the pilgrims. are highly characteristic and illustrate the humble beginning of this now large and. beautiful town. The numerous objects aa together to indicate its present prosperity, although on @ crowded field, are perfectly distinct; the architecture of the ee buildings is so exactly copied that they are gene re- cognized by an eye that is familiar with them, and the t foliage of this city of groves, is. gracefully displayed among its Squares and temples. This medal* was designed by Mr. Heze- kiah Augur, the well known sculptor, with the advice of Mr. Ithiel Town, and by ten executed in New York, by Mr. John ttle: aes Sy egret ne —— bo ry; = ro ‘sale at the bookstore of Young & Ulhorn. Fora very interesting account rise and progress of the colony, see Prof. Kingsley’s excellent historical dis- =— volume of historical sermons—of deep interest—by the Rev. Leon- 2 % aa - — as res tv rit ula by Po ogge: timation of 1 different bases in hese ormule are sufficiently exact, but probably not as. simple « or - comprehensive as might be desired. He alludes also to one annexed by the French t ansl: . Analysis. of i inorganic bodies ,’ by Berzelius yee lo 1 principles which it Ausiecs, I cannot suppose it pond claim to novelty, I have never seen proposed for this a ect, If you to find the ee a ; e or bul cof each base, by having given the specific _ gravity ioe each ingredient together with the specific gravity of _ Re mixture and its weight. Now since the specific gravities of each base or ingredient of the mixture are supposed to be known ~ in most if not all cases, all that is necessary will be to determine 9 finc 7 Let A=sp. gr. of one in- t, B=sp. gr. of the other, and C=sp. gr. “of mixture. Let = i and x and its of . the bases : then it is evident ee a 5tEt tae a a eres These eae aaa ae : | : c= —— and yan BC + ee xe ~ AG-BC AC—BG Multiply these fractions by the number expressing the wei cht of the mixture, and we have the weight of each base or ingredi- Vor, xxxvu, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 37 bd : —— 2 ee 290 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. ent; and as the volumes are inversely as the ‘specific gravities thoy are found by dividing the weights by the Sp. gr. of each. We give as an example the mixture of oxygen and azote in Sait air. = —1.1111—1.1111 x.9722. __ 309 es ——"Tiii11—.9722 7389 = proportional weight of — oxygen. e _ Likitx 9722. .9722 1080 L.111i~ 9g? «ais Azote. o % Now since 100 cubic inches of air weigl ee 22: 23, dof azote 77.77, desde: these fas the S] eA and it willbe found that the volume per cent. ‘o that of oxygen 20.2 nearly, which corresponds result of the most rigid and careful experiments. _ need sca ireely remark that this formula applic? ora: in cases where the specific gravities are determined by the same standard comparison, although in every case they may be reduced to the same by an easy mathematical ——— Liberty Co., Geo., Aug. 15th, 1 ye : Arr. XVIL—Abstract of a Monograph of the Genus Sciurus, with descriptions of several new species and varieties; by ag J. Bacuman, D. D., President of the Lit. and Phil. Soc. of * Charleston, S. C.* Many of the species of this very widely diffused genus are, through the influence of climate and other alterative causes, subject to remarkable variations, which have proved a fruit- ful source of error in oe the specific forms of oe ‘as inhabit the Old World From the vastness of the territory over which ‘they are ‘dis. persed, still greater difficulties have presented themselves in de- seribing and separating the species of Sciuri peculiar to our own continent. ‘Their anatomy and habits through the whole genus, Present striking similarities, while on the other hand differences bolas as povarkable both in size, color and habit, are observable : * Abridged from Mag. of Nat. Hist. for March, 1839, et seq. _. Monograph of the boy Sciurus. 291 among varieties of the sar certainty, and the too slight atte ists have hitherto given to their elucidation, all our on age MO 4 nographs remain all more or less erroneous. +s The task of ageccond these deficiences, and adding to our “s former knowledge of the genus, has not been undertaken by me rT Many hundred specimens from various parts of North America have been carefully ined and com- : to procure hares of all the spe- exception, (S. macrourus, Say) and this latter I jortunity of examining in the collection: of the scree seum. » Many species, no doubt, remain as yet nindisoveaees Louis- jana, with the countries bordering upon Texas and Mexico, may hereafter : reward the quest of naturalists with many ew and in- teresting : — ge) ~~ SERS “Onder RODENTIA. eee, Genus Sciurus, Linn., Cuvier, etc. if ae Dental formula—Incis. 2 Can. 9° Gr. 44 or 28 —20 or 22. — Srrecies—Capistratus. Fox Squrrret. S. capistratus ; Bosc, ‘ Ann. du Museum,’ v. i. p. 281. 8. vulpinus? Linn. Ed. Gmelini, 1788. S. niger; Catesby. “ae Black squirrel ; Bartram’s Travels. ad: S. capistratus ; Desm. Mammalogie, p. 332. S. variegatus ; Desm. idem, p. 333. S. capistratus; C. ‘Regne An.’ v. i. p. 193. ‘Fox squirrel ; Lawson’s Carolina, P- 124. S. vulpinus ; Godman. Eissenr. cHar. Size large; tail longer than the body ; hair coarse ; ears and nose white ; subject to great varieties in color. Dental formula. In. 2. Can. 28. Grind. 44,—20, General description. . Forehead slightly arched; whiskers black, longer than the head; hair very coarse, appearing in some specimens geniculate ; tail broad and distichous; body strong and heavy. Var. griseus, nose, ears, feet and belly white; fore- 292 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. head and cheeks brownish black ; hairs of the back, plumbeous at the roots, then cinereous, then black, with white lips ; hairs of the tail white with a ring of black three fourths of the way from roots. General hue light grey, with occasional black hairs - interspersed mostly on the neck and shoulders. This is the va- riety called by Bosc, 8S. capistratus. Var. niger. (S. niger. Cates. and Bartram.) Nose and ears white, with a few light colored hairs on the feet. Body and tail black. Var. griseo-nigricans. Nose, mouth, under-jaw and ears white ; head, thighs, and beneath, black. Desm. Encye. Method. Mam. 333. A fourth variety is common.in Alabama; sometimes also seen in South Carolina. Of this, the head and neck are black ; the ears and nose white ; back, dark rusty brown; neck, thighs, and beneath, bright ferruginous ; tail annulated with black and red. The color of the young does not always correspond with that of the parent of the same sex. Thus the male parent of a : black color, may produce young of the same sex which are grey. and vice versa. Dimensions of the Fox Squirrel. In. Lines. Length of head and body, - 3 = = “of tail, (vertebre, ) - “ - = 12 4 ‘of palm, and middle foreclaw, - - 1 9 ss of sole and middle hind claw, - - 22 “of fur on back, — - - - - - “ s Height of ear posteriorly, - ~ é . mee’ Geographical distribution and habits.—Exists sparingly in New Jersey ; not observable in the mountainous districts of Vir- ginia. In the pine forests of the Carolinas, it is a common inhab- itant. Found also in Florida and Alabama. The fox squirrel prefers high and thinly wooded pine ridges, and frequently resorts to the vicinities of rich valleys for the nuts, acorns, and chinka- pins, Castanea pumila, which such soils produce. The nest is commonly a hollow oak, through the thin decayed trunk of which it either gnaws with its teeth a sufficient cavity, or occupies the deserted hole of the ivory-billed woodpecker. (Picus. principalis.) “The summer duck too is frequently a competitor for the same residence idenc: '; Contests for possession occasionally take place between these = Species, and I have generally observed, that the tenant that sai Piste a Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 293 has already deposited its eggs. or young in such situations is seldom ejected. The male and summer duck unite in chasing and beating with their wings any squirrel that may approach their nests, nor are they idle with their bills and tongues, but continue biting, his- sing, and flapping their wings until the intruder is expelled. On the © other hand, when the squirrel = its young in the hole of a tree, = and is awnded on either by a woodpecker or a summer duck, it im-- mediately rushes to its hole, and aa having entered, remains at the | mouth of it, occasionally protruding its head, and ee. ey and angry bark keeps possession until the intruder, weary of the contest, leaves it unmolested. ‘Thus, nature imparts to each species additional spirit and in defence of its young ; whilst at the same time the intruder on the possession of others, as if conscious of the injustice of his acts, evinces a peer of pusillanimity and cowardice. “In the vicinity of this permanent residence of the fox squirrel, several nests, composed of sticks, leaves and mosses, are usually seen on the pine es. These are seldom placed on the summits, but in the fork of a a tree, and more frequently where several. branches unite to afford a. resting- & place to these nests. This may be called their summer home, fo tseems to be occupied only in fine weather, and is deserted during wintry and stormy seasons.’ The breeding season is in December and January, and the young are feecbaity produced as early as the first of March. The nests containing young, as often as I have observed them, were always found in the hollow of decayed trees. They appear to bring forth young but once during the year. “The food of this species is various; besides acorns and the different kinds of nuts, its principal subsistence for many weeks in autumn is on ‘the fruit extracted from the cones of the pine, especially that of our long- leaved pitch pine (Pinus palustris.) Whilst the green corn is yet in its milky state, the fox squirrel s long journeys to visit the fields, and for the sake of convenience fr y builds a temporary summer-house in the vicinity, in order to share with the little Carolina squirrel and the crow a portion of the delicacies and treasures of the husbandman ; where he is also exposed to the risks incurred by the thief and plunderer ; for these fields are usually guarded by a gunner, and in this way thou- sands of squirrels are destroyed during the green corn season. It is doubtful whether the fox squirrel lays up any winter stores. There ap- pears to be no food in any of his nests, nor does he, like the red squirrel (Sciurus.Hudsonius) resort to any hoards which, in the season of abund- ance, were buried in the earth or concealed under logs and leaves. Dur- ing this season he leaves his retreat but seldom, and then only for a short 294 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. time, and in fine weather in the middle of the day. He has evidently the power, like the marmot and racoon, of being sustained for a consid- erable length of time, without much suffering, in the absence of food. When this animal makes his appearance in the winter, he is seen search- ing among the leaves where the wild turkey has been busy at work, and gleaning the refuse acorns which have escaped his search; at such times also this species does not reject worms and insects which he may detect beneath the bark of fallen or decayed trees. Towards spring he feeds on — the buds of the hickory, oak, and various other trees, as well as on sev- eral kinds of roots, especially of the wild potato. As the spring advan- ces farther, he is a constant visitor to the black mulberry tree (Morus rubra) where he finds a supply for several weeks. From this time till winter the fruits of the field and forests enable him to revel in abund- ance. i “Most other species of this genus when alarmed in the woods imme- diately betake themselves to the first convenient tree that presents itself, —not so with the fox squirrel. When he is aware of being discovered whilst on the ground, he pushes directly for a hollow tree, which is often a quar- ter of a mile distant, and it requires a good dog, a man on horseback, or a very swift runner, to induce him to alter his course, or compel him to ascend any other tree. When he is silently seated on a tree, and im- agines himself unperceived by the person approaching him, he suddenly spreads himself flatly on the limb, and gently moving to the opposite side, often by this stratagem escapes detection. When however he is ona small tree, and is made aware of being observed, he utters a few queru- lous, barking notes, and immediately leaps to the ground and hastens to a more secure retreat. If overtaken by a dog he defends himself with great spirit, and is often an overmatch for the small terriers which are used for the purpose of treeing him. He is very tenacious of life, and an ordinary shot gun, although it may wound him repeatedly, will seldom bring him down from the tops of the high pines to which he retreats when pursued, and in such situations the rifle is the only certain enemy he has to dread. : “This squirrel is seldom seen out of its retreat early in the mornings and evenings, as is the habit of the other species. He seems to be a late riser, and usually makes his first appearance at 10 or 11 o'clock, and re- _ tires to his domicile long before evening. He does not appear to indulge Af equently in the barking propensities of the genus as the other and aller speci This note when heard is not very loud but hoarse and guttural. He is easily domesticated, and is occasionally seen in cages, but is less active and sprightly than the smaller species, __ As an article of food the fox squirrel is apparently equally good with any other species, although I have observed that the little Carolina squir- rel, is usually preferred, as being more tender and delicate. Where how- Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 295 ever squirrels are very abundant, men soon become surfeited with this kind of food, and in Carolina, even among the poorer class, it is not gen- erally preferred. “ This species, like all the rest of the squirrels, is infested during the summer months with a troublesome larva, which, fastening itself on the neck or shoulders, must be very annoying, as those most affected in this manner are usually poor, and their fur appears thin and disordered. It is however less exposed to destruction from birds of prey and wild beasts than the other species. It leaves its retreat so late in the mornings and retires so early in the afternoons, that it is wholly exempt from the depre- dations of owls, so destructive to the Carolina squirrel. I have seen it bid defiance to the attacks of the red-shouldered hawk, (Falco lineatus,) the only abundant species in the south, and it frequents those high grounds and open woods where the fox and wild cat seldom resort, dur- ing the middle of the day, so that man is almost the only enemy it has to drea 2. Species Texianus. (n. s.) Textan Squirren. In the Museum at Paris, I observed a Species of squirrel said to have been received from Mexico, of which I could find no descrip- tion. At Berlin and Zurich I observed the same species, and in the British Museum a specimen obtained by Douglass in Texas, agreeing with the former in every particular. I have also the de- scriptions of a specimen received from the southwestern part of Louisiana, which differs from the above in no important particulars, General description.—Size of S. capistratus ; above, mingled black and yellow ; beneath, deep yellow ; under sides of the limbs whitish ; fore legs externally and feet rich yellow; ears yellow, with white hairs interspersed; nose and lips brownish white. Hairs of tail rusty yellow at base, with a broad black space near extremity, and tipt with yellow. __ : In. Lines. Length of body, = . eee es iB 6 ‘‘ of tail to end of hair, “- = - = = RO 2 “ of farsus, - = - * % - 3 0 re 5 Height of earstoendoffur, - - -~ - = 6 3. Species sub-auratus. (n. s.) GoLpEN-BELLIED SquirRe. EssentTIaAL CHARACTERS.—Size intermediate between the North- ern Grey and the Little Carolina Squirrel ; tail longer than the body ; color above grey, with a wash of yellow, beneath deep gol- den yellow. : ta : Dental formula.—Incis. 3. Can. $3. Mol. $4.—20. 296 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. General description.—Body slight and formed for activity; tail broad and long; color, above grey, washed with yellow; hairs of the upper surface, slate colored at base, annulate with yel- low, then black, and annulated with yellowish white; sides of the face and neck and ail beneath, with the feet and inner side of limbs golden yellow; hair of the ears, long, golden yellow; hairs of the feet blackish at root, sometimes tipt with black ; hairs of tail black at base, yellow, triannulate with black ; whiskers black, longer than the head. _ Dimensions. - : In. Lin Length of head and body, - - - . 10 6 Ditto of tail, (vertebra, ) - - - - 9 2 Ditto including fur, - - - ~ 12 0 Ditto of palm to end of middle fore claw, - os Ditto of heel to point of middle nail, Tee z Ditto _ of fur on the back, - - - - “= Height of ear posteriorly, . - - - i ae Breadth of tail with hair extended, - ~ - 8 6 Weight 14 lbs. : A, Species magnicaudatus. GREAT-TAILED SQUIRREL. Sciurus macrourus. Say, Long’s Expedition, vol. i, p. 115. magnicaudatus. Harlan’s Fauna, p. 170. macrourus. Godman’s Nat. Hist. Vol. 2, p. 134. EssentiaL cHaracters.—Size intermediate between S. cine reus and S. leucotis ; body above and on each side mingled grey and black ; ears long ; tail very broad. General description.—Fur plumbeous; black at the base; then, in sucession, pale cinnamon, black, cinereous, and tipt with black ; ears, without, bright ferruginous, within, dull ferrugi- nous, with the hairs tipt with black; sides of the head, with the orbits of the eyes and belly, pale ferruginous ; under part of head and neck, upper part of feet, with the tail, ferruginous ; this latter beneath, bright, and above, marked with black; cheeks beneath the eyes and ears dusky, and the mouth margined with black ; whiskers disposed in five series of flattened hairs, the inferior more distinct. The fur of the belly is plumbeous at the base ; fur of the under surface of the tail, bright ferruginous at base with 4 sub-marginal line, that of the upper surface of a pale cinnamon within, with the base and three bands black ; palms of the * ed 2 ~ Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 297 feet black ; rudimental thumb covered by a broad flat nail. The hair in summer ,7, of an inch in length, which increases in win- ter to one and one and three quarter inches. _. The bones of this species are distinguished by their remarkable red color. 5. Species aureogaster. (F. Cuv. and Geoff.) Cauirornian ‘SQUIRREL. “ Sciurus aureogaster ; F. Cuv. and Geoff. Mamm. “* Ecureuil de la Calafornie; Id. “General hue above deep grey grizzled with yellow; under parts and inner side of limbs deep rusty red; chin, throat and cheeks pale grey ; limbs externally and feet colored as the body above ; hairs on the toes chiefly dirty white; tail large and very bushy ; hairs of the tail black, twice annulated with dirty yellow, and broadly tipped with white, the white very conspicuous where the hairs are in their natural position ; ears thickly clothed, chiefly with blackish hairs, the hinder basal part exter- nally with long white hairs, extending slightly on the neck ; all the hairs of the body are grey at the base, those of the upper parts annulated first with yellow, then black, and then white ; whiskers black, the hairs very long and bristly ; the under incisors almost as deep an orange color as the upper. “ Habitat Mexico and California. DIMENSIONS. oe In. lines. “Length from nose to root of tail, - - Fane - 12 0 Ditto of tail to end of hair, = - - - - - 10 6 Ditto of heel to end of claws, - - - - - 2 5) Ditto from nose to ear, - . - - - - 2 ib Height of ear posteriorly, i ae 2 Ty 6. Species cinereus. Lin. Cat Squrrre.. Essentia CHARACTERS.— A little smaller than the For Squir- rel; larger than the northern Grey Squirrel ; body stout ; legs rather short; nose and ears not white ; tail, longer than the body. General description.—Head shorter and more obtuse than that of the fox squirrel; neck short, legs short and stouter ; tail also shorter, less distichous ; the body is also stronger and of a more heavy, clumsy appearance. Incisors narrower than those of the fox squirrel, also shorter and less prominent; the nails shorter, Narrower, and less arched. The color is subject to considerable Variations between light grey and black ; sometimes they are found nearly white, without the red eyes of the albinos. ‘The varieties ~*Vol. xxxvul, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. “if 298 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. of 8. capistratus are permanent in their colors, while those of the present may be found of every shade between black and white. “On the cheeks there is a slight tinge of yellowish brown, extending to — ; ; a pa oe i aa the neck at the insertion of the head; the inner surface of the ears of the same color, the outer surface of the fur on the ear, which extends a little beyond the outer edge, and is of a soft woolly appearance, is light cinereous edged with rusty brown; whiskers black and white, the former. color predominating. Under the throat, the inner surface of the legs and thighs, and the whole under surface, white ; on the back the fur is dark — cinereous near the roots, then light ash, then a line of black and tipt with white, giving it on the outer surface an iron-grey appearance. The tail, which does not present the flat distichous appearance of the majority of the other species, but is more rounded and narrower, is composed of hairs which, separately examined, are of a soiled white tint near the roots, then a narrow marking of black, then white, then a broad line of black, and finally broadly edged with whit: DIMENSIONS. i Tea ** Length of head and body, - eee Ditto of tail, (vertebrae), . - < rs eon & Ditto of tail to the tips, -- 4 = + oie hs = ow 12 6 Height of ear posteriorly, - . = = 2 sett Palm and middle fore claw, - - - - « es Heel and middle hind claw, - - . - - - 29 Length of fur on the back, - wee - - “a This species is said to be common in the oak and hickory woods of Pennsylvania. I also observed one in the hands of a gunner near Fredericksburgh, Va. It is very uncommon in the northern parts of New York, but more frequent in the south- ern counties. Its habits are sluggish when compared with the lightness and activity of the grey squirrel. It rarely leaps, and seldom mounts to the tops of trees, but ‘contents itself with creep- ing slowly and cautiously along the branches. ‘ 7. Species lJeucotis. Norruern Gt « ee> lea Pennant’s Arctic 3 5a eg i 3 i 0. 27 : 3 - Re Corkias nsis ; Godman, non i Gui ; Sciurus leucotis ; Gapper, Zool. Journ. vol. v, p. 206, published about 1830. “ Esser. Crar. —Larger — the Carolina Grey Squirrel ; tail much longer than the boli ss aller than the Cat Squirrel ; subject to many in color. fs Sag Bos. a Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. -—=—-299 “This sprightly and very common species, existing in the northern and middle States, has hitherto been united with the Carolina grey squirrel ; the name having been first appropriated to the latter, and the present species being, as [ shall endeavur, in this and the succeeding article, to prove, specifically distinct, I have proposed for it the above name. “This squirrel seems to have permanently twenty two teeth; among a large number procured in different seasons of the year and some of them, from the manner in which their teeth were worn, appearing to be old animals, all presented the small front molars in the upper jaw, except a single specimen, and even in this instance, these teeth may have acci- dentally dropped out. This permanency in teeth that have been usually regarded as deciduous, would seem to require an enlargement of the characters given to this genus; it will moreover be seen that the majority of our species are similar to this in their dental arrangements.” General description.—Incisors strong, compressed, the upper ones with a sharp cutting edge and Shine. -shaped ; the lower ones much longer and thinner. The anterior grinder round and small, and equal in length with the second; the remaining four ornders present two transverse ridges of enamel. The lower grinders corresponding with those above have also elevated crowns. Hair alittle softer than that of the cat squirrel, being coarser on the forehead. 'The winter clothing is longer than that of summer. ** Color.—Although this spe ies exist under many varieties, there ap- pear to be two very permanent ones, which I shall attempt to describe. 1. Grey variety—The nose, cheek, around the eyes extending to the insertion of the neck, the upper surface of the fore, and hind feet, and a stripe along the sides, yellowish brown; the ears on their posterior surface are asoiled white, edged with brown; on the back from the shoul- der there is an obscure stripe of brown, broadest at its commencement, and running down toa point at the insertion of the tail; in a few speci- mens this stripe is wanting. _ On the neck, sides, and hi the color is light grey; the hairs separately are for one half their length dark ciner- eous, then light os ae: ni 1 arrow mark of black, and tipt with white; a considera hairs are in feraperiod. giving it above a hai re light yellowish brown from the roots, str e of Hace ase. one being widest, and broadly tipt with white ; the whole undersurface i is white. ye 3 Black variety —This variety I have, on several occasion taken from the same nest with the grey squirrel. They breed aa rear their young together, and the observations made with regard to the fox squirrel will also apply to these. This is of the ay and form of the grey Variety ; iJ it is a dark bral black’on the whole of the upper surface, A 300 — of the Genus Sciurus. a little lighter b he The hairs of the back and sides of the body and tail are obscurely annu- lated with yellow. There is here and there a white hair interspersed — among the fur of the body, a no tuft of white as in Sciurus niger. * ~ DIMENSIONS. In. ~ “Tength of ss body, 11 Ditto. of tail, one , : . ; 10 Ditto of the ; xara 13 Height of ear, ; ‘ : a rs ditto to the end 2 fury — ee : Say *s as ee ; - ack, act : 3 Breadth of tail ii hairs ecthgdeds : A ies, “Geographical Distribution. —The northern limits of this species are not determined ; it however exists as far as Hudson’s Bay, was formerly very common 4 the New England States, and in the less cultivated portions is still fr y met with. Itis abundant in New York, and in the moun- tainous portions of Pennsylvania. I have observed it on the northern mountains of Virginia. It probably extends still farther south; in t lower parts of North and South Carolina however it is replaced by a smaller species. ‘The black variety is more abundant in upper Canada, in the western part of New York, and in the states of Ohio and Indiana. It does not exist in Georgia, Florida, or Alabama; and among the speci- mens sent from Louisiana, stated to be of ail the species existing in that state, I discovered that this squirrel was not of the number. “ Habits.—This appears to be the most active and sprightly species ex- isting in our Atlantic states. It rises with the sun, and continues indus- triously engaged in search of food during four or five hours in the morn- ing, scratching among leaves, running over fallen logs, ascending trees, and playfully coursing from limb to limb—often faking almost incredible Jeaps from the higher branches of one tree to another. In the middle o the day it retires for a few hours to its nest, resuming its active labors and amusements in the afternoon, and continuing ; without intermission till the ‘getting of the sun. During the warm weather of spring and summer it materials, but finds them ready at hand on the tree where it intends to take ‘up its temporary residence. It first breaks off dried sticks, if they ean be procured oa muke a superstructure ; if — such materials ommen gnawing ¢ green branches the size of a'thumb, and lays them i in the ony of the tree, or of some In summer its color is less black than in init Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 301 large branch. It then proceeds to the extremities of the branches, and breaks off those portions that contain tufts of leaves, with which a com- pact nest is constructed, which, in the inner side, is sometimes lined with such mosses as are found on the bark of trees. In the preparation of as nest a pair is usually engaged, for an hour i in the morning, during ‘several successive da s; and the noise they make in cutting dee Stnticlnd: y Jn g ’ and dragging them with their leaves to the nests, ca number of five or six, probably the produce of a pair 4 om the pi aC g season, may occupy the same nest during winter, yet the y all pair off in épfing;- when each couple seems to occupy a separate nest, in order to en- gage in the duties of reproduction. The young, in number from four to six, are in the northern states, brought forth in May; they are of quick growth, and sufficiently advanced in a few weeks to leave the nest: at such times they are seen clinging aro on Pi which contains their domi as soon as alarmed, they r e hole, when one of them usually returns, and, protruding his head set of the hole, watches the = ee movements of the intruder. In this stage of growth they are easily cap- | tured ; their hole is stopped up, another opening is made beneath, and they are taken out by the hand protected by a glove. Phey soon become tolerably gentle, and are frequently kept in cages with a ] attached, in which, as in the interior of a tread mill, they amuse themselves in playing for hours together. Sometimes two are placed together, and they soon learn to accommodate themselves to | heel, and move together with great regularity. However gentle they may Becdine i in confinement, no instance has come to my knowledge of their having produced young in a state of domestication; although in a suitable cage such a result would in all probability be produced. A tame squirrel is, however, a troublesome pet; it is always ready to use its teeth on the, fingers of every intruder on its cage, and does not always spare even its feeder; and when permitted to have the freedom of the house, it soon incurs the dis- pleasure of the prudent housewife by its habit of gnawing chairs, tables, and books. ~ a ** During the breeding season the nailed ‘lie those of doer: Pa Giher species, engage in frequent contests, and often bite and wound each other severely. The story of their emasculating each other on these occasions # has been so often repeated, that it has become a matter of history, and it — would now be somewhat dangerous to set it down as a vulgar error. ve might however be advanced, on the other hand, eae the admi such skill and refinement in cruelty would bing to the me a higher degree of physical and surgical kaowledge than is possessed by any other quadruped. From the observations I have been enabled to make, I have been led to believe that the error bia diated from the = ae 302 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. fact that those parts in the male which in one season are greatly enlarged, are in the other equally diminished, and that in young males especially, they are drawn into the pelvis by the contraction of the muscle. Asa proof of this, a friend, who was a strenuous believer in this spiteful pro- y pensity ascribed to the squirrel, was induced to test the i = by an ex- f. amination of a suitable number of specimens. He obtained in afew weeks upwards of thirty males;—in none of these had this mutilation — taken place. Two however, out of this number were triumphantly brought forward as evidences of the truth of the doctrine; on examina- tion it appeared that these were young animals, with the organs perfect, but concealed in the manner above stated. - “Tt is generally believed that this species lays up a great hoard of food as a winter supply ; it ma yh prcrensbe reasonably doubted whether they are so provident i in this respect. The trees in which they conceal them- selves in winter are popendyeikaown, and no supply of provisions is ever found in their nests. In following their tracks in the snow they can- not be traced to any hoards buried in the ground. I have me eover t Ob served them during a warm day in winter coming from great #5 sunny day; andin this state of inactivity and partial er. it requis but little a “ This saisievel feeds upon the various nuts, seeds, and grain ae are periodically sought for by all the species of this genus, but it seems to prefer the shell-bark (Carya alba) and the several species of hickory, to any other kind of food. Even when the nuts are so green as to aflor scarcely any nourishment, the northern grey squirrel is seen gnawing off the thick epidermis, which drops to the ground like rain, and then, with its lower incisors, makes a small linear opening in the thing part of the shell, immediately over the kernel. When this part has been extracted it proceeds to another, till in an incredible short space of time, the nut is cut longitudinally on its four sides, and the whole kernel secured, leaving the portions of the hard shell untouched. Were, however, this species __ toconfine its depredations to the hickory, chestnut, beech, oak, and maple, _ it would be less obnoxious to the farmer; but sastieadantels for the peace of both, it is fond of the green corn and young wheat, to which the right- ful owner imagines himself to have a prior claim. A war of extermina- tion consequently ensues, and various inducements are held out to tempt the gunner to destroy them. In Pennsylvania an ancient law existed, ree pence a head for every squirrel destroyed, and in one year (1749), iinieseecaen of £8000 was paid out of the treasury, in pre Monograph of the Genus Sciuris. 303 miums for the destruction of these depredators. In several of the north- ern and western states, the inhabitants on an. appointed day, are in the habit of turning out on what is called a squirrel hunt. They arrange themselves under opposite leaders, each party being stimulated by the ambition of victory, and of fastening on the other the expense of a bountiful supper. The hunters range the forest in every direction, and the accounts given us of the number of squirrels brought sogetliier at the evening rendezvous, are almost incredible. “In addition to the usual enemies of this species in the northern states, such as the weasel, fox, lynx; &c., the red-tailed hawk seems to regard it as his natural and lawful prey. It j is amusing to see the skill and dexter- ity exercised by both in the attack and defence. When the hawk is un- accompanied by his mate, he finds it no easy matter to secure the squir- rel; unless the latter be unconsciously “pounced upon whilst on the ground, he is enabled, by his dodgings and twistings round the limb of a tree, to evac e the attacks of the hawk for hours, and frequently worries hi relu ctant retreat. But the red-tail, like other robbers, has rience that he is most certain of his prey when hunting i in uple Te is frequently accompanied by his mate, especially in the reeding season, and in this case the contest is soon decided. They urse rapidly, in opposite directions, above and below the limb; the at- i it, the talons of the hawk are in his back, and with a shriek of the latter bears him off, either to the aery of his young, or to b of a tree, or to a sheltered situation on the ground, where, spicious glance towards each other, and an occasional hissing and growling for the choice parts, the hawks devour their prey. “This species of squirrel has occasionally excited the wonder of the populace, by its wandering habits, and its singular and long migrations. Like the lemming (Lemmus Norvegicus) of the eastern continent, it is stimulated, either from a scarcity of food, or from some other inexplicable instinct, to leave its native haunts, and seek for adventures or for food in some distant and, to him, unexplored portion of our land. The news- from the west contain frequent details of these migrations; they appear to have been more frequent in former years than at the present time. ‘The farmers in the western wilds regard them with sensations _ which may be compared to the anxious apprehensions of the eastern na- tions at the flight of the devouring locust. At such periods, which usually occur in autumn, the squirrels congregate in different districts of the far . northwest, and, in irregular troops, bend their way instinctively in an ‘eastern direction. Mountains and cleared fields;—the head waters of lakes and broad rivers,—present no unconquerable impediments. On- _ ward they come, devouring on their way every thing that is suited toa squirrel’s taste,—laying waste the corn and wheat fields of the farmer ; ae 304 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. and as their numbers are thinned by the gun, the dog and the club, oth- ers are ready to fall in the rear and fill up the ranks, till they occasion infinite mischief and call forth no empty threats of revenge. It is often inquired how these little creatnres, that on common occasions, have such an instinctive dread of water, are enabled to cross broad and rapid rivers, like the Ohio and Hudson for instance. It is usually asserted, and be- lieved by many, that they carry to the shore a suitable piece of bark, and seizing the opportunity of a favorable breeze, seat themselves upon this substitute for a boat, hoist their broad tails as a sail, and float safely to the opposite shore. This, together with many other traits of intelligence ascribed to this species, I suspect to be apocryphal. That they do mi- grate at irregular, and occasionally at distant periods, is a fact sufficiently _ established ; but in the only instance in which I had an opportunity of Witnessing the migrations of the squirrel, it appeared to me that he was not only an unskilful sailor, but a clamsy swimmer. It was (as far as my recollection serves me of the period of early life) in the autumn of 1808 _ or9; troops of squirrels suddenly and unexpectedly made elr appear- ance in the neighborhood, but among the grey ones were yarieties not ote previously seen in those parts ; some were broadly striped with yellowon the sides, and a few with a black stripe on each side, bordered with yel low or brown, resembling the stripes of the little chippin mias Lysteri.) They swam the Hudson in various plac terford and Saratoga; those which I observed crossing ' vel swimming deep and awkwardly, their bodies and tails wholly submers Se eit and fatigued, that the boys stationed there with clubs, found no difficul y in securing them alive or in killing them. Their migrations on that oc- casion did not, as far as I could learn, extend farther eastwardly than the mountains of Vermont; many remained in the county of Rensselaer, and it was remarked that for several years afterwards the squirrels were far more numerous than before. It is doubtful whether any ever return westwardly, but finding forests and food suited to their taste and habits, they take up their permanent residence in their newly explored country ; there they remain and propagate their species, until they are gradually _ thinned off by the effects of improvement, and the dexterity of the sports- . men around them.” 8. Species Carolinensis,Gmel. Lrrrux C. a Grey SQuir- REL. : ee: 7 | Ecureuil gris de la Carolina. Bose, ii, 96, pl. 29. © Essenr. Cuar. Smaller than the Northern Grey Squirrel, ieee eee nat ~ tail narrower than in that species, the length of the body ; color Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 305 _ above, rusty grey, white beneath, not subject to vary in color. Dental formula: Incis. 2; Can. 22; mol. $5 ;__22 This has been invariable considered as identical with the Northern Grey Squirrel, but it is undoubtedly a distinct species. The head of the S. Carolinensis is shorter, and the space be- tween the ears proportionately broader; and the nose is sharper. The small anterior molar in the upper jaw is permanent. It is considerably larger than in S. dewcotis, and all my specimens, which indicate that the animal was more than a year old, instead of the small, thread-like, single tooth of the S. leucotis, have a distinct double tooth with a double crown; the other molars are in form not unlike those of the other species, but are shorter and smaller ; the upper incisors are nearly a third shorter. The body is shorter, less elegant in shape, and has not the appearance of sprightliness and agility, for which the other species is so distin- guished. "The ears, which are nearly triangular in shape, are so thed with hair internally that they may be said to be _ hearly naked: Ox! ernally they are sparsely clothed with short % On hair, which, however does not extend beyond the mar- in the other species. The nails are shorter and less The tail is shorter and does not present the broad dis- : of the other. ‘This species is not subject to is = side 2 DIMENSIONS. —* In. Lines Length of head and body, - - - - 9 Ditto of tail, (vertebre,) - - - - 7A Ditto to point of hair, - - - . - 9-6 Height of ear, - - . . - - 6 Palm toend of middleclaw, - - - - 13 Heel to end of middle nail, «Veh tee Bece e 5 Length of fur on the back, - “ wre Breadth of tail with hairs extended, ere-cett -Bo@ Color.—Teeth light orange; nails brown, lighter at the ex- tremities ; whiskers black; nose and cheeks, and around the eyes, a slight tinge of rufous grey. The fur on the back is for three fourths its length, dark plumbeous, then a slight marking of black, edged with brown in some hairs and black in others, giving it, on the whole upper surface, a uniform dark ochreous Vol. xxxvu1, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 39 * “= 306 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. color. In afew specimens there is an obscure line of lighter — brown along the sides, where the ochreous color prevails, and a tinge of the same color on the upper surface of the fore legs above the knees. The feet are light grey ; the tail, for three fourths of its length from the root is yellowish brown, then black edged with white; the throat, inner surface of the legs and the belly, white. This species is common in South Carolina, Alabama, Florida, &c. and is probably not rare as far north as Philadelphia. In habits this species differs much from the S. Jeucotis. Its bark is less full, and much shriller and more querulous. — Its usual haunts are in low swampy places, and among the trees overhang- _ing rivers. It is very active even after dusk, and in moonlit evenings. ‘The young are commonly five or six in number ee brought forth in March. cma 9. Species nigrescens. Bennett. Dust pre DIMENSIONS. : In. Lines. Length from point of nose to root of tail, eae 4 e~ Ditto of tail to end of hair, - - - 15 4 ie Tarsus, claws included, =~ le eae 2. ie Nose to ear, - - - ~ - 2 24 _ a Height of ear —- - - - - oy Prevailing color black, slightly grizzled on the body, crown of the head and legs, with grey; sides of the neck, groins, upper parts of the thighs and rump, grizzled with pale yellow; cheeks, — chin, throat, neck, breast and the whole of the under surface, 1- cluding the interior of the legs, dingy grey. Ears well clothed - with hairs; hind part dingy grey, fore part the color of the back ; hairs of the hinder parts of thighs black. Tail, hairs black at the roots, then grey, then a broad band of black, and broadly tipt with white. Feet black; the hairs of the toes grizzled with white points. Whiskers aboiit the length of the head, black. Hairs on the back plumbeous black at the roots, for two thirds of their length, then grey, then black, and tipt with whitish grey- Numerous strong black hairs interspersed, over the te RE Described from the original spe e Mu logical Society No. 429 in the Catalogue. Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 307 10. Species Colligi, Richardson. Cottie’s Squirret. Dimensions. # In. Lines. “Length from nose to root of tail, . ee 10 9 “of tail to end of hair, 9 6 Tarsus, including nail, ; ; 7 : 2 6 Height of ear posteriorly, : : : ; 0 6 Nose to ear, 2 0 * Color.—Above, grizzled black and buff volar: sides of muzzle, under parts, and inner sides of limbs white. Tail moderate, the hairs greyish white, three times annulated with black. Hairs of the body, both above and beneath, grey at the root; that of the back with a length- ened black tip, and broadly annulated with buff yellow. The hairs of the head resemble those of the back, except on the fore part, where they are Sandia with whitish. Top of the muzzle brown, cheeks greyish, Ears well -with hairs, which are internally of a yellowish color, externally grizzled with black and yellow on the fore part, but posteriorly with long whitish hairs. Hairs of feet. white, black at the root; the whiskers are as long as the head, composed of bristly black hairs. “ Described from the original specimen deposited by Dr. Richardson in the Museum of the Zoological Societ ety. a Sreecies niger. Tue Briack Sauirren. ~ Sciurus niger ; Linn. non Catesby. esm. Mammalogie, p. 334. Godman ; Nat. Hist. vol. ii, p. 133. “A little larger than the Northern Grey Squirrel. Fur soft and glossy ; ears, nose, and the whole body pure black, a few white tufts of hair inter- spersed. Dental formula; Incisors, ; Canines, $2; Molars, +4;—20. _“ Much confusion has existed with regard to this species. The orig- inal Sciurus niger of Catesby is the black variety of the fox squirrel. It is difficult to decide, from the description of Drs. Harlan and Godman, whether they described from specimens of the black variety of the north- ern grey squirrel, or of the species which I am about to describe. In- deed, there is so strong ‘a similarity, that I have admitted it as a species With some doubt and hesitation. Dr. Richardson has, under the head of Sciurus niger, (see ‘ Fauna Boreali-Americana,’ p. 191), described a spe- cimen from Lake Superior, of what I conceive to be the black variety of the grey squirrel; but at the close of the same article (p. 192), he has described another pore from Fort William, which answers to the description nel y before me. There is great difficulty in finding suite a 3 act es # by: ‘ic 1 the majority of our species of squir- 308 Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. rel can be designated ; but in none is there greater than in the present. All our naturalists seem to insist that we have a Sciurus niger, although they have applied the name to the black varieties of several other species. As the name, however, is likely to continue on our books, and as the spe- cimens before me, if they do not establish a true species, will show a very permanent variety, I shall describe them under the above name. “Dr. Godman states (Nat. Hist. vol. ii, p. 133), that the black squirrel has only twenty teeth ;—the specimens before me have no greater num- ber, with the exception of one, evidently a young animal, a few months old, which has an additional tooth on one side, so small that it appears like a white thread, the opposite and corresponding one having already been shed. If bivtack examinations go to establish the fact, that this additional molar in the northern grey squirrel is persistent, and that of the present deciduous, there can be no doubt of their being distinct species. ‘Its head appears to be a little shorter and more arched than that of the grey squirrel, although it is often found that these differences exist among different individuals of the same species. Incisors compressed, strong, and of a deep orange color anteriorly. | Ears elliptical, and slightly _ rounded at the tip, thickly clothed with fur on both surfaces, that on the outer surface in a winter specimen, extending three lines beyond the mar- gin: there are, however, no distinct tufts. Whiskers a little longer than the head; tail long and — thickly clothed with eglerately coarse haji “The fur is softer to the toch than that of the northern grey equieall The whole of the upper and lower surface, as well as the tail are bright glossy black ; at the roots the hairs are a little lighter. The summer specimens de not differ materially in the color of their fur from the win- ter ones, except that they are not so intensely black. In all the speci- mens I have had an opportunity of examining, there are small tufts of white hairs irregularly situated on the under surface, resembling those on the body of the mink. There are also a few scattered white hairs on wm z back and tail. Dimensions, In. Lines "5 Length of head and body, . of tail (westebra); : : are - including fur, ; : . js 13 0 Palm to end of middle fore claw, . : ea Length of heel to the point of middle ‘dei, : 2 7 “of fur onthe back, . ; 2 8 Breadth of tail with hair extagiled “ 5 0 “ Geographical Distribution.—The specimens from which this de- ection has been taken were procured, through the kindness of friends, ai a Monograph of the Genus Sciurus. 309 in the counties of Rensselaer and Queen’s, New York. I have seen it on the borders of Lake Champlain, at Ogdensburgh, and on the eastern shores of Lake Erie ; also near Niagara, on the Canada side. The.in- dividual described by Dr. Richardson, and which may be clearly referred to this species, was obtained by Capt. ‘Bayfield at Fort William, on Lake Superior. s exist through all our western wilds, and to the northward of the great lakes; but whether they are of this species, or the black variety of the grey aa I have not had the means of de- ciding. “ Habits.—An opportunity was afforded me many years since of noti« cing the habits of this species im the northern parts of the state of New York. A seat under the shadow of a rock, and near a stream of water, was, for several successive summers, a-favorite resort for retirement and reading. In the immediate vicinity were several large trees, in which were a number of holes, and from which, at almost every hour of the day, were seen issuing this species of black squirrel. There seemed to be a dozen of them; they were all of the same glossy black color; and although the northern grey squirrel and its black variety were not rare in that neighborhood, yet, during a period of five or six years I never wit- nessed any other than the present species in that locality ; and recently, after the lapse of twenty years, a specimen, from which the above de- Scription was in part drawn up, was sent to me, which had been procured on that identical spot. They appe r the northern grey squirrel ;—appear and drier and more elevated situations : observed that one of their fa- Vorite trees, to which they retreated on hearing the slightest noise, was a large white pine ( Pinus Strobus), in the immediate vicinity. I was sur- prised at sometimes seeing a red squirrel (Sciurus Hudsonius), which seemed also to have given a preference to this tree, pursuing the black Squirrel, seeming to quarrel with and scold it vociferously, till the latter / Was obliged to make its retreat. When the squirrels approached the ‘stream which ran within a few feet of my seat, they often stopped to drink, and instead°of lapping the water like the dog and cat, they pro- truded their mouths a considerable distance into the stream, and drank greedily ; they would afterwards sit npright, supported by the tarsus, and, with tail erect, busy themselves for a quarter of an hour in wiping their faces with their paws, the latter being also occasionally dipped in the water. Their barking and other habits did not seem to differ from those of the northern grey squirrel. General Remarks.—I have admitted this. as a true species, not so much in accordance with my own positive conviction, as partly in defer- ence to the opinions of all our naturalists, and principally from the con- sideration that if it be no more than.a variety, it has, by time and suc- m a 310 Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. cession, been rendered a permanent race: and as the species differso widely and uniformly in color, we may perhaps be warranted in regard- — ing. them as distinct. The oaly certain mode of deciding whether this. is a true species or merely a variety, would be to ascertain if the opposite sexes of these differently marked animals associate and breed together in a state of nature. Where the produce of two animals, however different in size and color, are in the constant habit of propagating their species in a wild state, we are warranted in pronouncing them identical. Where, on the contrary, there is no such result, we are begs te a to come to an opposite conclusion. [To be continued.] Art. XVIIL—Catalogue of Botanical Specimens collected by J. Wouter and A. L. Huewener, during the year 1837, in the vicinity of Bethlehem and other parts of Northampton County, Pennsylvania, in the order as they were found in bloom. Bethlehem, Nov. 2d, 1838. TO PROF. SILLIMAN. Dear Sir,—I take the liberty to transmit to you a Catalogue of Botanical Specimens collected by my friends Jacob Wolle, Esq. and Dr. A. L. Huebener of this place. Should it be desira- ble to have any specimens, you will please address Dr. A. L. Huebener, who is enabled to give any further information respect- ing the locality, habits, &c. of the different plants. It gives me pleasure as Principal of the Seminary for Young Ladies at this place, to contribute my mite to the extension of the. Science of Botany ; and to encourage my friends already urged by every means in my power to prosecute their researches, in hopes that many others may be induced to examine ie Flora of their own neighborhood with equal diligence. I am, dear sir, with sentiments of esteem, yours, : Very respectfully, Joun G. Kummer. ; April. {Corylus rostrata. Symplocarpas foetidus. Draba verna. oe. ulata. Gnaphalium plantagineum. Us Stallati moda Fad % i Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. Taxus Canadensis, Acer rubru Ulmus Siti mati do. fulva. Caltha palustris. Corydalis Cucullaria. Saxifraga Virginica. — Populus os ; do. candic Chrysoplonina ceippositifoliosh: ba. Hepatica trilo Anemone thalictroides. Sanguinaria Canadensis. Dirca palustris. Laurus Benzoin. Populus tremuloides. randidentata, Juniperus Virginiana. do. Sabina. Pinus microcarpa. Thlaspi Bursa pastoris. Ranunculus abortivus. do fascicularis, Anemone quinquefolia. Salix vitellina. Thalictrum dioie Erythronium American: Lamium am plexicaule. Viola obliqua. do. debilis. do. hastata. do. cucullata. do. ovata. ~ * do. pedata. ; Viola blanda. e,, C3 pe do. ochroleuca. do. eriocarpa Schw. do. ittata. do. clandestina. do. villosa. do. pubescens do. striata do. Canadensis. do. primulaefolia, do. velutina. o. asarifolia. . olata. Jeffersonia diphylla. | Zanthoxylum fraxineum. Thuja occidentalis. Acer dasycarpum. Trillium sessile. Chelidonium majus. Aquileja Canadensis. *Draba glabella. Comptonia asplenifolia. seers: tenuifolium. utinosum. Clecgtoriie ig -|Ranunculus nsy Uvularia sessilifolia. perfoliata. . flava. Arum triphyllum. eronica agrestis. do. _ serpyllifolia. do. peregrina. Orontium aquaticum. Cardamine Virginica. 311 ee ee 312 Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. Dodecatheon Meadia. Panax trifolia. Phlox reptans. do. setacea. Asarum Canadense Fraxinus juglandifolia. Osmunda interrupta. do. cinnamomea. Prunus borealis. Mitella diphylla. aurus Sassafras. Orchis spectabilis. Cypripedium pubescens. do. parviflorum. Vaccinium corymbosum. Andromeda racemosa. Aesculus glabra. “Trientalis Americana. Fagus sylvatica, ( Linn.) Cornus florida. i Convallaria biflora. do. bifolia. Arabis rhomboidea. Carpinus Americana. Dentaria laciniata. Cercis Canadiétein Myrrhis Claytoni. Tiarella cordifolia. ere recurvatus. bulbosus. ieieetsiium thaleetvaiden, weal Virginicum. n Acer do. do. Prinus palustris. Quercus Chinquapin. agit torla. oe do. Castanetec;.aee do montana. ; do. discolor. : (The remaining oaks found after they had flowered. ) Pinus (Larix) pendula. Polygala paucitolia. Juniperus communis. Azalea nudiflora. Blitum capitatum. Vicia Cracca. Myrrhis procumbens. . longistylis. Krigeron bellidifolius. Crataegus cordata. netata. Smyrnium pat re: Equisetum hyemale. Geranium maculatum. Prunus Virginiana. Obolaria Virginica. Juglans nigra. Oo e Vaccinium frondosum. do resinosum. do. penry nie do. mineum. Convallaria Eaaiara. Platanus occidentalis. Cardamine Pennsylvanica. Corydalis glauca. Staphylea trifolia. Lonicera parviflora. Rumex eer Galium Apari 2 les Viburnum pyxitolians arya alba. do. tomentosa. do. suleata. do. amara do. poreina Batschia canescens. Phlox arist Aronia arbutifolia. == Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. Salix repens (Linn. ) Plantago lanceolata. Convallaria ~~. Oxalis v sr do. ast Arenaria serpyitifolin. Sison integerrimus. Cochlearia officinalis. Senecio obovatus Gyromia Virginic Podophyllum sens Myosotis ee Iris versico Smilax vatioaiasi Chrysanthemum “Vancanits- mum Aralia nudicaulis. Sysyrinchium pri caee Thesium um “ ; Krigia Virginie Ornithogalum anibetatian. Geranium Robertianum. Acer ae Fixer 3 do. nig Vicia Rieinien Vi ium. Se ce Ice Pinus § do. viel rd -Sanicula Marilandica. Fagus ferruginea. Cynoglossum officinale. Cornus sericea Fraxinus sambucifolia. eon: Pyrus coronar Lupinus awe Nuphar eels Mastana: Veronica scutellata. do. officinalis. do. Beccabunga. Cornus circinata. Silene antirrhina. Aristolochia Sipho. Polygala Senega. Potentilla Norvegica. Gillenia trifoliata. Helianthemum Canadense. Kalmia angustifolia. do. latifolia. do. lauea, d rosmarinifolia. Oo Arum Pracdut ntium Nyssa aquatica. IChionanthus Virginica. Lepidium on ( ae) Krigia amplexic Cerastium same Solanum Dulcamara. Arabis lyrata. Senecio vulgaris. Celastrus scandens. Vaccinium dumosum Pp c Iris Virginica. Osm es Viburnum acerifoli Spiractil opulifolia. Sparganium once 0. mplex. Rhus iGcsiadeetoane Heuchera Americana. Cochlearia Armoracia. oryaslis —— Vol. xxxvur, is pics, 1839. e, ~ oo 313 *Ulmus Americana var. pencaiey 314 Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. Geranium striatum. Pasay tite < cmmaea Sinilax Pscudo-China. pecleviag quadrifolia. Helonias dioica. rnefort ii. Scrophularia Marilandica. Cyppediui m pubescens (var. ) Thalictrum pubescens. Rannneulas aquatilis, + J e uncus effusus, Agrostemma Githago. Quercus obtusiloba. . Senecio heterophiaaa Hieracium venosum. © nigra. Salix n Sarracenia purpurea Apocynum hypericifolium. ida. Robinia his Erigeron strigosus. do. _ purpureus. ntstemon pu ae Rumex acutus, Ptelea trifoliata. m. 2 'Trichomanes . do. Ruta muraria. Peadescantia Virginica. pt vulgaris. icum iatfotan ae. Nh Asplenium angustifolium. d Neottia latifolia. | Habenaria Herbiola. Crataegus parvifolia. ~|Heracleum lanatum Viburnum prunifolium, do. den Krigeron integeaisline * eee quadrifolia. Vitis Senecio Balsarai tae. Malaxis liliifolia. Polypodium vulgare. | Adiantum pedatum. Oenothera ambigua. do. mur Aspidiante arg Lathyrus pefustris. | Aristolochia Serpentaria, Spiraea alba. do. corymbosa. Aoi Americana. Canariensis.. Grutiola Virginica. d Hypericum perforatum. Sanicula Canadensis. Pastinaca sativa. Campanula amplexicaulis. |Antirrhinum Linaria. {Oenothera pumila, ._ | obliquum. | fumarioides. ‘ oO. dissectum. ay Ambrosia trifida. do. _integrifolia. Sabbatia angularis. Hedysarum nudiflorum. do. rotundifolium. do. paniculatum. «* z Chara valk a Polygonum amphibium. Rudbeckia Jaciniata. Sagittaria henner Scirpus ten 0. ov Bidens bipinnata. connata. do. chrysanthemodes Cnicus lanceolat do. deed do. a epndlticd, : do. __Jaterifi Cnicus horridulus. do. muticus Collinsonia Canadensis. Sium latifolium do. Canadensis. | Sanguisorba Canadensis. Cnicus pumilus Aster pumilus. do. Radula. do. cordifolius. do. linarifolius. do. macrophyllus. do. pa | Eupatorium perfoliatum. do. eratoides do verticillatum. do aromaticu do. sessilifolium do. linearifolium. do. do. pedo netatum. ora. Hache enitaraédia, Stilosanthes elatior. Hieracium Gronovii. 0. paniculatum. Amphicarpaea monoica. Corallorrhiza arene 2 do odontorrhiza. Pycnanthemum lanceolatum. | Prenanthes altiesima: Monarda oblongata. On ; do.” diyma. do. punctata. Catalogue of Botanical Specimens. 319 Cannabis sativa. Gaura biennis. Schollera graminea. Sagittaria acutifolia. Aysimachia ciliaris. Potamogeton pauciflorus, Apios tuberosa. , do. simplex. Rumex ee Aralia rac Hedeoma ‘ellegiolos, Hypericum Kalmianum. ampanula acuminata. Polygala ambigua Trichostema dichotoma: Myriophyllum ambiguum. Gerardia tenuifolia. do. purpurea. Lythrum verticillatum. Inula Helenium. Impatiens fulva. pallida. Onoclea sensibilis. Helianthus mollis. i) giganteus do altissimus do frondosus do. divaricatus do. angustifolius. Lespedeza capitata. do. sessiliflora. do. hirta. A — Lth. Side 1b; ranma S282°95°. 37. =e On. ade tae m: (10th, rE 5036 8b aa th. « Qh, 69 35 69 194 2h. “ Qh, a “ 2 9 6-2 42 34 691 ‘The meteors were increasing in freqnency when we left the field, and had we continued observation until 4 o’clock, we should doubtless have seen in all more than a thousand. — Several of the meteors were as brilliant as Venus. About one third surpassed in brightness stars of the first magnitude, and a larger portion than this left luminous trains. We noticed nothing peculiar as to the duration of their flights: few of them exceeded half a second. = About th. 50m. (A. “M. 10th ,) a fire ball, much superior in splen- dor to Manu fell almost vertically in the S. 8. E., and suddenly, when at the brightest, disappeared near Fomalhaut. It traversoth an are of about 20°, and was remarkable for its great ‘magnitude, its brilliant train, and its golden green light.* The night of the 10th was also very favorable. Prof. Stanley, Messrs. Bush and Haile, and myself, watched for hree hours, and ti | > different me- teors as follows :— . N. E. s, Ww. Total. 10h. to 11h. ag 35°36. a6 ae 11h. to 12h. 50 add SERS eg Oh. to th. a.m, (1th,) 32 44 61 BDeSCi«iL' HE As to general characters the meteors were similar to those of the night preceding. Several of the most splendid ones were on both nights seen before we commenced observations. On the evening of the 10th, two were plainly seen a few minutes after 7 P.M., while the daylight was quite strong. About 11 P. M. we saw one low in the N., which after traversing an are of about 5°, flashed out with greenish blue scintillations, of dazzling bril- Hiancy. The train remain ‘din sight from 18 to 20 seconds after.t Mr. E. P. Mason, who was using the large Reflector, for several hours on both nights, saw during that period, about twenty me- teors, less brilliant than stars of the seventh magnitude, (and of course invisible to the naked eye,) passing across the field of view. When we left our station, soon after 1 A. M. of 11th; the meteors were becoming a little more frequent; but owing to fa- tigue incurred the day previous, and to the expectation of a watch * Several of the meteors grates a greenish tinge. Meteors wholly green have 1etimes observed. e is described by B. =i Silliman, oe in this Jour- nal, vol. xiv, p. 199. : Bee. Owing to an ssa = ae of the cheervallteet ara meteors st « laptig lle hour, lost in the N. and W. aria probably as many as 20 in all. The appa- rent diminution is therefore not re e permanence of some meteoric trains is truly astonishing. They are occa- sionally seen to remain as long as thirty seconds after the extinction of the meteor. On the morning vs November 14th, 1838, pcrehcee observers, who were then in about lat. 15° S., lon. 34° W., saw among other meteors one at Lh. 40m. A. M., = train ellis visible four minutes. Senin the meteoric shower of No- . ember, 1833, the train of a large fire ball is said to have been seen a nearly or quite Shooting Stars of August, 1839, 82 tee ee, 328 Shooting Stars of August, 1839. on the nights following, we thought best to retire. The time of the greatest abundance cannot be determined from our data; but there is reason to presume that it occurred after three o’clock in the morning. It ought to be mentioned that at our station, the sky around the horizon was somewhat obstructed, so that probably a tenth or fifteenth part of the meteors which might have been seen above our horizon, were concealed from view. The radi- ant of the meteors, being a matter of great importance, received our special attention. It would have been more satisfactory if we could have determined it by marking, on a celestial map, the track of each meteor; but this we could not do without losing great numbers. During the whole period of observation this subject was in mind, and each morning, after we ended the enumeration, we devoted several minutes solely to this purpose. The radiant was, as we have heretofore seen, not a definite point, but a region comprehending several degrees. During both nights the centre of radiation was not far from the cluster of stars in the sword-han- dle of Perseus. About 1h. A. M. of the 11th, we considered the centre to be nearer 4 Persei. We did not notice during the two nights, ain? very perceptible change of radiant with regard to the fixed stars.* The nights of the Lith, 12th, and 13th, were too cloudy to permit observation. The evening of the 1th was clear. Messrs. Bradley and Haile, and myself, watched from 10h. to 12h. P. M., and saw seventy-two meteors as follows :— 10h. to lh. p.m, nen. 9 s. bye. 10 new. 9 =28 ~ 1th. to 12h. Sy d8s: sl 2 46>: « 46g Of these, about 15 equaled stars of the first magnitude. The radiant was less definite than on the nights of the 9th and 10th, but nearly in the same region of the heavens. At midnight the sky was becoming cloudy. The nights of the 15th, 16th, 17th, and 18th, were almost wholly overcast. On the night of the 3ist, I watched in the N.N. E. from Sh. 55m. to 10 P. M., and Saw seven meteors. Most of them might be traced back to a region between Cassiopeia and Perseus. = Iti is worthy of mention, that a faint Aurora Borealis was visible during our ob- on the night of die 10th. It was seen also on the 28th and 31st. Shooting Stars of August, 1830. 329 2. Middletown, Ct.—Mr. L. L. Knox, of the Wesleyan Uni- versity, has communicated to me the following particulars. “On the evening of the 10th of August, 1839, I commenced my ob- servations at 9 o’clock; I had however seen four meteors in the west before this. The following were the hours of observation and the number of meteors seen during each. _ Pe, 9h. to 10h. pv. m. ‘between 3 and W., 31 meteors, =31 10h. to 11h. “ 41, and2inE, =43 Ilh. to 12h. “ y 45, and2in N.E. =47 3h. to 4h. a.m. ( Lith ,) Various quarters, 66, =66 From 9h. to midnight, my attention was directed almost en- tirely to the S. W. I turned my eye a few times to the N. E. and saw four meteors in that direction, as stated above. With a few exceptions, these meteors siteined to converge nearly, toa point in the Milky Way in the 8S. W., 10° or 15° below the ho- rizon. ‘Their directions would not eres each other in a single point, but would intersect within a space of 4° or 5°. The paths of a very few were nearly at right angles to the general direction. Between 11 and 12 o’clock, only ten were seen the first half hour. They increased so much that the next half hour produced 37. I _ Yetired at midnight, and rose in season to recommence observa- tions at 3 A. M. of the 11th. ‘During the first 35 minutes I saw Jifty, but as the morning light increased, the nuimber of meteors diminished so much that only 16 more appeared before 4 o’clock. At 3h. A. M., the place of convergence had descended so far be- low the horizon, that I directed my attention to the point of di- vergence, which was now but little to the N. E. of the zenith. The meteors appeared to radiate still from the same place in the heavens, and moved in all directions from this point. The me- teors were generally very brilliant. Three ee I saw in the S. W. between 11h. and 12h., were n brillianey to the planet Venus. About 15 minutes before iih., while looking to- wards the S. W., 1 observed a bright flash on surrounding ob- jects, exactly Septet to a faint flash of lightning, which at first I Supposed it was, but it soon occurred to me that it must have been a meteor. I immediately turned to the N. E. and saw the train it had left, still quite brilliant, and it was several seconds be- “fore it dititely disappeared. ‘The train was short, and lay in Vol. xxxvi1, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 42 330 Shooting Stars of August, 1839. a horizontal direction, directly west from the point of diver- gence.* “ Professor Smith requests me to say that he saw 23 meteors in N. E. and E. between 9h. 30m. and 10 P. M. and 9 or 10 after 10 o’clock. The point or rather space of divergence he places near Algenib in the constellation Perseus.” 3. New York City—Mr. Charles Baldwin writes me as fol- lows :—‘‘ About 9 P. M. of the 10th Aug., I saw several meteors in quick succession ; and walking on, I met a friend who had been abroad for shout: an hour previous, during which time he had counted upwards of 40 meteors. Between that time and half past 10, I observed for about 30 to 45 minutes; my field of view _ being from the N. by way of the E. to the S. E. In that time I counted 36 meteors, many of which left long luminous trains behind them. They moved almost universally in a southern di- rection.” 4. Niagara, N. Y.—Mr. W. C. Redfield of New York, has favored me with the following memorandum, “ On the evening of the 10th of August, 1839, about 9 o’clock, being-at Niagara Falls, my attention was arrested by several brilliant shooting stars which successively crossed the heavens. This led me to recol- lect that it was one of the periods at which their recurrence was expected, and on giving my attention for a part of the time be- tween 9 and half past 10, 1 saw many of these meteors, differing from each other in brilliancy and apparent magnitude, but all pas- sing in a southerly direction. One of great brilliancy passed to the west of south, and was lost to me behind the roof of the ho- tcl. My estimate of the probable number that might be seen by constant observation, was an average of one per minute; but in one instance three or four were seen in less than a minute.” 5. Philadelphia, Pa.—Mr. Azariah, Smith, Jr., has published in Bites ‘Public Ledger,” an account of the observations made by fin a? Philadelphia, of which the following is an abstract. ‘The ee of meteors seen between 10h. P. M. of the 9th and 1 A. . of the 10th, by one observer watching only half ss — about 50. The position was nafayorbie, viz. in| “* Mr. Knox ‘han minutely described the apparent position of this meteor, ye was probably identical with the brilliant one we saw about the same tim , but y we did not fix its place with sufficient precision, to enable us sf de- termine its altitude, size, d&c. i! ba * Shooting Stars of August, 1839. a or at a third-story window of a building in the city, the houses on the opposite side of the street being one story higher. Seven meteors were seen between 11h. 55m. and 12h., four of which fell in one minute; and in two other instances ‘have were seen to fall in the same time. At least four fifths of the whole number seen had manifest trains, and one fourth of these were unusually brilliant, and varying from 10° to 20° in length. e were un- able to fix upon the radiating point until 11 o’clock, when it was in the breast of Cassiopeia; at 12 it was near 3 Cassiopeize, and at 1 near the tail of the Camelopard. At none of these times, however, was the radiant an exact point; and twice the routes of two meteors were observed to cross each other, in the first case at 2°, and in the last at about 4° from their origin. Four or five of the 12 seen before 10h. P. M. seemed to come from near the body of the Swan; and two or three of those observed after this hour must be set down as unconformable, since although they came from the Northern part of the heavens, they could not be traced to the radiant region of the others On the 10th I commenced observations with a friend, from the top of a building, at Sh. 20m. P. M., and although both looked in the same direction, (N.) we saw 36 meteors between that time and 9 o’clock. From 9h. to 9h. 15m. the number seen was 13, while in the half hour succeeding, only 19 were observed. At this time we began to observe in different portions of the heavens, and before 10h. we saw six in the N. and seven in the S. In the next fifteen minutes, ten were seen in the same man- ner, when we retired to our room; after which, and before 11h., twelve were seen through a window opening towards the north; the whole number seen after 8h. 20m. being ninety-three. ‘These, with the exception of not more than 13, were visible to one ob- The trains left by the meteors were less brilliant ee one Or The 2 of radiation was not as clearly circumscribed as on — the evening of the 9th, and at haif past 8, was in the same situa-_ tion as it was on that evening at 11. It appeared to move slowly in the same direction, and when we ceased our observations, had * Doubtless some were unconformable ; but as we see only the position of the ‘plane in which the — moves, its real direction may in some cases be nearly ranrse a to its app 332 Shooting Stars of August, 1839. apparently advanced about the same distance. We would sug- gest the query, whether these meteors do not generally come from a belt of the heavens, rather than from a circumscribed spot. ‘Several persons have remarked to.us that more than an ordinary number of meteors were seen on the evenings of the 7th and 8th, but no definite observations were made.—Ledger, Aug. 13, 1839. 6. Mississippi and Ohio Rivers.—Mr. Forrest Shepherd of this city, who was travelling from the 3d to the 12th of August last on the Mississippi and Ohio, made during that period such observations for meteors as his circumstances permitted, and with the following general results. During the nights from 3d to 6th, inclusive, the number of meteors was greater than usual. On the 7th, the number was somewhat diminished. From the 8th to 10th, inclusive, meteors were much more abundant, and attracted the attention of unconcerned persons. On the 12th he made no observation, and on the next night he found that they were be- coming less frequent. 7. Pensacola, Florida.—Mr. E. Fitch, Prof. Maths. U. 8. N., has sent me an account of some brief observations which intervals of clear sky permitted him to make about the 9thof August. His letter not being at hand, I can here only state that during the early part of the night, at that epoch, it did not appear that me- teors were unusually numerous, but after midnight they were rather more frequent than common. At Claiborne, Ala., the state of the sky prevented the observers at that place from obtaining any satisfactory view. 8. At sea, lat. about 44° N. ; lon. 46° to 44° W.—Prof. c. U. Shepard expected to observe, (oni his passage to London in the eee British Queen,) the meteors which might appear on bout the 9th of August. Ihave this day learned from him that ve enings, from the 9th to the 13th, inclusive, proved unfa- ble. . “On the evening of the 7th, several meteors were seen, sf which, at 11h. 5m. P. M., was very splendid, and illumina- ted the northern quarter of the heavens for at least one minute.* Soa Roberts informed me the next day that between midnight and 4 A. M., (of the 8th,) he was struck by the number of shoot- In g stars. He was decidedly of opinion that they were more fre- t than.common.” On the evening of the 8th, it did not ap- ix From m this it may be inferred that the tratn of the meteor remained in sight for one minute, 5 ate Shooting Stars of August,1839. 383 pear that they were more numerous than usual, but there was no systematic observation. For five days subsequent to this, the weather was unpropitious. I am indebted to Prof. 8. for the fol- lowing extract from the London Globe of Aug. 20, 1839. 9. Brussels, Belgium.— Falling Stars.—During the nights of Friday and Saturday, the 9th and 10th of August, the heavens were bestrewed with little falling stars of extraordinary bright- ness. Mr. [T.?] Forster counted above 600 of them. It is not a little singular that the peasants of Franconia and Saxony have believed for ages past, that St. Lawrence weeps tears of fire, which fall from the sky every year on his féte, (the 10th of Au- gust.) This ancient popular German tradition or superstition has been found, within these few years, to be a fact which engages the attention of astronomers. The inhabitants of Brussels can bear witness that on the night of the 10th, this deg St. Law- rence shed abundance of tears.— Brussels Paper. Remarks. It is evident from the observations above detailed, that on the nights of August 9th and 10th, 1839, shooting stars were much more abundant than usual; and it will probably not be doubted that they were also unusually numerous, but to a less degree, du- ring a few days previous and subsequent to that time. At this place, (and probably in all parts of the globe having about the same ora higher northern latitude,) the number seen during these two nights was at least four or five. times greater than the yearly average. ‘This average is not yet settled with much exactness, but from several observations made here, it seems improbable that it exceeds 30 per hour for four observers. On the night succeed- ing July 16, 1839, Messrs. Bush and Haile, and myself, aepaved for three hours, ending at 2 A. M. of the 17th, with special ence to a comparison with August 9th and 10th. or i 74 meteors; adding to this number a third part, we 100, or an average of 33 per hour for four observers. The ti night at which the meteors were most frequent, was, probably, as appears by the observations of Mr. Knox, at Middletown, later than 3 A. M., at which time the radiant was not far from the meridian. The sian of the radiant as determined here, differs but little from the mean of the observations made in this country in August, 1838, (this Jour., vol. 35, p: 169, etc.,) but it cannot be considered as settled with all the precision which may be hereafter attained. 4 . >t 834 Shooting Stars of August, 1839. Tt will be noticed that fis: centre is about 40° N. of the point in the eclipti , towards which at that time the earth’s motion is di- rected? a differs little from it in Right Ascension. It will also be remarked, that the radiants of the meteors of August 9 and 10, and of December 6 and 7, (1838, this Jour., vol. 35, p. 364,) are in the same region of the heavens, and that at the former time the earth is moving towards a point about 117° from the place towards which its motion is directed at the latter season. It » remains to be ascertained what is the position of the radiant as “ observed in southern latitudes; if indeed meteors are found to be unusually abundant there at this epoch, which is somewhat doubtful. Further Observations on the Meteors of Aug. 9th and 10th, 1838. 1. Professor Barnard of the University of Alabama, Tuscaloosa, in an article published in July, 1838, in “ The Flag of the Un- ion,” at the place just named, invited the attention of the south- ern public to the meteoric season expected during the August en- suing. At the appointed time the weather was generally very unfavorable for observation. In a communication to the above- mentioned paper of Sept. 12th, 1838, Professor Barnard remarks, “ During the entire night of the 9th—10th ult., the sky was heav- _ ily overcast, the greatest rain of the month having occurred on the evening of the preceding day. Clouds very much obscured the heavens on several nights previous. Nevertheless, I observed an unusual number of remarkably bright meteors, though nothing » which could be denominated a shower. The same was the result * of observations continued through the two succeeding nights, though the heavens were then clearer. I have heard but from two places in the south which enjoyed an unobscured sky on the : % x of meteors was observed, amounting in one place to more oh Sie sieatl in half an hour before midnight.” 2. The Lond. and Ed. Phil. Mag. Oct. 1838, contains observa- Len M: A. Quetelet at Brussels ; and by Messrs. E. J. Cooper, -Wartmann and others at Geneva. (1.) At Brussels the t of the 9th Aug. was overcast. Night of 10th-partly clear ; : 11—1th. 50m., 39; afterwards cloudy. Night A saw from 9—10, 34 meteors; from 10— from 11—12, 24; from 12—1, 32; from 1—2, 12; from cars ae ase. ight of the 9th—10th. In those places quite an unusual num-— Shooting Stars of Ae ug 2—24,10. M. Quetelet remarks sent their general direction was from N. E. to S. W.; and if the sky had been clear, many more would doubtless tare been seen. (2.) At Geneva, during the night of the 10th, six observers saw from 8 P. M. to 4 A. M. (11th,) 380 meteors. Mr. C. states that the meteors did not ap- pear to come from a common focus; but the details which he gives, correspond substantially with the account of their direction given by Quetelet. On the night of the 11th, meteors were nearly as abundant as on the 10th. M. Wartmani; in his ; count of the same observations, (Bib. Univ. Aott, 1838,) aot that—(3.) At Planchettes, Switzerland, M. Reynier, observed alone, between 9 P. M. of 9th and 2 A. M. of 10th August, sixty- three meteors; and on the night succeeding, from 84 P. M. to A. M., one hundred and four. (4.) At Vienna, (as appears by a note in L’Institut, No..261, Dec. 27, 1838,) M. Littrow (with how many assistants is not stated) observed at the August epoch in 1838, with the following results. On the 7th and 8th, meteors were counted at the rate of about 6 per hour; 9th, 15 per hour; 10th, 60 per hour; 11th and 12th, about 30 per hour. It was then cloudy until 18th, and the mean number seen during the clear intervals was 10 per hour. és It must be remembered, that on this occasion the light of the moon greatly interfered with the observations, concealing, proba- bly, full half of the meteors which might have been seen in her absence. Additional facts concerning the Meteoric season of August. During the year past, the following additional evidence has come to my knowledge. (1.) In a letter to Dr. Rush, dated Northumberland, E23; im 4 Ath, 1801, Dr. Joseph Priestley makes the annexed — fatement, which, although expressed with singular indirect dou, refers to a very considerable display of shooting stars. a 0 on the eighth of August last, I was called out of my ‘house to 2 serve a singular kind of lightning ; indeed, it was more of the na- ture of a meteor than of lightning ; for the flashes were of some continuance, and many of them threw out a prodigious nu of balls of fire. One of these streams of lightning, for they could not well be called flashes, very much resembled a rocket. It arose from below the horizon, and extended beyond the zenith; and there came from all the parts of it, in every direction, sald ~ . ~ a a. eer ee) 5 oe : 3 4 s of August, 1839. ’ fire, Ww mmon optical deception, seemed to 0 seme with | their source by fine strings of fire. They some distance and then vanished. It was a magnificent “Those flashes, some more and some less remark tim tall and I doubt not, were of the nature of meteors.” —Medical Repos., 8vo. N. Y. tol 6 . (1802.) pp. 33, 34. (2.) I am indebted to Prof. Olmsted, fot the following facts re- cently communicated to him by an officer of the U. S. Navy, who the memoranda at the time. — August 8, 1836. I have observed for several nights past, an unusual-number of shooting stars, darting towards all parts of the heavens. “Lat. at merid. 34° 45’ N. Long. 174° 49’ E. of Greenwich. * August 9, 1836. Saw more brilliant meteoric appearances last night ; one of them left a train similar to a rocket. “ Lat. at merid. 33° 49 N. Long. 177° 10’ E. of Greenwich. “ August 11, 1836. Last night I again observed an unusual number oo meteors, and I find that the — have noti- ced the e in their watches “Lat. at merid. 31° 27’ N, Lon 179° 50’ E. of Greanwich: % It will be remembered that unusual numbers of meteors were seen in this country about the same time, by Prof. Joslin and oth- (This Jour. vol. 33, p. 178. G. ) Chladni, (iiber Favor Matcore, etc. Ato. Wien, 1819,) after referring to the meteoric showers of 533, 763, 1096, 1798 (Dec. 6,) 1799 (Nov. 12,) adds, “On the evening of the 10th of August, 1815, also, as I have been assured by a trustworthy ob- server, there must have appeared a very large number of shooting stars. as. SK of the 9th and 10th, on Anges 1822 ,) I observed a number of gor. shooting meteors.” il. 1823,) vol. 2. p. xlviii, under | date of Missouri, Aug ‘Tomas. Srzciric Cuaracter.—L. flexuosa. Stem flexuous. Leaves few ; upper lance- * ih, semi-amplexicaul Peduncles from the upper isite, bracted, supporting one flower. Osservations.—Root, tuberous. Stem, a foot high, simple, smooth, striate, Leaves, 12 to 15, clasping the stem half round, ee acute, nerved ; ciliate near the base, slightly pubescent on the - if surface, smooth beneath. Lower leaves linear, somewhat ring towards the base, from 6 to 10 inches long, but short aaa the middle of "es stem upwards, until the upper ms . Be ae E leaves become lance-linear to 10, pale red-purple. — nz I have cultivated this Bie two height. From one root, four stems itive: arisen - me a inches high; but of a dozen plants which { gathered n of nature, no root had more than one stem. apirat.—East bank of the Niagara river, below the Falls. Flowers in. the stab month, ( one ) Sy FAS) SY, A, ss ~ or. ‘ - Af Prise ahi <2. BN Ss Liatria flexuosa. ti at i A a < be i ~~ Xe ae i - 340. Observations on the New Haven Tornado. Art. Observations on the New Haven Tornado of July 31, 1839; by Denison Otmsrep, Professor of Natural Philoso- phy’ and Astronomy i in Yale College. On the 31st of July, 1839, there occurred, on the western skirts of the city of New Haven, a tornado of the most violent class. 'The preceding morning had been cloudy and sultry, and Sra, Say to the tornado, a thunder storm seemed approaching from the west, attended by some appearances of h wind. I was, at the time, about a mile eastward of the track of the storm, observing the phenomena from my chamber window. The clouds betrayed that singular agitation, which usually forebodes a hurricane, and the vane of a neighboring steeple was constantly shifting its position. A short time before the tornado commenced, the wind blew fresh from the southeast, having been in this quarter during the preceding morning; it changed suddenly to the south, and in a moment more st was heavy rumbling noise was heard, not ‘unlike the ashe ore ra long _ train of railway cars, which was ‘widible in every part of the city. _ Such were the only facts of importance which I had an oppor- tunity of observing at the time; but the circumstances have proved unusually favorable for in ¥etivatine the laws of the storm, occurring as it did at mid-day, and so near to us that we have been able to repeat our examinations of the grounds a number of times. Among those included within the limits of the tornado, were several accurate and intelligent observers, who remarked the apie much attention; and even those who were buried beneath the ruins of their houses, have all survived to tell their story. In addition to these peculiar opportunities for ascer- taining t the facts respecting the storm, I have had the still greater - advantage of comparing my owu observations with those of my ee Professor Stanley, Mr. A. B. Haile, and Mr. E. C. Herrick, 7 of om have taken the greatest pains to investigate the phe- aq pomena seg. laws’ of the tornado. Hence the facts which I have tate, are, T think, the result of better opportunities for obser- ‘and of a more elaborate and careful examination, than “usual in storms of this class, ‘ es 5 eat oe may be proper to premise, that the city.of New Haven is situated at the head of a bay, that sets up five miles from the north side of Long Island Sound. It is built on a plain” which i is bounded on the west by a low range of hills, called the Woodbridge hills. At the northwestern and northeastern ang les of the town are the two celebrated bluffs, called West and East Rock, respect- ively, well as the southern terminations of the chains of eat mountains, that extend northward through Connecticut and Mas- sachusetts. The storm commenced in the low ground at the east- ern base of the Woodbridge hills. Its course was N. E. by E. across a level region occupied by farm-houses, cornfields, and gardens for amile anda half. It then ascended an inclined plane to a higher level, and passed through a wood towards East Rock. Bounding over this eminence, it descended its eastern declivity, and lost it- self in an extensive salt meadow that lies eastward of the mountain. Throughout this region its progress was indicated by marks of the greatest violence. Nearly every tree that came in its way through the open country, was prostrated or broken off ; six houses, and a number of barns, were completely emaclicdenill several other houses and barns were unroofed ; fields of corn, their: just earing, were laid close to the gioued; and indeed, the whole é space over which the tornado had passed, presented one uniform scene of ruin and desolation. ge extent, this tornado appears to have been very limited. Its length did not exceed four miles, and its average breadth was only sixty rods, varying however a little in different places. _ Its duration at any one place did not exceed half a minute, and its progressive motion may be est dat 40 miles per hour. These estimates are made by pe The appearance of the storm as it approached, was be contemplated by numerous observers, who saw it comi the plain. All describe it as a strange cloud, of terrific. aspect, * white like a driving snow-storm, or light foe, and agitated by the most violent intestine motions. It came suddenly upon ‘them with ‘ in order to make our Rilisigiions intelligible | to ” stacks) it # torrents of water—“ there was a rush—a crash—and i it was gone. » ee When first seen coming over East Rock, it seemed ‘lifted above the ridge of the mountain, but fell nearer to the earth as it. $ descended the eastern Ceclivity, and renewed its work of de- struction when it reached the plain. 4 342 Observations on the New Haven Tornado. Let us now trace more. particularly those facts which ms c bearing upon the laws which govern this storm. ere i 1. The first great fact that strikes us, is, that all the fecs rg bis other objects that mark the direction of the wind which prostra- ted them, are with very few exceptions, turned inwards on both sides towards the center of the track ; while near the center, the direction of the prostrate bodies is colin with that of the storm. 2. On more minute inspection, we find prevailing a remarka- ble law of curvature. 'This is most favorably seen in cornfields, as the prostrate corn indicates the course of the wind at each spot, with great precision. The law is this. Commencing on the northern margin of the track, the stalks of corn are turned back- ward, that is, toward the S. E. ;—proceeding towards the center of the track, their inclinations to the south become constantly less and less, turning gradually towards the course of the storm, until when we reach the center, they lie to the N. E., exactly in the line of the storm. This eurvature is in all cases more ob- servable on the northern, than on the southern side of the track. In the latter case, the stalks of corn lie more nearly at_ right 3} areeo | the course of the storm, (but inclining forward ;) still, on a1 towards the center of the track, 0 they had fallen, were turned farther roun on in which the tornado — Was moving, that is, towa s the 4. The ruins of buildings that were demolished, are scattered in nearly a right line towards the center of the track; but they frequently are strewed quite across the central parts, reaching, in some instances almost to the opposite margin. In this case, they are often found covered with trees, and other bodies lying in pre- = 4 cisely the opposite direction. (5. Ina by bye ay very limited spots are found where the rostrate b s hills of corn, lie in all directions. Examples here tion of the same hill of corn is turned west- ortion eastward. er these general statements we may now have recourse to nying diagram, and review particular cases of the s or modes of action. For this representation of < Observations on the New Haven Tornado. \ gram represents four successive se:tions of the storm, considerable inter- i ing omitte he bounding lines of the sections, bei s dia near 1 d for want of room. IV. - oct = Win, My Jind. 2 2 # 344 Observations on the New Haven Pocnaié the phenomena of the tornado, I am indebted to Mr. A. B. Hai who took the bearings of the various prostrate objects with a compass. In most cases, I have been able to attest the accur of the representations by actual inspection; and in regard the few instances where my attention has not been particul attracted to the fact represented, I entertain no doubt of the e1 accuracy of the delineation. The diagram commences at A, at a mulberry grove half a mile from the spot where the tornado first formed. The dotted line bears N. 50° E. It will be perceived that the trees which lie in the center of the track generally coincide with it, and that those which lie on either side are turned inwards towards the center. Yet several examples are seen, where trees lie pointing outward from the center, both in the middle and in.the marginal portions of the track, as at N,Q, Rand 8S. These exceptions moreover, are all on the north side of the track. Examples of the remarkable law of curvature referred to, are seen at Gand O, where the figures represent the direction of stalks of corn in two. fields nearly a mile distant from each other. It will be observed by the diagram, that from the margin the direction of the stalks | inclines more and more inwards, and finally, in the center, coin- - cides with the course of: the storm. It is also. obvious from the * figure that this law is more fully developed on the left than on a the <= side of the track. The same tendency to this curve ttere In some cases a moved round into the places the y niece y: tree is seen to have commenced falling at right angles to the track, but during its fall to have been twisted round towards the course of the storm. Similar examples are found of limbs bent around the trunks of the trees from which they were partially 3 Observations on the New Haven Tornado. 345 st remote from the building, the fragments are covered by rn thrown down in the opposite direction. A more striking ample of the same fact, is seen near the eastern limits of the ado, where the fragments of a roof are scattered towards the ; while a a tree a few paces from the building, is turned di- ey towards the building, covering a portion of the fragments. At C is represented a limited spot in a cornfield where the stalks lie in every direction. While in a few places, at distant points, particular spots seem to have been subjected to a peculiar violence, ’ other limited spots exhibit a remarkable exemption from the ef- fects of the tornado. In a garden near H, are a few rows of pole beans apparently untouched by the storm, while within a few feet on either hand, the most violent effects are exhibited. Near L, a barn was demolished: and a dove-cote scattered in fragments, while a hen-roost which stood feebly on blocks, was unharmed. Large trees in the immediate vicinity were torn up by the roots. A house that stood between I, and L, was completely torn in pieces, leaving nothing but the southern half of the ground floor. _ In the room of this floor, a woman was washing, and another was at work in a basement room immediately below, while her child was asleep in a cradle in a room above, at the northeastern angle Be of the house.. They saw the tornado approaching; the wo in the basement ran up and caught her child in her arms, and immediately afterwards found herself and child in an open field a few paces north of the house, the child having been carried only. a few feet from the spot where they were, while the mother was carried eighteen or twenty feet fart to t estward. The other woman meanwhile was swept ¢ from the floor where she Was standing and carried north and deposited in the cellar, the floor of the northern half of the house having been borne away along with other parts of ‘the building. None of the party were Seriously injured. A bureau that was in the room where the Woman was washing, was carried half a mile to the eastward, and * portions of it were found sticking in the sides of ih err ss penetrated the thick wall of plank. A silk e also. from this house, and carried over East Rock to the diste three miles. to a barn that was blown down ont o east si of East Rock, a boy that was on a load of hay in transported across the street and deposited in a miforine field pire unharm Vol. seeaens, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 44 boas, Se = eae oe - SEAS Se = ; ¥ ai a * a | 346 Observations on the New Haven Tornado. _ In other cases, however, forces seem to have acted with great violence upon the individual parts of bodies. Numerous ins ae ces occurred where hens were completely stripped of their feath-_ ef ers. A wagon was taken up along with the shed in which it was 7 standing. The shed was scattered in fragments, and the wagon was carried northward a hundred feet or more and dashed side- ways against a barn, leaving a full impression of one of the wheels on the walls of the barn. Having here nearly reached the cen- ter of the track, it took a turn to the northeast and was deposited at the distance of several rods in an exceedingly mutilated state, — the top having been carried off and not yet found, and the strong iron springs broken and bent in a manner that denoted an exceedingly violent action. No part of this violence is to be aseri- bed to the force with which it fell to the ground ; for it must have fallen very gently, since the ground was scarcely broken at all. The same fact was observed in the cases of trees and other heavy bodies that were raised into the atmosphere and transported to a> distance. They did not generally appear to have fallen with the ordinary force of falling bodies. These forces which acted upon the individual parts of a body often appear to have acted in contrary directions. The legs of the same table were found deposited at the distance of many feet from each other in different directions ; and this was true also of the hinges of the same door. We examined diligently for evidence of an explosive force act- ing on buildings from within, in consequence of a sudden rarefac- tion of the air on the outside of the building, agreeably to what is reported of the New Brunswick tornado, and of other similar storms. - We found but one case that favored such a supposition. This was the case of a barn where the walls were thrown out on every side, and without much apparent violence. At T, near the center of the track, are exhibited two trees, each of which bounded along in the directs tion of the storm. ‘The tree on the right was torn up at the place marked 1, and struck the ground successively at the points 2and 3. With the fo oing facts before us, we should naturally proceed * next to the inguiries, —How was this tornado formed? Whence did i it derive its violent intestine motions? What was the na these ?, Whence its progressive motion ? a. Miscellanies, ) rs In order to obtain a correct answer to these inquiries, we ought , a compare the facts. exhibited in this storm with those of various other storms similar to this, as has been done by Mr. Redfield and Col. Reid in respect to the great gales of the Atlantic. I have not at present the leisure for such an investigation, but may possi- bly recur to the subject in a future number of the Journal. MISCELLANIES, : FOREIGN AND DOMESTIC. Notices of geological and other physical facts and of antiquities in Asia, from Sir Robert K. Porter’s Travels in Georgia, Persia, Armenia, Ancient Babylonia, &c. &c., during the years 1817, 718, 719, and °20, with numerous engravings of portraits, Costumes, an- tiquities, &c. In two 4to vols. London, 1821. Vol. I, pp. 720. Vol. II, pp. 869. ’ eae The splendid volumes whose title is cited above, are, we have rea- son to believe, Jittle known to the reading public of this country. Being, from their size and their numerous graphic illustrations, very cave t ey é are found in a few of our libraries ; and it was See eee rtm th C 7 olle ege- Although the book is oat of print, we are assured that a copy may be occasionally obtained in England, and we venture strongly to re- commend the work as a great treasure in all libraries, especially in those of colleges and other public institutions. We hesitate not to say, that these solide form the most instructive, valuable and inter- esting book of travels which we have ever read. They are replete with the most important information, and from the numerous and striking proofs of the truth of the scripture history. wh ich are found in the places where the events occurred as well; as from innumerable relics of ancient structures and of pi mitive manners which, after thousands of years, linger still in their native places, Sir Robert Kerr Porter’s work leaves on the mind of the reader, and especially of the young, the strongest conviction that the Old Testament. is true, and that therefore the New cannot be false. Sir Robert’s mind seems to have ; been imbued with the highest reverence for the book 6f God, and he appears to be never more gratified than when he'finds, as he often does, illustrations of its truth. * — iy + ca Sr oie cant 348 Miscellanies. Ps * Being himself an artist, he enjoyed and enables his readers to “enjoy the highest advantage of vivid graphic sketches, made onthe ‘spot, and thus his great work is rendered perfectly intelligible and highly impressive and delightful. He disclaims all skill as a writer, ~ while his intellectual sketches vie with those of his pencil, and his eloquent and beautiful descriptions leave the strongest and most agreeable impressions on the mind. In perusing his work we made short notes of subjects relating chiefly to physical facts and phenomena, and especially to geology. Although they were made merely for private reference, we have thought ona reperusal fifteen months from their date, after our first vivid impres- sions have subsided, that they may be useful to others cultivating similar fields of knowledge, and we therefore insert them under our miscellany. They are more condensed than they would have been had we selected them originally with reference to the present use, but, as we have no copy of the work we cannot revise them either for en- -Jargement or for correction. 1. Vol. I, p. 75. Tue Caucasus RancE is described with the re- markable Pass of Darial on the river Terek, where there is a chasm of 1,000 feet high, while the general elevation of the mountain range is not less than 3,780* feet. 2. Basatt.—In the valley are Basaltie Columns arranged in huge masses over the surface of the mountain, and taking various diree- tions ; some shoot horizontally into its side, some stand in erect piles against it, and others incline more or less from the perpendicular 5 resembling the palaces, castles, temples, embattled walls, and other ruins of some vast antediluvian city- - This basaltic valley exhibits the most extraordinary features. It. appears not only as already remarked like the ruins of some vast city, but on the top of one of its cliffs are the ruins of a real ancient towe?s or castle, or temple, probably Roman. The basaltic columns have sometimes serpent-like forms—twining together or radiating in a hundred points: others are again perfectly perpendicular, forming vast and sublimely pillared walls; or they are horizontal or traverse each other obliquely, or, perhaps tumble 3 together in all directions—standing, lying, and leaning, com posing the wildest and most picturesque combinations. The columns are 1? general pentagons, usually with the upper surface convex like those of the giant’s causeway ; texture close, color dark grey- In gene- a Sa eee ee 2 S * Mount Elborus is the highest point being 16,700 feet above the sea level. Mount Kasibeck is 14,400 feet ; both are covered by eternal snow. a Tocks sloping inwards, and thence springs a second wall of columns . running up to the same height; then comes another slope and another Miscellanies. 349 ral the masses shoot up from the valley vertically to the height ) to 400 feet; at the summit there is a short receding ledge © wall and so on till these successions of terraces and basaltic super- structures terminate at the top of the mountain under a thick stratum of shapeless rock. Consequently the entire height of these groups or successions of columnar terraces must be from 1, 000 to 2,000 or more feet high. 3. Fioops.—-Immense floods, arising from the thawing of the snows, throw down tremendous avalanches of rocks. There was a deluge ‘in the Caucasus in June, 1776, when the water rose 258 feet; the depth of the snow rolled down owing to the fall of the peak of the Kasibeck was 186 feet; it dammed the Terek for twelve days, when it burst away in an overwhelming torrent, resounding louder than thunder, and burying valleys, villages, and- people under snow, ‘ice, and rocky ruins. 4. Hor Batus.—Near Tiflis (Geo.) the hot water is very abundant, feeding the baths; the temperature at their source is 42. R= 941 F the smell is sulphureous; there is a great number of baths frequented by all classes, and every thing about them is wet and dirty; the baths are excavated in the solid rock over which the water formerly e female apartments there was no disguise ; the females F from observation. At Elija, near one of the sources of the Euphrates, there is a hot spring where three or four buffaloes were enjoying the bath, and about fifteen or twenty boys were play- ing beneath them. 5. Bortinc SpriNG NEAR THE AKHOOR River.—The spring issues | from the ground with rolunen of steam, wreathing in white clouds through the air. 6. ARARAT—ExTiNcT VoLcaNno NEAR Mount Ararat.—There is no verdure, but universal sterility ; all parts are covered with volca- nic stones or masses like cinders, black, heavy and honey-combed, as if thrown from an iron-forge. A hill near Ararat is evidently an extinct volcano, athough no author mentions any volcano near to this mountain From the plain below Ararat appeared “as if the hugest moun- tains in the world had been piled upon each other to form this one sublime immensity of earth, and rock, and snow. The icy peaks of its double heads rose majestically into the clear and cloudless heav- ens: the sun blazed bright upon them; and the reflection sent forth my 350 | Miscellanies. ‘a dazzling radiance equal to other suns. The eye, not able to rest, for any length of time, upon the blinding glory of its summits, wan- dered down the apparently interminable sides till their vast lines could be no longer traced in the mists of the horizon; when the eye was by an irrepressible impulse carried up again to fix its gaze upon the awful glare of Ararat.” No one has ascended the peaks of Ararat, which is covered with eternal ice and snow.* 7. An INTERNAL VoLcaNno.—In the Courdish country there isa hill 250 feet high, with a rucky crater forty five feet wide at top and with a funnel-shaped hole, as wide as a well, and quite fathomless. Several stones thrown in produced no report; the natives said that the hole _ reached through to Yankey Doonia, i. e. the new world. A register gh ae 25 _ kept at Eitch-mai-adzen for 800 years, makes no mention of any volcanic eruption. a al 8. Sarr near Tanr1z.—Salt is dug in the hills near this place, and the river Augi is perfectly salt. ot 9. Sait 1n Laxe Oroomta, about five days journey long.—This_ water contains one third more salt than the sea; the Jake is hemmed in by a broad border or belt of salt looking at a distance like a vio- lent surf (congealed); itis three or four miles wide, and one foot thick, or more in places where the shore shelves or gently slopes. 10. Satr Mine near Erivan.—There is a salt mine in the hills; the revenue to the governor of Erivan is about £5,000 sterling. It supplies the neighborhood, and Turks and Georgians repair to it for immense loads; several hundred bullocks were at the time carrying it away in large slabs like alabaster. There are excavations in the mountain in vast galleries and caverns giving a dazzling reflection from the surface when any light strikes them; the salt has been wrought from the earliest times, gives great supplies, and is not yet exhausted. 11. Sar or THE Great Sart Desert.—Lat. 35° N. Long. 70° E- —There is a copious salt stream and over some hills is seen the salt desert, and east and southwest a vast region of sand reaching to the horizon. The large tracts of salt appeared in the distance, spotting the burning plain like so many shining lakes, one fourth of an inch thick and smooth as a mirror; the view was one of awful grandeur, connected as sandy deserts usually are with “ consuming blasts, over- whelming sands and the burying of thousands of human beings.” ial rete nt CS * Sir R. K. P. thinks that the ark rested in the hollow between the two peaks. eat te at oe A i Es Miscellanies. — a 351 12. Earruquakes at Tasriz.—In 1727, 70,000, wis ine 1787; 40,000, persons nearly the entire population of Tabriz, perished by earthquakes. During the present season, (Jan. 1819,) and towards the spring, scarce a week passes without some dreadful signals. The first signal is a heaving of the earth with rapid shaking of doors and win- dows ; sometimes whole ranges of houses fall, and all theit inmates disregarding the timely warning, are buried in their ruins. There are generally two thunderings in the ground, seeming to roll regularly on towards the mountains, whence after a pause of several seconds, loud noises are heard, like distant tremendous ex- plosions. If the imprisoned powers (gases, vapors, &c.) do not find vent, they then roll back again, filling every creature with horror. The earth becomes literally palsied, and even should the dreadful » current again take a retrograde motion, every building falls a heap of Tuins where the convulsion is felt. During the awful suspense, the people run out to avoid the shock, the most piercing. cries are ir and the very dogs how] and bark. To the European residents at Tabriz, these sounds are often the first signals of alarm ; their houses being so constructed as to yield like wicker work. The whole envi- rons, for more than a mile around the walls, are covered with over- turned houses, mosques, &c., half buried among the shattered rocks which mingle in every direction with torn heaps of earth and ruins. 13. Taurus Mounrarns, sovru or THE Evxine.—This range was passed by Sir R. K. Porter, in the.night. These mountains are fear- fully magnificent. In passing them, there was the utmost danger of plunging down perpendicularly many hundred feet; the party ascen- ded steeps and passed along rocky ledges, scarcely wide enough to ad- mit a single horse, on the brink of precipices so terrifically high, that in broad light they would not have dared to tempt them on foot. The train of baggage horses, tied head and tail by halters, and loaded with heavy cases, scrambled over the most dangerous points, when it was so dark that nothing but some preternatural instinct could guide them- In this way they moved with an unswerving pace along the narrowest ridges, with a wall of rock pressing on one side, and the shelving path receding from their footsteps on the other. Sir R. K. P. committed himself entirely to the little creature he rode, and never once touched the bridle ; if the animal’s head is at liberty he feels con- fidence in himself, while the pulling of the bridle often brings him to the ground. 14. Copper Mines.—Near the town of Samsoon are silver and cop- per mines, two of which, called Malett and Jumbish, are very ancient, and have been recently opened; this lat a reaching quite to the Eux- So * es 352 Miscellanies. ine, has always been famous for workers in iron, which is both dug from the mountain and imported from the Crimea. 15. Copper, Leap, anp Sitver.—Tokat, (where Henry Martyn E died, south of the Euxine,) carries on a considerable trade in cups and other utensils of its own manufacture; there being mines about 50 hours distant, and 20 from Too-az; besides copper they produce lead and silver, and have 50 furnaces constantly at work; they furnish most of the silver for the mint at Constantinople. 16. Iron Ore is found, equal to the Swedish, lat. 40° N. pes 40° 2 of Motincelte Ovedan. 19. AVALANCHES OF MUD, STONES, AND MOUNTAINS.—They are tre- mendous from mount Mousselim, being the effects of frost, thaw, rain, — &c.; masses measuring several hundred yards sometimes break away and slide down into the valley, destroying men and cattle. A king of Trebizond, marching along this pass during the marshy season, to in- vade the country westward, is reported to have been suddenly buried with his army,.by the fall of half the mountain. 20. Immense. Brock or Granite.—Near Hamadan, the ancient Eabatana, is a block of fine grained red granite of the weight of many thousand tons. Ten feet from the ground there are two square exca- vations, about five feet square and one foot deep, each of which con-— ae tains three columns of engraved arrow-headed writing, in the most excellent preservation; hitherto they have never been decyphered. There are granite mountains here, and Elwund is probably of that rock: from its summit are seen the peculiarities of an Asiatic land- scape—rock, mountain, desert, and a sky of fire. 21. Nirrovus Errtorescence—is found on the ruins of accuse z and in many other places. 22. Tower or Base..—This is an immense pile of ruins,—at its base it measures 3082 feet (in circuit,)—width 450 feet; it presents two stages of hills; the first about 60 feet high, cloven into a deep ravine by the rain, and intersected by the furrows of ages. To the base of the second ascent is about 200 feet from the bottom of the entire pile, - and from the base of this ruin to the top is 35 feet. On the western side, the entire mass rises at once from the plain in one stupendous =a F Miscellanies. 353 though irregular pyramidal hill, broken in the slopes of its sweeping acclivities by time and violence. The south and north fronts are par- ticularly abrupt towards the point of the brick ruin; on the north side there are large piles of ruins of fine and solid brick-work, projecting from among immense masses of rubbish at the base; the fine bricks were evidently part of the facing of this side. The tower-like ruin of the extreme summit is a solid mass 28 feet broad, made of the most beautiful brick masonry, and presenting the apparent angle of some structure originally of a square shape, the remains of which stand on the east to the height of 35 feet, and to the south 22 feet. It is rent from the top to nearly half way down; the remains of the masonry fu mace-burnt bricks: they are united by a calcareous cement ti of an inch in thickness, havi ring in it a layer of straws, and so a sf: it could not be separated. The base of the structure was not : altered, but the piles of fine bricks thrown down were eee ze Til rifical ion is of glass in the miter ete the lines se cemen visible. and distinct, and are vitrified. ‘The consuming power appears to have acted from above, and the scattered ruins fell from a higher point than the summit of the present standing fragment. “The heat of the fire which produced such amazing effects, must have burned with the force of the strongest furnace; and from the general appearance of the cleft in the wall and these vitrified masses, I should be inclined, says the author, to attribute the catastrophe to lightning from heaven. Ruins, by the explosion of any combustible matter, would have exhibited very different appearances.” The en- tire surface of the structure appears to have been faced with fine rick. 23. Naprua Sprines anp SutpHur.—Lat. 341° N., Long. 45° E. Near Sulimania or Shinkook, in Old Assyria, ten in number—they were described by Strabo. A sulphurous air is mentioned, (probably it was mistaken for the vapor of the Naptha,) which, on drawing near, produced instantly excruciating headaches. Several pits or wells, seven or eight feet in diameter, and ten or twelve feet deep, are found all within the compass of 400 or 500 yards; a flight of steps is cut in each pit down to the fluid, which rises or falls according to the dryness or moisture of the weather. The natives dip it out with ladles into bags of skins, which are car- ried to Kirkook for sale—profits per annum 30,000 to 40,000 pias- tres. 24. Tue Kirxoox Naprua-—The Kirkook Naptha is black, and is consumed in the S. W. of Courdistan. Bagdad and its environs are Vol. xxxvu, No. 2.—July-October, 1839 45 354 Miscellanies, supplied chiefly from Kufri. Near to the wells is a pool of muddy stagnant water, covered with a thick scum deeply tinged with sulphur. A few hundred yards to the east of the top of the same hill is a flat circular spot, 50 feet in diameter, perforated by 100 or more small holes, whence issue clear smokeless flames, smelling strongly of sul- phur. In fact, the whole surface of this perforated spot of ground appeared as a crust of sulphur over a body of fire within; the sur- face being perforated by a dagger, a flame instantly issued, rising, sometimes, even higher than the others. : The government derives a revenue from the sale of the sulphur from this place; it is called by the natives Baba Gurgur—gur being their name for naptha or bitumen. Between Baba Gurgur and Kirkook were * observed innumerable spots of native sulphur, and a great many pools se . +4 Paes properties, which might be converted into excellent medi- _ ci al baths. ole ca 25. Narrua Sprines or Baxon.—N. Lat. 40°—20, E. Long. 49°— Z 50.—The peninsula of the Caspian is called Absheron. These foun- ie tains of light and heat are even more productive than those of Kir- kook, and like them are deemed inexhaustible. . Near the springs spreads the celebrated burning plain, almost @ mile wide. ‘To this place the disciples of Zoroaster resort, by thou- sands, to adore the eternal blaze, and to convey to their own hearths a portion of the sacred flame. At the distance of one mile and three fourths from the naptha springs is the fine temple of the Gubres, nearly a mile in circumference, from the centre of which arises @ bluish flame. Some small houses have been built on the spot, and the people smother the flame by covering the earth with a thick coat- ing of loam; on perceiving this, they light a flame at the orifice and apply it to culinary purposes, and the flame is easily extinguished by closing the aperture. A sulphurous gas arises from the flame, and @ strong current of inflammable air continues to issue even after the flame is extinguished, and leathern bottles are frequently filled with it. The whole country around Bakon appears sometimes as if envel- oped in flames; the fire appears to roll down from the mountains with incredible velocity and in large masses, and during the clear _ moonshine nights of November and December, a bright blue light is observed at times to cover the whole western range. Jonas Hanway mentions six springs of white naptha near Niezabad ; there were wells of dark naptha not far off. When the weather is thick and hazy, the springs boil up higher, and the naptha sometimes taking fire, runs, like burning lava, into the sea. In boiling over around the mouths of the pits, the oily substance sometimes becomes of the consistency f pitch. The poorer people sometimes use it as we do oil, to boil 5 = Miseellanies. 355 their food ; it burns best when mixed with a small quantity of ashes; and to avoid accidents, they preserve it ata distance from their houses in earthen pots, under ground. Both the black and white naptha are used for varnishes. When the naptha has been kindled accidentally, the effects have often been fatal, and Strabo says the flame cannot be extinguished by water. 3 The flaming soil, or everlasting fire, as it is called, of Bakon, is not less famous than its naptha springs. According to Mr. Rich, the principal bitumen pit at Hit,* (which place must have furnished the builders of Babylon,) has two sources, divided by a wall, on one side of which the bitumen bubbles up, and on the other the oil of naptha. . ~ In order to enable the bitumen to adhere to the bricks, as a cement, it must be boiled with a certain proportion of oil; the principal ob- ject is to guard against dampness, especially in the lower parts of buildings ; it is at present used for caulking cisterns and boats,t &e. Rock salt and sulphur are obtained in the naptha country (near Nie- zaba 26. YeLLow TRANSPARENT MARBLE OF TABRIZ, NEAR L. Oroomta. —This is found in the heights near Deygurgan. It is a kind of pet- rifaction (calc sinter) formed by water flowing from the rocks above and depositing itself, by a gradual sinking through the surface of the earth, to a certain depth beneath. A sort of incrustation covers the whole far spread mass, which extends down the slope of the hill, and over the level of its valley for a considerable way ; it is found some few feet below the crust, in thin layers, which are cut into long and wide slabs, about ten or twelve inches thick ; they are used for skirt- ing decorations for the saluons of the opulent, bordering the room all around just above the floor. When cut into very thin sheets it is translucent, like ground glass, and is used for windows of baths, &c. Pieces of it are also cut into small tablets for tomb-stones, to be im- pressed with words from the Koran. 27. Enormovs Catcareous Derosir.—Near the ruins of an an- cient city called Tact i Solomon, is a lake 60 yards by 30; its water is- sues from a channel and strikes down the side of the hill; it is so high- ly charged with lime, that the courses through which it has flowed are how transformed into long serpentine ridges of stone, running not only down the hill, but to a considerable distance along the valley, and then standing nearly three feet high above the level of the ground. The overflowings of the lake have incrusted the earth and ruins, and Spree ae ee * About four days journey N. W. of Bagdad. t And now (1839) for making pavements and roads.—B. S. Mert 356 Miscellanies. the face of the fortress in that direction, with a cream colored deposit ; nay, the hill itself on which the old city was built, 50 feet high above the plain, may probably have been raised in the same way, the pres- ent small lake being only the remains of a much larger one formerly level with the plain; and this may explain why the present lake ap- pears to be fathomless. The hill thus raised by the waters became eventually covered by a noble city, the ruins of which are now in turn covered more or less by the calcareous deposit- 28. LimesTonE wiTH Sueiis.—At Kerefto there are vast caverns wrought by art in limestone, or natural caverns enlarged and modi- fied by art; in this limestone were remains of shells ‘resembling cockles, and of nearly the same size ;’’ the caverns were very nu- merous and curiously wrougls el II, pp. 550, &c. 29. LimEsTONE PaowoNToRY on Istanp Oroom1a—It rises 800 feet high out of the lake, and is an island in the winter when the water is high, but becomes a peninsula when it is low. It is called Gooro- hin Shala. It has been made a fortress, and has but one entrance into its natural or artificial caverns, in which there is abundance’ of the most pellucid fresh water in a rock rising out of one of the saltest . lakes in the world: The ridge of the rock is scarcely six feet broad, and while the observer stands upon it at the giddy height of 800 feet above the azure Oroomia, the hollow roarings of whose waters dash- — ing into the caverns they have worn through the rock at its base, serve to increase his nervous giddiness. 30. Mica containing Potash and Lithia—M. V.Regnault has analyzed these micas; they fuse easily at a red heat, and without suffering any sensible loss of weighiinaaet are afterwards easily reduced to a fine pow- der. — at The analysis was performed by acting upon the mica, previously fused and reduced to fine powder, with hydrochloric acid, and separating the silica in the usual way. The alumina and peroxide of iron were precip- itated together by carbonate of ammonia; the liquors being evaporated, after the addition of sulphuric acid, left a residue, which, when calcined, yielded the alkaline sulphates, which were dissolved in water, and decom- posed by chloride of barium. The excess of barytes added was after- wards precipitated by dilute sulphuric. acid, added gradually; and the solution containing the. alkaline chlorides, after the addition of chloride of platina, was evaporated nearly to dryness. By the addition of alcohol, edi cl of potassium and platina was separated; the lithia was ¢ by difference, and by the composition of the sulphates. Miscellanies. 357 In order to determine the fluorine, the mica was acted upon with car- bonate of soda, and then treated with boiling water. ‘The alkaline liquor was concentrated after filtration, and then subjected to a current of car- bonic acid gas, which produced an abundant precipitate of glutinous silica. A solution of oxide of zine in carbonate of ammonia was after- wards added to the filtered liquor, and it was then evaporated to dryness ; the last traces of silica and alumina were thus separated. The saline mass was treated with a small quantity of boiling water, and the Fu, was supersaturated with hydrochloric acid in a platina capsule. lution was suffered to remain for twenty four hours, in order to i the carbonic acid to separate perfectly. It was then saturated by ammonia, and the ee precipitated by chloride of caleium.—Lond. and Edin Phil. & 31. Heat of the interior of the mis —dAs the result of numerous experiments and observations on the temperature of artesian wells in Mid-Lothian, Sterlingshire, and Clackmannanshir ein otland, Dr. Robert Patterson has deduced the following table. et. Name of Place. ~ pace District. reel | a ~ Rate of Increase. = Feet. eoownane 493 463 159 1 for orny a Ker 514 46 231 41 42 , Mots 51 46 213-11 % 42.7} 3: = Loans 48 46 100 Lee ge 50 | nad Distillery Bore 514 |. 46 2700 ee 49.1 Spring immediately under Mr. — Te 30 11 « 50 ruce of Kennet’s house The four springs here noted are 51 46 aU wk Soe 42 in the immediate neighbor- 49 46 160 | 1 at 53.1 pte hood of se and quite 50% 46 wok Se 42.6 lose to the 51 46 al0"* |. 1 42 arish of Witlinnant. 48 45 18 1 = 60 | Av erage| A for Md) HL 47. 11 A simple inspection of this table will sae how very ry pearlytihie re- sults of different localities approximate ; and if we take the average number of these results, 1° for every 48 feet as we descend, we shall find that it comes very near the average, as fixed upon by the British Association, which is 1° for every 45 feet in depth. On comparing ~ this table with the following, which has been drawn up from a vari- ety of sources, but more especially from papers which are to be found in Professor Jameson’s Journal, we shall find that the average of the former is much less than the latter, and this chiefly in consequence of some of the observations we have quoted havigg pen made on en- * This is the supposed depth ; accurate information regarding it could not be pro- cured t Mr r. Kincaid has furnished me with this observation, on which perfect reliance can be placed. * we 358 Miscellanies. closed waters at the bottom of old pits. We have altogether kept out of view the experiments of Spasky and Kupffer on the artesian wells of Vienna, as there is certainly some mistake, or rather, as Professor Bischof remarks, some militating cause, and he conjectures ‘that the depths of these springs are not equal to the lowest point of ~~ eke of the spring, but that the springs rise from a still greater ° Feet. Ridersdorf ovis vi and ere: ea 1 in every 48.3 as sted ions ; : | Seas 51.2 nore rece si Bragebirge (Bischob ) scan shiseeatioien on enclos- “a ms a 6s 3 Monk’ Wearmoath, ‘Sere oer sg ; : 59.7 * | Cornwall, from springs, | as? ——— . ey 54.8 Cornwall, from enclosed wat § Rd 52.7 Uralian Mountains, froma comparieon of the host authentic observations in these region a 55.4 LRidersdorf, from rising “ihe | ie, 54.4 Paris, Well at Port St. Ouen, ‘ 1yi8 72.1 Departments du Nord, Wel . Marquette, ; : an t du Pas de Calais, “« SL Vincent, Acca 47. Nig is, = > ‘ oe 4l. ‘ : P SO 41.8 acs (De la Rive et Marcet ah ots . : os 50. Paris, Slaughterhouse of Grenelle, a | ted 57.1 + r Ave 1 for every 53.1 ay rage, Jameson’s Journal, shprit to July, 183%ya5 32. Notice of remarkable Agitations of the Sea at the Sandwich _ Islands, on the 7th November, 1837; by T. Caas. Bype Rooke, F- ey R. C. $.—On the ev ening and night of the 7th November, a most re- markable commotion of the sea was witnessed at Hanolulu, in many respects similar to that witnessed at these islands in May, 1819. One inch and a half of rain had fallen during the previous twenty four hours; the wind was fresh from the N. E., squally at intervals. The atmosphere was clear and cool. Therm. 74.5; the barometer had gradually fallen during the four previous days, but this evening had again risen to 30.06, at six o’clock, when the alarm was given that the sea was retiring. The first recession was the greatest, something more than eight feet; but being unprepared to make observations at the moment, the exact fall was not measured. The reefs surroundin the harbor were left dry, and the fish aground were mostly dead. * Copied and reduced from Professor Bischof’s paper on Thermal Springs. Miscellanies. 359 The sea quickly returned, and in twenty eight minutes reauhed the height of an ordinary high tide; scarcely remaining stationary, it again receded and fell six feet. This was repeated at intervals of twenty eight minutes. On the third rising it was four inches above ordinary high-water mark, and fell again six feet four inches. After the fourth rising, t the length of time occupied by the rise and fall varied, and the rise and fall diminished gradually but not reg- ularly. At eleven p. m. the therm. stood at 74°; barometer 30.04; wind freshening and frequent showers; the ebb now occupied twenty six minutes, and the flow ten. At eleven, 30, it became calm, with constant rain. Therm. 73.5; barometer, 30.03. The ebb and flow still continued occupying the same space of time, but the rise and fall decreasing. This continued during the forenoon of the 8th. The rapidity with which the water fell varied in different parts of the har- bor. On the east side, the greatest rapidity noticed was six inches in a minute; but on the north, at one time during the third recession, it fell twelve inches in thirty seconds. At no time did the water rise higher than a common spring tide; but the fall was about six feet be- low low water-mark. The same occurrence is related to have taken place in 1819, when the tide rose and fell thirteen times in the space of a few hours. On neither occasion was there any perceptible motion or trembling of the earth, or unusual appearance of the atmosphere. Since the above was written, distressing accounts have been received - ee Maui, and Hawaii, of the damage done to property and loss of On the leeward side of Maui, the same rise and fall took place gis : # Hénolula; but on the windward part of the Island, the sea re- Hs .d about twenty fathoms, and quickly returned in one gigantic = ve, sweeping every thing before it ;—houses, trees, canoes, and ev- fa ery moveable object exposed to its fury. Ata small village called 2 Kahului, in the district of Walluku, on the sea retiring, the amazed inhabitants followed it as it recedes, eagerly catching the stranded fish, shouting and hallooing with re, when suddenly the sea rose perpendicularly before them like a - precipice, and, rushing to the beach, buried the assembled multitudes in the flood, and overflowing the shore, swept away every house in the village but one ; the canoes and property of the natives were all destroyed. Happily, owing to the amphibiuus education of the people, but two lives were lost here ; but as the same occurrence happened all along the sea-side, we shall probable hear of more deaths. At Byron’s Bay, on Hawaii, the same phenomenon took place. An unusual number of persons were collected together attending a pro- tracted meeting, consequently every house was crowded. At half past six, the sea retired at the rate of four or five knots an hour, re- Dy 360 Miscellanies. ducing the soundings from five to three and half fathoms at the an- chorage, and leaving a great extent of the harbor dry. Hundreds of curious souls rushed down to witness the novelty, when a gigantic wave came roaring to the shore at the rate of six or eight knots an hour, rising twenty feet above high water mark, and fell on the beach with a noise recembling a heavy peal of thunder, burying the people in the flood, destroying houses, canoes, and fish-ponds, washing away the food and clothing of the inhabitants, large quantities of animals, fire wood, and timber collected on the strand for sale. The cries of — distress were horrible; those in the water, unable to swim among the — . wreck of houses and pieces of timber, struggling for their lives, and those on shore wailing for their friends and relatives. The British whale ship, Admiral Cockburn, was at anchor in the bay, and to the timely aid and humane exertions of her master (Lawrence) and crew, many are indebted for their lives; but for the assistance rendered by their boats, many, who were stunned and insensible, would have been carried out to sea and perished, as the natives had not a single canoe left that would float. Every thing was destroyed ; those who escaped with their lives had neither food nor raiment left. In Kanokapa and -Kaahelu alone sixty six houses were destroyed, and eleven persons lost their lives, four men, two women, and five children ; at Waiolama and Hauna a woman and child were drowned ; at Kauwale one certained, nor is it known how many times the sea rose an though it is sseegieank That the volcano of Kilauea was u disturbed oe them m egenivg — the fires were suddenly q and ya were burst open in perry trang | ‘ction peste wit i ands on the 7th, at various distances; but none ‘of Sich Ronee thing unusual in the sea or atmosphere. That this apparent subma- rine volcanic action has taken place at some distance from the islands, is proved bt the wave striking the different islands simultaneously, and ap tly in the same direction; but at what distance we have "mo means ‘at present to determine. Perhaps the internal fires have und a new vent, which may be laying the foundation of a new group islands in our clase: It is now = — since a similar tl t, nor was : was witnessed at Wailuku (Maui :) xu podi at had been ‘ : from the sea were. conveyed together to the church, fol- by a great multitude : a funeral sermon was preached on the : Miscellanies. SE ae occasion ;—this solemn warning made a deep, and it is hoped, a last- ing impression on those who witnessed it, of the uncertain tenure b which we hold our lives.” Copied from the Ceylon Chronicle in the Literary Gazette of Jan. 1839.—ib. 33. Rose Mica Lepidolite —This mica has the form of very small rose- colored plates. It is found disseminated in a kaolin, which is employed in the porcelain manufactures of Vienna. It is separated by washing from the kaolin, ‘The mean of four analyses gave Z ; “ ica : ‘ ; . 52°40 e Alumina . ; a : 26°80 Potash : y : : 914 Lithia : : : : 4°85 Fluorine : : 4°40 Deutoxide of daregealiie ‘ 1.50—99°09. Yellow Mica. Silica : : ; : 49°78 Alumina . - 3 ‘ 19.88 Peroxide of iron. : 3 13°22 Potash : ee 8°79 Lithia o 4°15 Fluorine 42 les de Chimie et de Phys. 3S we. 69-72. Enid: & Edin. Phil Mag. Notice of a cheap and simple method of preparing paper for phic Drawing, in which the use of any salt of silver is 1 with; by Munco Ponton, Esq., F.R.S.E., Foreign Society of Arts for Scotland. Communicated by the So- of Arts.*—While attempting to prepare paper with the chro- e ‘of silver, for which purpose I used first the chromate of potash, and then the bichromate of that alkali; I discovered that when paper was immersed in the bichromate of potash alone, it was powerfully and rapidly acted on by the sun’s rays. It accordingly occurred to me, to try paper so prepared to obtain drawings, though I did not at first see how they were to be fixed. The result exceeded my expec- tations. When an object is laid in the usual way on this pa tl _ portion exposed to the light speedily becomes tawny , passing more or less into a deep orange, according to the strength of the solution, and the intensity of the light. The portion covered by the object retains the original bright yellow tint, which it had before exposure, and the object is thus represented ion upon an onolt ground, ee Wiki: * Read before the Society of Arts fr Scotland 29th May, 1839. Vol. xxxvu, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 46 2 ar 362 Miscellanies. there being several gradations of shade, or tint, according to the greater or less degree of transparency in the different parts of the object. : In this state, of course, the drawing though very beautiful, is evan- escent. To fix it, all that is required is careful immersion in water, when it will be found that those portions of the salt which have not been acted on by the light are readily dissolved out, while those which have been exposed to the light are completely fixed in the paper. By this second process, the object is obtained white upon an orange ground, and quite permanent. | If exposed for many hours together to strong sunshine, the color of the ground is apt to lose in depth, but not more so than most other coloring matters. The action of light o1 the bichromate of potash differs from that upon the salts of silver. Those of the latter which are blackened by light are of themselves insoluble in water, and it is difficult to impreg- nate paper with them in an equable manner. The blackening seems to be caused by the formation of oxide of silver. In the case of the bichromate of potash, again, that salt is exceedingly soluble, and pa- per can be easily saturated with it. The agency of light not only changes its color, but deprives it of solubility, thus rendering it fixed in the paper. This action appears to me to consist in the disengage- ment of free chromic acid, which is of a deep red color, and which seems to combine with the paper. This is rendered more probable from the circumstance that the neutral chromate exhibits no similar change. > 5 Zt The active power of the light in this instance, resides principally in the violet rays, as is the case with the blackening of the salts of silver. To demonstrate this, three similar flat bottles were filled, one with ammoniuret of copper which transmits the violet rays, one with bichromate of potassa transmitting the yellow rays, the third with tincture of iodine transmitting the red rays. The paper was readily acted on through the first, but scarcely if at all through the second and third; although much more light passed through the bottle filled with bichromate of potassa than through the one filled with ammoni- uret of copper. The best mode of preparing paper with bichromate of potash is to use a saturated solution of that salt; soak the paper well in it, and then dry it rapidly at a brisk fire, excluding it from daylight. Paper = #6 thus prepared acquires a deep orange tint on exposure to the sun. If the solution be less strong or the drying less rapid the color will not be so deep. Pthors ae A pleasing variety may be made by using sulphate of indigo along with the bichromate of potash, the color of the object and of the pa- Miscellanies. 363 per being then of different shades of green. In this way also the object may be represented of a darker shade than the ground. Paper prepared with bichromate of potash is equally sensitive with most of the papers prepared with salts of silver, though inferior to some of them. It is not sufficiently sensitive for the camera obscura, but answers quite well for taking drawings from dried plants, or for copying prints, &c. Its great recommendation is its cheapne : the facility with which it can be prepared. The price of the bichro- mate of potash is 2s. 6d. per Ib., whereas of the nitrate of silver only half an ounce can be obtained for that sum. The preparing of paper with the salts of silver is a work of extreme nicety, whereas both the preparing of the paper with the bichromate of potash and the subsequent fixing of the images are matters of great simplicity, and I am therefore hopeful that this method may be found of considerable practical utility in aiding the operations of the lithographer.—Jame- son’s Journal, April to July—1839. aS Edinburgh, 18, May, 1839. = 35. Fossil-Tree at Granton, near Edinburgh.—A great fossil-tree similar to that at Craigleith, has been discovered in the sandstone quarry at Granton. Its dimensions cannot yet be ascertained, but the distance between the extreme points already uncovered is about forty five feet, and its breadth, where most exposed, is about three feet.—Jb. gh ee a * 36. Notice upon the Alcoholic Strength of Wines ; by Dr. Curts- __ gyson.—Various accounts have been given of the alcoholic strength “3 ‘of wines by Mr. Brande, Julia-Fontenelle, and others. The author has been engaged for some time in experiments for determining the proportion of aleohol contained in various wines of commerce, and also the circumstances which occasion a variety in this respect. The present paper is an interim notice of the results. The method of analysis consisted in the mode of distillation, which was applied with such contrivances for accuracy that nearly the whole spirit and water was distilled over without a trace of empy- reuma, and without the loss of more than between two and six grains 4n 2000. From the quantity and density of the spirit, the weight of = ‘absolute alcohol of the density 793.9, as well the volume of proof mA spirit of the density 920, was calculated from the tables of Richter founded on those of Gilpin. ee. The author has been led to the general conclusion that the alcoholic strength of many wines has been overrated by some experimentalists, and gives the following table as the result of the investigations he has hitherto conducted. The first column gives the per-centage of 364 Miscellanies. absolute aleohol by weight in the wine, the second the per-centage of proof spirit by volume. : * . Sp. p. & by weight. by volume. 30.56 ae ea . ‘ : i , 14.97 ean of 7 wines, F . é ‘ 16.20 33.91 : scadimcaik i . ; : . 17.10. 37.27 White Port, . i i é é : 14.97 31.31 alee titre, . 13.98 30.84 a Mean of 13 wines, excluding th those very : f: : long kept in cask, a 15.37 33.59 ‘Sheny—Strongest, ‘ 16.17 35.12 _ Mean of 9 wines ani iia hept.i in ar inthe EastIndies, . . 14.72 32.30 = ~ Madre da Xeres, . ‘ ‘ : 16.90 37.06 ‘ all long in cask § Strongest : 14.09 ‘ Madeira, ze Bat Indies Weakest . 16.90. 36.81 Teneriffe, long in cask at Calcutta, ‘ . . 13.84 .2ee8 Cercial, ‘ ‘ ‘ oe ‘ : 15.45 33.65 Dry Lisban, 16.14 34.71 » Shiraz, z : : ; ; : ia 28.30 Amontlhido; : : “ : 12.63 27.60 Claret, a first growth af 1811, ° : : 7.72 16.95 Chateau-Latour, first growth 1825, ; : 7.78 17.06 Rosan, second growth 1825, 7.61 16.74 Ordinary Claret, a aries “ vin seth? 8.99 1806;2 45 Rives Altes, : = . ; 9.31 22.35 > Malmsey, . : ; . 12.86 28.37 - Rudesheimer, sngation caality: Sanaa. 8.40 18.44 Rudesheimer, inferior quality, . . > 6.90 15.19 Hambacher, superior quality, . . . 7.35 16.15 Giles’ Edinburgh Ale, before bottling, : 5.70 12.60 The same Ale, two years in bottle, , 6.06 13.40 Superior London Porter, four months bottled, 5.36 11.91 In addition to certain obvious general conclusions which may be drawn from this table, the author stated, as the result of his experi- ments, that the alcoholic strength of various samples of the same kind bears no relation whatever to their commercial value, and is often © d by the taste even of an € effect os on the “ Miscellanies. 365 for a series of years through the cask, above all, in hot climates. The researches made by the author on this head are not yet complete ; but he is inclined to infer, from the” experiments already made, that, for a moderate term of years, the proportion of alcohol increases in the wine, but afterwards, on the contrary, diminishes; and that the period when the wine begins to lose in alcoholic strength is probably that at which it ceases to improve in flavor. The increase which takes place at first in the alcohol of wine undergoing evaporation through the cask, appeared at first view parallel to the fact generally admitted ¢ on the ‘authority of Soemering, that spirit becomes stronger when con- fined in bladder, or in a vessel] covered with bladder, in consequence of the water passing out by elective exosmose. The author, however, on repeating the experiments of Soemering, as related by various writers (for he could not obtain access to the original account of them,) was unable, by any variation of the pro- cess he could devise, to obtain the results. indicated by the German anatomist. Constantly the spirit, whatsoever its strength, whether proof spirit or rectified spirit, became weaker. It was observed at the same time, that if the bladder containing spirit was enclosed in a confin- ed space with quicklime, the spirit slowly became absolute alcohol of the density 796, in consequence of a permanent atmosphere of alco- hol being speedily formed, while the watery atmosphere was absorbed by the quicklime as fast as it was produced. Subsequently it was proved that the bladder was not essential to the process ; for an open cup of rectified spirit, enclosed in a confined space with quicklime, to absorb the water which arose from the spirit, became in two months absolute alcohol of the density 796. Professor Graham of London, some time ago proved the analogous fact, that spirit might be thus rendered pure alcohol in the air pump vacuum. A vacuum, however, is, upon principle, as well as in fact, not necessary for the process ; it merely accelerates it. ‘The new method is obviously applicable on the great scale for obtaining absolute alcohol, wherever time may be allowed.—Jameson’s Journal, April to July, 1839. * 37. Dr. Berendt’s Investigations on Amber.—We learn with much _ gatisfaction, from a letter sent us very recently by Dr. Berendt of = Dantzig, that his important work on the insects, &c. found imbedded in amber, and which, though commenced in 1830, has been inter- rupted in its publication, is cow. to be. carried on and completed with as Tittle delay as possible. The first, ape contains an analytical ) ler Synthetical account. of er tree, and of the flowers ia fruits of other ve; etable I ictions © which grew in the amber Crags e pr ods. ~ hago rendt. has transmitted to us the fifteen lithographed Sey = % * = =: * he ol | ‘pe oh 366 Miscellanies. — plates illustrative of his second part, and which have greatly inter- ested and surprised us by the richness of the Entomological Fauna they exhibit. These figures represent the Crustacea, Myriopoda, Arachnida, and Aptera, examined by the author; and it would ap- pear that all the species found in amber are now extinct, and that but a small number of the genera at present exist. Many new genera have therefore been formed, and also one entirely new family. Of the latter, the species Archea paradoza, figured in plate 2d, at once arrests the attention by its singular structure and form. The 3d part ~-is also in preparation, and will include the Hemiptera, Orthoptera, =. and Lepidoptera; the 4th will contain the Neuroptera, and Hymen- -optera; the 5th, the very numerous division of the Diptera: and contain the equally rich section of the Coleop- ‘the 6th and tera. © 88. Notice regarding the Stone used in constructing the Temples at Pestum.—When at Pestum, on the 3d of June, 1838, I observed a fact regarding the travertine of which the splendid Grecian temples there are constructed, which you may perhaps think worth inserting in your Journal, and thus lead future travellers to inquire into the cause of the phenomenon. We remarked, that the color of the three temples was very different, although they are all built of the same materials, (travertine or fresh-water limestone, containing imbedded fresh-water shells ;) two of them being of a grey color, and the other, that usually known as the “ Temple of Neptune,” of a rich yellowish brown. On closer examination, I found that this difference in the color was caused by the two former being covered with a grey crus- taceous lichen, from which the latter was perfectly free. I was for some time unable to account for this, when it struck me, that it might be caused by the stone containing some matter inimical to vegetation ; and on applying a freshly broken piece to the tongue, I perceived @ distinctly saline taste. I brought away specimens of the stone from the different temples, which I gave for examination to my friend Mr. Kemp, who informs me, that after reducing portions of it to powder and boiling it in distilled water, he found, ina portion taken from one of the smaller temples, no saline matter in solution ; but in that from the largest, or the “‘ Temple of Neptune,” a considerable quantity of muriate of lime. ‘This fact accounts at once for the absence of veg- etation on that building. It would be interesting to ascertain whence this salt was derived, and I regret much that we had not time to ex- 1e the spot where are said tobe the ancient quarries, about two les inland from the ruins, an inspection of which might clear up i —Letter from W.C. Trevelyan, Esq.—Ib. ee aoe Peea ‘ = te Sis ca Miscellanies. : 367 89. Products of Respicatiatent different periods of the day; by Cuas. T. Coatuurs, Esq.—Lon. and Edin. ; Phil The subject of the experiment is was 3 weight 140 pounds; average pulse. " to tion 18 to 21 per minute os Omitting the Seana of apparatus, and the det: s of experiment ; some of the most important results are as follows: a The corrected result of 32 experiments made before breakfast and comprising 8 days, gave 4.37 for the per centage of ee acid sic duced in respiration. Fifteen experiments between 10 and noon in 7 days indicated 3.90 per ” cent. of carbonic aci a Seven experiments ‘between noon and I P. M. in five days gave 3.92 per cent. Twenty nine experiments between 2 P. M. and 54 P. M. in 8 days, indicated 4.17 per cent. Seventeen experiments between 7 P. M. and 8} P. M. in 8 days, age 3.63 per cent. Twenty four experiments between 9 P. M. and midnight itidioated 4.12 per cent. and the average of all the experiments, 124 in number, in almost every hour between 8 A. M. and midnight in eight days, gives 4.09 per cent. as the total daily average of the carbonic acid gas in the air re- spired from the lungs. The carbonic acid gas produced in respiration, is therefore, a variable quantity—less during active digestion and increasing with abstinence from food; in the same individual, it varies at similar periods of different days, Excitement of any kind, whether from stimulus or annoyance, caused a diminution of carbonic acid in the air respired, compared with the ordinary average of that respired at a similar period of the day, and during a state of ordinary tranquillity. While the total average indicated 4.09 the maximum observed at any single examination was 7.98. This was at 8 A. M., Feb. 5, the maximum was 1.91; at 7} P. M., Feb. 7th. These results differ widely from those of Messrs. Allen and Popys, published in Phil. Trans. in 1809. Their average was 3 per cent. of carbonic acid in the air respired. By protracting the respiratory process, there was an increase of carbonic acid of one fourth more than the av- erage of natural respiration. Due allowance being made for this and for aqueous vapor, the 8 per cent. of Allen and Popys is reduced to 6.4 per cent. Their experiments were made before breakfast and just be- fore dinner when the largest quantity of carbonic acid is produced; the considerable volumes of air which they employed were renewed not over thrice, and were obtained at one period of the day; the quantity of car- - bonic acid which they found, had it been obtained in natural respiration, would not have been over 6.4 per cent., which is the maximum at aoe most favorable periods for its production. : 368 The experiments of Mr. Coathupe, were many times repeated upon ~ other individuals and always accorded with the average results already stated. General conclusion 1. The average oe by most adult individuals, varying. between 17 and 20 per minute, may be stated at 20 per minute. 2. The average bulk of air, varying between 14 and 18 cubic inches, may be stated. at 20 cubic inches. 3. The average production of carbonic acid gas in “human respiration, varying between 1. 9 and 7.98 per cent., may be stated at 4 per cent. Hence 460.800 cubic inches, or 266.66 cubic feet of air respired by a healthy adult, of average stature and health in 24 hours, of which 10.666 cubic feet will be converted into carbonic acid = = 2386. 27 grains, or 5.45 avoird. ounces of carbon. This gives 99.6 grains of carbon per hot by one human adult, or 124.328 pounds annually. The population of Great Britain and Ireland 263 millions, emit 147.070 tons of carbon annually. he maximum quantity of air requisite for a healthy adult duce 24 hours, (even supposing that no portion of the air was inspired twice,) will not exceed 266.666 cubic feet. For the proofs of these important con- clusions we must refer to their very valuable memoir already cited ; it occupies 14 pages 8vo., with a large proportion of figures and tables. _ Eps. 40. Chemical Equivalents Richard Phillips, Esq., F. R. S., in a pa- per read to the Royal Society on the chemical equivalents of certain bodies, concludes that “no material and even scarcely any appreciable error can arise from considering the equivalent numbers of hydrogen, azote, and chlorine, as being 1, 8, 14 and 36 respectively.” It is most desirable to be freed from the necessity of introducing frac- tions into the numbers oo chemical equivalents.—Lond. and Edin. Phil. Mag., May, 18 eee power of Light from ng Coke.—Mr. Robert Mallet has discovered that the light emitted by incandescent coke black- ens photogenic paper in about forty five seconds ; ‘a property possessed in ial lights. The author discovered a con- ht emitted by incandescent coke at the twyer of a cupola furnace contains the chemical rays in sufficient abun- dance. It is supposed that there will be no difficulty in burning a small quantity of coke at a high temperature, and that the light may be made “= to — nocturia genio —Id. 4 a — 369 of Prof. Bronn on fossil iene remains, (Vol. xxxiu, p. 204. Bya letter received from him dated Heidelberg, Betoher 26, 1838, ‘we learn that the first edition of the Lethwa Geognostica was already aes even before the volume was finished. ‘This volume has there- n reprinted, an enlarged edition of the second volume-has. been published, and a new edition is spoken of as necessary. . ae is at The author being occupied with other labors and be ng anxio rect all errors that may be discovered, to add to the | 2w discov ries and a certain number of supplementary plates, so tha the possessor of the first or second edition shall have no occasion to chase any thing © more than the additional text and plates; for these reasons the new edi- tion will not appear under from two to four years. It is not improbable that a I’rench edition will then appear. This will be an important —— as many persons in countries = French who cantiot read them in Germa an. es, Fas Prof. Bronn having already arranged for exchanges 0 n the part ] Museum of Heidelberg with certain individuals in Towne i Yor. and Philadelphia, as far as regards birds, shells, and petrifactions, is still desirous of effecting the same object in other branches of natural history, especially for quadrupeds, insects, and reptiles. We beg leave to com- mend this subject to the attention of our naturalists, not doubting (and our own experience justifies the confidence) that they will receive a fair and honorable equivalent for the objects they may send. The labors of Prof. Bronn are worthy of all encouragement, and it gives us pleasure to keep them in the view of our countrymen both on account of their intrinsic value, and because the German savans are dis- tinguished for their courteous and liberal treatment of this country. this work has been k aly fi forwarded to us by t author. In Vol. xxxiv, p. 212, we announ ced the intention of Prof. iz to publish it, and are happy now to add. our confirmation that it well maintains the envia- ble reputation of the author of the Poissons Fossiles. In the introduction he recapitulates the facilities which he has enjoyed in drawing up his history, from the Jiberality of all his scientific friends on the continent and in England, in placing at his disposal their collec- tions and labors in this department of Bae History. Speaking of the * Monographies D’Echinodermes Vivansiet Boasil iles, par L. Agassiz , ler Pe cai. son, contenant les Salenies. Neuchatel, pre rs 10 fis de France ; a ae received by A. Mayor, 8 Pine-street, New Vol. xxxvit, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 47 is te 370 Miscellanies. plan of his work he says: “ My intention is to figure and describe all the new and less common species, as well as those hitherto incorrectly figured. But not being able consistently with the interests of the work to confine myself to a regular mode of publication, and to that end to publish on a given day, before the rest, those parts of my researches in” which I have united the new materials and the most perfect notes, I will publish in succession, monographies, each embracing a natural group and forming continuous wholes, whose order of sequence will be of little consequence, since they will, in the conclusion, fall into their proper places, with those general coisiderations which will terminate this work. _ These monographies whose extent will be proportioned to their contents, will appear at irregular intervals. ‘This is I believe the only course which an author can follow, who publishes his labors in Livraisons, with- out continually incurring the ch of delay and remissness, often so little merited. | "Thus conducted, this work may in some sort, be regarded during the course of its publication, as a journal or record devoted to the investigation of the whole class of Echinodermata ; and I shall be happy _ to record there any new facts which may be transmitted to me. “The new species, which have been omitted in the chapter devoted to ‘their genera, ill be described in the supplements which will accompany the monographies, as often as there is occasion for them. I have (that my correctness may be tested) caused plaster casts to be made of all my new genera and species when the specimens would permit, which I now offer to museums and individuals'in hopes of obtaining by exchange new materials for my work.” The present Livraison is devoted to the consideration of the Salénies the number of whose species he has quadrupled and divided in the fol- lowing manner. 1. Those having te anal aperture in front, comprising I. personata, Ag. the Cidaris personata of Defrance. II. scripta, Ag. The only ex- ample of this species which I have seen, forms part of the Paris Museum, and was communicated to me by M. Valenciennes; its origin is un- known. III. petalifera, Ag. Echinus petaliferus, Des M. IV. geomet- rica, Ag. V. scutigera, Gray. Cidarites scutiger. Minst. VI. gibba, Ag. VII. S. trigonata, Ag. 2. Those having the anal a aperture placed Bremer VIIL. S. stellu- lata, Ag. IX, S. areolata, “Ag. Chapter II treats of the new genus Goniopygus, Ag. containing the following species: I. G. peltalus, Ag. II. G. intricatus. III. G. Menardi, Ag. Echinus Menardi, Doses IV. G. heteropygus, Ag. V. G. globosus, Ag. VI. G. major, Ag. Chay- ter Hil contains the genus Peltastes, Ag. in two species, viz. I. P. pul chellus, Ag. IT. P. marginalis. Chapter IV is devoted to the genus soniophoru s, of which he has described I. G. lunulatus, Ag. and G, ap- ps Miscellanies. 371 The above enumeration of species comprises the contents of the Ist Livraison of thirty two pages of description and five plates. Each species described is illustrated by eight figures on stone by M. Nicolet, very _ beautiful, but still small, although some of the parts are much magnified. We could wish that he may be cheered in his noble exertions for the ad- vancement of Geological Science, not only by the liberal patronage of his work among our countrymen, but also by the transmission of spe- cimens in this branch of Natural History, which will then be accu- rately figured and ably described earlier than we can hope to do it at home. . - aia 7 Pe 44, Solid impressions and casts of Drops of Rain.—Mr. Cunning- am communicated to the Geological Society, Feb. 27, 1839, an account of impressions and casts of drops of rain in the quarries at Storeton Hill, Cheshire, England. The effects of a shower falling on very fine ashes of Vesuvius in 1822, are seen in the rounded globules like those that arise from sprinkling water on a dusty floor ; these accumulated globules formed a mass in some places a foot or more thick, and they became af terwards so firm as to require a smart blow with a hammer to break the mass. o In the Storeton quarry, where the footsteps of the chirotherium were found, “the under surface of two strata at the depth of thirty two and thirty five feet from the top of the quarry, presents a remarkably blistered or watery appearance, being densely covered by minute hemispheres of the same substance as the sandstone. These projections are casts in relief of indentations in the upper surface of a thin subjacent bed of clay and due in the author’s opinion to drops of rain. On one of the layers of — clay they are small and circular, as if produced by a gentle shower ; on the other, they are larger, deeper, and less regular in form, indicating a more violent operation possibly accompanied by hail. On the surface of these layers of clay there are also impressions of the feet of small ani- mals, which appear to have passed over the clay during the showers or “not long before. Ripple marks are also exhibited on the surface of many sandstone strata in the same quarries.” Prof. Hitchcock of Amherst, Mass., is also disposed to believe that he has found similar appearances - _ in the sandstone of the Connecticut river valley, and we understand from him that a specimen of the stone has been taken to England by Prof. Shepard for the purpose of comparison.—Lond. and Edin, Phil. Mag. sup. July, 1839. 45. Megatherium.—Mr. Owen, after a careful examination of the re- lated animals fossil and recent, and especially of the armadillo, concluded that the Megatherium had not a bony armor, and states that in no case among twelve skeletons of that animal of which he gives a table, did any 372: Miscellanies. portion ‘of bony armor oceur “with ‘or near the bones: he concludes that both by its‘tegumentary covering and its osseous system it is more nearly allied to the ant-eaters and sloths than to the armadillos.—Jd. Hot Springs.—Hot springs burst forth in great force about seven a half x miles east of Singerli, in Asia Minor ; the temperature is sup- y Mr. Hamilton to be equal to that of boiling water.* Deposi- tions in some places eight or ten feet thick occur around the mouths ¢ of the springs with a sulphureous smell; yet the cool water is taste- less. The. water after flowing a mile and a half and turning several ills is us 2 bath —Id. ton = i of Rev. Peter Patker, M. Bs” as ma intained Dy sever on the nights of the 12th and - 13th Nov. 1838, and some time sabsenaadl From a notice published by him i in the ° ee Register of Dec. 11, 1838, it appears that the chief i Misry yore, and one minute, ats at ‘alles Sneerall ing the few hours of » ~~ clear sky of the night.” it ree sea, N. lat. 8° 27'; W. lon, 28° 48’- Beaton by Rev. es S.R - Brown, and Rev. Davia Abeel, on board the ship Morrison bound y ton. By a letter. sree here from Mr. B., we learn that the : the 13th-L4th, wa fly clear, and that paily i in the evening ey rs weré rather I merous than usual. “From 2h. to 4h. A. M. 1d from that time till the moon rose, about a cpa before 5, we took note of twenty five more. Thus there were about 2 an hour from 2 to'5 o'clock according to our reckoning. Soon Moet moon rose, the sky was overcast so as to Prevent any further observ All these meteors were rather small, excep -one which shone witha splen- dor and red, light like that of a roc et, and exploded much in the same manner. agian ae point in the curve of the sickle “ (in Lea), or a r paths being traced ‘ek would intersect each other somewhere between Regulus and 2 Leonis. In appearance they were somewhat unlike ordinary meteors, their trains of light being longer and rather more permanent than is asask while their direction was from to. W. in most cases and always from the point before mentioned. Some-_ times they shot across and behind an intervening cloud.” = os Meme by W. I. Hamilton, Esq., on the Geology of the western in pave of Asia mor. Miscellanies, : | 2873 48. Stars missing.—The Greenwich Observations for 1837, (re- cently published in a large quarto volume,) contains the following list of stars which have been repeatedly sought for at the Observatory, but of which no traces are now discoverable. In the Astronomical nay’ s Catalogue, the stars Nos. 337, 805, and 2460; tale siare L and c’, observed at Cambridge with Halley’s comet; (Camb. Obs 1835 ;) and the following stars observed by Sir John Herschel 1 with ‘Halley’s comet, (Ast. Soc. Mem. Vol. X,) A. R. 10h. 10s., N. P.D. 99° 17; A.R. 15h. 38m. 31s. N. P.D. 119° 30°; A.R. 15h. Alm. 4s., N. P. D. 119° 16’ (2); and A. R. 15h. 42m. 39s., N.P. D. . 119° 6. Thus ten small stars, at least, have disappeared Hom the 23 pe they once omnes in ta mai am ted Mag. Tune, 1889 "49. Double Stars.—It is a curious: fact that has often been noticed schel, they all move one way. The comets, hoy no law, as they are found moving in almost all Pottble: aifecttne. Professor Madler, of Berlin, was led to inquire whether a uniformity in the motions of certain fixed stars about others, might not exist, like ee that among the planets. The result i is that. out of Bh 5 34 are in favor of it gd, 17 against it.—Ibid. 50. Five or more rings around Saturn.—On the night of May 29, 1838, the astronomers of the Roman College, using their large and excellent telescope (of Cauchoix’s manufacture) thought they saw — several new divisions in the rings of Saturn. Careful examination on the 7th of June following, fonderéa perfectly certain the existence | te of four distinct rings exatind that planet. M. Decuppis was invited to assist in the obsexveteiiit: and on the night of June 18, he distinet- ty saw the four rings. On attentive examination he imagined that he = 4w a new division in the interior rin, ng. ee higher power was applied, and it was then evident to: Il the obsert i A fifth division was indistinetly tra i oning from the planet. “This divisi sion was again seen June 27 and | July 10, and more clearly than at first. Micrometrical t measurements of the planet, rings, &c. were several times taken, and are given in the table below. M. Decuppis adds, that they saw with perfect distinctness and cer- ta ry the seven satellites of Saturn, two of which have probably “never been hitherto seen except by Herschel. _ A law similar to that detected by Bode among the planets, obtains among these satellites ; their distances from Saturn being represented ~ a6 - Mt + 3 A . ay Soret * . @ 374 Miscellanies. by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16,.. . 64. There seems to be a blank between the sixth and seventh; to be filled perhaps by the discovery of a new satellite ; as was the apparent hiatus between Mars and Jupiter by the four tel- escopic planets. . Table of the approximate dimensions of Saturn and of his rings. rench leagues. Equatorial diameter of the planet, - - 28, Interval between Saturn and interior ring, - 6,912 Internal diameter of do. - 42,488 Diameter of first division, - - - 45,468 second, - : - - 49,720 third, - - 52,806 ? Externa 1 diameter of infers ing. - - 54,926 Interval between the two rings, - - - 648 ? Internal diameter of the exterior ring, - - 56,223 Diameter of the fourth division, - - - 60,286 External diameter of the exterior ring, - - 63,880 2 Thickness of ring, aceording to Herschel, Comptes Rendus Acad. Sci. Sept. 24, 1838, p. 658, 9. te wil be remembered that several divisions in Saturn’s ring have long been suspected and occasionally seen, as by Cassini, Short, Quetelet, and Kater; but the evidence hitherto brought forward is far less satisfactory than that above recorded. 51. Solar Painting.—The barbarous term, Daguerrotype, inven- ted to_ ‘commemorate M. Daguerre, the discoverer of the improved method of copying figures by the sun’s light, denotes the instrument by which this beautiful result is obtained. M. Arago has recently revealed the secret to the French Institute at Paris. We omit his recapitulation of the rise and progress of dis- covery in regard to the effect of the sun’s rays on colors, and also the more appropriate notice of the labors of M. Niepce, who eo M. Daguerre in the research. The following is the account of the process of M. Daguerre :—A copper sheet, plated with silver, well cleaned with diluted nitric acid, is exposed to ‘the vapor of iodine, to form the first coating, which is very thin, as it does not e: exceed the millionth part of a millimetre in thickness. There are certain indispensable Pe ea ee to render this coating uniform, the chief of which is t of metal round the sheet. The sheet thus prepared, is pla camera obscura, where it is allowed to remain from eight to’ utes. = is then — the most eaperioaced eye cams arcely is Mg oe Miscellanies. 275 detect any trace of the drawing. The sheet is now exposed to the va- por of mercury, and when it has been heated to a temperature of 60 de- grees of Reaumur, or 167 Fahr., the drawings come forth as if by en- chantment. One “singtiler and hitherto inexplicable fact in this pro- cess is, that the sheet, when exposed to the action of the vapor, must be inclined, for if it were placed in a direct position over the vapor the results would be less satisfactory. The angle used is 48 degrees. The last part of the process is to place the sheet in a solution of the hyposulphite of soda, and then to wash it in a large quantity of dis- tilled water. The description of the process appeared to excite great interest in the auditory, amongst whom were many distinguished persons connected with science and the fine arts. Unfortunately the locality was not adjusted suitably for the perform- ance of M. Daguerre’s experiments, but we understand that arrange- ments will be made for a public exhibition of them. Three highly curious drawings obtained in this manner were exhibited ; one of the Pont Marie; another of Mr. Daguerre’s atelier ; and a third of a room containing some rich carpeting, all the minutest threads of which were represented with the most mathematical accuracy, and with wonder- ful richness of effect London Globe of 23d August. We have to add, that a professional gentleman in New York in- formed us before the late arrival of the British Queen, (which brought the first printed account of M. Arago’s disclosure,) that he was in possession of the secret, and in connection with an eminent chemist in New York had already obtained beautiful results, but is not able as yet fully to arrest them. The surface of the mercury should be as large as the plate. Practical difficulties are encountered in giving the mercury the proper temperature and in avoiding the corrosive vapors so distress- ing to the eyes; but we trust that these and all other difficulties will be o overcome, and that we may have the pleasure of announcing the entire success of the i ingenious experimenters. le * 52. Aurora Borealis of Sept. 3, 18 - most magnificent character was seen ughout th -eou try on the night of September 3, 1839. An aan of observations upon it at Various Senet, will be given in our next number. 53. Geological Surveys.—We have héfore.s us numerous reports on ge- ~ Slogical surveys, most of which were named at the close of Vol. xxxv1. * “thas been. found hitherto impossible to peruse and digest them intelli- Ae ie and indeed the wide range of geological exploration in the various ‘esents. such voluminous details, that we are compelled to relin- quish ect present even a condensed. summary of them. This . 376. Miscellanies. we have in various cases attempted in former volumes—with what suc- cess our readers must judge. But we are almost in despair of carrying | out this plan, because we have, from several states, annual reports; the . same ground is explored first in generality and afterwards in specific de- tails, topographical, geological, economical, &c.; in many cases the mineral features of certain districts and even of particular townships and estates are given ; mountain ranges and valleys and systems of strata with their mineral and organic contents are described often with great minuteness, and this multifarious information scarcely admits of abridg- ment or generalization. The local facts and deductions are in many cases scarcely intelligible without sections, maps and plans, which when given we cannot copy ; but more frequently they are postponed to a con- cluding general report, in which we are led to hope that all the materials will be arranged i in symmetry and lucid clearness. For these ‘concluding summaries we shall wait with no small interest, expecting from them much instruction; but we must be first placed in a condition to under- stand their extent and the manner in which they will be exhibited, as well as to appreciate our own various engagements before we can decide how far we can exhibit those results in this Journal. That they will eventually be highly important both to scientific and economical geology, cannot be doubted. This will, we are convinced, appear still more conspicuously when after many more years of laborious research all our states and territories shall have been surveyed, and geol- ogists of high attainments, under we trust a national direction, and sus- s tained by national funds, shall give a clear digest of our scientific geol- ogy, and draw with a masterly hand, not only our great outlines but the most important of our local geological features, For the present our effort will be to record the progress of geological exploration without pretending to give even a summary of the facts, but se pan from this immense storehouse some leading particulars of chief inte Drawing near to the conclusion of the present volume, we can de ite more than name three reports, reserving the mention of others to a future occasion. 1. Third annual report of the Geology of the state of Maine; by Charles _ T. Jackson, M. D., State Geologist, &c., 1839. Ste 2. First, second, and third reports of the progress of the geological sur- vey of the state of Roe 1836-37 and 38; by phi: Wm. B. Ro- gers , State Ge 3. Third angel’ report of the state of Pennsylvania; by Prof. Henry D. Rogers, State Geologist. 1. Maine.—Dr. Jackson’s labors in this state have been repeatedly no- ticed in former volumes. The present report contains 272 pages, of - which 59 are occupied by elaborate tables of the barometer and thermo- ameter, and there is an. ie of 64 pages containing catalogues of spe- x Tey Miscellanies. 377 cimens collected for the state in 1836-7 and 8; they exceed stcbon hundred in number and are arranged and ticketed. There are also ten ~ other collections for the colleges, academies, and societies provided for by aw. ere is an introduction of 14 pages, containing a sketch of ele- mentary geology as far as Maine is concerned. Under the head of Dilu- vial Deposit, it is said that there are abundant proofs of a cataclysm in every part of Maine—the course being from north towards the south, sweeping with it all loose materials and Sopomning them far from their parent beds; the record of facts in the state “is so legible that he who runs may read.” A letter of 10 pages is prefixed to the Report and ad- dressed to Gov. Fairfield, explaining the progress and results of the survey. To a highly practical people, having more in view the immediate pe- cuniary advantages of the survey than the higher claims of science, Dr. Jackson has thought it necessary to address strongly their love of emolu- ment, public and private. ‘This is a prominent and pervading object in the report, nor can we censure it, ‘Since it is probable that no other argu- ment would have prevailed with the legislature to continue the su rvey, especially absorbed as it has been with the din of diplomatic and minis- terial conflict, and the more ominous belligerent movements of armed bands on its disputed frontier. But as these clouds of war have rolled away, leaving a clear sky, we trust that the legislature will no longer hes- itate to sustain their zealous and able geologist, until his laborious and ca Tesponsible duty shall be consummated. In the letter to Gov. De pg it is stated that cmmense quantities of limestone ha for agricultural and common uses, and which may be afforded for. twenty five to fifty cents a cask, instead of from two to four dollars, the present price in particular districts. ~ Eighteen pages are occupied by tabular results of the analysis of many : varieties of soils, and five more by that of limestones applicable to agricul- ture as well as to other purposes. This important subject is strongly and “deservedly urged upon the state as being of the highest importance to its iItural interests, and we trust that Dr. J ackson’s labors on this sub= eet will be the beginning of a new era in ee motto of Maine. = * se iscataqua river, and will doubtless be applied to great - Extensive resources exist within the state for the seqnifactareef iron and glass, and the roofing slate on the Piscataqua will probably, on this side of the Atlantic, supersede the use of that of Wales. Impressions of fom leaves with drooping fronds and of faci, on the Waterville slate, geologically too ancient for the coal formation, Sete that the former-plants “were brought down by some ancient river from higher land at the time when the present slate rocks were the bottom of ancient sea, Vol. —, No. 9." July-October, 1839. 48 378 Diluvial markings are common on the i generally they run N. and S., while the strata bear N. E. and " Bowlders are common, some weiiking twenty or thirty tons; in the town of Avon there is a granite bowlder measuring 30 X20 X 15 feet = ~ 9000 cub. feet or 643 tons; these bowlders have been removed doubtless by ice and water from their native beds in the mountains to the north —probably of the Mount Abraham range. There are also bowlders of novaculite and magnetic iron ore, the latter with granite bowlders on the summit of an insulated hill with an infinity of deeply worn diluvial fur- rows, running N. 50° W. and S. 50° E. » pointing directly to Saddleback Mountains. Every part of Maine evinces, that since the consolidation of all the rocks and the deposition of the tertiary clays, a deluge has swept _ along forcing large masses ang rocks from their parent ledges and deposi- ting them in distant re Mount Abraham is 2470. feet high above the base, and 3387 above the sea. Ina high mountain valley—June 16—in very hot weather, the ex- plorers found abundance of ice still solid beneath rocks and moss. In “Mount Vernon the strata of mica slate run N. E. and S. W., and dip in «Opposite directions on each side of the granite, which in a vein 90 feet eae id of unknown length in the direction of the strata, has broken } and elevated them. "Pe tiny deposits form the substratum of a large portion of the valley of Augusta, and rise from 88 to 100 feet above the level of high water on | the Kennebec. ein ere gypsum is rapidly Ded by the decomposition of py- a the so ae ding the lime. At Cornville are rounded masses of a filled with impressions of terebratulz. “Boundary Between Canada and Maine : , nia, 1839. We have in Vol. 1, p- 192, mentioned with decided approbation the preliminary surv vey: ay Virginia, by Prof. Wm. B. Rogers. The pre- liminary report published by him on that occasion gave equally an earnest of the importance of the undertaking and of the talent and zeal with which it would be prosecuted. We have mentioned (Id.) in similar terms the labors of his. brother Prof. Henry D, Rogers in Pennsylvania; and the present notice will have reference to both the above, because the states are contiguous and have eer geological features in common, and because also a similar mode of ation has been pursued by these gentlemen are abstracts giving a brief sketch of their plan of re- poartt, and of the progress in their plan of investigation during each sea- son. They have great similarity in their mode of grouping the formations of the Appalachian and Allegany regions; we are indeed assured that 2 Pea work in concert, and coinciding in their geological views, they have ey the same method. Their cautious and laborious mode of re- pve is likely to insure the approbation of all sound and judicious geol- ogists, and when the entire body of their results with a multitude of illustrative sections and other delineations shall be made public, it does not admit of a doubt that the course of strict induction which they are — pursuing will be fully approved. The ° gcpagens of structure, the illustration of the directions, and arative energies of geological powers, are among the most important 2 research. The wide scale of the formations which reat" listurbing fortes to which they have been exposed, will afford them the opportunity of elucidating perhaps more clearly than it can have been done elsewhere many important general views not alw ays without nov- elty. : Such we presume are the general views of these gentlemen, although — in their annual reports they are merely glanced at, but will have their fall » development in the end. We contemplate also with satisfaction the coin- cidence of similar labors i in the State of New York whose formations are but the extension of some of the most important of those of Pennsylva- nia and Virginia. Able geologists are there in the field and we have already presented an earnest of the result of their examination it is not now in our power to survey their most recent la _ In relation to Virginia and Pennsylvania it is not our purpose to enu- meine even the most important facts which the reports present. We é ‘ omit the mention of a few. oi Se ee A great abundance of wehesies limestones has heen. discovered in the Appalachian series, and the interesting fact as that, in all cases, these rocks are highly magnesi: : ous analyses have settled this point; well known hydraulic S$ uniformly yield- ing by analysis a large proportion of magnesia, 1es found by analysis to have a magnesian composition proving on trial to be decidedly hydraulic. _ When silica is entirely absent the reo property is di- minished but i is still evident, while a small portion of silica is capable of giving fu ‘development to the character, provided the magnesia be abun- dant. It has been before proved in one or two instances in England that magnesia produces this effect, but it is now for the first time fully proved in this country by numerous careful analyses attended by corresponding practical trials of the cement. There is reason to conclude that as anal- yses are extended it will prove to be a universal rule that all magnesian limestones are capable of induration under water; limestones of this description probably form a very large proportion of those of the transi- tion series, particularly in the great valley of Virginia, Pennsylvania, Ma- ryland, and Tennessee ; and the same fact has been abundantly proved as to these limestones from New York and Kentucky. Prof. W. B. Rogers finds that in them the carbonate of magnesia is 3 where that of lime is The natural bridge of Virginia consists of magnesian limestone a part of which is eminently hydraulic. The shells of the tertiary region of Virginia furnish an important resource for agriculture; but the proportion of carbonate of lime in the marls and other earthy mixtures varies very much, Not unfrequently the sulphuric acid formed from pyrites decomposes the carbonate of lime: a the shells and forms sulphate of lime, a useful ingredient in the soil ; which are present also sulphates of iron, alumina, and magnesia, ot even free sulphuric acid. The coal of Virginie has in many instances a composition which adapts it happily to use; the amount of bitumen varies between 27 and 38 per cent., the ash from 2 to 5, and the carbon from 75.to 80; a composition not. unlike that of the Frostburgh coal in . Maryland, * combining combustibility, endarance, and intensity. Iron ore is found in vast abundance in Virginia and of an excellent quality : gold Beene diffused, and although justly regarded as an eiaehGes in- county ; and salt springs abound in the valley of the Holston—thirty thousand gallons are evaporated in a day, producing one thousand bushels of salt. The sandstones of the Blue Ridge are now known to be subjacent to the limestone of the great valley, and from the peculiar attitude in which this rock, (the sandstone,) is found, and from the marine and littoral * Which we haye examined in situ and by analysis. impressions with which it is sometimes crowded, it marks out the ancient coast line of a wide spread sea, beneath whose waters the vast extent of sedimentary rocks stretching westward from the Blue Ridge were suc- cessively deposited. The rock appears to have had a littoral origin, or at least to have been deposited in shallow water and near the margin of the sea. Throughout the whole of the vast area extending from the Blue Ridge westward, the strata are for the most part of oceanic origin. The ancient coast line has been traced out by Prof. H. D. Rogers, in a vast circuit north and west through Pennsylvania and New York, and even into the valley of the Mississippi, along the region of the great lakes— over which wide area similar geological laws prevailed—to an extent without any known parallel—marine and littoral animals prevailing throughout the whole of this region. The series of rocks is-numbered and described in detail in the reports. The limestone of the great val- ley of Virginia affords numerous marbles—grey, white, red, and of many colors. Near Wyer’s cave a dyke of trap is found contiguous to the limestone, and is the only mass of “ igneous rock intruded among the limestones of the valley ;” it is observed also that along the line of the canal near Har- per’s ferry the sandstones are vitrified by the subjacent igneous rocks, while both they and the slates contain specks of epidote and chlorite, and the lower beds have a jointed structure and confused stratification. It is added, that in another place even the massive beds of hard sandstone “display the marks of those violent agencies to which they owe their present erect or inverted position, in countless intersecting joints and sur- faces, polished by the attrition of rock grinding against rock, under the most enormous pressure.” Prof. Rogers. is happy in his descriptions, which are pictures to the mind, and his. style throughout is of a scholar accustomed to good writing. phere: ae ame The rocks of Pennsylvania are in many respects very similar to those of Virginia, but in the latter state there are vast deposits of the marine tertiary which are absent from the former. We shall not attempt to give the characters of the various formations which are described by Prof. H. D. Rogers in regular order from the primary rocks to those above the coal formation. © portion of the United States is richer in valuable minerals than Pennsylvania and Virginia. Coal, iron, lead, gold, limestone, gypsum, — and valuable saline and mineral waters are among their tre*sures, and the marine tertiary affords to Virginia inexhaustible resources 4. agriculture. Large portions of secondary rocks appear to have been swept away by The Potomac marble, used for columns in the capitol at Washington, is member of the red sandstone formation; it extends into Pennsylvania and New Jersey on the one hand and into Virginia on the other. It is acon- Miscellanies. 383 glomerate made up from pebbles derived from a great variety of rocks, of which a large proportion are limestone, and the cementing earth, fre- ~quently red and also of various colors, contains much lime mixed with other materials; when polished it is beautiful, especially in large masses. This rock belongs to the middle secondary, and appears to have been produced along with other rocks of the same age at a period subsequent to the elevation of the lower secondary, including the coal formation. The red sandstone formation is frequently disrupted by trap, which ri- ses above it in ridges and peaks, and has frequently indurated the shales and sands into a rock resembling a brick or tile. The strata of the anthracite coal formation evidently owe their position and limits to elevation by fire, and denudation by water, which has often "swept away extensive masses formerly connected. We cannot enter upon the phenomena of the coal fields, nor upon the proofs of their disturbance, which are presented by their synclinal and anticlinal axes, and by innumerable indications of violent movements, as by the upheaving of the strata along certain lines, and “ the simultaneous destruction of large portions of them by the scooping action of a mighty flood. ‘To the effects of these grand geological dynamics Prof. Rogers will himself do justice in his final report. The geological statistics of our surveys are now swelling annually into a vast magazine of materials entirely incompatible with the limits of a journal of science even to sketch, but affording to local interests a happy guide, and an encouraging excitement, while science will in the end vin- dicate her claims by drawing those conclusions which are the safer, and the more important as they are built upon a wider induction from facts well observed and faithfully described. _ 64 Dr. Hare’s new Eudiometer.—At a conversation meeting of the Franklin Institute of Philadelphia, held May 23d, 1839, Dr. Hare ex- hibited an improved aqueous, sliding-rod, hydro-oxygen Eudiometer, and stated that this instrument enabled him to analyze the air accu- rately within thirty seconds. Being, however, made to be used with water, accurate results could not be obtained by it when carbonic acid was one of the products, of which an accurate measurement would be necessary. It would of course be impossible to ascertain how far an absorption of this gas by water might add to the absorption resulting _ from the combustion and consequent condensation of hydrogen. Hence, in order to analyze gaseous carburets, another eudiometrical instrument hy. been constructed many years ago, in which mercury was the confining liquid. The mercurial sliding-rod eudiometer, now laid before the Institute, was an improved modification of that instru- ment. The pressure within the receiver of the apparatus in question being varied, (by pushing in or pulling out the rod through a collet 384 Miscellanies. of leathers, or stuffing box,) a communication was successively made, by means of cocks, with a reservoir of the gas to be analyzed, a re- servoir of oxygen, and with a receptacle of ammonia: an appeal was made intermediately, in each case, to a mercurial glass syphon gauge, in order to bring the density, at the time of admeasurement, to the at- mospheric standard. The ignition of the gaseous mixture was effected by means of the discharge of a calorimotor through a platina wire. These preliminary explanations being made, the process for analy- zing the carburetted hydrogen furnished by the Gas Light Company, was then performed by Dr. Hare’s skillful and intelligent assistant, Mr. J. Bishop. The following results were obtained, agreeably to several experi- ments in which the condensation and absorption were the same. e oxygen employed having been first analyzed, by igniting it with three volumes of hydrogen, was found to contain four per cent. of impurity. The gas exploded with the oxygen imparted to it, one measure of impurity for every 20 measures employed. ence, 20 measures being assumed as representing one volume, in order to have that quantity of pure gas, 21 measures were taken into D the eudiometrical receiver, and were mingled. and ignited with seven- ae ty-five measures of oxygen. * A condensation of thirty-five measures was found to ensue—one volume, or twenty measures, being attributable to the disappearance ofthe gas. Since by its conversion into carbonic acid, oxygen under- goes no change of volume, fifteen measures out of the thirty-five were to be ascribed to the oxygen consumed by hydrogen. But fifteen measures. of oxygen require thirty of Bydrazen. equal to a volume and a half; and thus it a that this last mentioned quantity of the last mentioned gas existed in the vol gas subjected to analysis. The residue, after being well washed with ammonia, was found to have lost fifteen measures, which, containing, agreeably to the known composition of carbonic acid, a like volume ak carbon, represents the quantity of this element in the gaseous volume subjected to examina- tion. Bas It follows, that there are three-fourths of a volume of core one and a half of hydrogen, condensed into one volume of the gas} that in four cubic feet, there are three cubic feet of vapor of carbon, and six of hydrogen. The gas obtained by passing the vapor of alcohol through a notcekae lain tube, has been found, by Dr. Hare, to contain a volume of carbon onda volume of hydrogen condensed into one volume. That obtained Miscellanies.. 385 from the same liquid by sulphuric acid, usually known as olefiant gas, and with which the former has been confounded, contains two-of car- bon and two of hydrogen in one volume, as is generally received. The gas-light gas therefore contains twice as much hydrogen in proportion to its carbon, as those above described, and this might have been inferred from its being sufficiently buoyant for balloons, agreeably to Mr. Wise’s aéronautical experience. As the excess of — hydrogen tends to lessen the liability to smoke, it is presumed that the gas, as constituted, may be preferable, for the purpose of illumina- tion, to such as contain a greater proportion of carbon.—Journal of the Franklin Institute, July, 1839, a 55. Fall of a Meteorite in Missouri, February 13, 1839.—On the afternoon of the 13th of February, 1839, a meteor exploded near the settlement of Little Piney, Missouri, (lat. 37° 55’ N.; lon. 92° 5’ W.) and cast down to the earth one stony mass or more in that vicinity. Mr. Forrest Shepherd, of this city, who was at the time exploring this region in the line of his profession; viz. that of a mineralogical and _ geological surveyor; hearing of the explosion of the meteor, exerted = himself to collect all the circumstances of the occurrence. He subse- quently succeeded in obtaining several fragments of one of the stones thrown down by the meteor. Mr. Shepherd has favored me with an opportunity to examine these fragments, and has also communicated to me the details below related. The meteor exploded between 3 and 4 o’clock P. M., of the 13th of February, 1839, and although the sky was clear, and the sun of course shining at the time, the meteor was plainly seen by persons in Potosi, Caledonia, and other towns near which it passed. At Caledonia, which is about nine miles southwesterly from Potosi, the meteor passed a lit- tle north, and at the latter place, a little to the south of the zenith. Its course was almost precisely to the west. The most eastern spot at which it was seen is about fifteen miles west of St. Genevieve, (or about lat. 378° N.; lon. 90° W.)—the most western is Little Piney, near which it exploded. To the observers at the latter place, the meteor appeared of the size of a large star. They represent its mo- tion as very slow; but do not state how many seconds it was in sight. s have no data for determining the meteor’s size, or velocity, or the nation of its path to the horizon. The direction of the meteor’s motion with regard to that of the earth, was probably such that the velocity of the former would be apparently diminished ; and as at Lit- tle Piney the meteor must have traversed only a small arc, its mo_ tion, to an observer there, would appear quite slow. At the time of the occurrence, Mr. Shepherd was on the western bank of the Missis- Vol. xxxvu, No. 2.—July—October, 1839. 386 Miscellanies. sippi, near St. Mary’s landing, and heard a distant report, which he was afterwards inclined to refer to the explosion of this meteor. At Little Piney, Mr. Harrison and others saw the meteor burst in pieces, and in a minute or a minute and a half afterwards, they heard three explosions in quick succession. Some of the inhabitants went in quest of the stones which they supposed had fallen, and finally found a tree which appeared to have been recently injured by the collision of some solid body. Near this tree they discovered (although the ground was covered with three or four inches of snow,) one of the meteoric stones, about as large as a man’s head, partly imbedded in the earth; and from the circumstances of its position and appearance, there could be no reasonable doubt that this was the body which had struck the tree. It is to be hoped that further search will be made for other portions of this meteorite. The total weight of all the fragments which’ Mr. S. has brought home, is 973 grains. The specific gravity of one of the small fragments is 3.5; but different portions of the stone may vary slightly in this re- spect, as they may contain more or less of the metallic matter. The resemblance between this meteorite and those of Tennessee, (this Jour. 17, 326.) Georgia, (Ib. 18, 389,) and of Weston, Conn., is very close, and one might almost imagine that they were all parts of the same original mass. The cohesion of the stone is not great, as it crumbles under a moderate blow. Two of the fragments retain por- tions of the crust or exterior coating. This is a fifteenth of an inch thick, and bears evidence of intense ignition and partial fusion. It is black, with a wrinkled or cellular surface, and is traversed with seams. The general color of the interior is an ash-gray. The whole mass is studded with metallic particles, (varying from the size of small shot down to mere points,) and prese ents numerous rusty spots, and occa- sional small spheroidal concretions which do ot ei to differ in materials from other parts of the stone. The little metallic masses (doubtless of nickeliferous iron) are attracted by the magnet; and are generally permeated by the earthy matter. They are mostly of an iron-white color, but several are yellow and slightly iridescent. One of these minute masses being removed from the stone, it was by the ham- mer at once extended into a thin Jamina, and was evidently malleable. An analysis may be expected hereafter. Sept. 25, 1839. Remark.—-Having been familiar with meteorites and Seed many of them, I hesitate not to say that Iam perfectly assured of the. genuine meteoric origin of the fragments described above, even with- out any reference to the testimony.—Sen. Ed. - io ss E. C. Herrick. : a Miscellanies. 387 56. Explosions in American Coal Mines—Those distressing events for- merly so frequent in England, are beginning to happen in this country. It is desirable that the memory of them should not pass away, but produce a strong. impression on the public mind, which may lead to all possible caution and to the use of every available protection, for as our numerous mines are wrought deeper, such casualties wi come more frequent. We have heard of several explosions in our mines, but cannot present the details. We are assured even that our anthracite mines are not exempt from them. We should hardly have looked for their occur- rence in them, although we have proved* that a large quantity of inflam- mable gas is extricated by heat from these coals. ‘The following account is from the Richmond Compiler of April, 1839. Explosion of Gas in the Black Heath Coal Mine.—The Black Heath Mine, worked by the “Black Heath Coal Company,” is one of the richest and most extensive in this country. It is twelve miles from Rich- mond, in nearly a western direction, and is situated in the midst of bitu- ~ minous coal fields of unknown extent. The shaft from which the explo- sion recently took place, has not been long sunk, and we believe is the deepest in the Union: being more than 700 feet to its bottom. Up- wards of 10,000,000 bushels of coal had been obtained in the pit reached by it; and-none can conjecture how much more a further exploration would discover. he steam engines and apparatus for hoisting coal from the shaft were excellent; and the system and facility with which the hoisting process was conducted, produced an average of about 2,500 bushels of coal per day. It is to be regretted that these operations—adding so much to our pro- ductive capital and commercial strength, have been interrupted—and this regret is increased by an afflicting catastrophe. The explosion was most violent, but its origin is uncertain, although it » is beyond all doubt that it occurred from neglect or disregard of the pos- itive orders and regulations of the pit. The drifts and “ air coasts,” (pas- sages for the air from chamber to chamber,) were so arranged as to keep up constant ventilation. It is the general opinion that one of the doors of the air coasts must have been closed, and that thus the “ Inflamma- ble gas” accumulated on Sunday to such an extent as to produce the ex- aa plosion soon after the laborers entered the pit, on Monday morning. Sir Humphry Davy’s safety lamp was regularly used in the mine, and no doubt is entertained but that it was used on Monday morning. It . was commonly carried forward to test the presence of the gas. It may have been out of order; a slight rent in the wire gauze covering, would teadily ignite the gas. Other lamps were used; and one of these may have been taken into a chamber or drift where the safety lamp had not * * This Journal, Wu, PP- 78 to 100. a 388 Miscellanies. been presented. Either of these causes would have involved careless- ness. ‘The density and inflammability of the gas might have caused the wire to have become oxidated, and thus to fall to pieces; but that could not have occurred till after indication by flame inside the gauze, of a danger in the face of which it would have been madness in the laborers to remain. Whatever might have been the immediate cause, the arrange- ments and rules of the pit, drawn from the lights of science and experi- ence in mining, were such as if properly attended to, to have insured safety. But would it not be well, in order to diminish the chances of danger from even carelessness itself, to use Davy’s lamp exclusively, = all pits, where there has been an exhibition of carburetted hydrogen or “ in- flammable gas ?” One of the superintendents of the operations in the pit, who was below when the explosion took place, was a man of great skill in his profession, having been many years engaged in it, in some of the most famous of ns English mines. He was a Scotchman, named John Rynard. Mr. John Hancock, a native of Chesterfield, of respectable ‘ane ily, ¥ A: other unfortunate superintendent. pee ee The laborers were all colored men. The superintendents. shows the ee tea that about forty were below. They cannot speak with cer- tainty. Many had gone to distant plantations to see their wives, and it Was not known how many had returned. “The explosion was _so powerful as to blow pieces of timber out of the shaft to a distance of. one hundred yards fromit. Three men were blown up in a coal hamper, to a height of some thirty or forty feet above its top ; two of them fell out of the hamper in different directions, and were im- ately Ij —the third remained in it, and fell with it, escaping most “mirac with his 1 a both legs — mn. He is now doing 5 very well. Much ev b : ~ the shaft, and four of the tae as we have alre from beneath a large bulk there, in a mutilated state. Four ak Me. out shortly after the explosion on Monday—one of win died. The others are in a fair way to recover. Every possible exertion consistent with safety, has been made to rescue the unfortunate beings. It appeared upon going down the shaft, that much carbonic acid gas (the product of combustion) was present. This is called at the mines “ black damp,” and though not inflammable, is well known to be eminently destructive to human life. This then had first to be dispersed. The partitions too, in the shaft, necessary for the ingress and egress of air in the pit, were much torn to pieces by the ex- ~ plosion and had to be repaired, as death would have resulted to those who - went down the shaft. These explosions were formerly’ very common in the north of England. One occurred at the Felling colliery in Northumberland, England, on the bottom of eS: ‘ « 24 oie the 25th May, 1812, in which 92 lives were lost. Miscellanies. 389 This is the greatest destruction ever known from the same causes. In 1815, an explosion occurred in a mine at Durham, in which 57 persons were destroyed, and The discoveries of Sir Humphry Davy and other contributors to science and benefactors of mankind have since rendered it certainly possible to avout these destruc- in another, 22 were killed in the same manner, tive explosions. In our mines, no explosions of any extent has ever occurred from the ignition of inflammable gas. Such events may as certainly be guarded against as the bursting of steam boilers, , the safeguards i in each case being as simple as effective. 57. Relative temperature of the water of the Saco river, and the atmos- phere for the years 1837 and 1838.—The table annexed gives the mean temperature of the water of the Saco river, and of the air as observed at vation was 63°.2,—difference 2°.7. It will be observed that the differ- ence in the mean temperature for the year is but ?. T am aware that this is only an approximation to the truth, for in order to insure perfect accuracy, the observations the whole course of the river. 7s Of a degree. should be made th - Barcue.per. Water " out 0 6 he 1 21 a r= A 9 6 A 0 die yea PeeR Air Air Water | Ratio. -: | 1837, | 1837. | 1838. | 18938. | oo - 14° | 32°.0 | 28° | 32°.0 | 649.0. February, - -— - I 32 .0| 14 | 32 0 | 23 ‘March, - - - 26 32 .0| 32 32.0 bl April, -#h-. - 38 | 36.6| 36 [43.1 | 32 May, - - ee: on 46 | 50 .2| 49 | 53 3) 53 3 ee alae: cea ear 58 | 63.8 |°62 | 67 6 68 | at oe eer 63. | 71.4) 68 |.73 5177 ugus Pas Poca Gl_..| 0.0} 64 14.72 7.172 September, - - - 54. | 63 6] 56 | 63 2) 65 eh Se 44 ;49 9| 42 | 49 8 | 47 November, - > - 34 | 36.6 | 31 36 .9 | 33 cember, - - ~ 24 32 4) 2. | 82 0} 27 481 | 569.5 | 502 | 588.1 | Mean temp. for the year, 40.08 | 47.46 | 41.83 | 49.01 | 49.53 x - Portland. —The fifth column shows what the temperature of the river would be, provided it was subject to no other influences than those of the mosphere.—For example; take the month of September ;—54° air in - 737 : 63°.6 water in 737 :: 56° air in 38 : 65°.9; while the water by ohare 58. British Association.—This interesting meeting convened on the 26th of August at Birmingham. Prof. C. U. Shepard of this city = 390 Miscellanies. (New Haven) was one of the number, and to attend the meeting went from London to Birmingham, one hundred and eight miles, in five hours. One thousand members appeared at the first meeting, and at a conversation assembly in the evening, one thousand five hun- dred were present of whom about one half were ladies; the scene was one of animated conversation with incessant promenading, and sublime music from the largest organ in the world played by a first rate German performer and composer. The evening was closed bya supper. The next day Sir Robert Peel, now in retirement from min- yee power, gave a splendid entertainment to a select party of sci- entific and literary men at his magnificent villa of Drayton Manor, 24 miles from Birmingham, at which our correspondent was present with Re Mr. sates, the President of 1 the British Association, Drs. and of Oxf iver | acai Peacock and ins of Cambridge, Mr r. Greenough, Mr. Hallam ne historian, Prof. Shenbein of Basie, Count de Tambone, the dean of Ely, Mr. Horner, Mr. James Peel, and others. Scientific Excursion to the Dudley Coal Mines.—Friday, Aug. 30, a party of 450 in number went by canal in five boats to visit the ‘Dud- ley co and i Iron region. The canal is very large and expensive ; manufactories are every where in view on all the route of nine miles, and for the last six miles it is one vast coal region; a bed of coal 30 feet thick passes under the whole country and deep pits descend into it in almost innumerable places, over which the lofty chimneys like shot towers were throwing out dense clouds of smoke, and over every one of them is a furnace both for the working of steam emp, gines and. for tone the mines. The party penetrated the vast | tunnel, excavated about 100 years ago under Dudley eastle, which was built as it is said in at D. 700, or about that time. The tunnel, which is about three quarters of a mile long, is one vast cavern, in some pieces 60 feet high and every where from 30 to 100 feet wide. Large boats, holding each 60 persons, conveyed the party. e sides of the tunnel were illuminated by 4000 candles, besides — a splendid exhibition of lights disposed in regular figures at its ex- tremity. For the first quarter of a mile, the party proceeded i in almost the darkness of midnight, when suddenly they descried in the distance an immense concourse of people of both sexes, occupying an extended platform of the rock, which was illuminated by the light of day de- scending upon them through an opening carried up through the solid strata 150 feet to the surface. The effect was wonderful, and it seemed as though the party had arrived in another world, while shouts and cheers were given and returned. From the point where the illumina- tion began, the company in the boats continued on while the people 391 on the platform accompanied them, walking along on the side of the cavern. A great cavern terally i ia steal te rock that has been blasted out is used as a flux for iro iro ee and has been and is worth more than the richest mine in En, When they reached the end of the gallery Mr. Marchison gave a lecture, and the marquis of Northumberland (query—N orthampton ?) made an address. Ata sig- nal given, blue lights were kindled behind the columns: of stone, left for the support of the mine, when suddenly all. tt e cavern for a Jength as far as the eye could see, was illuminated, a | repeated dis- charges of cannon at the entrance of the tunnel were reverberated in ing echoes. Then came red lights alternating with the blue, sheaesends of persons manifesting their delight by cheering and elap- ping, and all united in the national hymn, God save the Queen. The party then returned to the mouth of the cave where they had landed and having formed a circle round an eminence, Dr. Buckland gave an interesting lecture of an hour, and after an excursion of a mile, Mr, Murchison, gave another. 59. Proceedings of the Boston Society of Natural History, from September 19th, 1838, to March 21st, 1839. Compiled from the Re- cords of the Society, by Jurrrizs Wyman, M. D., Recording Sec- retary. In accordance with the intention of the Society, as explained in a preceding number of the Journal, the following contribution of the Pracestageng of the Society has been drawn up by its direction. It is ¢ that the original record was made by the late secretary, ; Se 19, 1838.—Dr. J. B. S. Jackson, in the chair. Dr. T. W. Harris exhibited and presented for the herbarium, spe- cimens of the following plants ; Liatris scariosa from Exeter, N. H.; which had also been found by Mr. Tuckerman in Cambridge—Sabbas tia chloroides, with a white variety, growing on the clean sand, on borders of ponds in Plymouth, not on salt bogs as stated by Beck— Drosera tenuifolia, Utricularia purpurea, and U. resupinata, all from Plymouth. Mr. G. B. Emerson had also found the three species of Drosera growing together at Plymouth, and also four species of Utricularia. Mr. E. had lately visited the Saddleback Mt., which he strongly recommended to the notice of every lover of nature. He exhibited Specimens of Taxus Canadensis and Pinus Fraseri from this lo- calit Dr. Srorer had recently met with two rare fishes, and had been able to determine them satisfactorily. One of them, commonly called ? 392 Miscellanies. Havre mackerel or Albicore, proves to be the tunny, Thynnus vulga- ris, of the Mediterranean.* The other is the Xiphias gladius, sword fish, which Dr. Richardson thinks does not exist on this coast. This, however, as well as several others, was taken near Martha’s Vine- yard. Great discrepancy exists in the figures of this fish, especially as to the dorsal fin. Dr. 8. also stated that the Siren recently presented by Mr. Olm- stead was the Menobranchus lineatus. Mr. T. M. Brewer had met with the Lestris pomerana, or Yager, killed on the south shore. It is is said by Nuttall to come only as far south as Hudson’s Bay. Mr. Epwarp Tuckerman, Jr., exhibited specimens of Crypta mi- eS nima found at Cambridge in company with another plant of similar aracter. Beck places this plant in the genus Adatone. Oct. 22, 1838.—G. B. Emerson, Esq., President, in the chair. Dr. Srorer communicated a paper from Dr. Kirtland of Ohio, de- scribing several new species of fishes from the waters of that State. Dr. Kirtland is engaged in the zoological survey of the State. . T. M. Brewer presented some specimens of madrepore taken from the stomachs of fishes on the coast of Labrador. He also pre- sented the eggs of the following birds :—Fringilla socialis and tris- tis—Sylvia aestiva—Sturnus Ludovicianus—Turdus polyglottus and Ardea virescens. Mr. E. Tuckerman, Jr., read a paper entitled “Notices of plants new to the Boston Flora.” The species detected by him, which Te new to our Flora were as follows :—Camelina sativa— Urtica urens— Viola Pema if ia—Lechea thymifolia— Hypericum ellipti- gulata— Alnus unde a tine diandra—Sedum telephinum—Convallaria trifolia— Digitaria filiformis— Paspalum ciliatifolium—-Setaria viridis. He also added many new localities to numerous other rare plants. He added the testimony of his observation to the constancy of the characters of Bigelow’s Viola acuta—Salicornia mucronata ‘and Sonchus spinu- losus. Dr. A. A. Govtp, stated that he had recently received a specimen of Helix aspersa from Portland, from a gentleman who assured him that it was very common in that vicinity, and appeared in great num- pers after the ground had been burned over. _ Dr. Amos Binney exhibited specimens of Helices from Martinique, and the beautiful Carocolla spinosa, Lea, of our Southern States. An individual of this species was taken in New Haven harbor in June, 1839- —E. C. H, Misaanit 393 November 6, 1838.—Rev. F. W. P. GueENwoon, Vice President, in the chair. : 3: E; Tscuruxedieiaa: made a report on the Gomphocarpus fruticosus, a native of the Cape of Good Hope. “It is one of the As- clepiadez, allied to Asclepias Syriaca; differing from it in the shape of the wings of the seed vessel and in not having a milky juice. The coma is composed of the pollen tubes ang not of the compressed calyx, as in the composite plants. Mr. 'TescHEMACHER exhibited some orpuliie of stilbite and fluor spar, illustrative of the theory of decrement by solid angles, in which nature strictly accords with theor Dr. J. Wyman exhibited the skeldioh of a human fetus of about the third month, illustrating the comparative size of the head and the rest of the body, the advanced state of ossification of the ribs and jaws beyond other parts of the skeleton; this last observation is interesting in connection with the fact, that respiration and nursing, in which the jaws and ribs play an important part, are the first voluntary acts of the new born child. Mr. Epwarp AppieTon had noticed a hyacinth whose bulb had been accidentally planted in an inverted position. A scape had de- scended into the earth and was terminated by a spike of colorless flowers, the whole plant being six inches in length. When placed erect in the earth they did not survive. r. ©. T. Jackson exhibited some maize from the Rocky Moun- hie with only two kernels in each husk, and stated that it was not yet determined whether it was a new species or merely a variety. Dr. Ray of Augusta, Ga., being present, observed that it was not unlikely to be the normal form of the fruit of the bread corn. A par- tial calyx encloses two kernels, and a number of these are enclosed in acommon calyx. It is supposed that the partial calyces are obliterated by pressure of the kernel enlarged under cultivation, thus forming the ear as we usually find it. He states that this form had appeared in Tennessee, extending to Georgia, and did great damage to the crops, its farina being disseminated to the impoverishment of the full ear. Dr. C. T. Jackson gave an analysis of Indian pipe- -stone from the famous quarry of Coteau du Prairie, and brought from thence by Mr. Catlin, the first white man allowed by the Indians to visit it. ‘The layers of pipe-stone are overlaid by polished quartz rock in which are found relievos, which must have been wrought by the hand of man ; the Indians however declare them to be the tracks of the Great» Spirit: It is usually called steatite, but is not this mineral; it is har- der than gypsum and softer than carbonate of lime. Dr. Jackson Vol. xxxvi1, No. 2.—July-October, 1839. 50 394 Miscellanies. proposes for it the name of Catlinite, in honor of the famous delinea- tor of theIndians. The following is the result of chemical analysis. Water, - - - - - 84 Silica, - - - - - 48-2 Alumina, - - - - - 28°2 Magnesia, - - - + - 6:0 Carbonate of lime, - . - - 2°6 Peroxide of iron, - - - “ 5-0 Oxide of manganese, - - - 6 99-0 Loss, probably magnesia, - - - 1-0 ~ 100-0 Ft eae 1838. —Rev. Fr. w. P. Greenwoop, Vice President, in the chair. Mr. Epwarp TuckermAN, Jr. read a paper entitled, “ An enume- ration of the Lichens of New England not included in our Floras, with notices of some interesting species.” He also read a historical sketch of Lichenography ; these papers being the commencement of a monograph to be prepared in connection with another gentleman. Dr. A. A. Goutp exhibited living specimens of the beautiful Beroe Pileus; and also the Mysis Fabricii, a species of crustacea, not pre- viously observed in our waters, both taken from the river under Cragie’s bridge. December 18, 1838.—Gero. B. erg Esq., President, in the chai Dr. D. H. siiibiisivea that he had éxainined the donation of fishes received last summer from Mr. Cordis, and had ascertained that there were 87 species, belonging to the following 38 genera, Viz. Serranus; Merra; Plectropoma; Mesoprion; Holocentrum; Poly- nemus; Sphyrena; Mullus; Dactylopterus; Cottus; Scorpena; Sciena; Chetodon; Holocanthus; Caranx; Zeus; Acanthurus; Mugil; Blennius; Julis; Scarus; Clupea; Alosa; Chatoessus ; En- graulis; Monochamus; Solea; Echineis; Ammodytes; Hippocam- pus; Tetraodon; Balistes; Monacanthus; Ostracion; and Carcha- Trias. Dr. J. Wyman had examined as far as practicable the collection of fossil bones recently received from Athens. They were principally bones of large Ruminants mixed with those of Solidungulated ani- ls. Those of the former consisting of fragments of jaws, head of a tibia, and lower extremity of a femur; those of the latter were . metacarpal and phalangeal bones. s Me i: : = inte 395 January 16, 1839.—Rev. F. W. P. Greenwoop, Vice President, in the chair. Dr. Martin Gay made a report upon some specimens of minerals committed to him, and more particularly upon what is termed Arbo- rescent native Silver. It is usually supposed that minerals assume the arborescent, fibrous form, by a sort of crystallization. But he had been led to suppose that it was produced mechanically, some- thing in the following way: A mass of ore is subjected to heat, suf- ficient to reduce the metal to a semifluid state. This is suddenly cooled, when the whole mass as suddenly contracts, and forces out the metal through the interstices of the matrix in the thread like form in which we find it. Dr. Gay has in his possession a piece of copper ore which he took from a furnace and which afterwards presented upon its surface these so called arborescent crystals. Dr. Gay had not heard the phenomenon accounted for in this way, nor met 53 any detail of so plausible an explanation in any book. Dr. D. H. Srorer announced the reception of a collection of fishes from Puerto Cabello, among which were the following genera; Me- soprion; Prionotus ; Hemiramphus; Exocetus; Clupea; Caranx ; Chetodon and Acanthurus. February 5, 1839.—Geo. B. Emerson, Esq., President, in the chair. _D. H. Srorer read a letter from J. G. Anthony, Esq., of Cin- cinnati, Obio, containing the description and figure of a new species of Anculotus, found near that city, to which he gave the name of Anculotus costatus. Also announcing a new species of fossil Caly- mene, an another curious fossil recently discovered by him and about to be published. Simon E. Greene, Esq., stated that he had lately seen the Parus Hudsonianus in Brookline, which is much farther south than it has been before noticed. Audubon had seen it in Labrador, and believed that it had been seen in Maine. Nuttall mentions its original discov- ery at Hudson’s Bay. Dr. T. M. Brewer exhibited the skin of a goose, killed in Boston harbor, and which is rarely seen in this region; it was the young of the snow goose Dr: J: ee exhibited the head of a young Lemur, (Lemur cotta), from Madagascar—also specimens of ‘ measly pork” in which Were vast numbers of parasitic animals, inhabiting the cellular mem- brane; they did not agree in their characters with the Cysticencus, which is senelly. described as constituting this disease. Mie = es Miscellanies. February 20, 1839.—Rev. F. W. P. Greenwoop, Vice President, in the chair. J. E. Teschemacnuen, read a report on the fruit commonly called the sea-cocoa. It was the fruit of the Lodoicea Sechellarum, a no- ble palm, found only at the Seychelles Islands, a small rocky and mountainous group, to the northeast of Madagascar. He gave an account of its fabulous history, and of its final discovery at these islands in 1743, after which, it was described by Sonnerat. Previous to this period, it had only been found floating on the sea, about the Maldive Islands. As a medicine, the nut was regarded as a specific for all maladies. It was highly valued, and esteemed one of the most costly of regal gifts. Rochon says, the Emperor Rhodolphus offered = 800. florins for ones and that another was valued at A par- ar account was given of the tree, and its mode of ifenctification illustrated. He also proceeded to demonstrate that the shell of the nut was but a modification of the leaf; and made an interesting dem- onstration of the hilum and the course of the nutritive vessels, which were here exhibited on a large scale. Dr. T. W. Harris, had in his possession some notes, which went "to show that Sonnerat was not the discoverer of this plant, but that it was discovered by Alexis Marie de Rochon, as early as 1679. Mr. Epwarp Tuckerman, Jr., presented specimens of Marchantia polymorpha, with its fructification, and another specimen of which he ee not determined the species. March 6, ee F. W. P. Greenwoop, Vice President, in the chair. Dr. A. A. = ee exhibited specimens of a rare shell from the northern Atlantic shores. It was originally described. by Beck, as a fossil shell from the St. Lawrence Bay, and is figured i in Guerin’s Magazin de Zoologie. It is not a fossil shell. It is named Rostella- ria (Aporrhais) occidentalis, and is frequently taken from the stom- achs of codfish taken on the bank fisheries. A nearly entire one has been found near Portland, one at Saco Beach, and another at Nahant Beach, and numerous tips of the spire at Sana Beach and other points in our harbor. Mr. J. E. Tescuemacuer, presented numerous specimens of veg- etable impressions from Bridgeport coal mines, N.S. Most of them were also other forms which he had been unaccustomed to see. A large and exceedingly valuable collectian of zoological speci- mens, recently received from Dr. F. W. Crogin, of Surinam, was laid on the table. It consisted of a great variety of mammalia, birds, rep- Miscellanies. 397 tiles, fishes, insects and erustacea. Among them were specimens of the Molossus ater, Didelphis opossum; Surinam toad (Rana pipa); Gymnotus electricus and others equally rare and valuable. March 21, 1839.—G. B. Emerson, Esq., President, in the chair. Mr. J. E. Tescuemacuer, read a report on Darlington’s “Flora Cestrica.” This work contains a vast quantity of original and valu- able information; the details are minute and correct. It is the work of a thorough and zealous botanist of the Linnean school. The minute and faithful description of many plants renders it indispen- sable to the library of the botanist. Mr. T. also made a report on some minerals from Franconia; viz., Garnets associated with iron, and green Epidote, Andalusite or Mackle; this had been analyzed by Dr. C. T. Jackson, but he did not indicate the black substance connected with it. Upon analysis Mr. T. found it to contain ;4; magnesia, and concluded that it was hornblende. —_. - a Mr. T. had examined a doubtful mineral from Franconia, and found | it to be the black sulphuret of zinc, or blende, in the unusual form of the rhomboid dodecahedron. It is of rare occurrence, and may in- deed be worthy to be considered as a new species. Dr. D. H. Storer, spoke of the changeable localities of the Mol- lusca, and mentioned particularly the Nucula thracieformis, which was not uncommonly found a year since, in the Platessa dentata, taken off Race point, Cape Cod; but though these fishes have been taken there more abundantly than usual during the past winter, only a single specimen has been heard of. The same fact with regard to other species sometimes found abundantly on our coast, was adverted to by Méssrs. Emerson & Gould. Dr. J. Wyman, made a report on three specimens of bats, two of which were from Surinam, and the other from this state. > form- er were specimens of the Molossus ater, a male and female. The Molossi are characterized by incisors 11, those of the lower jaw seeming to be crowded out of their places by the great development of the canines; ears broad, meeting on the median line over the nose ; tragus round, outside of concha; hair black; tail not developed by interfemoral membrane. The other specimen was the Vespertilio emarginatus. 60. British Antarctic Expedition —The British Government have determined to send out an expedition for scientifie discovery in the Antarctic seas, under command of Capt. James C. Ross. The scientific instructions prepared for the expedition, by the Council of the Royal Society, are given in the London Athenzum, August, 1839. = x a es: Bey oe 398 Miscellanies. 61. Liquefaction of Carbonic Acid.—In Vol. xxxv, p. 346, we repub- lished from the Franklin Journal an account of the liquefaction of car- bonic acid by Prof. J. K. Mitchell. Dr. Hare, Dr. Torrey, Dr. J. W. Webster, and Prof. Bailey have labored with success on this subject. A letter from Prof. Bailey contain the following remarks I have had several fine trials of Prof. Mitchell’s apparatus and can now manage it with perfect ease. I have repeatedly made masses of the solid CO? as large as two fists, and have frozen by means of it as much as four ounces of mercury into one mass. Several of my students have had blisters raised on their hands by pressing the solid into close contact with ~ West Point, January 21, 1839. 62. A new mineral.—Dr. Charles T. Jackson, of Boston, has just Shtckeieds new mineral among those which he brought from Chessy copper mines in central France. He was led to analyze it in conse- quence of its resemblance to the artificial crenates of copper which he had formed while analyzing peat and soils; he then discovered that it was a native Crenated Hydro-Silicate of Copper. Composition, Silica 21:0; Oxide of Copper 46°8; Crenic acid 158; Water 10-0; Al. and Ox. Iron 4:4; Carb. Acid 2-0 = 100. Dr. Jackson names this new mineral Beaumontite, after the cele- brated Prof. L. Elie De Beaumont of Paris.* 63. Progress of the U.S. Exploring Expedition —We learn from the National Intelligencer that letters were received in August last, stating that the vessels of the Exploring Squadron which departed from Tierra del Fuego Feb. 26, vat nad soceeres in pushing their explorations to a poi nt farther south than American the French and the had Valparaiso about the middle of M ay. Th : different vessels were generally in excellent health and spirits, notwith- standing the fatigues which they had undergone. By more recent intelligence it appears that the Relief arrived at Callao on the 5th of June, and that the other vessels had sailed for jae nandez, p the exploring vessels of etr: They returned to s and crews of the 64. Mechanical Vaporization of Earths by distillation ; veri of a letter to Prof. Silliman, from Willis Gaylord, dated at Otisco—My inquiry of you respecting distilled water, or whetbes ne completely separated it from all earthy ingredients, arose t nner in which some writers have spoken of the effects of 7 with distilled in edamene x _ * Not less known for his scientific attainments thaeener his won) to strangers, especially Americans. # ws ¢ = » Miscellanies. 399 water, as though all earthy ingredients were separated. Of this I have some doubts, and think that distilled water will contain as much earthy matter as plants require in ordinary cases. Our water in this section of country as you are well aware, contains large quantities of sulphate or carbonate of lime in solution, while the water is as transparent as air. A short time since from the steam pipe of an old distillery, a pipe through which nothing but steam had ever passed, I cut a section of the wood, and this disclosed a perfect tube of stone nearly three eighths of an Sack in thickness, smooth and solid. The base of it is lime, as it effervesces freely in muriatic acid ; and of course it must have beet arrested from the steam in its passage, by condensation against the sides of the tube. I have no doubt that silex when in a state of solution would also pass over in all the necessary quantities required to perfect plants ; and hence deem the doctrine that the earths found in plants watered with distilled water, is created by them, absurd. Your answer confirmed me that my suspi- cions were correct; and that the theories built on distilled water are in the main untenable. ? : 65. New Hall of the Academy of Natural Sciences at Philadelphia.— We are happy to observe that this early and most respectable institution is soon to be accommodated by a new fire proof building forty five feet front by eighty five deep, which will contain “a single saloon with ranges of galleries, beneath which, in the basement, will be a lecture room for five hundred persons.” Wiiu1am Mac org, long known for his great munificence to objects of science and benevolence, has contributed twenty thousand dollars* to the society during the last two years, seventeen thousand of which have been reserved for the erection of the building, and this sum has been greatly enlarged by the liberal subscriptions of members and others friendly to the cause of science. ss The foundation stone of the building was laid May 25, 1839, and a very appropriate discourse delivered by Walter R. Johnson, A. M., M. A. &c. &c. : Pidadelphia and New York may now vie with each other in the ac- commodations of their respective academies ; the younger sister having been laudably emulous of the fame and worthy deeds of the elder. wt 66. Dr. Hare’s method of removing the resin which contaminates the best Oil of Turpentine of commerce by an alcoholic solution of Chloride of Calcium.—Mr. Guthrie recommended some years since in an article published oY us, the employment of diluted sulphuric acid to remove resin nm Oil naman Dr. Hare has for the same purpose used suc- a 7m inralianaglic many specimens in natural history had a hele given to the Academy by Mr. Maclure. * ha’ * * * 400 Miscellanies. cessfully a saturated solution of Chloride of Calcium in Alcohol, which he considers as preferable because the acid is liable to produce a resin as well as to remove it from the oil. 67. British Annual and Epitome of the progress of Science for 1839. Edited by R. D. Thomson, M. D. London, 1838.—It might seem inappropriate to notice an Annual so long after the time of its appearance, were it not that this little work, like its prototype the Annuaire, contains information of lasting and general interest on many subjects, while its minute and accurate tables give it the char- acter of a hand book for all classes of readers. We have been much struck in the perusal of this and the previous volumes with the valu- -. bemiensation, they contain of different scientific subjects. Of th this cha are ) Robert E. Grant’s general view of the charac- of extinct animals in the present volume. On the eerneples of classification as applied to the primary divisions of the animal kingdom by the same author; and a sketch of the his- tory and present state of Geology, by Thomas Thomson, M. D., _ F.R.S. But it may appear invidious to attempt a distinction among so many articles where all.are of great value, and we accordingly » «give a classified Sst: of the table of contents of the present volume. - Poe = Es An Astronomical Calendar; Table of the Chronology of Science ; Weights and Measures and Coins of many countries; Table of Spe- cific Gravitie nd Atomic Weights ; Universities, Academies of Sci- ence, Profession nal Schools, &c. in Britain, Ireland, France, Holland, Russia, &¢.; Population and Power of Europe, Asia, Australia, and - the Polar regions; Statistics of the World; British Population ; Crimes and Punishments; Steam Navigation; Learned Societies; Dr. Grant’s view already inal : Hips x eee Beton 5 ; New Chemical Substances. We have heard with much regret from the fesraed editor (to whosé polite attention we owe the receipt of the three volumes of the An- nual now published) that this interesting work will probably. be diss continued after the present year, owing partly to want of e rage rg a ment and partly to the pressure of numerous more important duities. We cannot. but hope however that so Telpahia a work e be eon tinued. : eect 68. Longitude of New York.—At the very — — ber we have received from Messrs. Ev& G : paper read by Mr. E. J. Dent, F. R. 7 8.1 bef tion at Birmingham, Aug. 26, #8 giving t Ss ae Wisccllanies. : 401 ference of longitude between Greenwich and New York. Our limits permit us to give only the results. The longitude of N. Y. City Hall, resulting from the observations of three chronometers (sent by Mr. D. in July last, in the steamship British Queen; their rates being duly ascertained at Greenwich, Brooklyn, and again at Greenwich,) is 4h. 56m. 3.35s. W. As given by M. Daussy, in the Connaisance des Temps, it is 4h. 56m. 0.72s.; difference, 2.63s. As determined by R. T. Paine, Esq., and published i in the American Almanac, 9 longitude of N. Y. City Hall is 44. 56m. 4.5s. (previous « tions being about .5s. less,) which differs only 1. 15s. from the Pest of these Chronometrical observations. 69. Jays Catalogue of Shells, 3d edition.*—At page 399 of Vol. 36, we acknowledged the receipt of a copy of Dr. Jay’s new catalogue, intending to revert to it again. This edition is a great enlargement and improvement on the two former; it contain the names of 3872 spe- cies arranged according to Lamarck’s S: with a full reference to the habitat and the original description. As the numbers on the left of — the names are constant and intended to remain so, this work becomes a very convenient form of catalogue for all conchological collectors, as by placing on the specimen the number of the catalogue they have without further trouble a systematic arrangement of their own cabinets. There are ten quarto colored plates attached to the catalogue, with descriptions of new and rare shells in the collection, which add much to the value as well as beauty of the work. The shells figured and described are, plate I, Bulimus cinctus, Turbo Rotelliformis, Ampul- laria Brownii, and A. Storeria, Helix Planorbis, Paludina scalaris, Lym- nxa gracilis, Nucula Eightsii, Couthouy; Venerupis Peruviana, Fissu- - yella nigrita? Sowb., Trichotropis costellatus, Couthouy; Nucula Portlandica, Hitchcock; Helix denticulata. Plate II, Cerithium mar- moratum, Quoy et Gaimard; Ranella pulchra, Gray. Plate HI, An- . pullaria scalaris, D’Orbigny ; A. ochracea, Helix speciosa. Plate IV, Pa latica fluctuata, Sowb.; Neritina granosa, Sowb.; Plate V, Unio -spinosus, Lea; Plate VI, Bulimus ustulatus, B. uROT, Achatina bi- : color, Bulimus virgatus, B. porraceus, Pandora striata, Quoy et Gai- m rd. Plate VII, Bulimus tristis, Conus rhododendron, Couthouy ; ekg a Cumingii? Sowb.; Bulimus dubiosus, Cyclostoma multi- - Sag pace syclostoma Rauclonk Melania laeta, Cyclostoma multiline- 2 ‘Plates vil and IX, Dolium melanostomum. Plate X, Voluta hells arranged eae to the Lamarckian System, con- on of John Clar kso n Jay, M.D. Illustrated by ten plates. Wiley & 161 Broadway, and 35 Paternoster f Ye 83 Ka | % —July-October, 1839. 51 y ; 402 Miscellanies. armata, var. In the above enumeration those names without any au- thor annexed are the new species of Dr. Jay. The plates are in general beautifully executed, although the author expresses his regret in the introduction, that they do so little justice to the originals. 70. Lizards in Chalk.—We were more than two years since favored by a lady of New York, formerly resident in England, with the copy of a letter, of which the following is an extract. It is from the Rev. William Bassett, curate of Bran- don in Suffolk, to a former college friend. Although it has lain on file till this aa the facts ‘neve not bécome obsolete.—Sen. Ed. r. Farvell, a clergyman, formerly living at Elvedon, was present when some workmen dug up two lizards at a depth of fifty feet in a chalk pit, and which on being put into water lived till his father, having the care of them, let them esc s one about w binant bien was Zend oe Brandon at the depth of twelve feet ; was find dead. Dr. ‘Clarke Ke 2 ae two found by Mr. Farvell, for several years at his lectures at Cambridge At the time I wrote the letter to y whidk your cousin adverts, Dr. Clarke thought, and I believed, that there were no living lizards in England of the same kind, but have since seen them in the same Parish I have observed that ponds i in Suffolk mhicli abound with lizards in the spring, contain none in the a autumn or winter, and in met vie a lad a few years since to dig a hole in which to plant a tree, he in a solid piece of grass-land in my sight, dug up two lizards, one like those foundi in the chalk, and the we the Lacertus vulga- ris of Linneus, though I know not what Cuvier calls it. Now I am as unable to say how these lizards got into the place where I saw them found, as I am to tell how the others got into the chalk ; but in the last, which I myself witnessed, they seemed only to be hybernating, and to have removed themselves out of the reach of frost. This discovery diminished certainly my former confidence, that the other lizards had been so long in the chalk as I had thought, and although those found by Mr. Farvell were fifty feet deep, yet I reflected that these pits were not sunk at 7 but Im successive years; and supposing one to be sunk forty nine feet in one year, a lizard had only to burrow into the chalk one foot in order to be found fifty feet from the original surface. I am now in _ Suspense upon the subject.* - Toads and bats have often been found in trees alive, i in situations where they must have been many years, and if an animal can live ten years in a tree or in the earth, I know not where to fix any limit to the time its life may continue. As far as I re- collect, the gentleman in Warwickshire, whose name was Hoare, found a toad and a heard | in a rock in his garden, which he supposed must have been confined w a foot of each other. Both, if not alive, became so on being exposed to the air. * What the really learned, such as Prof. Sedgwick, (to whom I communicated these facts, and => 6} 1 eae r ae ae et ib eth him since,) and Buckland say, Iknow not. © 4%. INDEX TO VOLUME XXXVII. -_ his n the a te ta, noticed, 369 Alcoholic strength of wines, 363. an, John, on Coins and Meda Is w Haven. Centennial Medal, 287. Amber, on Insects in, by Dr. Berendt, 365. American Lpheogp Society, notice of their transactio ons, Antarctic eapudiehil British, for scien-|| ifie over Ararat, extinct voleano nea r, 349. Asaphu diurus, a new trilobite, 40. August, shooting stars of, 325. Spreaias of Sept. 3 1839, 375. B. patel. ae * the tower of, 352. hma abstract of his mono- rr a _ W. on liquefaction o: carbonic ac Bariu um, on a extrication ‘of, by Dr. Hare Basaltie columns of the Caucasus range, || Bassett, Rev. William, on Lizards in Ik, cha Batchelder, J.M.on temperature of Saco er and adjacent air, 38 Beaumontite, a new mineral, 398 Berendt, his work on insects in amber, 365. Berzelius on meteoric stones, 93. mpenichen, Seg catalogue of plants col- lected n : Bevan, esi: ‘biographical notice of, og “Bewic do. Biography, sci scientific, ‘announced es ef 193. Bischof, Prof. Gasiay, natural history of volcanos and e: akes, 41. <— Black Heath pon mine, exploniol in, Boracic acid lagoons of Tuscany, 270. — Boston Society of Natural History, pro- amen ing : 7 ‘391. wring, Dr. J. on bo oragic acid lagooiisll , ce |British Antarctic Expedition, 397. Assoc 389. jation, August, 1839, ? aera ‘notices of, by Rev. Cc, Fox Broan’ Prot his Lethea Geognostica, notice a, 369. —e of specimens of Natu- ral Histo 369. Brown col: Sesmation of Texas, 216, Cc. Calcareous deposits in Persia, &c., 355. ae os m, evolution of, by Dr. Hare, 267, Caldas a eeeaeine heights by the boil- ing o we ee Bulb, remarks on, by Prof. J. \Ca rpouic acid, eet of, 398. ye name proposed for Ind. Pipe Gold, Sori ton Chalk, jeaties in, 4 Christison on *teoholic strength of netiometrical determination of the longitude of New Yor Cinnabar not _— in Michigan, 185. Climate of Colom Coal mines, aeiien, explosions in, of Dudley, excursion to, 390. _— strata of the Trinity County, Tex- Coathupe on ager of respiration at ifferent hours, 367. yore pose its light used in photog- f ae imum, connected with cuagnetic pol Colombia, Rateorolocies! "observations in, b Col. R. Wright, 1. Co e, rved . Conductors of lightning, for ships, re- marks on, by the editor ary werd wus tables of, by Prof. J. W. Gib Copper, egies pene “ig taaaas of, 398. D. Da Costa, biog. notice’o f, 155. Daguerre’ 8 Piocet3 oe: 169. or eee y on ee meta- ee he noticed, _ of Tuseany, British reel bgt r, R. D. Thomson, noticed, 400. Daubeny, Prof. his views of ie ermal springs, &c. 53. 404 Da si ae his reply to Prof. Bischof, on vo Dent, E. I. chrosenvettital determination of longitude of se ork, 400. Desmarest, A: aia of, 124. ewey, Chester, on polished limestone of =— Y. 240. temperature of lake On- 6, 242. Dippivg deat mode = fe gs 277. ne = ical excitement of leather By frictio - Dudley coal mines, exttivsiien to, 390. EB Earth, heat of the a of, 35 BT. caine carried ove n distillation, 398. meena he at Tabriz y of, by. Prof. Edinceeee Sa s Sore on, no- ticed, 369. Editor, 1 dalgehgtag on the Limulus Po- lypbem Editors, remarks on a tornado in Alle-| ghany Co. N.Y. Sas Ss : < ~eBle ee o > on ges oft ightnin on packet| ship New BS 23° gon pa a othe Porler's Pear from notices aE geological Gat s of the States, 375. restoration of magnetism to compass needles, notice to subscribers and read- Ehrenberg’ Seca concerning fos- = nimaleu es, 116. valk ee in leath-| one, OGne rva INDEX. Formula for finding the Sg and vol- ume in a mix of two bases, 289 Fossil tree at Granton ox, Rev. ., notices of British Nat- rhe oy 136. Fox, R. W., on formation of metallic So 199. Prods ham, ae J., on vibrations of pen- dulums, 278 Fulminating powder , by Dr. Hare, 268. Fyfe, 31% = on photographic pro- cesses G. se ag santos. of gunpowder in blast- ing, by e, 2 Gaylord, Willis ot mechanical vapori- zation of ea 98. account of a tornado in New York, 91. a Dynamics, Prof. Whewell Geological Society of London, officers f,1 Geological Society of oe Whe- well’s addr — before, urveys of shee Seated noticed, 375. . en he 4 W., on the Greek conju- es the on oe ‘metamorphosis of the or- ayer lants, Greek bel een e remarks on, 112. Green, Prof. J., description of a new tri- lobite, reen, Prof. J., on trilobites in general, 25. temarks on Calymene Bufo, 32. ons in I 1. || hai = Sir R: K. extracts from his trav- els in Persia, &c., 347. great value of his work, 347. Potosi, analysis of meteoric iron from, Proceedin gs of Boston Nat. Hist. Soc’ty, 91. R. Rain Te solid apressions and casts Raphael tapestries, revival of their col- Ss, 244. Regnault, ona of mica containing tash and lith ia, 356. Respiration, products of, at different Rick: Clonies, on the effects ig one, rn, five or more in num- on the packet ship New York, Riddell, Prof. J. L., geolo ogy of the Trin- ity orate ex as, n ber 373. Robison ee on photographic draw- Roch ester, polished limestone of, 240. Rogers, Prof. H. Bs ce of his geolo- gical report of Rogers, Prof. W. B, ‘notice of his ae gical report of Va. Toecll = a \Saco river, ' ure f 889. am Salmon, Wm. biog. notice of, 121. Salt, deposits of in Persia, &c., 350. rl Texas, 213. Ww he sea at, a great agitations of Saturn’s so five or Emre we , 373. Schloth Baron, biog. notice of, 128: Sei, nancerrage of the by Dr. J. Bach- ee Seat Sandwich Islands, greatly.agi- tated, Noy. 7, ay as fue Ot springs 278. i "Thos. no ice of, 146. Pennsylvania, Rotice of Prof. H. D. Ro- ce V, , no otice of, 1 ab Dr. ‘Jay’s ge of, eetteed, herd, Forrest, account of the fall of . & meteorit e ee uri ie F oting Stars o: pbb ¢., 325. : vember, 1 1838, 372. ov '|\Sibbald, Sir Robert, notice of, 138. INDEX. © ata mee of Murchison, noticed Soa : t ode of making, 194. Solar Panne 169, 374. prings, mineral in Texas, 213. thermal, their connection with oes 53. Singerli, 372. Saaterels: A North America described, Stars, — motions of, 373. missin ki geting Oe Society of London, notice of e Ste hen ‘Kaspar biog. Stickne aie upposed discovery of cin in “Mich igan, 185. Stones Baeoric, fall of in Missouri, 385. h Africa, 190. notice of, 125. investigation of, by Ber- elius, 93. Vir Srontians extrication of, by Dr. Hare, Sulphuric acid, its reaction with essen- tial oil of heml ock, 246. kT. de ae at, 351. Talbot, H , photographic drawing, 71. eevee. 4 Bors revival of their vir intern atarth d, 351. Pretainl a rings, causes of, 53. Thomas, Davi id, © on a new species of Li- atris. Thom 1Son, R. D., his British Annual no- ticed, 400. Wi Webster, Prof. J. Trilobites, remarks on, by Prof. J. Green, 25. . . Dr. erat yd Trinity Country, Texas, geology of, 211. ebies a the colors of the Raphael Ta- Tiekerman, , Edward Jr., on the Lichens rather. Shee E. Segoe examination of the fire dam Beta oil w purified, 399. n, Wm.,no taeo ‘Taceny, boracic acid Ante of, 270. — of inte by distillation, i etation as affected by climate, 15. eins — formed by voltaic agen- cy, Vivepins prnincsts, notice of, 195. ‘of. * try, 350. beeen ecg 4: theory of, defended by Dau ; Te vatienia history of, by Prof. G. Bischof, 41. Ww. Weer, eae of, its use in ‘measuring A heig ate ea a thietiivniny on, 250. W., on explosions of hydrogen and oxygen, 104. S proposed bi- i graphy of scientific men, 193. Tomlinson, D., on preserving anima] Sifcado jin ss Co. N. Y., July 25, 1838, 9 New Brunswick, N. J. June 19, 1835, 255. New Haven, July 31, 1839, r of Babel, ruins of, 352. Prasactions of ‘Amer. Phil. Soc. Vol. , 363. eee on materials of the temples wcttin meteorite, velocity of, 32. hewell, Rev. Wm., address before Lond. Geol mee! pas 116, 21 hite, Gilbert, n ine -) NO wdere ines, alcoholic strength of, 363. Wolle, J., an uebener, their Catalogue = Plants Wri ic rd, meteorological ee an re man, Dr roc Soe. of Nat. Hist. 391. ees Boston , 366. pee, new species of, 40. = Yarrell, Wm., notice of, 167. The following atieesiiecs ‘ind corrections were received “after the article * w eat they 2 and the © Page containing the errata, were printed. XIII. XIV. CONTENTS OF VOLUME XXXVII. NUMBER ie , Meteorological Observations during a Residence in Co- lombia, between the Years 1820 and 1830; by = Richard Wright, - Remarks on the Trilobite; by Prof, see M. D. * Description of a New Trilobite ; by Prof. Jacob Green, M. D., - On the Natural History of Yoleamia a Parihghekee? ; by Prof. Gustav Bischof, M. D., . Reply of Dr. Daubeny to Prof. Bischof ’s Orjections to the Chemical Theories of Volcanos, . ; . Mountains in New York; by E. F. Johnson, . Account of a Tornado; by Willis Gaylord, . On Meteoric Stones—From the Annual Account of the Progress of Physics and Chemistry; by Berzelius, . Terrestrial Magnetism; by J. Hamilton, . . Explosion of Hydrogen and Oxygen, with ies on Hemming’s Safety Tube; by Prof. J. W. Webster, . On the Greek Conjugations ; by Prof. J. W. Gibbs, . Notice of Prof. Ehrenberg’s Discoveries in relation to Fossil Animalcules; also Notices of Deceased Mem- bers of the Geological Society of London, being ex- tracts from the Address of Rev. William Whewell, B.D. Re Bee cots ‘i . ‘ . “ Account of a Meteor seen in Connecticut, December 14, 1837; with some considerations on the Meteo- rite which exploded near Weston, ‘Dec. 14, — By Edward C, Herrick,” Some Notice of British Woeturalictes by ey. Charies > Ae . ‘ ~ MISCELLANIES. 1. Pictorial delineations by light; solar, lunar, stellar, and arti- ficial, called Photogenic and the art Photography, . . Correction of an Error—Cinnabar not found in Michigan, 104 112 iv CONTENTS. 3, 4. An Essay on the Development and Modifications of the external Organs of Plants—Journal of the Essex County (Mass.) Natural History Society, ” 5. Transactions of the American Philosophical Society, : 6, 7. Notice of the Journal of the Statistical Society of London. —Progress of the U. S. Explering Expedition, 8, 9. Cold Bokkeveld Meteorites—Meteoric Iron from Potosi, 10,. 11. Encke’s Comet—Remains of the Mastodon in Missouri, 12. Latanium, a New Metal, 13. Biography of Scientific Men, . 14, 15, 16. Note by Mr. E. F. Johnson, Civil iciacare ak Nor- thern Lynx fangs in Conngcticut—F reservation of animal Fa at for Soap Mak ; 17. Notice of errhtio® ‘Pritnosus’ and Jeteras Plionfesue, = 18. Malaria, . ? 19. Electrical Excitement i in Lesthet by Friction, 20, 21. Great Scheme for Magnetical Giskivastonszchelion of Spongy Platina, ‘ Formation of Metallic Veins = ‘Galvauite Agency, ; Be x our Subscriber and Readers, © . + : ss "NUMBER IL Art. I. es gee Examination of the Fire-Damp from the Coal Mines near Newcastle. By [the late] Epwarp a dike: M. D., F. R.S. Lon. and Edin., V. P. G. ge ™ S., Professor of orem d in the Saersity of ~ = * “Sete ndon, IL. foes a He’ Oevhogy-ot the Trinity Oeinitry, Texas, made during an excursion there in April and May, 1839; by Prof. J. L. Rivpet, M. D., Ill. Extracts from the Anniversary Address of the Rev. Wm. WueEweELt before the Geological Society of London ? ’ ; ‘ . . > . -. IV. On the Polished Limestone of Rochester; by Prof. Cuerster DewrEy V. On the Temperature of exe Ontaifo: by Prof Cite TER Dewey, _ VI. On the Effects of Light Gur, — Wm M. Scayth. oA ADAS. : ‘QueRec, Samuel Neikon. oe = Bepham. ee E RMS. Ss las ee annum ; publihed in four Quarterly numbers, oak ing two vol- - om eigh s lor both tit to nine: = hundred. ae yaia Set whieh are fully. NG. 2 Of ene 7 — —— is not ofmere mittances may be made tironeh €s ot $10 are. converiient, 38 hey can be eredi ite 3 in ie ceotnt. Money remitted will in all eases be. No. of the Journal: ff nos ar paper is sits it may be pe that the e : taitfance has eek a very rare ereurrence,) Com AR = now 37 vols. ., até. furnished ata suitable discount. The tnal being greater, and the aor Taga. fase’ ssary one dollar mo re pe